eee0c9d4dd79666f288f6cc796f5b5ee4d27df47
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
878 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @value{GDBP} -p 1234
883 @end smallexample
884
885 @noindent
886 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
887 can omit the @var{program} filename.
888
889 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
890 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
891 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
892 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
893 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
894
895 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
896 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
897 option processing.
898 @smallexample
899 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
900 @end smallexample
901 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
902 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
903
904 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
905 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
906 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
907
908 @smallexample
909 @value{GDBP} --silent
910 @end smallexample
911
912 @noindent
913 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
914 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
915
916 @noindent
917 Type
918
919 @smallexample
920 @value{GDBP} -help
921 @end smallexample
922
923 @noindent
924 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
925 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
926
927 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
928 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
929 @samp{-x} option is used.
930
931
932 @menu
933 * File Options:: Choosing files
934 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
935 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
936 @end menu
937
938 @node File Options
939 @subsection Choosing Files
940
941 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
942 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
943 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
944 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
945 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
946 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
947 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
948 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
949 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
950 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
951 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
952 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
953 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
954
955 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
956 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
957 argument and ignore it.
958
959 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
960 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
961 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
962 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
963 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
964
965 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
966 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
967 @c it.
968
969 @table @code
970 @item -symbols @var{file}
971 @itemx -s @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--symbols}
973 @cindex @code{-s}
974 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
975
976 @item -exec @var{file}
977 @itemx -e @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--exec}
979 @cindex @code{-e}
980 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
981 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
982
983 @item -se @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--se}
985 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
986 file.
987
988 @item -core @var{file}
989 @itemx -c @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--core}
991 @cindex @code{-c}
992 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
993
994 @item -pid @var{number}
995 @itemx -p @var{number}
996 @cindex @code{--pid}
997 @cindex @code{-p}
998 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
999
1000 @item -command @var{file}
1001 @itemx -x @var{file}
1002 @cindex @code{--command}
1003 @cindex @code{-x}
1004 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1005 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1006 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1007
1008 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1009 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1010 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1011 @cindex @code{-ex}
1012 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1013
1014 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1015 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1016
1017 @smallexample
1018 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1019 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1020 @end smallexample
1021
1022 @item -init-command @var{file}
1023 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1024 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1025 @cindex @code{-ix}
1026 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1027 after loading gdbinit files).
1028 @xref{Startup}.
1029
1030 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1031 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1032 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1033 @cindex @code{-iex}
1034 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1035 after loading gdbinit files).
1036 @xref{Startup}.
1037
1038 @item -directory @var{directory}
1039 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1040 @cindex @code{--directory}
1041 @cindex @code{-d}
1042 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1043
1044 @item -r
1045 @itemx -readnow
1046 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1047 @cindex @code{-r}
1048 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1049 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1050 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1051
1052 @item --readnever
1053 @anchor{--readnever}
1054 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1055 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1056 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1057 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1058 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1059 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1060 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1061 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1062 @end table
1063
1064 @node Mode Options
1065 @subsection Choosing Modes
1066
1067 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1068 batch mode or quiet mode.
1069
1070 @table @code
1071 @anchor{-nx}
1072 @item -nx
1073 @itemx -n
1074 @cindex @code{--nx}
1075 @cindex @code{-n}
1076 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1077 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1078
1079 @table @code
1080 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1081 This is the system-wide init file.
1082 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1083 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1084 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1085 have been processed.
1086 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1087 This is the init file in your home directory.
1088 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1089 command options have been processed.
1090 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1091 This is the init file in the current directory.
1092 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1094 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1095 @end table
1096
1097 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1098 For documentation on how to write command files,
1099 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1100
1101 @anchor{-nh}
1102 @item -nh
1103 @cindex @code{--nh}
1104 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1105 in your home directory.
1106 @xref{Startup}.
1107
1108 @item -quiet
1109 @itemx -silent
1110 @itemx -q
1111 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1112 @cindex @code{--silent}
1113 @cindex @code{-q}
1114 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1115 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1116
1117 @item -batch
1118 @cindex @code{--batch}
1119 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1120 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1121 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1122 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1123 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1124 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1125 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1126
1127 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1128 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1129 make this more useful, the message
1130
1131 @smallexample
1132 Program exited normally.
1133 @end smallexample
1134
1135 @noindent
1136 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1137 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1138 mode.
1139
1140 @item -batch-silent
1141 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1142 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1143 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1144 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1145 for an interactive session.
1146
1147 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1148 messages, for example.
1149
1150 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1151 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1152
1153 @item -return-child-result
1154 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1155 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1156 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159 @item
1160 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1161 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1162 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1163 @item
1164 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1165 @item
1166 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1167 the exit code will be -1.
1168 @end itemize
1169
1170 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1171 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1172 interface.
1173
1174 @item -nowindows
1175 @itemx -nw
1176 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1177 @cindex @code{-nw}
1178 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1179 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1180 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1181
1182 @item -windows
1183 @itemx -w
1184 @cindex @code{--windows}
1185 @cindex @code{-w}
1186 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1187 used if possible.
1188
1189 @item -cd @var{directory}
1190 @cindex @code{--cd}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1192 instead of the current directory.
1193
1194 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1195 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1196 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1197 @cindex @code{-D}
1198 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1199 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1200 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1201
1202 @item -fullname
1203 @itemx -f
1204 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1205 @cindex @code{-f}
1206 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1207 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1208 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1209 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1210 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1211 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1212 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1213 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1214 frame.
1215
1216 @item -annotate @var{level}
1217 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1218 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1219 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1220 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1221 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1222 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1223 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1224 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1225 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1226
1227 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1228 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1229
1230 @item --args
1231 @cindex @code{--args}
1232 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1233 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1234 This option stops option processing.
1235
1236 @item -baud @var{bps}
1237 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1238 @cindex @code{--baud}
1239 @cindex @code{-b}
1240 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1241 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1242
1243 @item -l @var{timeout}
1244 @cindex @code{-l}
1245 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1246 for remote debugging.
1247
1248 @item -tty @var{device}
1249 @itemx -t @var{device}
1250 @cindex @code{--tty}
1251 @cindex @code{-t}
1252 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1253 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1254
1255 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1256 @item -tui
1257 @cindex @code{--tui}
1258 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1259 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1260 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1261 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1262 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1263 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1264
1265 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1266 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1267 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1268 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1269 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1270 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1271
1272 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1273 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1274 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1275 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1276 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1277 interfaces are no longer supported.
1278
1279 @item -write
1280 @cindex @code{--write}
1281 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1282 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1283 (@pxref{Patching}).
1284
1285 @item -statistics
1286 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1287 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1288 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1289
1290 @item -version
1291 @cindex @code{--version}
1292 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1293 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1294
1295 @item -configuration
1296 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1297 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1298 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1299 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1300
1301 @end table
1302
1303 @node Startup
1304 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1305 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1306
1307 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1308
1309 @enumerate
1310 @item
1311 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1312 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1313
1314 @item
1315 @cindex init file
1316 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1317 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1318 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1322 @item
1323 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1324 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1325 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1326 that file.
1327
1328 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1329 @item
1330 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1331 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1332 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1333 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1334 gets loaded.
1335
1336 @item
1337 Processes command line options and operands.
1338
1339 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1340 @item
1341 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1342 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1343 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1344 This is only done if the current directory is
1345 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1346 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1347 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1348 @value{GDBN}.
1349
1350 @item
1351 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1352 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1353 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1354 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1355
1356 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1357 you must do something like the following:
1358
1359 @smallexample
1360 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1361 @end smallexample
1362
1363 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1364 off too late.
1365
1366 @item
1367 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1368 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1369 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1370
1371 @item
1372 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1373 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1374 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1378 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1379 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1380 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1381 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1382 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1383
1384 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1385 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1386
1387 @cindex init file name
1388 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1389 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1390 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1391 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1392 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1393 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1394 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1395 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1396
1397
1398 @node Quitting GDB
1399 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1401 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1402
1403 @table @code
1404 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1405 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1406 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1407 @itemx q
1408 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1409 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1410 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1411 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1412 error code.
1413 @end table
1414
1415 @cindex interrupt
1416 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1417 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1418 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1419 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1420 until a time when it is safe.
1421
1422 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1423 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1424 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1425
1426 @node Shell Commands
1427 @section Shell Commands
1428
1429 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1430 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1431 just use the @code{shell} command.
1432
1433 @table @code
1434 @kindex shell
1435 @kindex !
1436 @cindex shell escape
1437 @item shell @var{command-string}
1438 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1439 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1440 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1441 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1442 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1443 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1444 @end table
1445
1446 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1447 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1448 @value{GDBN}:
1449
1450 @table @code
1451 @kindex make
1452 @cindex calling make
1453 @item make @var{make-args}
1454 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1455 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1456 @end table
1457
1458 @table @code
1459 @kindex pipe
1460 @kindex |
1461 @cindex send the output of a gdb command to a shell command
1462 @anchor{pipe}
1463 @item pipe [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1464 @itemx | [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1465 @itemx pipe -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1466 @itemx | -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1467 Executes @var{command} and sends its output to @var{shell_command}.
1468 Note that no space is needed around @code{|}.
1469 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is repeated.
1470
1471 In case the @var{command} contains a @code{|}, the option @code{-d @var{delim}}
1472 can be used to specify an alternate delimiter string @var{delim} that separates
1473 the @var{command} from the @var{shell_command}.
1474
1475 Example:
1476 @smallexample
1477 @group
1478 (gdb) p var
1479 $1 = @{
1480 black = 144,
1481 red = 233,
1482 green = 377,
1483 blue = 610,
1484 white = 987
1485 @}
1486 @end group
1487 @group
1488 (gdb) pipe p var|wc
1489 7 19 80
1490 (gdb) |p var|wc -l
1491 7
1492 @end group
1493 @group
1494 (gdb) p /x var
1495 $4 = @{
1496 black = 0x90,
1497 red = 0xe9,
1498 green = 0x179,
1499 blue = 0x262,
1500 white = 0x3db
1501 @}
1502 (gdb) ||grep red
1503 red => 0xe9,
1504 @end group
1505 @group
1506 (gdb) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1507 this contains a PIPE char
1508 (gdb) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1509 this contains a PIPE char!
1510 (gdb)
1511 @end group
1512 @end smallexample
1513 @end table
1514
1515 The convenience variables @code{$_shell_exitcode} and @code{$_shell_exitsignal}
1516 can be used to examine the exit status of the last shell command launched
1517 by @code{shell}, @code{make}, @code{pipe} and @code{|}.
1518 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}.
1519
1520 @node Logging Output
1521 @section Logging Output
1522 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1523 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1524
1525 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1526 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1527
1528 @table @code
1529 @kindex set logging
1530 @item set logging on
1531 Enable logging.
1532 @item set logging off
1533 Disable logging.
1534 @cindex logging file name
1535 @item set logging file @var{file}
1536 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1537 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1538 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1539 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1540 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1541 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1542 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1543 @item set logging debugredirect [on|off]
1544 By default, @value{GDBN} debug output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1545 Set @code{debugredirect} if you want debug output to go only to the log file.
1546 @kindex show logging
1547 @item show logging
1548 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1549 @end table
1550
1551 You can also redirect the output of a @value{GDBN} command to a
1552 shell command. @xref{pipe}.
1553 @node Commands
1554 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1555
1556 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1557 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1558 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1559 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1560 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1561
1562 @menu
1563 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1564 * Command Settings:: How to change default behavior of commands
1565 * Completion:: Command completion
1566 * Command Options:: Command options
1567 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1568 @end menu
1569
1570 @node Command Syntax
1571 @section Command Syntax
1572
1573 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1574 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1575 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1576 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1577 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1578 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1579
1580 @cindex abbreviation
1581 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1582 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1583 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1584 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1585 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1586 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1587 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1588
1589 @cindex repeating commands
1590 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1591 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1592 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1593 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1594 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1595 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1596 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1597
1598 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1599 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1600 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1601
1602 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1603 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1604 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1605 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1606 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1607
1608 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1609 @cindex comment
1610 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1611 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1612 Files,,Command Files}).
1613
1614 @cindex repeating command sequences
1615 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1616 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1617 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1618 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1619 for editing.
1620
1621
1622 @node Command Settings
1623 @section Command Settings
1624 @cindex default behavior of commands, changing
1625 @cindex default settings, changing
1626
1627 Many commands change their behavior according to command-specific
1628 variables or settings. These settings can be changed with the
1629 @code{set} subcommands. For example, the @code{print} command
1630 (@pxref{Data, ,Examining Data}) prints arrays differently depending on
1631 settings changeable with the commands @code{set print elements
1632 NUMBER-OF-ELEMENTS} and @code{set print array-indexes}, among others.
1633
1634 You can change these settings to your preference in the gdbinit files
1635 loaded at @value{GDBN} startup. @xref{Startup}.
1636
1637 The settings can also be changed interactively during the debugging
1638 session. For example, to change the limit of array elements to print,
1639 you can do the following:
1640 @smallexample
1641 (@value{GDBN}) set print elements 10
1642 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1643 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 The above @code{set print elements 10} command changes the number of
1647 elements to print from the default of 200 to 10. If you only intend
1648 this limit of 10 to be used for printing @code{some_array}, then you
1649 must restore the limit back to 200, with @code{set print elements
1650 200}.
1651
1652 Some commands allow overriding settings with command options. For
1653 example, the @code{print} command supports a number of options that
1654 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
1655 print} subcommands. @xref{print options}. The example above could be
1656 rewritten as:
1657 @smallexample
1658 (@value{GDBN}) print -elements 10 -- some_array
1659 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1660 @end smallexample
1661
1662 Alternatively, you can use the @code{with} command to change a setting
1663 temporarily, for the duration of a command invocation.
1664
1665 @table @code
1666 @kindex with command
1667 @kindex w @r{(@code{with})}
1668 @cindex settings
1669 @cindex temporarily change settings
1670 @item with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1671 @itemx w @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1672 Temporarily set @var{setting} to @var{value} for the duration of
1673 @var{command}.
1674
1675 @var{setting} is any setting you can change with the @code{set}
1676 subcommands. @var{value} is the value to assign to @code{setting}
1677 while running @code{command}.
1678
1679 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is
1680 repeated.
1681
1682 If a @var{command} is provided, it must be preceded by a double dash
1683 (@code{--}) separator. This is required because some settings accept
1684 free-form arguments, such as expressions or filenames.
1685
1686 For example, the command
1687 @smallexample
1688 (@value{GDBN}) with print array on -- print some_array
1689 @end smallexample
1690 @noindent
1691 is equivalent to the following 3 commands:
1692 @smallexample
1693 (@value{GDBN}) set print array on
1694 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1695 (@value{GDBN}) set print array off
1696 @end smallexample
1697
1698 The @code{with} command is particularly useful when you want to
1699 override a setting while running user-defined commands, or commands
1700 defined in Python or Guile. @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
1701
1702 @smallexample
1703 (@value{GDBN}) with print pretty on -- my_complex_command
1704 @end smallexample
1705
1706 To change several settings for the same command, you can nest
1707 @code{with} commands. For example, @code{with language ada -- with
1708 print elements 10} temporarily changes the language to Ada and sets a
1709 limit of 10 elements to print for arrays and strings.
1710
1711 @end table
1712
1713 @node Completion
1714 @section Command Completion
1715
1716 @cindex completion
1717 @cindex word completion
1718 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1719 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1720 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1721 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, command options, and the names of symbols
1722 in your program.
1723
1724 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1725 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1726 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1727 enter it). For example, if you type
1728
1729 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1730 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1731 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1732 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1733 @smallexample
1734 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1739 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1740
1741 @smallexample
1742 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1743 @end smallexample
1744
1745 @noindent
1746 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1747 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1748 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1749 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1750 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1751 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1752
1753 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1754 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1755 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1756 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1757 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1758 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1759 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1760 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1761 example:
1762
1763 @smallexample
1764 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1765 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1766 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1767 make_abs_section make_function_type
1768 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1769 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1770 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1771 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1772 @end smallexample
1773
1774 @noindent
1775 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1776 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1777 command.
1778
1779 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1780 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1781 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1782 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1783 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1784
1785 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1786 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1787 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1788
1789 @smallexample
1790 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1791 main
1792 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1793 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1794 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1799
1800 @table @code
1801 @kindex set max-completions
1802 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1803 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1804 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1805 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1806 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1807 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1808 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1809 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1810 completion slow.
1811 @kindex show max-completions
1812 @item show max-completions
1813 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1814 during completion.
1815 @end table
1816
1817 @cindex quotes in commands
1818 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1819 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1820 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1821 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1822 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1823 @value{GDBN} commands.
1824
1825 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1826 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1827 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1828 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1829 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1830 Operators}).
1831
1832 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1833 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1834 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1835 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1836 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1837 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1838 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1839 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1840 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1841
1842 @smallexample
1843 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1844 func<int>() func<float>()
1845 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1846 @end smallexample
1847
1848 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1849 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1850 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1851 function:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1855 func<int>() func<float>()
1856 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1857 @end smallexample
1858
1859 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1860 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1861 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1862 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1863 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1864 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1865
1866 @smallexample
1867 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1868 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1869 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1870 bubble(double)
1871 @end smallexample
1872
1873 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1874 require quoting.
1875
1876 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1877 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1878 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1879 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1880
1881 @cindex completion of structure field names
1882 @cindex structure field name completion
1883 @cindex completion of union field names
1884 @cindex union field name completion
1885 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1886 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1887 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1888 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1889 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1890 left-hand-side:
1891
1892 @smallexample
1893 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1894 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1895 to_data to_isatty to_write
1896 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1897 to_flush to_read
1898 @end smallexample
1899
1900 @noindent
1901 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1902 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1903 follows:
1904
1905 @smallexample
1906 struct ui_file
1907 @{
1908 int *magic;
1909 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1910 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1911 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1912 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1913 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1914 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1915 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1916 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1917 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1918 void *to_data;
1919 @}
1920 @end smallexample
1921
1922 @node Command Options
1923 @section Command options
1924
1925 @cindex command options
1926 Some commands accept options starting with a leading dash. For
1927 example, @code{print -pretty}. Similarly to command names, you can
1928 abbreviate a @value{GDBN} option to the first few letters of the
1929 option name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous, and you can also use
1930 the @key{TAB} key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word
1931 in an option (or to show you the alternatives available, if there is
1932 more than one possibility).
1933
1934 @cindex command options, raw input
1935 Some commands take raw input as argument. For example, the print
1936 command processes arbitrary expressions in any of the languages
1937 supported by @value{GDBN}. With such commands, because raw input may
1938 start with a leading dash that would be confused with an option or any
1939 of its abbreviations, e.g.@: @code{print -r} (short for @code{print
1940 -raw} or printing negative @code{r}?), if you specify any command
1941 option, then you must use a double-dash (@code{--}) delimiter to
1942 indicate the end of options.
1943
1944 @cindex command options, boolean
1945
1946 Some options are described as accepting an argument which can be
1947 either @code{on} or @code{off}. These are known as @dfn{boolean
1948 options}. Similarly to boolean settings commands---@code{on} and
1949 @code{off} are the typical values, but any of @code{1}, @code{yes} and
1950 @code{enable} can also be used as ``true'' value, and any of @code{0},
1951 @code{no} and @code{disable} can also be used as ``false'' value. You
1952 can also omit a ``true'' value, as it is implied by default.
1953
1954 For example, these are equivalent:
1955
1956 @smallexample
1957 (@value{GDBP}) print -object on -pretty off -element unlimited -- *myptr
1958 (@value{GDBP}) p -o -p 0 -e u -- *myptr
1959 @end smallexample
1960
1961 You can discover the set of options some command accepts by completing
1962 on @code{-} after the command name. For example:
1963
1964 @smallexample
1965 (@value{GDBP}) print -@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1966 -address -max-depth -repeats -vtbl
1967 -array -null-stop -static-members
1968 -array-indexes -object -symbol
1969 -elements -pretty -union
1970 @end smallexample
1971
1972 Completion will in some cases guide you with a suggestion of what kind
1973 of argument an option expects. For example:
1974
1975 @smallexample
1976 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1977 NUMBER unlimited
1978 @end smallexample
1979
1980 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
1981 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
1982 uppercase.
1983
1984 (For more on using the @code{print} command, see @ref{Data, ,Examining
1985 Data}.)
1986
1987 @node Help
1988 @section Getting Help
1989 @cindex online documentation
1990 @kindex help
1991
1992 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1993 using the command @code{help}.
1994
1995 @table @code
1996 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1997 @item help
1998 @itemx h
1999 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
2000 display a short list of named classes of commands:
2001
2002 @smallexample
2003 (@value{GDBP}) help
2004 List of classes of commands:
2005
2006 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2007 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2008 data -- Examining data
2009 files -- Specifying and examining files
2010 internals -- Maintenance commands
2011 obscure -- Obscure features
2012 running -- Running the program
2013 stack -- Examining the stack
2014 status -- Status inquiries
2015 support -- Support facilities
2016 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
2017 stopping the program
2018 user-defined -- User-defined commands
2019
2020 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
2021 commands in that class.
2022 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2023 documentation.
2024 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2025 (@value{GDBP})
2026 @end smallexample
2027 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
2028
2029 @item help @var{class}
2030 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
2031 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
2032 help display for the class @code{status}:
2033
2034 @smallexample
2035 (@value{GDBP}) help status
2036 Status inquiries.
2037
2038 List of commands:
2039
2040 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
2041 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
2042 info -- Generic command for showing things
2043 about the program being debugged
2044 show -- Generic command for showing things
2045 about the debugger
2046
2047 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2048 documentation.
2049 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2050 (@value{GDBP})
2051 @end smallexample
2052
2053 @item help @var{command}
2054 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
2055 short paragraph on how to use that command.
2056
2057 @kindex apropos
2058 @item apropos [-v] @var{regexp}
2059 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
2060 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
2061 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. The optional flag @samp{-v},
2062 which stands for @samp{verbose}, indicates to output the full documentation
2063 of the matching commands and highlight the parts of the documentation
2064 matching @var{regexp}. For example:
2065
2066 @smallexample
2067 apropos alias
2068 @end smallexample
2069
2070 @noindent
2071 results in:
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 @group
2075 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
2076 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2077 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2078 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2079 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2080 @end group
2081 @end smallexample
2082
2083 @noindent
2084 while
2085
2086 @smallexample
2087 apropos -v cut.*thread apply
2088 @end smallexample
2089
2090 @noindent
2091 results in the below output, where @samp{cut for 'thread apply}
2092 is highlighted if styling is enabled.
2093
2094 @smallexample
2095 @group
2096 taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
2097 and empty output).
2098 Usage: taas COMMAND
2099 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s COMMAND'
2100
2101 tfaas -- Apply a command to all frames of all threads
2102 (ignoring errors and empty output).
2103 Usage: tfaas COMMAND
2104 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s frame apply all -s COMMAND'
2105 @end group
2106 @end smallexample
2107
2108 @kindex complete
2109 @item complete @var{args}
2110 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
2111 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
2112 command you want completed. For example:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 complete i
2116 @end smallexample
2117
2118 @noindent results in:
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 @group
2122 if
2123 ignore
2124 info
2125 inspect
2126 @end group
2127 @end smallexample
2128
2129 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
2130 @end table
2131
2132 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
2133 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
2134 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
2135 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
2136 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
2137 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
2138 Index}.
2139
2140 @c @group
2141 @table @code
2142 @kindex info
2143 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
2144 @item info
2145 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
2146 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
2147 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
2148 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
2149 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
2150 @w{@code{help info}}.
2151
2152 @kindex set
2153 @item set
2154 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
2155 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
2156 @code{set prompt $}.
2157
2158 @kindex show
2159 @item show
2160 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
2161 @value{GDBN} itself.
2162 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
2163 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
2164 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
2165 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
2166
2167 @kindex info set
2168 To display all the settable parameters and their current
2169 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
2170 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
2171 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
2172 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
2173 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
2174 @end table
2175 @c @end group
2176
2177 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
2178 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
2179
2180 @table @code
2181 @kindex show version
2182 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
2183 @item show version
2184 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2185 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
2186 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
2187 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
2188 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
2189 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
2190 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2191 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
2192 @value{GDBN}.
2193
2194 @kindex show copying
2195 @kindex info copying
2196 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
2197 @item show copying
2198 @itemx info copying
2199 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
2200
2201 @kindex show warranty
2202 @kindex info warranty
2203 @item show warranty
2204 @itemx info warranty
2205 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
2206 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2207
2208 @kindex show configuration
2209 @item show configuration
2210 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
2211 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
2212 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
2213 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
2214 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
2215 your report.
2216
2217 @end table
2218
2219 @node Running
2220 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
2221
2222 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
2223 debugging information when you compile it.
2224
2225 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
2226 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
2227 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
2228 kill a child process.
2229
2230 @menu
2231 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
2232 * Starting:: Starting your program
2233 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
2234 * Environment:: Your program's environment
2235
2236 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
2237 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
2238 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
2239 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
2240
2241 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
2242 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
2243 * Forks:: Debugging forks
2244 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2245 @end menu
2246
2247 @node Compilation
2248 @section Compiling for Debugging
2249
2250 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
2251 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
2252 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
2253 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
2254 and addresses in the executable code.
2255
2256 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2257 the compiler.
2258
2259 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2260 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2261 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2262 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2263 executables containing debugging information.
2264
2265 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2266 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2267 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2268 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2269 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2270
2271 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2272 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2273 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2274
2275 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2276 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2277 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2278 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2279 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2280 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2281
2282 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2283 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2284 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2285
2286 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2287 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2288 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2289 format in @value{GDBN}.
2290
2291 @need 2000
2292 @node Starting
2293 @section Starting your Program
2294 @cindex starting
2295 @cindex running
2296
2297 @table @code
2298 @kindex run
2299 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2300 @item run
2301 @itemx r
2302 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2303 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2304 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2305 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2306 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2307
2308 @end table
2309
2310 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2311 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2312 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2313 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2314 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2315 message like this one:
2316
2317 @smallexample
2318 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2319 Try "help target" or "continue".
2320 @end smallexample
2321
2322 @noindent
2323 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2324 first (@pxref{load}).
2325
2326 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2327 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2328 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2329 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2330 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2331 divided into four categories:
2332
2333 @table @asis
2334 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2335 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2336 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2337 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2338 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2339 the arguments.
2340 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2341 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2342 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2343 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2344 below for details).
2345
2346 @item The @emph{environment.}
2347 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2348 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2349 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2350 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2351
2352 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2353 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2354 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2355 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2356 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2357 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2358 Directory}.
2359
2360 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2361 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2362 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2363 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2364 set a different device for your program.
2365 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2366
2367 @cindex pipes
2368 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2369 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2370 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2371 wrong program.
2372 @end table
2373
2374 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2375 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2376 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2377 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2378 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2379
2380 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2381 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2382 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2383 your current breakpoints.
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex start
2387 @item start
2388 @cindex run to main procedure
2389 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2390 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2391 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2392 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2393 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2394 procedure, depending on the language used.
2395
2396 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2397 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2398 the @samp{run} command.
2399
2400 @cindex elaboration phase
2401 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2402 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2403 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2404 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2405 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2406 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2407 will remain to halt execution.
2408
2409 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2410 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2411 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2412 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2413 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2414
2415 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2416 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2417 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2418 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2419 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2420 use the @code{starti} command.
2421
2422 @kindex starti
2423 @item starti
2424 @cindex run to first instruction
2425 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2426 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2427 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2428 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2429 the start of the elaboration phase.
2430
2431 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2432 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2433 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2434 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2435 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2436 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2437 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2438 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2439 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2440 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2441 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2442 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2443
2444 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2445 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2446 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2447 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2448
2449 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2450 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2451 environment:
2452
2453 @smallexample
2454 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2455 (@value{GDBP}) run
2456 @end smallexample
2457
2458 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2459 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2460
2461 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2462 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2463 @item set startup-with-shell
2464 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2465 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2466 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2467 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2468 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2469 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2470 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2471 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2472 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2473 startup failures such as:
2474
2475 @smallexample
2476 (@value{GDBP}) run
2477 Starting program: ./a.out
2478 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2483 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2484 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2485 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2486 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2487 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2488
2489 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2490 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2491 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2492 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2493 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2494 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2495
2496 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2497 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2498 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2499 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2500 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2501 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2502
2503 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2504 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2505 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2506
2507 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2508 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2509
2510 @smallexample
2511 (@value{GDBP}) run
2512 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2513 @end smallexample
2514
2515 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2516 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2517
2518 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2519 @code{target native} command. For example,
2520
2521 @smallexample
2522 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2523 (@value{GDBP}) run
2524 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2525 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2526 (@value{GDBP}) run
2527 Starting program: ./a.out
2528 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2529 @end smallexample
2530
2531 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2532 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2533 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2534 disconnect.
2535
2536 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2537 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2538 proc}, @code{info os}.
2539
2540 @kindex set disable-randomization
2541 @item set disable-randomization
2542 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2543 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2544 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2545 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2546 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2547
2548 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2549 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2550
2551 @smallexample
2552 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2553 @end smallexample
2554
2555 @item set disable-randomization off
2556 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2557 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2558 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2559 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2560 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2561 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2562
2563 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2564 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2565 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2566 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2567 a code at its expected addresses.
2568
2569 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2570 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2571 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2572 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2573 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2574 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2575 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2576 a randomly chosen address.
2577
2578 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2579 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2580 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2581 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2582 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2583
2584 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2585 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2586
2587 @item show disable-randomization
2588 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2589 the virtual address space of the started program.
2590
2591 @end table
2592
2593 @node Arguments
2594 @section Your Program's Arguments
2595
2596 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2597 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2598 @code{run} command.
2599 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2600 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2601 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2602 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2603 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2604
2605 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2606 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2607 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2608 the program, not by the shell.
2609
2610 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2611 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2612
2613 @table @code
2614 @kindex set args
2615 @item set args
2616 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2617 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2618 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2619 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2620 it again without arguments.
2621
2622 @kindex show args
2623 @item show args
2624 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 @node Environment
2628 @section Your Program's Environment
2629
2630 @cindex environment (of your program)
2631 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2632 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2633 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2634 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2635 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2636 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2637 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2638
2639 @table @code
2640 @kindex path
2641 @item path @var{directory}
2642 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2643 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2644 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2645 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2646 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2647 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2648 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2649
2650 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2651 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2652 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2653 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2654 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2655 @var{directory} to the search path.
2656 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2657 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2658
2659 @kindex show paths
2660 @item show paths
2661 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2662 environment variable).
2663
2664 @kindex show environment
2665 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2666 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2667 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2668 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2669 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2670
2671 @kindex set environment
2672 @anchor{set environment}
2673 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2674 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2675 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2676 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2677 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2678 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2679 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2680 null value.
2681 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2682 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2683
2684 For example, this command:
2685
2686 @smallexample
2687 set env USER = foo
2688 @end smallexample
2689
2690 @noindent
2691 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2692 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2693 are not actually required.)
2694
2695 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2696 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2697 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2698 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2699 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2700
2701 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2702 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2703 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2704
2705 @kindex unset environment
2706 @anchor{unset environment}
2707 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2708 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2709 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2710 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2711 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2712
2713 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2714 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2715 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2716 @end table
2717
2718 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2719 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2720 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2721 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2722 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2723 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2724 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2725 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2726 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2727 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2728
2729 @node Working Directory
2730 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2731
2732 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2733 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2734 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2735 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2736 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2737 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2738 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2739 debugging.
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex set cwd
2743 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2744 @anchor{set cwd command}
2745 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2746 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2747 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2748 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2749 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2750 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2751 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2752 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2753 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2754 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2755 fallback.
2756
2757 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2758 the @code{cd} command.
2759 @xref{cd command}.
2760
2761 @kindex show cwd
2762 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2763 @item show cwd
2764 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2765 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2766 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2767
2768 @kindex cd
2769 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2770 @anchor{cd command}
2771 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2772 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2773 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2774
2775 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2776 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2777 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2778 @xref{set cwd command}.
2779
2780 @kindex pwd
2781 @item pwd
2782 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2783 @end table
2784
2785 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2786 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2787 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2788 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2789 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2790 current working directory of the debuggee.
2791
2792 @node Input/Output
2793 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2794
2795 @cindex redirection
2796 @cindex i/o
2797 @cindex terminal
2798 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2799 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2800 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2801 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2802 running your program.
2803
2804 @table @code
2805 @kindex info terminal
2806 @item info terminal
2807 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2808 program is using.
2809 @end table
2810
2811 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2812 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2813
2814 @smallexample
2815 run > outfile
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 @noindent
2819 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2820
2821 @kindex tty
2822 @cindex controlling terminal
2823 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2824 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2825 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2826 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2827 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 tty /dev/ttyb
2831 @end smallexample
2832
2833 @noindent
2834 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2835 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2836 that as their controlling terminal.
2837
2838 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2839 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2840 terminal.
2841
2842 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2843 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2844 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2845 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2846
2847 @cindex inferior tty
2848 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2849 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2850 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2851 program.
2852
2853 @table @code
2854 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2855 @kindex set inferior-tty
2856 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2857 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2858 @value{GDBN}.
2859
2860 @item show inferior-tty
2861 @kindex show inferior-tty
2862 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2863 @end table
2864
2865 @node Attach
2866 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2867 @kindex attach
2868 @cindex attach
2869
2870 @table @code
2871 @item attach @var{process-id}
2872 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2873 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2874 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2875 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2876 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2877
2878 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2879 executing the command.
2880 @end table
2881
2882 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2883 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2884 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2885 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2886
2887 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2888 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2889 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2890 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2891 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2892 Specify Files}.
2893
2894 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2895 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2896 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2897 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2898 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2899 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2900 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @kindex detach
2904 @item detach
2905 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2906 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2907 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2908 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2909 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2910 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2911 executing the command.
2912 @end table
2913
2914 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2915 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2916 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2917 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2918 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2919 Messages}).
2920
2921 @node Kill Process
2922 @section Killing the Child Process
2923
2924 @table @code
2925 @kindex kill
2926 @item kill
2927 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2928 @end table
2929
2930 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2931 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2932 is running.
2933
2934 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2935 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2936 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2937 outside the debugger.
2938
2939 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2940 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2941 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2942 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2943 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2944 breakpoint settings).
2945
2946 @node Inferiors and Programs
2947 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2948
2949 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2950 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2951 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2952 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2953 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2954 from multiple executables.
2955
2956 @cindex inferior
2957 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2958 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2959 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2960 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2961 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2962 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2963 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2964 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2965 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2966 threads running in it.
2967
2968 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2969 inferiors}}:
2970
2971 @table @code
2972 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2973 @item info inferiors
2974 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2975 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2976 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2977 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2978
2979 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2980
2981 @enumerate
2982 @item
2983 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2984
2985 @item
2986 the target system's inferior identifier
2987
2988 @item
2989 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2990
2991 @end enumerate
2992
2993 @noindent
2994 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2995 indicates the current inferior.
2996
2997 For example,
2998 @end table
2999 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3000
3001 @smallexample
3002 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3003 Num Description Executable
3004 2 process 2307 hello
3005 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
3006 @end smallexample
3007
3008 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
3009
3010 @table @code
3011 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
3012 @item inferior @var{infno}
3013 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
3014 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
3015 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
3016 @end table
3017
3018 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
3019 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
3020 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
3021 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
3022 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3023 information on convenience variables.
3024
3025 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
3026 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
3027 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
3028 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
3029 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
3030 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
3031
3032 @table @code
3033 @kindex add-inferior
3034 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
3035 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
3036 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
3037 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
3038 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
3039 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
3040
3041 @kindex clone-inferior
3042 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
3043 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
3044 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
3045 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
3046 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
3047
3048 @smallexample
3049 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3050 Num Description Executable
3051 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3052 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
3053 Added inferior 2.
3054 1 inferiors added.
3055 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3056 Num Description Executable
3057 2 <null> helloworld
3058 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3059 @end smallexample
3060
3061 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
3062
3063 @kindex remove-inferiors
3064 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3065 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
3066 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
3067 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
3068
3069 @end table
3070
3071 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
3072 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
3073 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
3074 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
3075
3076 @table @code
3077 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3078 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
3079 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
3080 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
3081 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
3082 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3083
3084 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3085 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3086 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
3087 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
3088 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
3089 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3090 @end table
3091
3092 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
3093 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
3094 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
3095 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
3096
3097
3098 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
3099 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
3100
3101 @table @code
3102 @kindex set print inferior-events
3103 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
3104 @item set print inferior-events
3105 @itemx set print inferior-events on
3106 @itemx set print inferior-events off
3107 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
3108 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
3109 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
3110 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
3111
3112 @kindex show print inferior-events
3113 @item show print inferior-events
3114 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
3115 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
3116 @end table
3117
3118 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
3119 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
3120 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
3121
3122
3123 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
3124 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
3125 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
3126 info program-spaces}} command.
3127
3128 @table @code
3129 @kindex maint info program-spaces
3130 @item maint info program-spaces
3131 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
3132 @value{GDBN}.
3133
3134 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
3135
3136 @enumerate
3137 @item
3138 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3139
3140 @item
3141 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3142 the @code{file} command.
3143
3144 @end enumerate
3145
3146 @noindent
3147 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
3148 indicates the current program space.
3149
3150 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
3151 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
3152 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
3153
3154 @smallexample
3155 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3156 Id Executable
3157 * 1 hello
3158 2 goodbye
3159 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
3163 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
3164 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
3165 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
3166 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3170 Id Executable
3171 * 1 vfork-test
3172 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
3176 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
3177 @end table
3178
3179 @node Threads
3180 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
3181
3182 @cindex threads of execution
3183 @cindex multiple threads
3184 @cindex switching threads
3185 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
3186 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
3187 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
3188 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
3189 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
3190 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
3191 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
3192
3193 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
3194 programs:
3195
3196 @itemize @bullet
3197 @item automatic notification of new threads
3198 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
3199 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
3200 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
3201 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
3202 @item thread-specific breakpoints
3203 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
3204 messages on thread start and exit.
3205 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
3206 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
3207 isn't compatible with the program.
3208 @end itemize
3209
3210 @cindex focus of debugging
3211 @cindex current thread
3212 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
3213 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
3214 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
3215 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
3216 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
3217
3218 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
3219 @cindex thread identifier (system)
3220 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
3221 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
3222 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
3223 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
3224 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
3225 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
3226 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
3227 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
3228
3229 @smallexample
3230 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
3231 @end smallexample
3232
3233 @noindent
3234 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
3235 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
3236 further qualifier.
3237
3238 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
3239 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
3240 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
3241 @c program?
3242 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
3243 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
3244 @c threads ab initio?
3245
3246 @anchor{thread numbers}
3247 @cindex thread number, per inferior
3248 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
3249 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
3250 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
3251 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
3252 between threads of different inferiors.
3253
3254 @cindex qualified thread ID
3255 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3256 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3257 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3258 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3259 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3260 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3261 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3262 inferior.
3263
3264 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3265 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3266 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3267 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3268
3269 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3270 @cindex thread ID lists
3271 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3272 argument. A list element can be:
3273
3274 @enumerate
3275 @item
3276 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3277 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3278 @samp{1}.
3279
3280 @item
3281 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3282 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3283 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3284
3285 @item
3286 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3287 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3288 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3289 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3290 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3291
3292 @end enumerate
3293
3294 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3295 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3296 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3297 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3298 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3299 7.1}.
3300
3301
3302 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3303 @cindex global thread number
3304 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3305 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3306 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3307 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3308 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3309 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3310
3311 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3312 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3313 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3314
3315 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3316 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3317 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3318 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3319 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3320 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3321 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3322 general information on convenience variables.
3323
3324 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3325 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3326 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3327
3328 @smallexample
3329 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3330 @end smallexample
3331
3332 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3333
3334 @smallexample
3335 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3336 @end smallexample
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @kindex info threads
3340 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3341
3342 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3343 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3344 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3345 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3346
3347 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3348
3349 @enumerate
3350 @item
3351 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3352
3353 @item
3354 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3355 option was specified
3356
3357 @item
3358 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3359
3360 @item
3361 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3362 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3363 program itself.
3364
3365 @item
3366 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3367 @end enumerate
3368
3369 @noindent
3370 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3371 indicates the current thread.
3372
3373 For example,
3374 @end table
3375 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3376
3377 @smallexample
3378 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3379 Id Target Id Frame
3380 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3381 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3382 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3383 at threadtest.c:68
3384 @end smallexample
3385
3386 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3387 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3388 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3389
3390 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3391 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3392
3393 @smallexample
3394 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3395 Id GId Target Id Frame
3396 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3397 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3398 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3399 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3400 @end smallexample
3401
3402 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3403 Solaris-specific command:
3404
3405 @table @code
3406 @item maint info sol-threads
3407 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3408 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3409 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @table @code
3413 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3414 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3415 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3416 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3417 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3418 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3419
3420 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3421 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3422
3423 @smallexample
3424 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3425 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3426 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3427 8 printf ("hello\n");
3428 @end smallexample
3429
3430 @noindent
3431 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3432 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3433 threads.
3434
3435 @anchor{thread apply all}
3436 @kindex thread apply
3437 @cindex apply command to several threads
3438 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3439 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3440 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3441 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3442 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3443 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3444 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3445 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3446
3447 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3448 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3449 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3450 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3451 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3452
3453 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3454 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3455 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3456 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3457
3458 @table @code
3459 @item -c
3460 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3461 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3462 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3463 @item -s
3464 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3465 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3466 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3467 are not printed.
3468 @item -q
3469 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3470 information.
3471 @end table
3472
3473 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3474
3475 @kindex taas
3476 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3477 @item taas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3478 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3479 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3480
3481 The @code{taas} command accepts the same options as the @code{thread
3482 apply all} command. @xref{thread apply all}.
3483
3484 @kindex tfaas
3485 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3486 @item tfaas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3487 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s -- frame apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3488 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3489 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3490 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3491 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3492 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3493 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3494 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3495
3496 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3497 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3498 is, using:
3499 @smallexample
3500 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3501 @end smallexample
3502
3503 The @code{tfaas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
3504 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
3505
3506 @kindex thread name
3507 @cindex name a thread
3508 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3509 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3510 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3511 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3512
3513 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3514 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3515 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3516 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3517 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3518
3519 @kindex thread find
3520 @cindex search for a thread
3521 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3522 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3523 matches the supplied regular expression.
3524
3525 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3526 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3527 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3528 is the LWP id.
3529
3530 @smallexample
3531 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3532 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3533 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3534 Id Target Id Frame
3535 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3536 @end smallexample
3537
3538 @kindex set print thread-events
3539 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3540 @item set print thread-events
3541 @itemx set print thread-events on
3542 @itemx set print thread-events off
3543 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3544 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3545 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3546 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3547 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3548
3549 @kindex show print thread-events
3550 @item show print thread-events
3551 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3552 have started and exited.
3553 @end table
3554
3555 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3556 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3557 programs with multiple threads.
3558
3559 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3560 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3561
3562 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3563 @table @code
3564 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3565 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3566 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3567 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3568 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3569 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3570 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3571 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3572 macro.
3573
3574 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3575 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3576 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3577 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3578 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3579 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3580
3581 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3582 refers to the default system directories that are
3583 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3584 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3585 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3586
3587 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3588 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3589 was loaded in the inferior process.
3590
3591 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3592 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3593 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3594 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3595 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3596 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3597 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3598
3599 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3600 only on some platforms.
3601
3602 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3603 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3604 Display current libthread_db search path.
3605
3606 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3607 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3608 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3609 @item set debug libthread-db
3610 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3611 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3612 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 @node Forks
3616 @section Debugging Forks
3617
3618 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3619 @cindex multiple processes
3620 @cindex processes, multiple
3621 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3622 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3623 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3624 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3625 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3626 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3627 will cause it to terminate.
3628
3629 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3630 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3631 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3632 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3633 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3634 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3635 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3636 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3637 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3638 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3639
3640 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3641 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3642 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3643 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3644
3645 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3646 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3647 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3648
3649 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3650 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3651
3652 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3653 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3657 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3658 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3659 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3660 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @item parent
3664 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3665 unimpeded. This is the default.
3666
3667 @item child
3668 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3669 unimpeded.
3670
3671 @end table
3672
3673 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3674 @item show follow-fork-mode
3675 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3679 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3680 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3681
3682 @table @code
3683 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3684 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3685 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3686 retain debugger control over them both.
3687
3688 @table @code
3689 @item on
3690 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3691 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3692 independently. This is the default.
3693
3694 @item off
3695 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3696 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3697 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3698 is held suspended.
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3703 @item show detach-on-fork
3704 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3705 @end table
3706
3707 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3708 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3709 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3710 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3711 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3712 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3713
3714 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3715 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3716 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3717 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3718 and Programs}.
3719
3720 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3721 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3722 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3723 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3724 the child process's @code{main}.
3725
3726 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3727 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3728
3729 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3730 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3731 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3732 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3733 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3734 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3735 command.
3736
3737 @table @code
3738 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3739 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3740
3741 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3742 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3743
3744 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3745
3746 @table @code
3747 @item new
3748 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3749 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3750 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3751 original inferior.
3752
3753 For example:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3757 (gdb) info inferior
3758 Id Description Executable
3759 * 1 <null> prog1
3760 (@value{GDBP}) run
3761 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3762 Program exited normally.
3763 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3764 Id Description Executable
3765 1 <null> prog1
3766 * 2 <null> prog2
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @item same
3770 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3771 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3772 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3773 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3774 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3775
3776 For example:
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3780 Id Description Executable
3781 * 1 <null> prog1
3782 (@value{GDBP}) run
3783 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3784 Program exited normally.
3785 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3786 Id Description Executable
3787 * 1 <null> prog2
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 @end table
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3794 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3795
3796 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3797 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3798 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3799
3800 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3801 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3802
3803 @cindex checkpoint
3804 @cindex restart
3805 @cindex bookmark
3806 @cindex snapshot of a process
3807 @cindex rewind program state
3808
3809 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3810 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3811 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3812 later.
3813
3814 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3815 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3816 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3817 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3818 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3819
3820 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3821 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3822 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3823 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3824 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3825 start again from there.
3826
3827 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3828 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3829
3830 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3831
3832 @table @code
3833 @kindex checkpoint
3834 @item checkpoint
3835 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3836 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3837 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3838
3839 @kindex info checkpoints
3840 @item info checkpoints
3841 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3842 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3843 listed:
3844
3845 @table @code
3846 @item Checkpoint ID
3847 @item Process ID
3848 @item Code Address
3849 @item Source line, or label
3850 @end table
3851
3852 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3853 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3854 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3855 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3856 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3857 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3858 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3859
3860 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3861 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3862 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3863 the debugger.
3864
3865 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3866 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3867 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3868
3869 @end table
3870
3871 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3872 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3873 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3874 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3875 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3876 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3877 previously read data can be read again.
3878
3879 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3880 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3881 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3882 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3883 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3884 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3885
3886 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3887 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3888 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3889 different execution path this time.
3890
3891 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3892 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3893 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3894 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3895 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3896 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3897 potentially pose a problem.
3898
3899 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3900
3901 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3902 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3903 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3904 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3905 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3906 next.
3907
3908 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3909 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3910 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3911 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3912 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3913
3914 @node Stopping
3915 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3916
3917 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3918 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3919 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3920
3921 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3922 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3923 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3924 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3925 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3926 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3927 explicitly request this information at any time.
3928
3929 @table @code
3930 @kindex info program
3931 @item info program
3932 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3933 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3934 @end table
3935
3936 @menu
3937 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3938 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3939 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3940 Skipping over functions and files
3941 * Signals:: Signals
3942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3943 @end menu
3944
3945 @node Breakpoints
3946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3947
3948 @cindex breakpoints
3949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3955 program.
3956
3957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3958 the executable is run.
3959
3960 @cindex watchpoints
3961 @cindex data breakpoints
3962 @cindex memory tracing
3963 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3964 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3965 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3966 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3967 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3968 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3969 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3970 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3971 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3972 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3973 same commands.
3974
3975 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3976 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3977 Automatic Display}.
3978
3979 @cindex catchpoints
3980 @cindex breakpoint on events
3981 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3982 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3983 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3984 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3985 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3986 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3987 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3988
3989 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3990 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3991 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3992 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3993 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3994 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3995 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3996 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3997 enable it again.
3998
3999 @cindex breakpoint ranges
4000 @cindex breakpoint lists
4001 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
4002 @cindex lists of breakpoints
4003 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
4004 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
4005 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
4006 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
4007 are operated on.
4008
4009 @menu
4010 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
4011 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
4012 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
4013 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
4014 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
4015 * Conditions:: Break conditions
4016 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
4017 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
4018 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
4019 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
4020 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4021 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4022 @end menu
4023
4024 @node Set Breaks
4025 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
4026
4027 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
4028 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
4029 @c
4030 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
4031
4032 @kindex break
4033 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
4034 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4035 @cindex latest breakpoint
4036 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
4037 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
4038 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
4039 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
4040 convenience variables.
4041
4042 @table @code
4043 @item break @var{location}
4044 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
4045 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
4046 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
4047 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
4048 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
4049
4050 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
4051 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
4052 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
4053 that situation.
4054
4055 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
4056 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
4057 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
4058
4059 @item break
4060 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
4061 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
4062 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
4063 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
4064 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
4065 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
4066 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
4067 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
4068 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
4069 inside loops.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
4072 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
4073 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
4074 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
4075 existed when your program stopped.
4076
4077 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
4078 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
4079 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
4080 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
4081 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
4082 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
4083 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
4084
4085 @kindex tbreak
4086 @item tbreak @var{args}
4087 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
4088 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
4089 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
4090 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4091
4092 @kindex hbreak
4093 @cindex hardware breakpoints
4094 @item hbreak @var{args}
4095 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
4096 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
4097 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
4098 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
4099 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
4100 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
4101 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
4102 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
4103 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
4104 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
4105 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
4106 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
4107 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
4108 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
4109 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4110 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4111 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4112 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4113
4114 @kindex thbreak
4115 @item thbreak @var{args}
4116 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
4117 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
4118 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
4119 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
4120 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
4121 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
4122 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4123 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4124
4125 @kindex rbreak
4126 @cindex regular expression
4127 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
4128 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
4129 @item rbreak @var{regex}
4130 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
4131 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
4132 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
4133 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
4134 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
4135 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
4136
4137 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
4138 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
4139 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
4140 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
4141 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
4142 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
4143
4144 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
4145 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
4146 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
4147 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
4148 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
4149 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
4150
4151 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
4152 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
4153 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
4154 classes.
4155
4156 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
4157 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
4158 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
4159
4160 @smallexample
4161 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
4162 @end smallexample
4163
4164 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
4165 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
4166 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
4167 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
4168 every function in a given file:
4169
4170 @smallexample
4171 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
4172 @end smallexample
4173
4174 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
4175 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
4176
4177 @kindex info breakpoints
4178 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
4179 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4180 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4181 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
4182 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
4183 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
4184 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
4185
4186 @table @emph
4187 @item Breakpoint Numbers
4188 @item Type
4189 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
4190 @item Disposition
4191 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
4192 @item Enabled or Disabled
4193 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
4194 that are not enabled.
4195 @item Address
4196 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
4197 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
4198 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
4199 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
4200 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
4201 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
4202 @item What
4203 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
4204 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
4205 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
4206 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
4207 @end table
4208
4209 @noindent
4210 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
4211 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
4212 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
4213 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
4214 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
4215 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
4216
4217 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
4218 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
4219 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
4220 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
4221
4222 @noindent
4223 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
4224 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
4225 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
4226 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
4227 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
4228
4229 @noindent
4230 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
4231 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
4232 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
4233 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
4234 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
4235 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
4236
4237 @noindent
4238 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
4239 @code{info break} also displays that count.
4240
4241 @end table
4242
4243 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
4244 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
4245 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
4246 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4247
4248 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
4249 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
4250 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
4251 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
4252
4253 @itemize @bullet
4254 @item
4255 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
4256
4257 @item
4258 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
4259 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
4260
4261 @item
4262 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4263 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4264
4265 @item
4266 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4267 several places where that function is inlined.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4271 the relevant locations.
4272
4273 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4274 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4275 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4276 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4277 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4278 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4279 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4280
4281 For example:
4282
4283 @smallexample
4284 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4285 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4286 stop only if i==1
4287 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4288 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4289 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4293 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4294 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4295 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4296 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4297 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4298 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4299 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4300 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4301 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4302 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4303
4304 @cindex pending breakpoints
4305 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4306 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4307 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4308 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4309 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4310 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4311 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4312 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4313 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4314 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4315 is not yet resolved.
4316
4317 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4318 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4319 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4320 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4321 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4322 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4323
4324 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4325 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4326 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4327 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4328
4329 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4330 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4331 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4332
4333 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4334 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4335 address specification to an address:
4336
4337 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4338 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4339 @table @code
4340 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4341 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4342 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4343
4344 @item set breakpoint pending on
4345 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4346 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4347
4348 @item set breakpoint pending off
4349 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4350 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4351 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4352
4353 @item show breakpoint pending
4354 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4355 @end table
4356
4357 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4358 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4359 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4360
4361 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4362 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4363 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4364 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4365 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4366 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4367 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4368 breakpoints.
4369
4370 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4371
4372 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4373 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4374 @table @code
4375 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4376 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4377 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4378 breakpoint must be used.
4379
4380 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4381 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4382 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4383 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4384 @end table
4385
4386 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4387 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4388 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4389 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4390 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4391 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4392 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4393 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4394 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4395
4396 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4397 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4398 @table @code
4399 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4400 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4401 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4402 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4403
4404 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4405 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4406 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4407 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4408 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4409 @end table
4410
4411 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4412 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4413 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4414
4415 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4416 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4417
4418 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4419
4420 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4421 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4422 @table @code
4423 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4424 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4425 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4426 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4427 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4428
4429 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4430 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4431 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4432 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4433 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4434 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4435 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4436 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4437 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4438 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4439 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4440 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4441 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4442
4443 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4444 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4445 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4446 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4447 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4448 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4449 @end table
4450
4451
4452 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4453 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4454 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4455 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4456 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4457 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4458 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4459 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4460
4461
4462 @node Set Watchpoints
4463 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4464
4465 @cindex setting watchpoints
4466 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4467 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4468 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4469 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4470 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4475
4476 @item
4477 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4478 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4479 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4480
4481 @item
4482 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4483 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4484 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4485 @end itemize
4486
4487 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4488 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4489 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4490 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4491 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4492 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4493 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4494 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4495 the expression changes.
4496
4497 @cindex software watchpoints
4498 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4499 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4500 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4501 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4502 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4503 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4504 culprit.)
4505
4506 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4507 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4508 slow down the running of your program.
4509
4510 @table @code
4511 @kindex watch
4512 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4513 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4514 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4515 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4516 to watch the value of a single variable:
4517
4518 @smallexample
4519 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4523 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4524 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4525 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4526 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4527 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4528
4529 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4530 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4531 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4532 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4533 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4534 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4535 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4536 error.
4537
4538 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4539 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4540 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4541 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4542 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4543 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4544 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4545 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4546 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4547 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4548 Examples:
4549
4550 @smallexample
4551 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4552 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4553 @end smallexample
4554
4555 @kindex rwatch
4556 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4557 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4558 by the program.
4559
4560 @kindex awatch
4561 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4562 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4563 or written into by the program.
4564
4565 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4566 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4567 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4568 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4569 @end table
4570
4571 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4572 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4573 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4574 a never-changing value:
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4578 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4579 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4580 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4581 @end smallexample
4582
4583 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4584 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4585 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4586 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4587 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4588 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4589
4590 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4591 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4592 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4593 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4594 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4595 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4596 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4597 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4598
4599 @table @code
4600 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4601 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4602 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4603
4604 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4605 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4606 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4607 @end table
4608
4609 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4610 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4611 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4612
4613 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4614
4615 @smallexample
4616 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4617 @end smallexample
4618
4619 @noindent
4620 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4621
4622 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4623 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4624 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4625 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4626 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4627 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4628 will print a message like this:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4632 @end smallexample
4633
4634 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4635 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4636 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4637 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4638 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4639 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4640 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4641 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4642
4643 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4644 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4645 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4646 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4647 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4648 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4656
4657 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4658 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4659 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4660 expression with separately allocated resources.
4661
4662 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4663 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4664 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4665
4666 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4667 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4668 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4669 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4670 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4671 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4672 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4673 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4674 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4675
4676 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4677 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4678 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4679 watched expression from every thread.
4680
4681 @quotation
4682 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4683 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4684 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4685 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4686 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4687 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4688 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4689 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4690 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4691 @end quotation
4692
4693 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4694
4695 @node Set Catchpoints
4696 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4697 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4698 @cindex exception handlers
4699 @cindex event handling
4700
4701 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4702 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4703 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @kindex catch
4707 @item catch @var{event}
4708 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4709
4710 @table @code
4711 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4712 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4713 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4714 @kindex catch throw
4715 @kindex catch rethrow
4716 @kindex catch catch
4717 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4718 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4719
4720 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4721 regular expression will be caught.
4722
4723 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4724 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4725 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4726 exception being thrown.
4727
4728 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4729 @value{GDBN}:
4730
4731 @itemize @bullet
4732 @item
4733 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4734 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4735 supported.
4736
4737 @item
4738 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4739 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4740 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4741 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4742 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4743 built.
4744
4745 @item
4746 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4747 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4748
4749 @item
4750 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4751 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4752 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4753 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4754
4755 @item
4756 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4757 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4758 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4759 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4760 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4761 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4762 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4763 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4764 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4765
4766 @item
4767 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4768
4769 @item
4770 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4771 @end itemize
4772
4773 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4774 @kindex catch exception
4775 @cindex Ada exception catching
4776 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4777 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4778 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4779 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4780 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4781
4782 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4783 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4784 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4785 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4786 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4787 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4788 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4789 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4790
4791 @item exception unhandled
4792 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4793 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4794
4795 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4796 @kindex catch handlers
4797 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4798 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4799 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4800 specified at the end of the command
4801 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4802 only when this specific exception is handled.
4803 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4804
4805 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4806 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4807 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4808 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4809 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4810 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4811 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4812 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4813 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4814
4815 @item assert
4816 @kindex catch assert
4817 A failed Ada assertion.
4818
4819 @item exec
4820 @kindex catch exec
4821 @cindex break on fork/exec
4822 A call to @code{exec}.
4823
4824 @anchor{catch syscall}
4825 @item syscall
4826 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4827 @kindex catch syscall
4828 @cindex break on a system call.
4829 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4830 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4831 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4832 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4833 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4834 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4835 will be caught.
4836
4837 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4838 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4839 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4840 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4841
4842 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4843 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4844 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4845 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4846
4847 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4848 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4849 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4850 available choices.
4851
4852 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4853 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4854 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4855 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4856 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4857 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4858 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4859 behind the OS upgrades).
4860
4861 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4862 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4863 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4864 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4865 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4866 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4867 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4868 syscall groups available on your environment.
4869
4870 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4871 arguments to it:
4872
4873 @smallexample
4874 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4875 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4876 (@value{GDBP}) r
4877 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4878
4879 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4880 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4881 (@value{GDBP}) c
4882 Continuing.
4883
4884 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4885 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4886 (@value{GDBP})
4887 @end smallexample
4888
4889 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4893 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4894 (@value{GDBP}) r
4895 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4896
4897 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4898 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4899 (@value{GDBP}) c
4900 Continuing.
4901
4902 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4903 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4904 (@value{GDBP})
4905 @end smallexample
4906
4907 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4908 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4909 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4913 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4914 (@value{GDBP}) r
4915 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4916
4917 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4918 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4919 (@value{GDBP}) c
4920 Continuing.
4921
4922 Program exited normally.
4923 (@value{GDBP})
4924 @end smallexample
4925
4926 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4927
4928 @smallexample
4929 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4930 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4931 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4932 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4933 (@value{GDBP}) r
4934 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4935
4936 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4937 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4938
4939 (@value{GDBP}) c
4940 Continuing.
4941 @end smallexample
4942
4943 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4944 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4945 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4946 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4950 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4951 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4952 (@value{GDBP})
4953 @end smallexample
4954
4955 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4956 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4957 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4958 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4959 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4960 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4961
4962 @smallexample
4963 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4964 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4965 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4966 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4967 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4968 (@value{GDBP})
4969 @end smallexample
4970
4971 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4972
4973 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4974 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4975
4976 @smallexample
4977 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4978 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4979 @end smallexample
4980
4981 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4982
4983 @item fork
4984 @kindex catch fork
4985 A call to @code{fork}.
4986
4987 @item vfork
4988 @kindex catch vfork
4989 A call to @code{vfork}.
4990
4991 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4992 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4993 @kindex catch load
4994 @kindex catch unload
4995 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4996 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4997 matches one of the affected libraries.
4998
4999 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5000 @kindex catch signal
5001 The delivery of a signal.
5002
5003 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
5004 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
5005 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
5006
5007 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
5008 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
5009 signal names.
5010
5011 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
5012 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
5013 will be caught.
5014
5015 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
5016 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
5017 catchpoint.
5018
5019 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
5020 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
5021 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
5022 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
5023 commands.
5024
5025 @end table
5026
5027 @item tcatch @var{event}
5028 @kindex tcatch
5029 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
5030 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
5031
5032 @end table
5033
5034 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
5035
5036
5037 @node Delete Breaks
5038 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
5039
5040 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5041 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5042 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
5043 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
5044 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
5045 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
5046
5047 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
5048 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
5049 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
5050 their breakpoint numbers.
5051
5052 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
5053 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
5054 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
5055
5056 @table @code
5057 @kindex clear
5058 @item clear
5059 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
5060 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
5061 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
5062 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
5063
5064 @item clear @var{location}
5065 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
5066 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
5067 most useful ones are listed below:
5068
5069 @table @code
5070 @item clear @var{function}
5071 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
5072 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
5073
5074 @item clear @var{linenum}
5075 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5076 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
5077 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
5078 @end table
5079
5080 @cindex delete breakpoints
5081 @kindex delete
5082 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
5083 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5084 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
5085 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
5086 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
5087 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
5088 @end table
5089
5090 @node Disabling
5091 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
5092
5093 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
5094 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
5095 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
5096 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
5097 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
5098
5099 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
5100 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
5101 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
5102 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
5103 do not know which numbers to use.
5104
5105 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
5106 affects all of its locations.
5107
5108 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
5109 different states of enablement:
5110
5111 @itemize @bullet
5112 @item
5113 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
5114 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
5115 @item
5116 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
5117 @item
5118 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
5119 disabled.
5120 @item
5121 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
5122 N times, then becomes disabled.
5123 @item
5124 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
5125 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
5126 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
5130 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
5131
5132 @table @code
5133 @kindex disable
5134 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
5135 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5136 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
5137 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
5138 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
5139 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
5140 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
5141
5142 @kindex enable
5143 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5144 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
5145 become effective once again in stopping your program.
5146
5147 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
5148 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
5149 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
5150
5151 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
5152 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
5153 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
5154 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
5155 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
5156 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
5157 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
5158
5159 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
5160 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
5161 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
5162 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
5166 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
5167 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
5168 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
5169 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
5170 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
5171 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
5172 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
5173 Stepping}.)
5174
5175 @node Conditions
5176 @subsection Break Conditions
5177 @cindex conditional breakpoints
5178 @cindex breakpoint conditions
5179
5180 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5181 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
5182 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
5183 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
5184 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
5185 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
5186 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
5187 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
5188
5189 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
5190 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
5191 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
5192 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
5193 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
5194
5195 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
5196 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
5197 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
5198 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
5199 one.
5200
5201 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
5202 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
5203 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
5204 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
5205 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
5206 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
5207 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
5208 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
5209 conditions for the
5210 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
5211 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
5212
5213 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
5214 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
5215 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
5216 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
5217 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
5218 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
5219
5220 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
5221 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
5222 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
5223 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
5224 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
5225
5226 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
5227 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
5228 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
5229 with the @code{condition} command.
5230
5231 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
5232 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
5233 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
5234 catchpoint.
5235
5236 @table @code
5237 @kindex condition
5238 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5239 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
5240 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
5241 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
5242 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
5243 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
5244 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
5245 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
5246 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
5247 prints an error message:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5251 @end smallexample
5252
5253 @noindent
5254 @value{GDBN} does
5255 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
5256 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
5257 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5258
5259 @item condition @var{bnum}
5260 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5261 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5262 @end table
5263
5264 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5265 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5266 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5267 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5268 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5269 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5270 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5271 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5272 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5273 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5274 your program reaches it.
5275
5276 @table @code
5277 @kindex ignore
5278 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5279 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5280 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5281 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5282 takes no action.
5283
5284 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5285 a count of zero.
5286
5287 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5288 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5289 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5290 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5291
5292 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5293 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5294 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5295
5296 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5297 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5298 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5299 Variables}.
5300 @end table
5301
5302 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5303
5304
5305 @node Break Commands
5306 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5307
5308 @cindex breakpoint commands
5309 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5310 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5311 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5312 enable other breakpoints.
5313
5314 @table @code
5315 @kindex commands
5316 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5317 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5318 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5319 @itemx end
5320 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5321 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5322 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5323
5324 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5325 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5326
5327 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5328 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5329 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5330 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5331 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5332 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5333 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5334 Expressions}).
5335 @end table
5336
5337 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5338 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5339
5340 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5341 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5342 that resumes execution.
5343
5344 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5345 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5346 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5347 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5348 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5349
5350 @kindex silent
5351 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5352 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5353 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5354 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5355 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5356 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5357
5358 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5359 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5360 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5361
5362 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5363 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5364
5365 @smallexample
5366 break foo if x>0
5367 commands
5368 silent
5369 printf "x is %d\n",x
5370 cont
5371 end
5372 @end smallexample
5373
5374 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5375 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5376 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5377 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5378 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5379 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5380 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5381
5382 @smallexample
5383 break 403
5384 commands
5385 silent
5386 set x = y + 4
5387 cont
5388 end
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @node Dynamic Printf
5392 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5393
5394 @cindex dynamic printf
5395 @cindex dprintf
5396 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5397 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5398 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5399 having to recompile it.
5400
5401 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5402 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5403 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5404 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5405 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5406 redirects to files and so forth.
5407
5408 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5409 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5410 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5411 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5412 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5413 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5414 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5415
5416 @table @code
5417 @kindex dprintf
5418 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5419 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5420 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5421 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5422
5423 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5424 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5425 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5426 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5427 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5428 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5429
5430 @table @code
5431 @item gdb
5432 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5433 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5434
5435 @item call
5436 @kindex dprintf-style call
5437 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5438 @code{printf}).
5439
5440 @item agent
5441 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5442 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5443 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5444 support running commands on the target.
5445 @end table
5446
5447 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5448 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5449 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5450 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5451 command.
5452
5453 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5454 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5455 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5456 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5457 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5458 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5459
5460 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5461 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5462 you could do the following:
5463
5464 @example
5465 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5466 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5467 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5468 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5469 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5470 (gdb) info break
5471 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5472 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5473 continue
5474 (gdb)
5475 @end example
5476
5477 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5478 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5479 the variable settings.
5480
5481 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5482 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5483 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5484 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5485 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5486 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5487
5488 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5489 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5490 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5495 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5496 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5497 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5498 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5499 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5500
5501 @node Save Breakpoints
5502 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5503
5504 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5505 breakpoints}} command.
5506
5507 @table @code
5508 @kindex save breakpoints
5509 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5510 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5511 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5512 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5513 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5514 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5515 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5516 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5517 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5518 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5519 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5520 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5521 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5522 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5523 that can no longer be recreated.
5524 @end table
5525
5526 @node Static Probe Points
5527 @subsection Static Probe Points
5528
5529 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5530 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5531 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5532 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5533 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5534
5535 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5536 ELF-compatible systems:
5537
5538 @itemize @bullet
5539
5540 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5541 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5542 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5543 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5544 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5545 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5546 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5547 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5548
5549 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5550 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5551 C@t{++} languages.
5552 @end itemize
5553
5554 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5555 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5556 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5557 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5558 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5559 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5560 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5561 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5562 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5563
5564 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5565 probes}, with optional arguments:
5566
5567 @table @code
5568 @kindex info probes
5569 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5570 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5571 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5572 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5573
5574 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5575 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5576 probes from all providers are listed.
5577
5578 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5579 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5580 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5581
5582 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5583 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5584 given, all object files are considered.
5585
5586 @item info probes all
5587 List the available static probes, from all types.
5588 @end table
5589
5590 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5591 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5592 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5593 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5594 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5595
5596 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5597 commands, with optional arguments:
5598
5599 @table @code
5600 @kindex enable probes
5601 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5602 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5603 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5604 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5605
5606 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5607 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5608 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5609
5610 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5611 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5612 given, all object files are considered.
5613
5614 @kindex disable probes
5615 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5616 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5617 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5618 @end table
5619
5620 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5621 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5622 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5623 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5624 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5625 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5626 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5627 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5628 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5629 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5630 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5631 at the current probe point.
5632
5633 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5634 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5635 an error message.
5636
5637
5638 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5639 @node Error in Breakpoints
5640 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5641
5642 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5643 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5644
5645 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5646 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5647 @smallexample
5648 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5649 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 @noindent
5653 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5654 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5655 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5656
5657 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5658 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5659
5660 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5661 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5662 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5663
5664 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5665 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5666 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5667 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5668
5669 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5670 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5671 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5672 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5673 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5674 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5675 first in the bundle.
5676
5677 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5678 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5679 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5680 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5681 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5682 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5683 is hit.
5684
5685 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5686 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5687
5688 @smallexample
5689 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5690 @end smallexample
5691
5692 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5693 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5694 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5695 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5696 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5697 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5698 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5699 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5700
5701 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5702 adjusted breakpoints:
5703
5704 @smallexample
5705 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5706 to 0x00010410.
5707 @end smallexample
5708
5709 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5710 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5711 frequently than expected.
5712
5713 @node Continuing and Stepping
5714 @section Continuing and Stepping
5715
5716 @cindex stepping
5717 @cindex continuing
5718 @cindex resuming execution
5719 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5720 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5721 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5722 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5723 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5724 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5725 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5726 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5727 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5728 handlers}).)
5729
5730 @table @code
5731 @kindex continue
5732 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5733 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5734 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5735 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5736 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5737 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5738 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5739 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5740 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5741 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5742
5743 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5744 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5745 @code{continue} is ignored.
5746
5747 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5748 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5749 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5750 @code{continue}.
5751 @end table
5752
5753 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5754 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5755 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5756 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5757
5758 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5759 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5760 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5761 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5762 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5763 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5764
5765 @table @code
5766 @kindex step
5767 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5768 @item step
5769 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5770 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5771 abbreviated @code{s}.
5772
5773 @quotation
5774 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5775 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5776 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5777 @c distinction here.
5778 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5779 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5780 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5781 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5782 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5783 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5784 below.
5785 @end quotation
5786
5787 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5788 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5789 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5790 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5791 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5792 called within the line.
5793
5794 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5795 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5796 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5797 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5798 was any debugging information about the routine.
5799
5800 @item step @var{count}
5801 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5802 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5803 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5804
5805 @kindex next
5806 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5807 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5808 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5809 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5810 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5811 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5812 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5813 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5814
5815 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5816
5817
5818 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5819 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5820 @c
5821 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5822 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5823 @c function are executed without stopping.
5824
5825 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5826 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5827 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5828
5829 @kindex set step-mode
5830 @item set step-mode
5831 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5832 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5833 @itemx set step-mode on
5834 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5835 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5836 information rather than stepping over it.
5837
5838 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5839 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5840 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5841
5842 @item set step-mode off
5843 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5844 debug information. This is the default.
5845
5846 @item show step-mode
5847 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5848 source line debug information.
5849
5850 @kindex finish
5851 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5852 @item finish
5853 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5854 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5855 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5856
5857 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5858 ,Returning from a Function}).
5859
5860 @kindex set print finish
5861 @kindex show print finish
5862 @item set print finish @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5863 @itemx show print finish
5864 By default the @code{finish} command will show the value that is
5865 returned by the function. This can be disabled using @code{set print
5866 finish off}. When disabled, the value is still entered into the value
5867 history (@pxref{Value History}), but not displayed.
5868
5869 @kindex until
5870 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5871 @cindex run until specified location
5872 @item until
5873 @itemx u
5874 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5875 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5876 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5877 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5878 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5879 than the address of the jump.
5880
5881 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5882 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5883 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5884 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5885 through the next iteration.
5886
5887 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5888 stack frame.
5889
5890 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5891 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5892 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5893 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5894 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5895
5896 @smallexample
5897 (@value{GDBP}) f
5898 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5899 206 expand_input();
5900 (@value{GDBP}) until
5901 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5902 @end smallexample
5903
5904 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5905 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5906 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5907 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5908 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5909 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5910 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5911
5912 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5913 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5914 argument.
5915
5916 @item until @var{location}
5917 @itemx u @var{location}
5918 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5919 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5920 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5921 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5922 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5923 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5924 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5925 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5926 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5927 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5928 invocations have returned.
5929
5930 @smallexample
5931 94 int factorial (int value)
5932 95 @{
5933 96 if (value > 1) @{
5934 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5935 98 @}
5936 99 return (value);
5937 100 @}
5938 @end smallexample
5939
5940
5941 @kindex advance @var{location}
5942 @item advance @var{location}
5943 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5944 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5945 @ref{Specify Location}.
5946 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5947 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5948 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5949 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5950
5951
5952 @kindex stepi
5953 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5954 @item stepi
5955 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5956 @itemx si
5957 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5958
5959 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5960 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5961 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5962 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5963
5964 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5965
5966 @need 750
5967 @kindex nexti
5968 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5969 @item nexti
5970 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5971 @itemx ni
5972 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5973 proceed until the function returns.
5974
5975 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5976
5977 @end table
5978
5979 @anchor{range stepping}
5980 @cindex range stepping
5981 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5982 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5983 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5984 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5985 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5986 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5987 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5988 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5989 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5990 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5991 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5992 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5993 if necessary:
5994
5995 @table @code
5996 @kindex set range-stepping
5997 @kindex show range-stepping
5998 @item set range-stepping
5999 @itemx show range-stepping
6000 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
6001
6002 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
6003 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
6004 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
6005 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
6006 default is @code{on}.
6007
6008 @end table
6009
6010 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
6011 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
6012 @cindex skipping over functions and files
6013
6014 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
6015 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
6016 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
6017 a particular file when stepping.
6018
6019 For example, consider the following C function:
6020
6021 @smallexample
6022 101 int func()
6023 102 @{
6024 103 foo(boring());
6025 104 bar(boring());
6026 105 @}
6027 @end smallexample
6028
6029 @noindent
6030 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
6031 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
6032 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
6033 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
6034
6035 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
6036 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
6037 is called from many places.
6038
6039 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
6040 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
6041 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
6042 @code{foo}.
6043
6044 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
6045 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
6046 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
6047
6048 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
6049 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
6050 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
6051 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
6052 the underlying system.
6053 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
6054 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @kindex skip
6058 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
6059 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
6060 that specify what to skip.
6061 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
6062
6063 @table @code
6064 @item -file @var{file}
6065 @itemx -fi @var{file}
6066 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
6067
6068 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
6069 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
6070 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
6071 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
6072 over when stepping.
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
6076 @end smallexample
6077
6078 @item -function @var{linespec}
6079 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
6080 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
6081 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
6082 @xref{Specify Location}.
6083
6084 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
6085 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
6086 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
6087 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
6088
6089 This form is useful for complex function names.
6090 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
6091 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
6092 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
6093 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
6094 regular expression makes this easier.
6095
6096 @smallexample
6097 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6098 @end smallexample
6099
6100 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
6101 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
6102
6103 @smallexample
6104 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6105 @end smallexample
6106 @end table
6107
6108 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
6109 will be skipped.
6110
6111 @kindex skip function
6112 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
6113 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
6114 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
6115 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
6116
6117 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
6118 will be skipped.
6119
6120 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
6121 @kbd{skip function file}.)
6122
6123 @kindex skip file
6124 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
6125 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
6126 will be skipped over when stepping.
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 (gdb) skip file boring.c
6130 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
6131 @end smallexample
6132
6133 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
6134 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
6135 @end table
6136
6137 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
6138 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
6139
6140 @table @code
6141 @kindex info skip
6142 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6143 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
6144 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
6145 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
6146
6147 @table @emph
6148 @item Identifier
6149 A number identifying this skip.
6150 @item Enabled or Disabled
6151 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
6152 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
6153 @item Glob
6154 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
6155 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6156 @item File
6157 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
6158 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6159 @item RE
6160 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
6161 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6162 @item Function
6163 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
6164 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6165 @end table
6166
6167 @kindex skip delete
6168 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6169 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
6170 skips.
6171
6172 @kindex skip enable
6173 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6174 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
6175 skips.
6176
6177 @kindex skip disable
6178 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6179 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
6180 skips.
6181
6182 @kindex set debug skip
6183 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6184 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
6185
6186 @kindex show debug skip
6187 @item show debug skip
6188 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
6189
6190 @end table
6191
6192 @node Signals
6193 @section Signals
6194 @cindex signals
6195
6196 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
6197 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
6198 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
6199 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
6200 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
6201 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
6202 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
6203 requested an alarm).
6204
6205 @cindex fatal signals
6206 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
6207 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
6208 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
6209 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
6210 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
6211 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
6212
6213 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
6214 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
6215 signal.
6216
6217 @cindex handling signals
6218 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
6219 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
6220 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
6221 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
6222 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
6223
6224 @table @code
6225 @kindex info signals
6226 @kindex info handle
6227 @item info signals
6228 @itemx info handle
6229 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
6230 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
6231 the defined types of signals.
6232
6233 @item info signals @var{sig}
6234 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
6235
6236 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
6237
6238 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
6239 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
6240 for details about this command.
6241
6242 @kindex handle
6243 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
6244 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
6245 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
6246 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
6247 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
6248 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
6249 say what change to make.
6250 @end table
6251
6252 @c @group
6253 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
6254 Their full names are:
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @item nostop
6258 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
6259 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
6260
6261 @item stop
6262 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
6263 the @code{print} keyword as well.
6264
6265 @item print
6266 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
6267
6268 @item noprint
6269 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6270 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6271
6272 @item pass
6273 @itemx noignore
6274 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6275 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6276 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6277
6278 @item nopass
6279 @itemx ignore
6280 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6281 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6282 @end table
6283 @c @end group
6284
6285 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6286 program until you
6287 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6288 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6289 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6290 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6291 program sees that signal when you continue.
6292
6293 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6294 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6295 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6296 erroneous signals.
6297
6298 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6299 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6300 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6301 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6302 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6303 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6304 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6305 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6306 Program a Signal}.
6307
6308 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6309 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6310
6311 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6312 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6313 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6314 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6315 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6316 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6317 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6318 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6319 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6320 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6321 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6322 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6323 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6324
6325 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6326
6327 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6328 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6329 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6330 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6331
6332 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6333 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6334 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6335 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6336
6337 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6338 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6339
6340 @smallexample
6341 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6342 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6343 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6344 (@value{GDBP}) c
6345 Continuing.
6346
6347 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6348 main () sigusr1.c:28
6349 28 p = 0;
6350 (@value{GDBP}) si
6351 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6352 9 @{
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6356 program to receive the signal first:
6357
6358 @smallexample
6359 (@value{GDBP}) n
6360 28 p = 0;
6361 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6362 (@value{GDBP}) si
6363 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6364 9 @{
6365 (@value{GDBP})
6366 @end smallexample
6367
6368 @cindex extra signal information
6369 @anchor{extra signal information}
6370
6371 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6372 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6373 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6374 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6375 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6376 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6377 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6378 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6379 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6380 system header.
6381
6382 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6383 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6384
6385 @smallexample
6386 @group
6387 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6388 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6389 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6390 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6391 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6392 type = struct @{
6393 int si_signo;
6394 int si_errno;
6395 int si_code;
6396 union @{
6397 int _pad[28];
6398 struct @{...@} _kill;
6399 struct @{...@} _timer;
6400 struct @{...@} _rt;
6401 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6402 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6403 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6404 @} _sifields;
6405 @}
6406 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6407 type = struct @{
6408 void *si_addr;
6409 @}
6410 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6411 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6412 @end group
6413 @end smallexample
6414
6415 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6416
6417 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6418 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6419 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6420 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6421 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6422 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6423 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6424 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6425 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6426 information is displayed.
6427
6428 The usual output of a segfault is:
6429 @smallexample
6430 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6431 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6432 68 value = *(p + len);
6433 @end smallexample
6434
6435 While a bound violation is presented as:
6436 @smallexample
6437 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6438 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6439 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6440 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6441 68 value = *(p + len);
6442 @end smallexample
6443
6444 @node Thread Stops
6445 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6446
6447 @cindex stopped threads
6448 @cindex threads, stopped
6449
6450 @cindex continuing threads
6451 @cindex threads, continuing
6452
6453 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6454 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6455 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6456 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6457 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6458 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6459 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6460 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6461 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6462
6463 @menu
6464 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6465 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6466 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6467 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6468 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6469 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6470 @end menu
6471
6472 @node All-Stop Mode
6473 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6474
6475 @cindex all-stop mode
6476
6477 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6478 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6479 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6480 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6481 underfoot.
6482
6483 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6484 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6485 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6486
6487 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6488 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6489 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6490 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6491 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6492 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6493 stops.
6494
6495 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6496 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6497 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6498 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6499
6500 @cindex automatic thread selection
6501 @cindex switching threads automatically
6502 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6503 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6504 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6505 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6506 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6507 thread.
6508
6509 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6510 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6511
6512 @table @code
6513 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6514 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6515 @cindex lock scheduler
6516 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6517 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6518 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6519 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6520 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6521 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6522 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6523 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6524 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6525 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6526 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6527 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6528 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6529 @code{on} in replay mode.
6530
6531 @item show scheduler-locking
6532 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6533 @end table
6534
6535 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6536 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6537 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6538 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6539 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6540 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6541 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6542 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6543 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6544 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6545 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6546 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6547 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6548 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6549
6550 @table @code
6551 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6552 @item set schedule-multiple
6553 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6554 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6555 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6556 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6557 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6558 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6559
6560 @item show schedule-multiple
6561 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6562 multiple processes.
6563 @end table
6564
6565 @node Non-Stop Mode
6566 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6567
6568 @cindex non-stop mode
6569
6570 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6571 @c with more details.
6572
6573 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6574 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6575 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6576 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6577 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6578 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6579
6580 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6581 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6582 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6583 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6584 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6585 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6586 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6587 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6588 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6589 independently and simultaneously.
6590
6591 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6592 or attach to your program:
6593
6594 @smallexample
6595 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6596 set pagination off
6597
6598 # Finally, turn it on!
6599 set non-stop on
6600 @end smallexample
6601
6602 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6603
6604 @table @code
6605 @kindex set non-stop
6606 @item set non-stop on
6607 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6608 @item set non-stop off
6609 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6610 @kindex show non-stop
6611 @item show non-stop
6612 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6613 @end table
6614
6615 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6616 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6617 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6618 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6619 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6620 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6621 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6622 default.
6623
6624 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6625 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6626 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6627
6628 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6629 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6630 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6631 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6632 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6633
6634 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6635 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6636 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6637 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6638 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6639
6640 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6641
6642 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6643 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6644 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6645 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6646 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6647 previously current thread.
6648
6649 @node Background Execution
6650 @subsection Background Execution
6651
6652 @cindex foreground execution
6653 @cindex background execution
6654 @cindex asynchronous execution
6655 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6656
6657 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6658 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6659 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6660 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6661 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6662 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6663
6664 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6665 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6666
6667 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6668 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6669 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6670 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6671 are:
6672
6673 @table @code
6674 @kindex run&
6675 @item run
6676 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6677
6678 @item attach
6679 @kindex attach&
6680 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6681
6682 @item step
6683 @kindex step&
6684 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6685
6686 @item stepi
6687 @kindex stepi&
6688 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6689
6690 @item next
6691 @kindex next&
6692 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6693
6694 @item nexti
6695 @kindex nexti&
6696 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6697
6698 @item continue
6699 @kindex continue&
6700 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6701
6702 @item finish
6703 @kindex finish&
6704 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6705
6706 @item until
6707 @kindex until&
6708 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6709
6710 @end table
6711
6712 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6713 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6714 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6715 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6716 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6717 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6718
6719 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6720 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6721
6722 @table @code
6723 @kindex interrupt
6724 @item interrupt
6725 @itemx interrupt -a
6726
6727 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6728 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6729 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6730 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6731 @end table
6732
6733 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6734 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6735
6736 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6737 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6738 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6739
6740 @table @code
6741 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6742 @cindex thread breakpoints
6743 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6744 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6745 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6746 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6747 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6748 specify some source line.
6749
6750 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6751 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6752 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6753 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6754 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6755
6756 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6757 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6758 program.
6759
6760 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6761 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6762 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6763
6764 @smallexample
6765 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6766 @end smallexample
6767
6768 @end table
6769
6770 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6771 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6772 thread list. For example:
6773
6774 @smallexample
6775 (@value{GDBP}) c
6776 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6777 @end smallexample
6778
6779 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6780 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6781 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6782 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6783 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6784 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6785 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6786 command.
6787
6788 @node Interrupted System Calls
6789 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6790
6791 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6792 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6793 @cindex premature return from system calls
6794 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6795 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6796 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6797 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6798 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6799 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6800 stop execution.
6801
6802 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6803 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6804 style anyways.
6805
6806 For example, do not write code like this:
6807
6808 @smallexample
6809 sleep (10);
6810 @end smallexample
6811
6812 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6813 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6814
6815 Instead, write this:
6816
6817 @smallexample
6818 int unslept = 10;
6819 while (unslept > 0)
6820 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6821 @end smallexample
6822
6823 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6824 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6825 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6826 @value{GDBN}.
6827
6828 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6829 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6830 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6831 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6832
6833 @node Observer Mode
6834 @subsection Observer Mode
6835
6836 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6837 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6838 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6839 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6840 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6841
6842 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6843 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6844 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6845 mode.
6846
6847 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6848 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6849 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6850 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6851 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6852
6853 @table @code
6854
6855 @kindex observer
6856 @item set observer on
6857 @itemx set observer off
6858 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6859 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6860 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6861 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6862
6863 @item show observer
6864 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6865
6866 @kindex may-write-registers
6867 @item set may-write-registers on
6868 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6869 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6870 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6871 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6872
6873 @item show may-write-registers
6874 Show the current permission to write registers.
6875
6876 @kindex may-write-memory
6877 @item set may-write-memory on
6878 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6879 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6880 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6881 defaults to @code{on}.
6882
6883 @item show may-write-memory
6884 Show the current permission to write memory.
6885
6886 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6887 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6888 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6889 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6890 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6891 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6892
6893 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6894 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6895
6896 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6897 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6898 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6899 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6900 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6901 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6902 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6903
6904 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6905 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6906
6907 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6908 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6909 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6910 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6911 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6912 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6913 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6914
6915 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6916 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6917
6918 @kindex may-interrupt
6919 @item set may-interrupt on
6920 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6921 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6922 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6923 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6924 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6925
6926 @item show may-interrupt
6927 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6928
6929 @end table
6930
6931 @node Reverse Execution
6932 @chapter Running programs backward
6933 @cindex reverse execution
6934 @cindex running programs backward
6935
6936 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6937 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6938 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6939 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6940
6941 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6942 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6943 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6944 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6945 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6946 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6947
6948 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6949 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6950 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6951 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6952 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6953 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6954 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6955 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6956 prior values@footnote{
6957 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6958 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6959 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6960
6961 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6962 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6963 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6964 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6965 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6966 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6967 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6968 }.
6969
6970 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
6971 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
6972 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
6973 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
6974 without requiring any special command.
6975
6976 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6977 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6978
6979 @table @code
6980 @kindex reverse-continue
6981 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6982 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6983 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6984 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6985 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6986 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6987 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6988
6989 @kindex reverse-step
6990 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6991 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6992 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6993 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6994
6995 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6996 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6997 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6998 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6999 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
7000 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
7001
7002 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
7003 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
7004
7005 @kindex reverse-stepi
7006 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
7007 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7008 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
7009 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
7010 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
7011 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
7012 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
7013
7014 @kindex reverse-next
7015 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
7016 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7017 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
7018 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
7019 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
7020 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
7021 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
7022 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
7023 line of a function back to its return to its caller
7024 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
7025
7026 @kindex reverse-nexti
7027 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
7028 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7029 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
7030 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
7031 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
7032 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
7033 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
7034 frame) is reached.
7035
7036 @kindex reverse-finish
7037 @item reverse-finish
7038 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
7039 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
7040 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
7041 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
7042
7043 @kindex set exec-direction
7044 @item set exec-direction
7045 Set the direction of target execution.
7046 @item set exec-direction reverse
7047 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
7048 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
7049 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
7050 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
7051 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
7052 @item set exec-direction forward
7053 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
7054 This is the default.
7055 @end table
7056
7057
7058 @node Process Record and Replay
7059 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
7060 @cindex process record and replay
7061 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
7062
7063 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
7064 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
7065 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
7066
7067 @cindex replay mode
7068 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
7069 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
7070 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
7071 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
7072 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
7073 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
7074 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
7075 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
7076 execution log.
7077
7078 @cindex record mode
7079 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
7080 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
7081 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
7082 for future replay.
7083
7084 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
7085 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
7086 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
7087 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
7088 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
7089 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
7090
7091 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
7092 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
7093 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
7094 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
7095
7096 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
7097 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
7098 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
7099 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
7100
7101 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
7102 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @kindex target record
7106 @kindex target record-full
7107 @kindex target record-btrace
7108 @kindex record
7109 @kindex record full
7110 @kindex record btrace
7111 @kindex record btrace bts
7112 @kindex record btrace pt
7113 @kindex record bts
7114 @kindex record pt
7115 @kindex rec
7116 @kindex rec full
7117 @kindex rec btrace
7118 @kindex rec btrace bts
7119 @kindex rec btrace pt
7120 @kindex rec bts
7121 @kindex rec pt
7122 @item record @var{method}
7123 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
7124 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7125 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
7126 recording methods are available:
7127
7128 @table @code
7129 @item full
7130 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
7131 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
7132 execution.
7133
7134 @item btrace @var{format}
7135 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
7136 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
7137 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
7138 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
7139 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
7140 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
7141 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
7142 @code{record stop}.
7143
7144 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7145 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
7146 formats are available:
7147
7148 @table @code
7149 @item bts
7150 @cindex branch trace store
7151 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
7152 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
7153 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
7154
7155 @item pt
7156 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
7157 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
7158 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
7159 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
7160
7161 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
7162 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
7163 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
7164
7165 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
7166 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
7167 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
7168 buffer-size with care.
7169 @end table
7170
7171 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
7172 @end table
7173
7174 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
7175 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
7176 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
7177 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
7178
7179 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
7180 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
7181 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
7182 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
7183 doesn't support displaced stepping.
7184
7185 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
7186 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
7187 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
7188 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
7189 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
7190 does not support these two modes.
7191
7192 @kindex record stop
7193 @kindex rec s
7194 @item record stop
7195 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
7196 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
7197 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
7198
7199 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
7200 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
7201 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
7202 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
7203 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
7204
7205 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
7206 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
7207 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
7208 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
7209 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
7210
7211 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
7212 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
7213
7214 @kindex record goto
7215 @item record goto
7216 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
7217 ways to specify the location to go to:
7218
7219 @table @code
7220 @item record goto begin
7221 @itemx record goto start
7222 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
7223
7224 @item record goto end
7225 Go to the end of the execution log.
7226
7227 @item record goto @var{n}
7228 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
7229 @end table
7230
7231 @kindex record save
7232 @item record save @var{filename}
7233 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7234 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
7235 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
7236
7237 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7238
7239 @kindex record restore
7240 @item record restore @var{filename}
7241 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7242 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
7243
7244 @kindex set record full
7245 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
7246 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
7247 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
7248 recording method. Default value is 200000.
7249
7250 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
7251 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
7252 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
7253 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
7254 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
7255 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
7256 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
7257 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
7258
7259 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
7260 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
7261 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
7262
7263 @kindex show record full
7264 @item show record full insn-number-max
7265 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
7266 recording method.
7267
7268 @item set record full stop-at-limit
7269 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7270 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7271 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7272 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7273 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7274 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7275 oldest one to be deleted.
7276
7277 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7278 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7279
7280 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7281 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7282
7283 @item set record full memory-query
7284 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7285 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7286 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7287 case.
7288
7289 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7290 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7291 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7292 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7293 results.
7294
7295 @item show record full memory-query
7296 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7297
7298 @kindex set record btrace
7299 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7300 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7301 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7302 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7303 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7304 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7305 You can use the following command for that:
7306
7307 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7308 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7309 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7310 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7311 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7312 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7313 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7314 position.
7315
7316 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7317 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7318 errata when decoding the trace.
7319
7320 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7321 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7322 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7323 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7324 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7325 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7326 which the trace was recorded.
7327
7328 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7329 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7330 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7331 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7332 disable the workarounds.
7333
7334 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7335 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7336 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7337 (default).
7338
7339 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7340 identifiers are currently supported:
7341
7342 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7343
7344 @item @code{intel}
7345 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7346
7347 @end multitable
7348
7349 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7350 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7351
7352 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7353 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7354 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7355
7356 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7357 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7358 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7359 supports.
7360
7361 @smallexample
7362 (gdb) info record
7363 Active record target: record-btrace
7364 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7365 Buffer size: 16kB.
7366 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7367 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7368 (gdb) info record
7369 Active record target: record-btrace
7370 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7371 Buffer size: 16kB.
7372 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7373 @end smallexample
7374
7375 @kindex show record btrace
7376 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7377 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7378
7379 @item show record btrace cpu
7380 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7381 workarounds.
7382
7383 @kindex set record btrace bts
7384 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7385 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7386 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7387 format. Default is 64KB.
7388
7389 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7390 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7391 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7392 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7393 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7394 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7395 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7396
7397 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7398 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7399
7400 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7401 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7402
7403 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7404 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7405 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7406
7407 @kindex set record btrace pt
7408 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7409 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7410 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7411 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7412
7413 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7414 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7415 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7416 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7417 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7418 actual buffer size for each thread.
7419
7420 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7421 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7422
7423 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7424 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7425
7426 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7427 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7428 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7429
7430 @kindex info record
7431 @item info record
7432 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7433 method:
7434
7435 @table @code
7436 @item full
7437 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7438 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7439
7440 @itemize @bullet
7441 @item
7442 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7443 @item
7444 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7445 @item
7446 Highest recorded instruction number.
7447 @item
7448 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7449 @item
7450 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7451 @item
7452 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7453 @end itemize
7454
7455 @item btrace
7456 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7457
7458 @itemize @bullet
7459 @item
7460 Recording format.
7461 @item
7462 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7463 @item
7464 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7465 instructions.
7466 @item
7467 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7468 @end itemize
7469
7470 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7471 @itemize @bullet
7472 @item
7473 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7474 @end itemize
7475
7476 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7477 @itemize @bullet
7478 @item
7479 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7480 @end itemize
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @kindex record delete
7484 @kindex rec del
7485 @item record delete
7486 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7487 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7488 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7489 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7490
7491 @kindex record instruction-history
7492 @kindex rec instruction-history
7493 @item record instruction-history
7494 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7495 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7496 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7497 are printed in execution order.
7498
7499 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7500 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7501 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7502
7503 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7504 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7505 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7506 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7507 @code{/p} modifier.
7508
7509 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7510 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7511 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7512
7513 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7514 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7515
7516 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7517 disassemble:
7518
7519 @table @code
7520 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7521 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7522 @var{insn}.
7523
7524 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7525 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7526 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7527 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7528 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7529 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7530
7531 @item record instruction-history
7532 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7533
7534 @item record instruction-history -
7535 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7536
7537 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7538 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7539 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7540 number @var{end} is included.
7541 @end table
7542
7543 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7544
7545 @kindex set record
7546 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7547 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7548 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7549 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7550 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7551
7552 @kindex show record
7553 @item show record instruction-history-size
7554 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7555 instruction-history} command.
7556
7557 @kindex record function-call-history
7558 @kindex rec function-call-history
7559 @item record function-call-history
7560 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7561 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7562 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7563 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7564 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7565 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7566 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7567 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7568 given together.
7569
7570 @smallexample
7571 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7572 1 void foo (void)
7573 2 @{
7574 3 @}
7575 4
7576 5 void bar (void)
7577 6 @{
7578 7 ...
7579 8 foo ();
7580 9 ...
7581 10 @}
7582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7583 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7584 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7585 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7586 @end smallexample
7587
7588 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7589 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7590 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7591 to print:
7592
7593 @table @code
7594 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7595 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7596
7597 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7598 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7599 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7600 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7601 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7602
7603 @item record function-call-history
7604 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7605
7606 @item record function-call-history -
7607 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7608
7609 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7610 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7611 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7615
7616 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7617 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7618 Define how many lines to print in the
7619 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7620 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7621
7622 @item show record function-call-history-size
7623 Show how many lines to print in the
7624 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7625 @end table
7626
7627
7628 @node Stack
7629 @chapter Examining the Stack
7630
7631 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7632 stopped and how it got there.
7633
7634 @cindex call stack
7635 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7636 is generated.
7637 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7638 the arguments of the call,
7639 and the local variables of the function being called.
7640 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7641 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7642 stack}.
7643
7644 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7645 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7646
7647 @cindex selected frame
7648 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7649 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7650 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7651 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7652 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7653 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7654
7655 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7656 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7657 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7658
7659 @menu
7660 * Frames:: Stack frames
7661 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7662 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7663 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7664 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7665 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7666
7667 @end menu
7668
7669 @node Frames
7670 @section Stack Frames
7671
7672 @cindex frame, definition
7673 @cindex stack frame
7674 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7675 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7676 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7677 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7678 which the function is executing.
7679
7680 @cindex initial frame
7681 @cindex outermost frame
7682 @cindex innermost frame
7683 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7684 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7685 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7686 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7687 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7688 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7689 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7690 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7691
7692 @cindex frame pointer
7693 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7694 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7695 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7696 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7697 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7698 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7699
7700 @cindex frame level
7701 @cindex frame number
7702 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7703 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7704 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7705 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7706 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7707 describe this number.
7708
7709 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7710 @c underflow problems.
7711 @cindex frameless execution
7712 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7713 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7714 @smallexample
7715 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7716 @end smallexample
7717 generates functions without a frame.)
7718 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7719 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7720 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7721 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7722 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7723 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7724 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7725
7726 @node Backtrace
7727 @section Backtraces
7728
7729 @cindex traceback
7730 @cindex call stack traces
7731 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7732 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7733 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7734 stack.
7735
7736 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7737 @kindex backtrace
7738 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7739 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7740 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7741 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7742 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7743 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7744
7745 @table @code
7746 @item backtrace [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7747 @itemx bt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7748 Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
7749
7750 The optional @var{count} can be one of the following:
7751
7752 @table @code
7753 @item @var{n}
7754 @itemx @var{n}
7755 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7756 number.
7757
7758 @item -@var{n}
7759 @itemx -@var{n}
7760 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7761 number.
7762 @end table
7763
7764 Options:
7765
7766 @table @code
7767 @item -full
7768 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7769 with the optional @var{count} to limit the number of frames shown.
7770
7771 @item -no-filters
7772 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7773 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7774 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7775 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7776 support.
7777
7778 @item -hide
7779 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7780 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7781 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{-hide}
7782 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7783 @end table
7784
7785 The @code{backtrace} command also supports a number of options that
7786 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
7787 backtrace} and @code{set print} subcommands:
7788
7789 @table @code
7790 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7791 Set whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}. Related setting:
7792 @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
7793
7794 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7795 Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
7796 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
7797
7798 @item -entry-values @code{no}|@code{only}|@code{preferred}|@code{if-needed}|@code{both}|@code{compact}|@code{default}
7799 Set printing of function arguments at function entry.
7800 Related setting: @ref{set print entry-values}.
7801
7802 @item -frame-arguments @code{all}|@code{scalars}|@code{none}
7803 Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments.
7804 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-arguments}.
7805
7806 @item -raw-frame-arguments [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7807 Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
7808 Related setting: @ref{set print raw-frame-arguments}.
7809
7810 @item -frame-info @code{auto}|@code{source-line}|@code{location}|@code{source-and-location}|@code{location-and-address}|@code{short-location}
7811 Set printing of frame information.
7812 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-info}.
7813 @end table
7814
7815 The optional @var{qualifier} is maintained for backward compatibility.
7816 It can be one of the following:
7817
7818 @table @code
7819 @item full
7820 Equivalent to the @code{-full} option.
7821
7822 @item no-filters
7823 Equivalent to the @code{-no-filters} option.
7824
7825 @item hide
7826 Equivalent to the @code{-hide} option.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 @end table
7830
7831 @kindex where
7832 @kindex info stack
7833 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7834 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7835
7836 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7837 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7838 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7839 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7840 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7841 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7842 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7843 multi-threaded program.
7844
7845 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7846 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7847 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7848 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7849 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7850 line number.
7851
7852 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7853 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7854
7855 @smallexample
7856 @group
7857 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7858 at builtin.c:993
7859 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7860 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7861 at macro.c:71
7862 (More stack frames follow...)
7863 @end group
7864 @end smallexample
7865
7866 @noindent
7867 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7868 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7869 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7870
7871 @noindent
7872 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7873 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7874 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7875 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7876 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7877 The command @kbd{set print frame-info} (@pxref{Print Settings}) controls
7878 what frame information is printed.
7879
7880 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7881 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7882 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7883 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7884 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7885 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7886 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7887 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7888 such a backtrace might look like:
7889
7890 @smallexample
7891 @group
7892 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7893 at builtin.c:993
7894 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7895 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7896 at macro.c:71
7897 (More stack frames follow...)
7898 @end group
7899 @end smallexample
7900
7901 @noindent
7902 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7903 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7904
7905 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7906 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7907 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7908
7909 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7910 @cindex program entry point
7911 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7912 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7913 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7914 @code{main}@footnote{
7915 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7916 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7917 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7918 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7919 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7920 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7921
7922 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7923 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7924
7925 @table @code
7926 @item set backtrace past-main
7927 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7928 @anchor{set backtrace past-main}
7929 @kindex set backtrace
7930 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7931
7932 @item set backtrace past-main off
7933 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7934 default.
7935
7936 @item show backtrace past-main
7937 @kindex show backtrace
7938 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7939
7940 @item set backtrace past-entry
7941 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7942 @anchor{set backtrace past-entry}
7943 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7944 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7945 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7946
7947 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7948 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7949 application. This is the default.
7950
7951 @item show backtrace past-entry
7952 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7953
7954 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7955 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7956 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7957 @anchor{set backtrace limit}
7958 @cindex backtrace limit
7959 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7960 or zero means unlimited levels.
7961
7962 @item show backtrace limit
7963 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7964 @end table
7965
7966 You can control how file names are displayed.
7967
7968 @table @code
7969 @item set filename-display
7970 @itemx set filename-display relative
7971 @cindex filename-display
7972 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7973
7974 @item set filename-display basename
7975 Display only basename of a filename.
7976
7977 @item set filename-display absolute
7978 Display an absolute filename.
7979
7980 @item show filename-display
7981 Show the current way to display filenames.
7982 @end table
7983
7984 @node Selection
7985 @section Selecting a Frame
7986
7987 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7988 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7989 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7990 of the stack frame just selected.
7991
7992 @table @code
7993 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7994 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7995 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7996 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7997 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7998 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7999
8000 @table @code
8001 @kindex frame level
8002 @item @var{num}
8003 @item level @var{num}
8004 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
8005 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
8006 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
8007 for @code{main}.
8008
8009 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
8010 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
8011 commands are equivalent:
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
8015 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 @kindex frame address
8019 @item address @var{stack-address}
8020 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
8021 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
8022 @command{info frame}, for example:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (gdb) info frame
8026 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8027 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
8028 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
8029 source language c++.
8030 Arglist at unknown address.
8031 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
8032 @end smallexample
8033
8034 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
8035 indicated by the line:
8036
8037 @smallexample
8038 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8039 @end smallexample
8040
8041 @kindex frame function
8042 @item function @var{function-name}
8043 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
8044 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
8045 most stack frame is selected.
8046
8047 @kindex frame view
8048 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
8049 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
8050 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
8051 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
8052
8053 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
8054 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
8055 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
8056 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
8057
8058 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
8059 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
8060 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
8061 for example @command{frame level 0}.
8062
8063 @end table
8064
8065 @kindex up
8066 @item up @var{n}
8067 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
8068 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
8069 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
8070
8071 @kindex down
8072 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
8073 @item down @var{n}
8074 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
8075 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
8076 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
8077 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
8078 @end table
8079
8080 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
8081 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
8082 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
8083 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
8084
8085 @need 1000
8086 For example:
8087
8088 @smallexample
8089 @group
8090 (@value{GDBP}) up
8091 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
8092 at env.c:10
8093 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
8094 @end group
8095 @end smallexample
8096
8097 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
8098 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
8099 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
8100 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
8101 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
8102 for details.
8103
8104 @table @code
8105 @kindex select-frame
8106 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8107 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
8108 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
8109 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
8110 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
8111 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
8112 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8113
8114 @kindex down-silently
8115 @kindex up-silently
8116 @item up-silently @var{n}
8117 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
8118 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
8119 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
8120 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
8121 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
8122 distracting.
8123 @end table
8124
8125 @node Frame Info
8126 @section Information About a Frame
8127
8128 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
8129 stack frame.
8130
8131 @table @code
8132 @item frame
8133 @itemx f
8134 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
8135 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
8136 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
8137 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
8138 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8139
8140 @kindex info frame
8141 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
8142 @item info frame
8143 @itemx info f
8144 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
8145 including:
8146
8147 @itemize @bullet
8148 @item
8149 the address of the frame
8150 @item
8151 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
8152 @item
8153 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
8154 @item
8155 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
8156 @item
8157 the address of the frame's arguments
8158 @item
8159 the address of the frame's local variables
8160 @item
8161 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
8162 @item
8163 which registers were saved in the frame
8164 @end itemize
8165
8166 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
8167 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
8168 the usual conventions.
8169
8170 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8171 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8172 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
8173 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
8174 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
8175 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
8176
8177 @kindex info args
8178 @item info args [-q]
8179 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
8180
8181 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8182 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
8183 have been printed.
8184
8185 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8186 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
8187 with the provided regexp(s).
8188
8189 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
8190 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8191
8192 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
8193 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8194 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8195 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8196 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8197 of special characters or quotes.
8198
8199 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
8200 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8201 @var{type_regexp}.
8202
8203 @item info locals [-q]
8204 @kindex info locals
8205 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
8206 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
8207 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
8208
8209 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8210 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
8211 have been printed.
8212
8213 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8214 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
8215 with the provided regexp(s).
8216
8217 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
8218 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8219
8220 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
8221 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8222 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8223 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8224 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8225 of special characters or quotes.
8226
8227 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
8228 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8229 @var{type_regexp}.
8230
8231 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
8232 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
8233 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
8234 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
8235 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
8236 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
8237 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
8238 @smallexample
8239 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
8240 @end smallexample
8241 @noindent
8242 or the equivalent shorter form
8243 @smallexample
8244 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
8245 @end smallexample
8246
8247 @end table
8248
8249 @node Frame Apply
8250 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
8251 @anchor{frame apply}
8252 @kindex frame apply
8253 @cindex apply command to several frames
8254 @table @code
8255 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
8256 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
8257 @var{command} to one or more frames.
8258
8259 @table @code
8260 @item @code{all}
8261 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
8262
8263 @item @var{count}
8264 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
8265 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8266
8267 @item @var{-count}
8268 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
8269 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8270
8271 @item @code{level}
8272 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
8273 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
8274 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
8275 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
8276 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
8277 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
8278
8279 @end table
8280
8281 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
8282 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
8283 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}.
8284 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
8285
8286 The @code{frame apply} command also supports a number of options that
8287 allow overriding relevant @code{set backtrace} settings:
8288
8289 @table @code
8290 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8291 Whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}.
8292 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8293
8294 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8295 Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8296 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8297 @end table
8298
8299 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
8300 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
8301 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
8302 following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item -c
8306 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
8307 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
8308 @code{frame apply} then continues.
8309 @item -s
8310 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
8311 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
8312 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
8313 are not printed.
8314 @item -q
8315 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
8316 information.
8317 @end table
8318
8319 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
8320 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
8321 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
8322 @code{#1 main} frame.
8323
8324 @smallexample
8325 @group
8326 (gdb) frame apply all p j
8327 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8328 No symbol "j" in current context.
8329 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
8330 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8331 No symbol "j" in current context.
8332 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8333 $1 = 5
8334 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
8335 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8336 $2 = 5
8337 (gdb)
8338 @end group
8339 @end smallexample
8340
8341 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8342 information before the command output:
8343
8344 @smallexample
8345 @group
8346 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8347 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8348 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8349 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8350 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8351 (gdb)
8352 @end group
8353 @end smallexample
8354
8355 If the flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8356 @smallexample
8357 @group
8358 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8359 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8360 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8361 (gdb)
8362 @end group
8363 @end smallexample
8364
8365 @end table
8366
8367 @table @code
8368
8369 @kindex faas
8370 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8371 @item faas @var{command}
8372 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8373 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8374
8375 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8376 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8377 is, using:
8378 @smallexample
8379 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8380 @end smallexample
8381
8382 The @code{faas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
8383 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
8384
8385 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8386 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8387 @end table
8388
8389
8390 @node Frame Filter Management
8391 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8392 @cindex managing frame filters
8393
8394 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8395 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8396
8397 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8398 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8399
8400 @table @code
8401 @kindex info frame-filter
8402 @item info frame-filter
8403 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8404 their name, priority and enabled status.
8405
8406 @kindex disable frame-filter
8407 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8408 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8409 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8410 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8411 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8412 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8413 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8414 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8415 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8416 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8417 may be enabled again later.
8418
8419 @kindex enable frame-filter
8420 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8421 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8422 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8423 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8424 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8425 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8426 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8427 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8428 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8429
8430 Example:
8431
8432 @smallexample
8433 (gdb) info frame-filter
8434
8435 global frame-filters:
8436 Priority Enabled Name
8437 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8438 100 Yes Reverse
8439
8440 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8441 Priority Enabled Name
8442 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8443
8444 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8445 Priority Enabled Name
8446 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8447
8448 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8449 (gdb) info frame-filter
8450
8451 global frame-filters:
8452 Priority Enabled Name
8453 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8454 100 Yes Reverse
8455
8456 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8457 Priority Enabled Name
8458 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8459
8460 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8461 Priority Enabled Name
8462 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8463
8464 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8465 (gdb) info frame-filter
8466
8467 global frame-filters:
8468 Priority Enabled Name
8469 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8470 100 Yes Reverse
8471
8472 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8473 Priority Enabled Name
8474 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8475
8476 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8477 Priority Enabled Name
8478 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8479 @end smallexample
8480
8481 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8482 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8483 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8484 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8485 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8486 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8487 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8488
8489 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8490 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8491 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8492 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8493 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8494 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8495 dictionary resides.
8496
8497 Example:
8498
8499 @smallexample
8500 (gdb) info frame-filter
8501
8502 global frame-filters:
8503 Priority Enabled Name
8504 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8505 100 Yes Reverse
8506
8507 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8508 Priority Enabled Name
8509 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8510
8511 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8512 Priority Enabled Name
8513 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8514
8515 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8516 (gdb) info frame-filter
8517
8518 global frame-filters:
8519 Priority Enabled Name
8520 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8521 50 Yes Reverse
8522
8523 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8524 Priority Enabled Name
8525 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8526
8527 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8528 Priority Enabled Name
8529 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8530 @end smallexample
8531 @end table
8532
8533 @node Source
8534 @chapter Examining Source Files
8535
8536 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8537 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8538 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8539 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8540 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8541 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8542 source files by explicit command.
8543
8544 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8545 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8546 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8547
8548 @menu
8549 * List:: Printing source lines
8550 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8551 * Edit:: Editing source files
8552 * Search:: Searching source files
8553 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8554 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8555 @end menu
8556
8557 @node List
8558 @section Printing Source Lines
8559
8560 @kindex list
8561 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8562 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8563 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8564 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8565 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8566
8567 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8568
8569 @table @code
8570 @item list @var{linenum}
8571 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8572 current source file.
8573
8574 @item list @var{function}
8575 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8576 @var{function}.
8577
8578 @item list
8579 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8580 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8581 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8582 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8583 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8584
8585 @item list -
8586 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8587 @end table
8588
8589 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8590 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8591 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8592
8593 @table @code
8594 @kindex set listsize
8595 @item set listsize @var{count}
8596 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8597 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8598 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8599 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8600
8601 @kindex show listsize
8602 @item show listsize
8603 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8604 @end table
8605
8606 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8607 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8608 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8609 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8610 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8611
8612 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8613 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8614 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8615 to specify some source line.
8616
8617 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8618
8619 @table @code
8620 @item list @var{location}
8621 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8622
8623 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8624 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8625 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8626 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8627 the same source file as the first location.
8628
8629 @item list ,@var{last}
8630 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8631
8632 @item list @var{first},
8633 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8634
8635 @item list +
8636 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8637
8638 @item list -
8639 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8640
8641 @item list
8642 As described in the preceding table.
8643 @end table
8644
8645 @node Specify Location
8646 @section Specifying a Location
8647 @cindex specifying location
8648 @cindex location
8649 @cindex source location
8650
8651 @menu
8652 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8653 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8654 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8655 @end menu
8656
8657 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8658 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8659 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8660 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8661 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8662
8663 @node Linespec Locations
8664 @subsection Linespec Locations
8665 @cindex linespec locations
8666
8667 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8668 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8669 specifying a linespec:
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @item @var{linenum}
8673 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8674
8675 @item -@var{offset}
8676 @itemx +@var{offset}
8677 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8678 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8679 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8680 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8681 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8682 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8683 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8684 linespec.
8685
8686 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8687 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8688 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8689 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8690 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8691 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8692 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8693
8694 @item @var{function}
8695 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8696 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8697
8698 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8699 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8700 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8701 means in all packages.
8702
8703 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8704 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8705 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8706
8707 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8708 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8709 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8710 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8711
8712 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8713
8714 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8715 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8716
8717 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8718 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8719 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8720 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8721 functions in different source files.
8722
8723 @item @var{label}
8724 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8725 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8726 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8727 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8728
8729 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8730 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8731 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8732 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8733 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8734 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8735
8736 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8737 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8738 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8739 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8740 each one of those probes.
8741 @end table
8742
8743 @node Explicit Locations
8744 @subsection Explicit Locations
8745 @cindex explicit locations
8746
8747 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8748 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8749
8750 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8751 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8752 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8753 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8754 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8755
8756 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8757 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8758 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8759 the symbol table to know.
8760
8761 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8762 following table:
8763
8764 @table @code
8765 @item -source @var{filename}
8766 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8767 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8768 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8769 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8770 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8771
8772 @item -function @var{function}
8773 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8774 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8775 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8776 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8777
8778 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8779 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8780 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8781 means in all packages.
8782
8783 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8784 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8785 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8786 breakpoint on both symbols.
8787
8788 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8789
8790 @item -qualified
8791
8792 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8793 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8794
8795 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8796 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8797 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8798
8799 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8800 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8801 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8802
8803 @item -label @var{label}
8804 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8805 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8806 selected stack frame.
8807
8808 @item -line @var{number}
8809 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8810 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8811 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8812 relative to the current line.
8813 @end table
8814
8815 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8816 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8817
8818 @node Address Locations
8819 @subsection Address Locations
8820 @cindex address locations
8821
8822 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8823 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8824
8825 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8826 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8827 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8828 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8829 source files.
8830
8831 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8832 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8833 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8834 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8835 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8836 of @var{address}:
8837
8838 @table @code
8839 @item @var{expression}
8840 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8841
8842 @item @var{funcaddr}
8843 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8844 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8845 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8846 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8847 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8848 (although the Pascal form also works).
8849
8850 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8851 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8852
8853 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8854 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8855 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8856 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8857 functions with identical names in different source files.
8858 @end table
8859
8860 @node Edit
8861 @section Editing Source Files
8862 @cindex editing source files
8863
8864 @kindex edit
8865 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8866 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8867 The editing program of your choice
8868 is invoked with the current line set to
8869 the active line in the program.
8870 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8871 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8872
8873 @table @code
8874 @item edit @var{location}
8875 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8876 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8877 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8878 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8879 command most commonly used:
8880
8881 @table @code
8882 @item edit @var{number}
8883 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8884
8885 @item edit @var{function}
8886 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8887 @end table
8888
8889 @end table
8890
8891 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8892 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8893 @footnote{
8894 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8895 following command-line syntax:
8896 @smallexample
8897 ex +@var{number} file
8898 @end smallexample
8899 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8900 the file where to start editing.}.
8901 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8902 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8903 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8904 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8905 @smallexample
8906 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8907 export EDITOR
8908 gdb @dots{}
8909 @end smallexample
8910 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8911 @smallexample
8912 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8913 gdb @dots{}
8914 @end smallexample
8915
8916 @node Search
8917 @section Searching Source Files
8918 @cindex searching source files
8919
8920 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8921 regular expression.
8922
8923 @table @code
8924 @kindex search
8925 @kindex forward-search
8926 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8927 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8928 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8929 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8930 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8931 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8932 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8933 @code{fo}.
8934
8935 @kindex reverse-search
8936 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8937 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8938 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8939 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8940 this command as @code{rev}.
8941 @end table
8942
8943 @node Source Path
8944 @section Specifying Source Directories
8945
8946 @cindex source path
8947 @cindex directories for source files
8948 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8949 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8950 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8951 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8952 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8953 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8954 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8955
8956 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8957 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8958 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8959 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8960 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8961 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8962 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8963 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8964 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8965 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8966 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8967
8968 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8969 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8970 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8971 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8972 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8973 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8974
8975 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8976 source files.
8977
8978 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8979 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8980 each line is in the file.
8981
8982 @kindex directory
8983 @kindex dir
8984 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8985 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8986 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8987
8988 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8989 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8990
8991 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8992 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8993 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8994 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8995 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8996 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8997 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8998 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8999 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
9000 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
9001 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
9002 name to look up the sources.
9003
9004 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
9005 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
9006 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
9007 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
9008 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
9009 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
9010 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
9011 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
9012
9013 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
9014 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
9015 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
9016 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
9017 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
9018 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
9019 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
9020
9021 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
9022 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
9023 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
9024 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
9025 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
9026 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
9027 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
9028 command.
9029
9030 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
9031 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
9032 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
9033 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
9034 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
9035 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
9036 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
9037
9038 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
9039 @cindex default source path substitution
9040 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
9041 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
9042 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
9043 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
9044 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
9045 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
9046 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
9047 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
9048 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
9049 together.
9050
9051 @table @code
9052 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
9053 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
9054 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
9055 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
9056 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
9057 part of absolute file names) or
9058 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
9059 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
9060
9061 @kindex cdir
9062 @kindex cwd
9063 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
9064 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
9065 @cindex compilation directory
9066 @cindex current directory
9067 @cindex working directory
9068 @cindex directory, current
9069 @cindex directory, compilation
9070 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
9071 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
9072 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
9073 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
9074 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
9075 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
9076
9077 @item directory
9078 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
9079
9080 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
9081 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
9082
9083 @item set directories @var{path-list}
9084 @kindex set directories
9085 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
9086 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
9087
9088 @item show directories
9089 @kindex show directories
9090 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
9091
9092 @anchor{set substitute-path}
9093 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
9094 @kindex set substitute-path
9095 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
9096 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
9097 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
9098
9099 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
9100 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
9101
9102 @smallexample
9103 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
9104 @end smallexample
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
9108 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
9109 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
9110
9111 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
9112 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
9113 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
9114 the substitution.
9115
9116 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
9117
9118 @smallexample
9119 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
9120 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
9121 @end smallexample
9122
9123 @noindent
9124 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
9125 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
9126 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
9127 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
9128
9129
9130 @item unset substitute-path [path]
9131 @kindex unset substitute-path
9132 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
9133 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
9134 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
9135
9136 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
9137
9138 @item show substitute-path [path]
9139 @kindex show substitute-path
9140 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
9141 which would rewrite that path, if any.
9142
9143 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
9144 rules.
9145
9146 @end table
9147
9148 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
9149 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
9150 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
9151
9152 @enumerate
9153 @item
9154 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
9155
9156 @item
9157 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
9158 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
9159 directories in one command.
9160 @end enumerate
9161
9162 @node Machine Code
9163 @section Source and Machine Code
9164 @cindex source line and its code address
9165
9166 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
9167 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
9168 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
9169 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
9170 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
9171 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
9172 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
9173 well as hex.
9174
9175 @table @code
9176 @kindex info line
9177 @item info line
9178 @itemx info line @var{location}
9179 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
9180 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
9181 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
9182 information about the current source line is printed.
9183 @end table
9184
9185 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
9186 the object code for the first line of function
9187 @code{m4_changequote}:
9188
9189 @smallexample
9190 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
9191 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
9192 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
9193 @end smallexample
9194
9195 @noindent
9196 @cindex code address and its source line
9197 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
9198 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
9199 @smallexample
9200 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
9201 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
9202 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
9206 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
9207 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
9208 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
9209 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
9210 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
9211 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
9212 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9213 Variables}).
9214
9215 @cindex info line, repeated calls
9216 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
9217 specifying a location will display information about the next source
9218 line.
9219
9220 @table @code
9221 @kindex disassemble
9222 @cindex assembly instructions
9223 @cindex instructions, assembly
9224 @cindex machine instructions
9225 @cindex listing machine instructions
9226 @item disassemble
9227 @itemx disassemble /m
9228 @itemx disassemble /s
9229 @itemx disassemble /r
9230 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
9231 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
9232 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
9233 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
9234 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
9235 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
9236 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
9237 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
9238 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
9239 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
9240
9241 @table @code
9242 @item @var{start},@var{end}
9243 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
9244 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
9245 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
9246 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
9247 @end table
9248
9249 @noindent
9250 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
9251 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
9252
9253 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
9254 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
9255
9256 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
9257 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
9258 @end table
9259
9260 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
9261 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
9262
9263 @smallexample
9264 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
9265 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
9266 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
9267 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
9268 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9269 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
9270 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
9271 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
9272 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
9273 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9274 End of assembler dump.
9275 @end smallexample
9276
9277 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
9278 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
9279 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
9280
9281 @smallexample
9282 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9283 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9284 5 @{
9285 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
9286 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
9287 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
9288 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
9289 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
9290
9291 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
9292 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
9293 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
9294
9295 7 return 0;
9296 8 @}
9297 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
9298 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
9299 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
9300
9301 End of assembler dump.
9302 @end smallexample
9303
9304 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
9305 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
9306 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
9307 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
9308 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
9309 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
9310 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
9311 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
9312 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
9313
9314 @file{foo.h}:
9315
9316 @smallexample
9317 int
9318 foo (int a)
9319 @{
9320 if (a < 0)
9321 return a * 2;
9322 if (a == 0)
9323 return 1;
9324 return a + 10;
9325 @}
9326 @end smallexample
9327
9328 @file{foo.c}:
9329
9330 @smallexample
9331 #include "foo.h"
9332 volatile int x, y;
9333 int
9334 main ()
9335 @{
9336 x = foo (y);
9337 return 0;
9338 @}
9339 @end smallexample
9340
9341 @smallexample
9342 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9343 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9344 5 @{
9345
9346 6 x = foo (y);
9347 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9348 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9349
9350 7 return 0;
9351 8 @}
9352 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9353 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9354 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9355 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9356
9357 End of assembler dump.
9358 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9359 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9360 foo.c:
9361 5 @{
9362 6 x = foo (y);
9363 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9364
9365 foo.h:
9366 4 if (a < 0)
9367 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9368 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9369
9370 6 if (a == 0)
9371 7 return 1;
9372 8 return a + 10;
9373 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9374 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9375 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9376 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9377
9378 foo.c:
9379 6 x = foo (y);
9380 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9381
9382 7 return 0;
9383 8 @}
9384 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9385 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9386
9387 foo.h:
9388 5 return a * 2;
9389 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9390 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9391 End of assembler dump.
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9395
9396 @smallexample
9397 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9398 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9399 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9400 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9401 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9402 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9403 End of assembler dump.
9404 @end smallexample
9405
9406 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9407 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9408 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9409 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9410
9411 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9412 mnemonics or other syntax.
9413
9414 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9415 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9416 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9417 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9418 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9419
9420 @table @code
9421 @kindex set disassembler-options
9422 @cindex disassembler options
9423 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9424 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9425 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9426 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9427 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9428 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9429 The default value is the empty string.
9430
9431 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9432 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9433 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9434 and S/390.
9435
9436 @kindex show disassembler-options
9437 @item show disassembler-options
9438 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9439 @end table
9440
9441 @table @code
9442 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9443 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9444 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9445 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9446 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9447 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9448
9449 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9450 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9451 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9452 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9453
9454 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9455 @item show disassembly-flavor
9456 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9457 @end table
9458
9459 @table @code
9460 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9461 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9462 @item set disassemble-next-line
9463 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9464 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9465 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9466 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9467 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9468 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9469 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9470 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9471 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9472 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9473 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9474 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9475 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9476 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9477 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9478 instruction.
9479 @end table
9480
9481
9482 @node Data
9483 @chapter Examining Data
9484
9485 @cindex printing data
9486 @cindex examining data
9487 @kindex print
9488 @kindex inspect
9489 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9490 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9491 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9492 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9493 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9494 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9495
9496 @table @code
9497 @item print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
9498 @itemx print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
9499 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9500 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9501 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9502 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9503 Formats}.
9504
9505 @anchor{print options}
9506 The @code{print} command supports a number of options that allow
9507 overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set print}
9508 subcommands:
9509
9510 @table @code
9511 @item -address [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9512 Set printing of addresses.
9513 Related setting: @ref{set print address}.
9514
9515 @item -array [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9516 Pretty formatting of arrays.
9517 Related setting: @ref{set print array}.
9518
9519 @item -array-indexes [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9520 Set printing of array indexes.
9521 Related setting: @ref{set print array-indexes}.
9522
9523 @item -elements @var{number-of-elements}|@code{unlimited}
9524 Set limit on string chars or array elements to print. The value
9525 @code{unlimited} causes there to be no limit. Related setting:
9526 @ref{set print elements}.
9527
9528 @item -max-depth @var{depth}|@code{unlimited}
9529 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
9530 ellipsis. Related setting: @ref{set print max-depth}.
9531
9532 @item -null-stop [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9533 Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related
9534 setting: @ref{set print null-stop}.
9535
9536 @item -object [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9537 Set printing C@t{++} virtual function tables. Related setting:
9538 @ref{set print object}.
9539
9540 @item -pretty [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9541 Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: @ref{set print
9542 pretty}.
9543
9544 @item -repeats @var{number-of-repeats}|@code{unlimited}
9545 Set threshold for repeated print elements. @code{unlimited} causes
9546 all elements to be individually printed. Related setting: @ref{set
9547 print repeats}.
9548
9549 @item -static-members [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9550 Set printing C@t{++} static members. Related setting: @ref{set print
9551 static-members}.
9552
9553 @item -symbol [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9554 Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related setting:
9555 @ref{set print symbol}.
9556
9557 @item -union [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9558 Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting:
9559 @ref{set print union}.
9560
9561 @item -vtbl [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9562 Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting:
9563 @ref{set print vtbl}.
9564 @end table
9565
9566 Because the @code{print} command accepts arbitrary expressions which
9567 may look like options (including abbreviations), if you specify any
9568 command option, then you must use a double dash (@code{--}) to mark
9569 the end of option processing.
9570
9571 For example, this prints the value of the @code{-r} expression:
9572
9573 @smallexample
9574 (@value{GDBP}) print -r
9575 @end smallexample
9576
9577 While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below)
9578 with the @code{-raw} option in effect:
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 (@value{GDBP}) print -r --
9582 @end smallexample
9583
9584 Here is an example including both on option and an expression:
9585
9586 @smallexample
9587 @group
9588 (@value{GDBP}) print -pretty -- *myptr
9589 $1 = @{
9590 next = 0x0,
9591 flags = @{
9592 sweet = 1,
9593 sour = 1
9594 @},
9595 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9596 @}
9597 @end group
9598 @end smallexample
9599
9600 @item print [@var{options}]
9601 @itemx print [@var{options}] /@var{f}
9602 @cindex reprint the last value
9603 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9604 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9605 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9606 @end table
9607
9608 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9609 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9610 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9611
9612 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9613 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9614 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9615 Table}.
9616
9617 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9618 @kindex explore
9619 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9620 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9621 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9622 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9623 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9624 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9625 embedded in the higher level data types.
9626
9627 @table @code
9628 @item explore @var{arg}
9629 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9630 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9631 @end table
9632
9633 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9634 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9635 C program as
9636
9637 @smallexample
9638 struct SimpleStruct
9639 @{
9640 int i;
9641 double d;
9642 @};
9643
9644 struct ComplexStruct
9645 @{
9646 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9647 int arr[10];
9648 @};
9649 @end smallexample
9650
9651 @noindent
9652 followed by variable declarations as
9653
9654 @smallexample
9655 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9656 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9657 @end smallexample
9658
9659 @noindent
9660 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9661 @code{explore} command as follows.
9662
9663 @smallexample
9664 (gdb) explore cs
9665 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9666 the following fields:
9667
9668 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9669 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9670
9671 Enter the field number of choice:
9672 @end smallexample
9673
9674 @noindent
9675 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9676 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9677 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9678 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9679 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9680 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9681 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9682 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9683
9684 @smallexample
9685 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9686 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9687 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9688 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9689
9690 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9691 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9692
9693 Press enter to return to parent value:
9694 @end smallexample
9695
9696 @noindent
9697 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9698 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9699 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9700 to explore.
9701
9702 @smallexample
9703 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9704 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9705
9706 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9707
9708 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9709
9710 Press enter to return to parent value:
9711 @end smallexample
9712
9713 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9714 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9715 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9716 level data structure).
9717
9718 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9719 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9720 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9721 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9722 same example as above, your can explore the type
9723 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9724 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9725
9726 @smallexample
9727 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9728 @end smallexample
9729
9730 @noindent
9731 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9732 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9733 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9734 example.
9735
9736 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9737 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9738 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9739 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9740 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9741
9742 @table @code
9743 @item explore value @var{expr}
9744 @cindex explore value
9745 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9746 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9747 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9748 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9749 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9750
9751 @item explore type @var{arg}
9752 @cindex explore type
9753 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9754 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9755 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9756 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9757 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9758 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9759 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9760 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9761 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9762 @end table
9763
9764 @menu
9765 * Expressions:: Expressions
9766 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9767 * Variables:: Program variables
9768 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9769 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9770 * Memory:: Examining memory
9771 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9772 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9773 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9774 * Value History:: Value history
9775 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9776 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9777 * Registers:: Registers
9778 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9779 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9780 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9781 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9782 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9783 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9784 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9785 character set than GDB does
9786 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9787 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9788 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9789 @end menu
9790
9791 @node Expressions
9792 @section Expressions
9793
9794 @cindex expressions
9795 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9796 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9797 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9798 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9799 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9800 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9801 @ref{Compilation}.
9802
9803 @cindex arrays in expressions
9804 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9805 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9806 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9807 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9808 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9809 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9810
9811 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9812 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9813 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9814 languages.
9815
9816 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9817 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9818
9819 @cindex casts, in expressions
9820 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9821 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9822 at that address in memory.
9823 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9824
9825 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9826 to programming languages:
9827
9828 @table @code
9829 @item @@
9830 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9831 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9832
9833 @item ::
9834 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9835 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9836
9837 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9838 @cindex type casting memory
9839 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9840 @cindex casts, to view memory
9841 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9842 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9843 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9844 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9845 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9846 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9847 @end table
9848
9849 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9850 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9851 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9852
9853 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9854 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9855 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9856 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9857 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9858 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9859 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9860
9861 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9862 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9863 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9864 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9865 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9866 as well.
9867
9868 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9869 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9870 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9871 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9872 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9873 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9874 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9875 choices.
9876
9877 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9878 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9879 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9880
9881 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9882 @smallexample
9883 @group
9884 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9885 [0] cancel
9886 [1] all
9887 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9888 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9889 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9890 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9891 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9892 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9893 > 2 4 6
9894 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9895 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9896 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9897 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9898 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9899 breakpoints.
9900 (@value{GDBP})
9901 @end group
9902 @end smallexample
9903
9904 @table @code
9905 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9906 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9907 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9908
9909 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9910 is ambiguous.
9911
9912 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9913 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9914 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9915 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9916 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9917 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9918 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9919 in the use of the menu.
9920
9921 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9922 when an ambiguity is detected.
9923
9924 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9925 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9926
9927 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9928 @item show multiple-symbols
9929 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9930 @end table
9931
9932 @node Variables
9933 @section Program Variables
9934
9935 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9936 in your program.
9937
9938 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9939 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9940
9941 @itemize @bullet
9942 @item
9943 global (or file-static)
9944 @end itemize
9945
9946 @noindent or
9947
9948 @itemize @bullet
9949 @item
9950 visible according to the scope rules of the
9951 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9952 @end itemize
9953
9954 @noindent This means that in the function
9955
9956 @smallexample
9957 foo (a)
9958 int a;
9959 @{
9960 bar (a);
9961 @{
9962 int b = test ();
9963 bar (b);
9964 @}
9965 @}
9966 @end smallexample
9967
9968 @noindent
9969 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9970 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9971 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9972 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9973
9974 @cindex variable name conflict
9975 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9976 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9977 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9978 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9979 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9980 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9981 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9982
9983 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9984 @ifnotinfo
9985 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9986 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9987 @end ifnotinfo
9988 @smallexample
9989 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9990 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9991 @end smallexample
9992
9993 @noindent
9994 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9995 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9996 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9997 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9998
9999 @smallexample
10000 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
10001 @end smallexample
10002
10003 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
10004 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
10005 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
10006 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
10007 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
10008
10009 @smallexample
10010 void
10011 foo (int a)
10012 @{
10013 if (a < 10)
10014 bar (a);
10015 else
10016 process (a); /* Stop here */
10017 @}
10018
10019 int
10020 bar (int a)
10021 @{
10022 foo (a + 5);
10023 @}
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @noindent
10027 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
10028 here is what you might see
10029 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
10030
10031 @smallexample
10032 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10033 $1 = 10
10034 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10035 $2 = 5
10036 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
10037 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
10038 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10039 $3 = 5
10040 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10041 $4 = 0
10042 @end smallexample
10043
10044 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
10045 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
10046 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
10047 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
10048 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
10049
10050 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
10051 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
10052 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
10053 @code{some_global}.
10054
10055 @smallexample
10056 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
10057 $1 = 23
10058 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
10059 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
10060 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
10061 $2 = 27
10062 @end smallexample
10063
10064 @cindex wrong values
10065 @cindex variable values, wrong
10066 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
10067 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
10068 @quotation
10069 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
10070 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
10071 scope, and just before exit.
10072 @end quotation
10073 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
10074 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
10075 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
10076 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
10077 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
10078 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
10079 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
10080 variable definitions may be gone.
10081
10082 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
10083 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
10084 when compiling.
10085
10086 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
10087 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
10088 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
10089 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
10090 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
10091 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
10092 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
10093
10094 @smallexample
10095 No symbol "foo" in current context.
10096 @end smallexample
10097
10098 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
10099 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
10100 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
10101 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
10102 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
10103
10104 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
10105 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
10106 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
10107 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
10108
10109 @cindex no debug info variables
10110 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
10111 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
10112 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
10113 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
10114 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
10115 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
10116 example, in a C program:
10117
10118 @smallexample
10119 (@value{GDBP}) p var
10120 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
10121 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
10122 $1 = 3.14
10123 @end smallexample
10124
10125 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
10126 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
10127 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
10128 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
10129 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
10130
10131 @smallexample
10132 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
10133 29 i++;
10134 (gdb) next
10135 30 e (i);
10136 (gdb) print i
10137 $1 = 31
10138 (gdb) print i@@entry
10139 $2 = 30
10140 @end smallexample
10141
10142 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
10143 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
10144 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
10145 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
10146 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
10147 For program code
10148
10149 @smallexample
10150 char var0[] = "A";
10151 signed char var1[] = "A";
10152 @end smallexample
10153
10154 You get during debugging
10155 @smallexample
10156 (gdb) print var0
10157 $1 = "A"
10158 (gdb) print var1
10159 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 @node Arrays
10163 @section Artificial Arrays
10164
10165 @cindex artificial array
10166 @cindex arrays
10167 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
10168 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
10169 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
10170 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
10171 program.
10172
10173 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
10174 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
10175 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
10176 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
10177 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
10178 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
10179 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
10180 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
10181 example. If a program says
10182
10183 @smallexample
10184 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
10185 @end smallexample
10186
10187 @noindent
10188 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
10189
10190 @smallexample
10191 p *array@@len
10192 @end smallexample
10193
10194 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
10195 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
10196 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
10197 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
10198 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
10199
10200 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
10201 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
10202 The value need not be in memory:
10203 @smallexample
10204 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
10205 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10206 @end smallexample
10207
10208 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
10209 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
10210 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
10211 @smallexample
10212 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
10213 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10214 @end smallexample
10215
10216 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
10217 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
10218 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
10219 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
10220 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
10221 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
10222 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
10223 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
10224 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
10225 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
10226
10227 @smallexample
10228 set $i = 0
10229 p dtab[$i++]->fv
10230 @key{RET}
10231 @key{RET}
10232 @dots{}
10233 @end smallexample
10234
10235 @node Output Formats
10236 @section Output Formats
10237
10238 @cindex formatted output
10239 @cindex output formats
10240 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
10241 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
10242 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
10243 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
10244 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
10245
10246 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
10247 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
10248 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
10249 letters supported are:
10250
10251 @table @code
10252 @item x
10253 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
10254 hexadecimal.
10255
10256 @item d
10257 Print as integer in signed decimal.
10258
10259 @item u
10260 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
10261
10262 @item o
10263 Print as integer in octal.
10264
10265 @item t
10266 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
10267 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
10268 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
10269 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
10270
10271 @item a
10272 @cindex unknown address, locating
10273 @cindex locate address
10274 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
10275 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
10276 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
10277
10278 @smallexample
10279 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
10280 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
10281 @end smallexample
10282
10283 @noindent
10284 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
10285 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
10286
10287 @item c
10288 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
10289 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
10290 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
10291 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
10292
10293 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
10294 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
10295 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
10296 data.
10297
10298 @item f
10299 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
10300 using typical floating point syntax.
10301
10302 @item s
10303 @cindex printing strings
10304 @cindex printing byte arrays
10305 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
10306 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
10307 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
10308 natural types.
10309
10310 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
10311 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
10312 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
10313 array.
10314
10315 @item z
10316 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
10317 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
10318 to the size of the integer type.
10319
10320 @item r
10321 @cindex raw printing
10322 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
10323 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
10324 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
10325 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
10326 pretty-printer which might exist.
10327 @end table
10328
10329 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
10330
10331 @smallexample
10332 p/x $pc
10333 @end smallexample
10334
10335 @noindent
10336 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
10337 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
10338
10339 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
10340 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
10341 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
10342
10343 @node Memory
10344 @section Examining Memory
10345
10346 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
10347 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
10348
10349 @cindex examining memory
10350 @table @code
10351 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
10352 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
10353 @itemx x @var{addr}
10354 @itemx x
10355 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
10356 @end table
10357
10358 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
10359 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
10360 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
10361 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
10362 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
10363
10364 @table @r
10365 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
10366 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
10367 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
10368 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
10369 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
10370 @c 4.1.2.
10371
10372 @item @var{f}, the display format
10373 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
10374 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
10375 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
10376 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
10377 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
10378
10379 @item @var{u}, the unit size
10380 The unit size is any of
10381
10382 @table @code
10383 @item b
10384 Bytes.
10385 @item h
10386 Halfwords (two bytes).
10387 @item w
10388 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
10389 @item g
10390 Giant words (eight bytes).
10391 @end table
10392
10393 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
10394 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
10395 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
10396 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
10397 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
10398 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
10399 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
10400 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
10401 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
10402 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
10403 be altered.
10404
10405 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
10406 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
10407 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
10408 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
10409 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
10410 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
10411 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
10412 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
10413 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
10414 a value from memory).
10415 @end table
10416
10417 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
10418 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
10419 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
10420 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
10421 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
10422
10423 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
10424 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
10425 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
10426
10427 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
10428 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
10429 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
10430 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
10431 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
10432
10433 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
10434 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
10435 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
10436 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
10437 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
10438 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
10439 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
10440 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
10441 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
10442
10443 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10444 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10445 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10446 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10447 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10448 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10449
10450 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10451 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10452 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10453 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10454 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10455 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10456 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10457
10458 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10459 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10460
10461 @smallexample
10462 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10463 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10464 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10465 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10466 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10467 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10468 @end smallexample
10469
10470 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10471 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10472 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10473 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10474 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10475 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10476 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10477 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10478 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10479
10480 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10481 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10482 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10483
10484 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10485 @cindex addressable memory unit
10486 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10487 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10488 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10489 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10490 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10491 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10492 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10493 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10494 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10495
10496 @cindex remote memory comparison
10497 @cindex target memory comparison
10498 @cindex verify remote memory image
10499 @cindex verify target memory image
10500 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10501 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10502 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10503 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10504 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10505 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10506
10507 @table @code
10508 @kindex compare-sections
10509 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10510 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10511 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10512 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10513 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10514 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10515
10516 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10517 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10518 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10519 @end table
10520
10521 @node Auto Display
10522 @section Automatic Display
10523 @cindex automatic display
10524 @cindex display of expressions
10525
10526 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10527 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10528 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10529 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10530 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10531 The automatic display looks like this:
10532
10533 @smallexample
10534 2: foo = 38
10535 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 @noindent
10539 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10540 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10541 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10542 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10543 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10544 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10545
10546 @table @code
10547 @kindex display
10548 @item display @var{expr}
10549 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10550 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10551
10552 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10553
10554 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10555 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10556 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10557 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10558 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10559
10560 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10561 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10562 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10563 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10564 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10565 @end table
10566
10567 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10568 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10569 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10570
10571 @table @code
10572 @kindex delete display
10573 @kindex undisplay
10574 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10575 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10576 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10577 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10578 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10579 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10580 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10581
10582 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10583 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10584
10585 @kindex disable display
10586 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10587 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10588 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10589 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10590 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10591 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10592 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10593 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10594
10595 @kindex enable display
10596 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10597 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10598 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10599 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10600 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10601 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10602 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10603
10604 @item display
10605 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10606 done when your program stops.
10607
10608 @kindex info display
10609 @item info display
10610 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10611 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10612 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10613 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10614 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10615 @end table
10616
10617 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10618 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10619 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10620 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10621 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10622 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10623 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10624 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10625 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10626 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10627 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10628
10629 @node Print Settings
10630 @section Print Settings
10631
10632 @cindex format options
10633 @cindex print settings
10634 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10635 and symbols are printed.
10636
10637 @noindent
10638 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10639
10640 @table @code
10641 @kindex set print
10642 @anchor{set print address}
10643 @item set print address
10644 @itemx set print address on
10645 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10646 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10647 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10648 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10649 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10650 @code{set print address on}:
10651
10652 @smallexample
10653 @group
10654 (@value{GDBP}) f
10655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10656 at input.c:530
10657 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10658 @end group
10659 @end smallexample
10660
10661 @item set print address off
10662 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10663 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10664
10665 @smallexample
10666 @group
10667 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10668 (@value{GDBP}) f
10669 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10670 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10671 @end group
10672 @end smallexample
10673
10674 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10675 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10676 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10677 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10678
10679 @kindex show print
10680 @item show print address
10681 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10682 @end table
10683
10684 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10685 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10686 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10687 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10688 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10689 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10690 it prints a symbolic address:
10691
10692 @table @code
10693 @item set print symbol-filename on
10694 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10695 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10696 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10697 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10698
10699 @item set print symbol-filename off
10700 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10701 default.
10702
10703 @item show print symbol-filename
10704 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10705 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10706 @end table
10707
10708 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10709 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10710 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10711
10712 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10713 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10714
10715 @table @code
10716 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10717 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10718 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10719 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10720 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10721 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10722 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10723 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10724
10725 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10726 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10727 symbolic address.
10728 @end table
10729
10730 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10731 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10732 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10733 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10734 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10735 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10736 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10737 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10738
10739 @smallexample
10740 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10741 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10742 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10743 @end smallexample
10744
10745 @quotation
10746 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10747 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10748 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10749 @end quotation
10750
10751 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10752 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10753
10754 @anchor{set print symbol}
10755 @table @code
10756 @item set print symbol on
10757 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10758 one exists.
10759
10760 @item set print symbol off
10761 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10762 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10763 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10764
10765 @item show print symbol
10766 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10767 address.
10768 @end table
10769
10770 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10771
10772 @table @code
10773 @anchor{set print array}
10774 @item set print array
10775 @itemx set print array on
10776 @cindex pretty print arrays
10777 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10778 but uses more space. The default is off.
10779
10780 @item set print array off
10781 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10782
10783 @item show print array
10784 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10785 arrays.
10786
10787 @cindex print array indexes
10788 @anchor{set print array-indexes}
10789 @item set print array-indexes
10790 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10791 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10792 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10793 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10794
10795 @item set print array-indexes off
10796 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10797
10798 @item show print array-indexes
10799 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10800 arrays.
10801
10802 @anchor{set print elements}
10803 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10804 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10805 @cindex number of array elements to print
10806 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10807 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10808 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10809 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10810 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10811 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10812 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10813 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10814
10815 @item show print elements
10816 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10817 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10818
10819 @anchor{set print frame-arguments}
10820 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10821 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10822 @cindex printing frame argument values
10823 @cindex print all frame argument values
10824 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10825 @cindex do not print frame arguments
10826 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10827 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10828 values are:
10829
10830 @table @code
10831 @item all
10832 The values of all arguments are printed.
10833
10834 @item scalars
10835 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10836 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10837 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10838 only scalar arguments are shown:
10839
10840 @smallexample
10841 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10842 at frame-args.c:23
10843 @end smallexample
10844
10845 @item none
10846 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10847 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10851 at frame-args.c:23
10852 @end smallexample
10853
10854 @item presence
10855 Only the presence of arguments is indicated by @code{@dots{}}.
10856 The @code{@dots{}} are not printed for function without any arguments.
10857 None of the argument names and values are printed.
10858 In this case, the example above now becomes:
10859
10860 @smallexample
10861 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (@dots{}) at frame-args.c:23
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 @end table
10865
10866 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10867 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10868 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10869 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10870 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10871 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10872 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10873 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10874 to @code{scalars} (the default), @code{none} or @code{presence} avoids
10875 this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10876
10877 @item show print frame-arguments
10878 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10879
10880 @anchor{set print raw-frame-arguments}
10881 @item set print raw-frame-arguments on
10882 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10883
10884 @item set print raw-frame-arguments off
10885 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10886 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10887 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10888 This is the default.
10889
10890 @item show print raw-frame-arguments
10891 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10892
10893 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10894 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10895 @kindex set print entry-values
10896 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10897 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10898 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10899 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10900 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10901
10902 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10903 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10904 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10905 @code{no} setting.
10906
10907 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10908 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10909 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10910 this information.
10911
10912 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10913
10914 @table @code
10915 @item no
10916 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10917 point.
10918 @smallexample
10919 #0 equal (val=5)
10920 #0 different (val=6)
10921 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10922 #0 born (val=10)
10923 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10924 @end smallexample
10925
10926 @item only
10927 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10928 values are never printed.
10929 @smallexample
10930 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10931 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10932 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10933 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10934 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @item preferred
10938 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10939 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10940 value for such parameter.
10941 @smallexample
10942 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10943 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10944 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10945 #0 born (val=10)
10946 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10947 @end smallexample
10948
10949 @item if-needed
10950 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10951 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10952 parameter.
10953 @smallexample
10954 #0 equal (val=5)
10955 #0 different (val=6)
10956 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10957 #0 born (val=10)
10958 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10959 @end smallexample
10960
10961 @item both
10962 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10963 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10964 optimizations.
10965 @smallexample
10966 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10967 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10968 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10969 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10970 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10971 @end smallexample
10972
10973 @item compact
10974 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10975 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10976 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10977 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10978 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10979 @smallexample
10980 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10981 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10982 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10983 #0 born (val=10)
10984 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10985 @end smallexample
10986
10987 @item default
10988 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10989 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10990 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10991 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10992 @smallexample
10993 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10994 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10995 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10996 #0 born (val=10)
10997 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10998 @end smallexample
10999 @end table
11000
11001 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
11002 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
11003
11004 @item show print entry-values
11005 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
11006 entry.
11007
11008 @anchor{set print frame-info}
11009 @item set print frame-info @var{value}
11010 @kindex set print frame-info
11011 @cindex printing frame information
11012 @cindex frame information, printing
11013 This command allows to control the information printed when
11014 the debugger prints a frame. See @ref{Frames}, @ref{Backtrace},
11015 for a general explanation about frames and frame information.
11016 Note that some other settings (such as @code{set print frame-arguments}
11017 and @code{set print address}) are also influencing if and how some frame
11018 information is displayed. In particular, the frame program counter is never
11019 printed if @code{set print address} is off.
11020
11021 The possible values for @code{set print frame-info} are:
11022 @table @code
11023 @item short-location
11024 Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the
11025 beginning of the location source line), the function, the function
11026 arguments.
11027 @item location
11028 Same as @code{short-location} but also print the source file and source line
11029 number.
11030 @item location-and-address
11031 Same as @code{location} but print the program counter even if located at the
11032 beginning of the location source line.
11033 @item source-line
11034 Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
11035 source line), the line number and the source line.
11036 @item source-and-location
11037 Print what @code{location} and @code{source-line} are printing.
11038 @item auto
11039 The information printed for a frame is decided automatically
11040 by the @value{GDBN} command that prints a frame.
11041 For example, @code{frame} prints the information printed by
11042 @code{source-and-location} while @code{stepi} will switch between
11043 @code{source-line} and @code{source-and-location} depending on the program
11044 counter.
11045 The default value is @code{auto}.
11046 @end table
11047
11048 @anchor{set print repeats}
11049 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
11050 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
11051 @cindex repeated array elements
11052 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
11053 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
11054 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
11055 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
11056 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
11057 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
11058 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
11059 is 10.
11060
11061 @item show print repeats
11062 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
11063 elements.
11064
11065 @anchor{set print max-depth}
11066 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
11067 @item set print max-depth unlimited
11068 @cindex printing nested structures
11069 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
11070 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
11071
11072 For example, given this C code
11073
11074 @smallexample
11075 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
11076 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
11077 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
11078 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
11079
11080 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
11081 @end smallexample
11082
11083 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
11084 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
11085
11086 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
11087 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
11088 @item unlimited
11089 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11090 @item @code{0}
11091 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
11092 @item @code{1}
11093 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
11094 @item @code{2}
11095 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
11096 @item @code{3}
11097 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
11098 @item @code{4}
11099 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11100 @end multitable
11101
11102 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
11103 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
11104 the structure that are visible, for example
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 (gdb) set print max-depth 2
11108 (gdb) p var
11109 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
11110 (gdb) p var.d
11111 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
11112 (gdb) p var.d.c
11113 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
11114 @end smallexample
11115
11116 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
11117 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
11118 @code{(...)}.
11119
11120 @item show print max-depth
11121 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
11122 replaces with ellipsis.
11123
11124 @anchor{set print null-stop}
11125 @item set print null-stop
11126 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
11127 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
11128 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
11129 contain only short strings.
11130 The default is off.
11131
11132 @item show print null-stop
11133 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
11134 @sc{null} character.
11135
11136 @anchor{set print pretty}
11137 @item set print pretty on
11138 @cindex print structures in indented form
11139 @cindex indentation in structure display
11140 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
11141 per line, like this:
11142
11143 @smallexample
11144 @group
11145 $1 = @{
11146 next = 0x0,
11147 flags = @{
11148 sweet = 1,
11149 sour = 1
11150 @},
11151 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
11152 @}
11153 @end group
11154 @end smallexample
11155
11156 @item set print pretty off
11157 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
11158
11159 @smallexample
11160 @group
11161 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
11162 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
11163 @end group
11164 @end smallexample
11165
11166 @noindent
11167 This is the default format.
11168
11169 @item show print pretty
11170 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
11171
11172 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
11173 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
11174 @cindex octal escapes in strings
11175 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
11176 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
11177 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
11178 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
11179 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
11180
11181 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
11182 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
11183 international character sets, and is the default.
11184
11185 @item show print sevenbit-strings
11186 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
11187
11188 @anchor{set print union}
11189 @item set print union on
11190 @cindex unions in structures, printing
11191 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
11192 and other unions. This is the default setting.
11193
11194 @item set print union off
11195 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
11196 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
11197 instead.
11198
11199 @item show print union
11200 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
11201 structures and other unions.
11202
11203 For example, given the declarations
11204
11205 @smallexample
11206 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
11207 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
11208 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
11209 Bug_forms;
11210
11211 struct thing @{
11212 Species it;
11213 union @{
11214 Tree_forms tree;
11215 Bug_forms bug;
11216 @} form;
11217 @};
11218
11219 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
11220 @end smallexample
11221
11222 @noindent
11223 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
11224
11225 @smallexample
11226 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
11227 @end smallexample
11228
11229 @noindent
11230 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
11231
11232 @smallexample
11233 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
11234 @end smallexample
11235
11236 @noindent
11237 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
11238 and in Pascal.
11239 @end table
11240
11241 @need 1000
11242 @noindent
11243 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
11244
11245 @table @code
11246 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
11247 @item set print demangle
11248 @itemx set print demangle on
11249 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
11250 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
11251 linkage. The default is on.
11252
11253 @item show print demangle
11254 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
11255
11256 @item set print asm-demangle
11257 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
11258 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
11259 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
11260 The default is off.
11261
11262 @item show print asm-demangle
11263 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
11264 or demangled form.
11265
11266 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
11267 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
11268 @kindex set demangle-style
11269 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
11270 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
11271 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
11272 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
11273 decoding style by inspecting your program.
11274
11275 @item show demangle-style
11276 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
11277
11278 @anchor{set print object}
11279 @item set print object
11280 @itemx set print object on
11281 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
11282 @cindex display derived types
11283 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
11284 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
11285 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
11286 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
11287 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
11288 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
11289 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
11290
11291 @item set print object off
11292 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
11293 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
11294
11295 @item show print object
11296 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
11297
11298 @anchor{set print static-members}
11299 @item set print static-members
11300 @itemx set print static-members on
11301 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
11302 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
11303
11304 @item set print static-members off
11305 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
11306
11307 @item show print static-members
11308 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
11309
11310 @item set print pascal_static-members
11311 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
11312 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
11313 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
11314 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
11315
11316 @item set print pascal_static-members off
11317 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
11318
11319 @item show print pascal_static-members
11320 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
11321
11322 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
11323 @anchor{set print vtbl}
11324 @item set print vtbl
11325 @itemx set print vtbl on
11326 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
11327 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
11328 @cindex VTBL display
11329 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
11330 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11331 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11332
11333 @item set print vtbl off
11334 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
11335
11336 @item show print vtbl
11337 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
11338 @end table
11339
11340 @node Pretty Printing
11341 @section Pretty Printing
11342
11343 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
11344 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
11345 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
11346
11347 @menu
11348 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
11349 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
11350 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
11351 @end menu
11352
11353 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
11354 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
11355
11356 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
11357 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
11358 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
11359
11360 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
11361 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
11362 pretty-printers with their names.
11363 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
11364 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
11365 Each such subprinter has its own name.
11366 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
11367
11368 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
11369 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
11370 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
11371 do anything special.
11372
11373 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
11374
11375 @itemize @bullet
11376 @item
11377 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
11378 all inferiors.
11379
11380 @item
11381 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
11382 when debugging that program.
11383 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
11384
11385 @item
11386 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
11387 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
11388 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
11389 @end itemize
11390
11391 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
11392 pretty-printers are selected,
11393
11394 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
11395 for new types.
11396
11397 @node Pretty-Printer Example
11398 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
11399
11400 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
11401
11402 @smallexample
11403 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11404 $1 = @{
11405 static npos = 4294967295,
11406 _M_dataplus = @{
11407 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
11408 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
11409 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
11410 @},
11411 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
11412 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
11413 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
11414 @}
11415 @}
11416 @end smallexample
11417
11418 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
11419
11420 @smallexample
11421 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11422 $2 = "abcd"
11423 @end smallexample
11424
11425 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
11426 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
11427 @cindex pretty-printer commands
11428
11429 @table @code
11430 @kindex info pretty-printer
11431 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11432 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
11433 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
11434
11435 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
11436 whose pretty-printers to list.
11437 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
11438 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
11439 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
11440 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
11441 looks up a printer from these three objects.
11442
11443 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
11444 to list.
11445
11446 @kindex disable pretty-printer
11447 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11448 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11449 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
11450
11451 @kindex enable pretty-printer
11452 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11453 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11454 @end table
11455
11456 Example:
11457
11458 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
11459 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
11460 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
11461 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
11462
11463 @smallexample
11464 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11465 library1.so:
11466 foo
11467 library2.so:
11468 bar
11469 bar1
11470 bar2
11471 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11472 library2.so:
11473 bar
11474 bar1
11475 bar2
11476 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
11477 1 printer disabled
11478 2 of 3 printers enabled
11479 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11480 library1.so:
11481 foo [disabled]
11482 library2.so:
11483 bar
11484 bar1
11485 bar2
11486 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
11487 1 printer disabled
11488 1 of 3 printers enabled
11489 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11490 library1.so:
11491 foo [disabled]
11492 library2.so:
11493 bar
11494 bar1 [disabled]
11495 bar2
11496 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
11497 1 printer disabled
11498 0 of 3 printers enabled
11499 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11500 library1.so:
11501 foo [disabled]
11502 library2.so:
11503 bar [disabled]
11504 bar1 [disabled]
11505 bar2
11506 @end smallexample
11507
11508 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
11509 as can each individual subprinter.
11510
11511 @node Value History
11512 @section Value History
11513
11514 @cindex value history
11515 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
11516 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
11517 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
11518 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
11519 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
11520 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
11521 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
11522 symbol table.
11523
11524 @cindex @code{$}
11525 @cindex @code{$$}
11526 @cindex history number
11527 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
11528 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
11529 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
11530 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
11531 history number.
11532
11533 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
11534 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
11535 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
11536 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
11537 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
11538 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
11539 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
11540
11541 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
11542 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
11543
11544 @smallexample
11545 p *$
11546 @end smallexample
11547
11548 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11549 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11550
11551 @smallexample
11552 p *$.next
11553 @end smallexample
11554
11555 @noindent
11556 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11557 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11558
11559 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11560 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11561
11562 @smallexample
11563 print x
11564 set x=5
11565 @end smallexample
11566
11567 @noindent
11568 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11569 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11570
11571 @table @code
11572 @kindex show values
11573 @item show values
11574 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11575 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11576 values} does not change the history.
11577
11578 @item show values @var{n}
11579 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11580
11581 @item show values +
11582 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11583 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11584 @end table
11585
11586 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11587 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11588
11589 @node Convenience Vars
11590 @section Convenience Variables
11591
11592 @cindex convenience variables
11593 @cindex user-defined variables
11594 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11595 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11596 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11597 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11598 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11599
11600 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11601 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11602 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11603 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11604 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11605
11606 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11607 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11608 For example:
11609
11610 @smallexample
11611 set $foo = *object_ptr
11612 @end smallexample
11613
11614 @noindent
11615 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11616 @code{object_ptr}.
11617
11618 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11619 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11620 value with another assignment at any time.
11621
11622 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11623 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11624 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11625 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11626
11627 @table @code
11628 @kindex show convenience
11629 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11630 @item show convenience
11631 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11632 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11633 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11634
11635 @kindex init-if-undefined
11636 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11637 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11638 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11639 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11640 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11641 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11642 override default values used in a command script.
11643
11644 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11645 any side-effects do not occur.
11646 @end table
11647
11648 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11649 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11650 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11651
11652 @smallexample
11653 set $i = 0
11654 print bar[$i++]->contents
11655 @end smallexample
11656
11657 @noindent
11658 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11659
11660 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11661 values likely to be useful.
11662
11663 @table @code
11664 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11665 @item $_
11666 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11667 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11668 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11669 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11670 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11671 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11672 to the type of @code{$__}.
11673
11674 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11675 @item $__
11676 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11677 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11678 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11679
11680 @item $_exitcode
11681 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11682 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11683 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11684 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11685
11686 @item $_exitsignal
11687 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11688 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11689 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11690 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11691
11692 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11693 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11694 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11695 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11696 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11697
11698 @smallexample
11699 #include <signal.h>
11700
11701 int
11702 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11703 @{
11704 raise (SIGALRM);
11705 return 0;
11706 @}
11707 @end smallexample
11708
11709 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11710 or signalled would be:
11711
11712 @smallexample
11713 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11714 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11715 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11716 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11717 >echo The program has exited\n
11718 >else
11719 >echo The program has signalled\n
11720 >end
11721 >end
11722 (@value{GDBP}) run
11723 Starting program:
11724
11725 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11726 The program no longer exists.
11727 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11728 The program has signalled
11729 @end smallexample
11730
11731 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11732 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11733 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11734 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11735
11736 @smallexample
11737 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11738 The program has exited
11739 @end smallexample
11740
11741 @item $_exception
11742 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11743 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11744
11745 @item $_probe_argc
11746 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11747 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11748
11749 @item $_sdata
11750 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11751 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11752 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11753 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11754 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11755
11756 @item $_siginfo
11757 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11758 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11759 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11760 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11761 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11762
11763 @item $_tlb
11764 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11765 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11766 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11767 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11768 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11769 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11770
11771 @item $_inferior
11772 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11773 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11774
11775 @item $_thread
11776 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11777
11778 @item $_gthread
11779 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11780
11781 @item $_gdb_major
11782 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11783 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11784 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11785 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11786 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11787 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11788 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11789 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11790 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11791 versions.
11792
11793 @item $_shell_exitcode
11794 @itemx $_shell_exitsignal
11795 @vindex $_shell_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11796 @vindex $_shell_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11797 @cindex shell command, exit code
11798 @cindex shell command, exit signal
11799 @cindex exit status of shell commands
11800 @value{GDBN} commands such as @code{shell} and @code{|} are launching
11801 shell commands. When a launched command terminates, @value{GDBN}
11802 automatically maintains the variables @code{$_shell_exitcode}
11803 and @code{$_shell_exitsignal} according to the exit status of the last
11804 launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to
11805 the variables @code{$_exitcode} and @code{$_exitsignal}.
11806
11807 @end table
11808
11809 @node Convenience Funs
11810 @section Convenience Functions
11811
11812 @cindex convenience functions
11813 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11814 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11815 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11816 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11817 @value{GDBN}.
11818
11819 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11820 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11821
11822 @table @code
11823
11824 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11825 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11826 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11827 returns zero.
11828
11829 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11830 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11831 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11832 it is @code{void}:
11833
11834 @smallexample
11835 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11836 $1 = void
11837 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11838 $2 = 1
11839 (@value{GDBP}) run
11840 Starting program: ./a.out
11841 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11842 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11843 $3 = 0
11844 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11845 $4 = 0
11846 @end smallexample
11847
11848 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11849 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11850 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11851 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11852 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11853 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11854 anymore.
11855
11856 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11857 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11858
11859 @smallexample
11860 void
11861 foo (void)
11862 @{
11863 @}
11864 @end smallexample
11865
11866 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11867
11868 @smallexample
11869 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11870 $1 = void
11871 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11872 $2 = 1
11873 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11874 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11875 $3 = void
11876 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11877 $4 = 1
11878 @end smallexample
11879
11880 @end table
11881
11882 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11883 @code{Python} support.
11884
11885 @table @code
11886
11887 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11888 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11889 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11890 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11891 Otherwise it returns zero.
11892
11893 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11894 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11895 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11896 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11897 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11898 regular expression support.
11899
11900 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11901 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11902 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11903 Otherwise it returns zero.
11904
11905 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11906 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11907 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11908
11909 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11910 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11911 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11912 Otherwise it returns zero.
11913
11914 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11915 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11916 The default is 1.
11917
11918 Example:
11919
11920 @smallexample
11921 (gdb) backtrace
11922 #0 bottom_func ()
11923 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11924 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11925 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11926 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11927 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11928 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11929 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11930 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11931 $1 = 1
11932 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11933 $1 = 1
11934 @end smallexample
11935
11936 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11937 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11938 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11939 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11940
11941 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11942 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11943 The default is 1.
11944
11945 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11946 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11947 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11948 Otherwise it returns zero.
11949
11950 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11951 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11952 The default is 1.
11953
11954 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11955 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11956 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11957 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11958
11959 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11960 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11961 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11962 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11963
11964 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11965 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11966 The default is 1.
11967
11968 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11969 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11970 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11971 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11972
11973 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11974 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11975 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11976
11977 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11978 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11979 an enumerated type:
11980
11981 @smallexample
11982 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11983 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11984 @end smallexample
11985
11986 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
11987 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
11988 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
11989 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
11990 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
11991 the complex number @var{value}.
11992
11993 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
11994 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
11995 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
11996
11997 @end table
11998
11999 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
12000 convenience functions.
12001
12002 @table @code
12003 @item help function
12004 @kindex help function
12005 @cindex show all convenience functions
12006 Print a list of all convenience functions.
12007 @end table
12008
12009 @node Registers
12010 @section Registers
12011
12012 @cindex registers
12013 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
12014 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
12015 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
12016 your machine.
12017
12018 @table @code
12019 @kindex info registers
12020 @item info registers
12021 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
12022 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12023
12024 @kindex info all-registers
12025 @cindex floating point registers
12026 @item info all-registers
12027 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
12028 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12029
12030 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
12031 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
12032 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
12033 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
12034
12035 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
12036 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
12037 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
12038 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
12039 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
12040 @end table
12041
12042 @anchor{standard registers}
12043 @cindex stack pointer register
12044 @cindex program counter register
12045 @cindex process status register
12046 @cindex frame pointer register
12047 @cindex standard registers
12048 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
12049 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
12050 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
12051 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
12052 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
12053 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
12054 register that contains the processor status. For example,
12055 you could print the program counter in hex with
12056
12057 @smallexample
12058 p/x $pc
12059 @end smallexample
12060
12061 @noindent
12062 or print the instruction to be executed next with
12063
12064 @smallexample
12065 x/i $pc
12066 @end smallexample
12067
12068 @noindent
12069 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
12070 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
12071 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
12072 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
12073 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
12074 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
12075 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
12076
12077 @smallexample
12078 set $sp += 4
12079 @end smallexample
12080
12081 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
12082 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
12083 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
12084 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
12085 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
12086 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
12087 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
12088
12089 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
12090 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
12091 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
12092 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
12093 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
12094 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
12095 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
12096
12097 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
12098 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
12099 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
12100 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
12101 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
12102 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
12103 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
12104 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
12105 prints the data in both formats.
12106
12107 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
12108 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
12109 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
12110 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
12111 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
12112 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
12113 registers in @code{struct} notation:
12114
12115 @smallexample
12116 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
12117 $1 = @{
12118 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
12119 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
12120 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
12121 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
12122 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
12123 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
12124 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
12125 @}
12126 @end smallexample
12127
12128 @noindent
12129 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
12130 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
12131 value to a @code{struct} member:
12132
12133 @smallexample
12134 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
12135 @end smallexample
12136
12137 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
12138 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
12139 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
12140 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
12141 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
12142 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
12143
12144 @cindex caller-saved registers
12145 @cindex call-clobbered registers
12146 @cindex volatile registers
12147 @cindex <not saved> values
12148 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
12149 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
12150 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
12151 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
12152 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
12153 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
12154 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
12155 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
12156 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
12157 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
12158 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
12159 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
12160 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
12161 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
12162 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
12163 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
12164 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
12165 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
12166 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
12167 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
12168 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
12169 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
12170 represent the value the register had just before the call.
12171
12172 @node Floating Point Hardware
12173 @section Floating Point Hardware
12174 @cindex floating point
12175
12176 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
12177 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
12178
12179 @table @code
12180 @kindex info float
12181 @item info float
12182 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
12183 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
12184 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
12185 the ARM and x86 machines.
12186 @end table
12187
12188 @node Vector Unit
12189 @section Vector Unit
12190 @cindex vector unit
12191
12192 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
12193 more information about the status of the vector unit.
12194
12195 @table @code
12196 @kindex info vector
12197 @item info vector
12198 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
12199 layout vary depending on the hardware.
12200 @end table
12201
12202 @node OS Information
12203 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
12204 @cindex OS information
12205
12206 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
12207 you debug your program.
12208
12209 @cindex auxiliary vector
12210 @cindex vector, auxiliary
12211 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
12212 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
12213 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
12214 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
12215 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
12216 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
12217 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
12218 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
12219 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
12220 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
12221 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
12222
12223 @table @code
12224 @kindex info auxv
12225 @item info auxv
12226 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
12227 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
12228 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
12229 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
12230 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
12231 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
12232 an unrecognized tag.
12233 @end table
12234
12235 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
12236 information and show it to you. The types of information available
12237 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
12238 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
12239 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
12240 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
12241 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
12242
12243 @table @code
12244 @kindex info os
12245 @item info os @var{infotype}
12246
12247 Display OS information of the requested type.
12248
12249 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
12250
12251 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
12252 @table @code
12253 @kindex info os cpus
12254 @item cpus
12255 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
12256 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
12257 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
12258 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
12259 kernel initialization.
12260
12261 @kindex info os files
12262 @item files
12263 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
12264 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
12265 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
12266 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
12267
12268 @kindex info os modules
12269 @item modules
12270 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
12271 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
12272 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
12273 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
12274 in memory.
12275
12276 @kindex info os msg
12277 @item msg
12278 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
12279 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
12280 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
12281 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
12282 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
12283 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
12284 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
12285 the message queue was last changed.
12286
12287 @kindex info os processes
12288 @item processes
12289 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
12290 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
12291 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
12292 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
12293 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
12294 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
12295
12296 @kindex info os procgroups
12297 @item procgroups
12298 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
12299 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
12300 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
12301 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
12302 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
12303 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
12304 and the process group leader is listed first.
12305
12306 @kindex info os semaphores
12307 @item semaphores
12308 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
12309 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
12310 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
12311 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
12312 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
12313
12314 @kindex info os shm
12315 @item shm
12316 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
12317 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
12318 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
12319 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
12320 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
12321 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
12322 attached to, detach from, and changed.
12323
12324 @kindex info os sockets
12325 @item sockets
12326 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
12327 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
12328 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
12329 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
12330 connection.
12331
12332 @kindex info os threads
12333 @item threads
12334 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
12335 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
12336 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
12337 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
12338 process is not listed.
12339 @end table
12340
12341 @item info os
12342 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
12343 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
12344 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
12345 types, this command will report an error.
12346 @end table
12347
12348 @node Memory Region Attributes
12349 @section Memory Region Attributes
12350 @cindex memory region attributes
12351
12352 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
12353 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
12354 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
12355 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
12356 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
12357 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
12358 user can override the fetched regions.
12359
12360 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
12361 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
12362 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
12363 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
12364 all memory.
12365
12366 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
12367 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
12368
12369 @table @code
12370 @kindex mem
12371 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
12372 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
12373 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
12374 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
12375 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
12376 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
12377
12378 @item mem auto
12379 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
12380 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
12381
12382 @kindex delete mem
12383 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12384 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
12385 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
12386
12387 @kindex disable mem
12388 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12389 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12390 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
12391 It may be enabled again later.
12392
12393 @kindex enable mem
12394 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12395 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12396
12397 @kindex info mem
12398 @item info mem
12399 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
12400 for each region:
12401
12402 @table @emph
12403 @item Memory Region Number
12404 @item Enabled or Disabled.
12405 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
12406 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
12407
12408 @item Lo Address
12409 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
12410
12411 @item Hi Address
12412 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
12413
12414 @item Attributes
12415 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
12416 @end table
12417 @end table
12418
12419
12420 @subsection Attributes
12421
12422 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
12423 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
12424 write accesses to a memory region.
12425
12426 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
12427 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
12428 etc.@: from accessing memory.
12429
12430 @table @code
12431 @item ro
12432 Memory is read only.
12433 @item wo
12434 Memory is write only.
12435 @item rw
12436 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
12437 @end table
12438
12439 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
12440 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
12441 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
12442 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
12443 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
12444
12445 @table @code
12446 @item 8
12447 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
12448 @item 16
12449 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
12450 @item 32
12451 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
12452 @item 64
12453 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
12454 @end table
12455
12456 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
12457 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12458 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
12459 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
12460 @c
12461 @c @table @code
12462 @c @item hwbreak
12463 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
12464 @c @item swbreak (default)
12465 @c @end table
12466
12467 @subsubsection Data Cache
12468 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
12469 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
12470 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
12471 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
12472 registers.
12473
12474 @table @code
12475 @item cache
12476 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
12477 @item nocache
12478 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
12479 @end table
12480
12481 @subsection Memory Access Checking
12482 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
12483 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
12484 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
12485 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
12486
12487 @table @code
12488 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
12489 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
12490 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
12491 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
12492 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
12493 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
12494 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
12495 The default value is @code{on}.
12496 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
12497 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
12498 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
12499 @end table
12500
12501
12502 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
12503 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12504 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
12505 @c
12506 @c @table @code
12507 @c @item verify
12508 @c @item noverify (default)
12509 @c @end table
12510
12511 @node Dump/Restore Files
12512 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
12513 @cindex dump/restore files
12514 @cindex append data to a file
12515 @cindex dump data to a file
12516 @cindex restore data from a file
12517
12518 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
12519 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
12520 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
12521 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
12522 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
12523 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
12524 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
12525
12526 @table @code
12527
12528 @kindex dump
12529 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12530 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12531 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12532 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
12533
12534 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
12535 @table @code
12536 @item binary
12537 Raw binary form.
12538 @item ihex
12539 Intel hex format.
12540 @item srec
12541 Motorola S-record format.
12542 @item tekhex
12543 Tektronix Hex format.
12544 @item verilog
12545 Verilog Hex format.
12546 @end table
12547
12548 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
12549 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
12550 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
12551 form.
12552
12553 @kindex append
12554 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12555 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12556 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12557 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
12558 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
12559
12560 @kindex restore
12561 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
12562 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
12563 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
12564 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
12565 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
12566
12567 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
12568 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
12569 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
12570 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
12571 from that location.
12572
12573 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
12574 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
12575 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
12576 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
12577
12578 @end table
12579
12580 @node Core File Generation
12581 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
12582 @cindex dump core from inferior
12583
12584 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12585 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12586 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12587 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12588 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12589 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12590 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12591
12592 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12593 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12594 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12595
12596 @table @code
12597 @kindex gcore
12598 @kindex generate-core-file
12599 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12600 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12601 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12602 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12603 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12604 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12605
12606 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12607 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12608
12609 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12610 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12611 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12612 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12613 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12614
12615 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12616 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12617 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12618 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12619 Enable or disable the use of the file
12620 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12621 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12622 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12623 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12624
12625 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12626 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12627 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12628 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12629 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12630 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12631 about the bits that can be set in the
12632 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12633 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12634
12635 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12636 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12637 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12638 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12639 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12640 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12641 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12642 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12643
12644 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12645 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12646 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12647 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12648 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12649 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12650 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12651
12652 The default value is @code{off}.
12653 @end table
12654
12655 @node Character Sets
12656 @section Character Sets
12657 @cindex character sets
12658 @cindex charset
12659 @cindex translating between character sets
12660 @cindex host character set
12661 @cindex target character set
12662
12663 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12664 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12665 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12666 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12667 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12668 @dfn{target character set}.
12669
12670 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12671 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12672 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12673 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12674 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12675 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12676 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12677 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12678 character and string literals in expressions.
12679
12680 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12681 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12682 target-charset} command, described below.
12683
12684 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12685 support:
12686
12687 @table @code
12688 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12689 @kindex set target-charset
12690 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12691 list of supported target character sets, type
12692 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12693
12694 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12695 @kindex set host-charset
12696 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12697
12698 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12699 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12700 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12701 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12702 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12703
12704 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12705 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12706 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12707
12708 @item set charset @var{charset}
12709 @kindex set charset
12710 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12711 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12712 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12713 for both host and target.
12714
12715 @item show charset
12716 @kindex show charset
12717 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12718
12719 @item show host-charset
12720 @kindex show host-charset
12721 Show the name of the current host character set.
12722
12723 @item show target-charset
12724 @kindex show target-charset
12725 Show the name of the current target character set.
12726
12727 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12728 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12729 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12730 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12731 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12732 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12733
12734 @item show target-wide-charset
12735 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12736 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12737 @end table
12738
12739 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12740 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12741 @file{charset-test.c}:
12742
12743 @smallexample
12744 #include <stdio.h>
12745
12746 char ascii_hello[]
12747 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12748 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12749 char ibm1047_hello[]
12750 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12751 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12752
12753 main ()
12754 @{
12755 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12756 @}
12757 @end smallexample
12758
12759 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12760 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12761 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12762
12763 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12764
12765 @smallexample
12766 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12767 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12768 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12769 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12770 @dots{}
12771 (@value{GDBP})
12772 @end smallexample
12773
12774 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12775 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12776 strings:
12777
12778 @smallexample
12779 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12780 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12781 (@value{GDBP})
12782 @end smallexample
12783
12784 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12785 initial character set:
12786 @smallexample
12787 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12788 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12789 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12790 (@value{GDBP})
12791 @end smallexample
12792
12793 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12794 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12795 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12796 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12797 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12798
12799 @smallexample
12800 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12801 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12802 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12803 $2 = 72 'H'
12804 (@value{GDBP})
12805 @end smallexample
12806
12807 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12808 literals you use in expressions:
12809
12810 @smallexample
12811 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12812 $3 = 43 '+'
12813 (@value{GDBP})
12814 @end smallexample
12815
12816 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12817 character.
12818
12819 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12820 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12821 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12822
12823 @smallexample
12824 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12825 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12826 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12827 $5 = 200 '\310'
12828 (@value{GDBP})
12829 @end smallexample
12830
12831 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12832 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12833
12834 @smallexample
12835 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12836 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12837 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12838 @end smallexample
12839
12840 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12841 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12842 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12843 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12844 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12848 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12849 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12850 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12851 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12852 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12853 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12854 $7 = 72 '\110'
12855 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12856 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12857 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12858 $9 = 200 'H'
12859 (@value{GDBP})
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12863 string literals you use in expressions:
12864
12865 @smallexample
12866 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12867 $10 = 78 '+'
12868 (@value{GDBP})
12869 @end smallexample
12870
12871 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12872 character.
12873
12874 @node Caching Target Data
12875 @section Caching Data of Targets
12876 @cindex caching data of targets
12877
12878 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12879 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12880 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12881 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12882 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12883 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12884 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12885 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12886 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12887 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12888 is executing.
12889 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12890 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12891 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12892 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12893 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12894 in the code segment.
12895 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12896 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12897
12898 @table @code
12899 @kindex set remotecache
12900 @item set remotecache on
12901 @itemx set remotecache off
12902 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12903 with old scripts.
12904
12905 @kindex show remotecache
12906 @item show remotecache
12907 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12908
12909 @kindex set stack-cache
12910 @item set stack-cache on
12911 @itemx set stack-cache off
12912 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12913 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12914
12915 @kindex show stack-cache
12916 @item show stack-cache
12917 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12918
12919 @kindex set code-cache
12920 @item set code-cache on
12921 @itemx set code-cache off
12922 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12923 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12924 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12925
12926 @kindex show code-cache
12927 @item show code-cache
12928 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12929 accesses.
12930
12931 @kindex info dcache
12932 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12933 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12934 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12935 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12936 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12937 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12938
12939 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12940 printed in hex.
12941
12942 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12943 @cindex dcache size
12944 @kindex set dcache size
12945 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12946
12947 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12948 @cindex dcache line-size
12949 @kindex set dcache line-size
12950 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12951 Must be a power of 2.
12952
12953 @item show dcache size
12954 @kindex show dcache size
12955 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12956
12957 @item show dcache line-size
12958 @kindex show dcache line-size
12959 Show default size of dcache lines.
12960
12961 @end table
12962
12963 @node Searching Memory
12964 @section Search Memory
12965 @cindex searching memory
12966
12967 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12968 @code{find} command.
12969
12970 @table @code
12971 @kindex find
12972 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12973 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12974 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12975 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12976 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12977 @end table
12978
12979 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12980 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12981
12982 @table @r
12983 @item @var{s}, search query size
12984 The size of each search query value.
12985
12986 @table @code
12987 @item b
12988 bytes
12989 @item h
12990 halfwords (two bytes)
12991 @item w
12992 words (four bytes)
12993 @item g
12994 giant words (eight bytes)
12995 @end table
12996
12997 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12998 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12999 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
13000 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
13001 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
13002
13003 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
13004 value's type in the current language.
13005 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
13006 pattern as a mixture of types.
13007 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
13008 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
13009 which is typically four bytes.
13010
13011 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
13012 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
13013 @end table
13014
13015 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
13016 (@code{"}).
13017 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
13018 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
13019
13020 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
13021 number of matches found.
13022
13023 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
13024 @samp{$_}.
13025 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
13026
13027 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
13028
13029 @smallexample
13030 void
13031 hello ()
13032 @{
13033 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
13034 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
13035 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
13036 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
13037 printf ("%s\n", hello);
13038 @}
13039 @end smallexample
13040
13041 @noindent
13042 you get during debugging:
13043
13044 @smallexample
13045 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
13046 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13047 1 pattern found
13048 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
13049 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13050 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13051 2 patterns found.
13052 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
13053 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13054 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13055 2 patterns found.
13056 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
13057 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13058 1 pattern found
13059 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
13060 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
13061 1 pattern found
13062 (gdb) print $numfound
13063 $1 = 1
13064 (gdb) print $_
13065 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
13066 @end smallexample
13067
13068 @node Value Sizes
13069 @section Value Sizes
13070
13071 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
13072 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
13073 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
13074 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
13075 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
13076
13077 @table @code
13078 @kindex set max-value-size
13079 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
13080 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
13081 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
13082 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
13083 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
13084
13085 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
13086 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
13087
13088 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
13089 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
13090 currently 16 bytes.
13091
13092 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
13093 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
13094 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
13095 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
13096 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
13097 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
13098 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
13099 size is less than @var{bytes}.
13100
13101 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
13102
13103 @kindex show max-value-size
13104 @item show max-value-size
13105 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
13106 allocate for the contents of a value.
13107 @end table
13108
13109 @node Optimized Code
13110 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
13111 @cindex optimized code, debugging
13112 @cindex debugging optimized code
13113
13114 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
13115 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
13116 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
13117 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
13118 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
13119 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
13120 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
13121
13122 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
13123 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
13124 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
13125 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
13126
13127 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
13128 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
13129 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
13130 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
13131 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
13132 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
13133
13134 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
13135 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
13136 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
13137 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
13138 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
13139
13140 @menu
13141 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
13142 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
13143 @end menu
13144
13145 @node Inline Functions
13146 @section Inline Functions
13147 @cindex inline functions, debugging
13148
13149 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
13150 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
13151 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
13152 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
13153 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
13154 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
13155 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
13156 @code{info frame} command.
13157
13158 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
13159 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
13160 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
13161 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
13162 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
13163 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
13164 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
13165 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
13166 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
13167 local variables in the caller.
13168
13169 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
13170 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
13171 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
13172 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
13173 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
13174 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
13175 instructions are executed.
13176
13177 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
13178 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
13179 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
13180 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
13181
13182 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
13183 function calls are the same as normal calls:
13184
13185 @itemize @bullet
13186 @item
13187 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
13188 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
13189 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
13190 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
13191 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
13192 or inside the inlined function instead.
13193
13194 @item
13195 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
13196 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
13197 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
13198 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
13199
13200 @end itemize
13201
13202 @node Tail Call Frames
13203 @section Tail Call Frames
13204 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
13205
13206 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
13207 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
13208 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
13209 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
13210 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
13211
13212 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
13213 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
13214 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
13215 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
13216 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
13217 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
13218 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
13219
13220 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
13221 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
13222 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
13223 this information.
13224
13225 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
13226 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
13227
13228 @smallexample
13229 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
13230 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
13231 (gdb) info frame
13232 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
13233 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
13234 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
13235 source language c++.
13236 Arglist at unknown address.
13237 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
13238 @end smallexample
13239
13240 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
13241 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
13242 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
13243 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
13244 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
13245 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
13246
13247 @table @code
13248 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
13249 @item set debug entry-values
13250 @kindex set debug entry-values
13251 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
13252 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
13253 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
13254 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
13255 result.
13256
13257 @item show debug entry-values
13258 @kindex show debug entry-values
13259 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
13260 values at function entry and tail calls.
13261 @end table
13262
13263 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
13264 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
13265 reference by variable @code{x}):
13266
13267 @smallexample
13268 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
13269 void (*x) (void) = c;
13270 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13271 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
13272 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
13273
13274 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
13275 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
13276 a () at t.c:3
13277 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13278 (gdb) bt
13279 #0 a () at t.c:3
13280 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
13284
13285 @smallexample
13286 int i;
13287 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
13288 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
13289 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
13290 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
13291 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
13292 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
13293 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
13294 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
13295
13296 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
13297 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
13298 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
13299 (gdb) bt
13300 #0 f () at t.c:2
13301 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
13302 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
13303 @end smallexample
13304
13305 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
13306 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
13307
13308 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
13309 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13310 @set ARROW @click{}
13311 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
13312 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
13313 @end ifset
13314 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13315 @set ARROW ->
13316 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
13317 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
13318 @end ifclear
13319
13320 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
13321 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
13322 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
13323
13324 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
13325 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
13326 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
13327 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
13328 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
13329 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
13330
13331 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
13332 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
13333 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
13334 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
13335 omitted.
13336
13337 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
13338 entry may fail:
13339
13340 @smallexample
13341 int v;
13342 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
13343 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
13344 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
13345 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
13346 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
13347 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
13348
13349 (gdb) bt
13350 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
13351 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
13352 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
13353 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
13354 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
13355 @end smallexample
13356
13357 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
13358 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
13359 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
13360 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
13361 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
13362
13363 @node Macros
13364 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
13365
13366 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
13367 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
13368 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
13369 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
13370 where it was defined.
13371
13372 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
13373 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
13374 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
13375 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
13376
13377 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
13378 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
13379 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
13380 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
13381 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
13382 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
13383 see @ref{List}.
13384
13385 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
13386 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
13387 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
13388
13389 @table @code
13390
13391 @kindex macro expand
13392 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
13393 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
13394 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
13395 @item macro expand @var{expression}
13396 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
13397 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
13398 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
13399 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
13400 it can be any string of tokens.
13401
13402 @kindex macro exp1
13403 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
13404 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
13405 @cindex expand macro once
13406 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
13407 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
13408 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
13409 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
13410 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
13411 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
13412 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
13413 can be any string of tokens.
13414
13415 @kindex info macro
13416 @cindex macro definition, showing
13417 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
13418 @cindex macros, from debug info
13419 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
13420 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
13421 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
13422 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
13423 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
13424 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
13425
13426 @kindex info macros
13427 @item info macros @var{location}
13428 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
13429 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
13430 command-line where those definitions were established.
13431
13432 @kindex macro define
13433 @cindex user-defined macros
13434 @cindex defining macros interactively
13435 @cindex macros, user-defined
13436 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
13437 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
13438 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
13439 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
13440 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
13441 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
13442 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
13443 @var{arglist}.
13444
13445 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
13446 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
13447 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
13448 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
13449 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
13450
13451 @kindex macro undef
13452 @item macro undef @var{macro}
13453 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
13454 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
13455 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
13456 in the program being debugged.
13457
13458 @kindex macro list
13459 @item macro list
13460 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
13461 @end table
13462
13463 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
13464 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
13465 show our source files:
13466
13467 @smallexample
13468 $ cat sample.c
13469 #include <stdio.h>
13470 #include "sample.h"
13471
13472 #define M 42
13473 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13474
13475 main ()
13476 @{
13477 #define N 28
13478 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13479 #undef N
13480 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13481 #define N 1729
13482 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13483 @}
13484 $ cat sample.h
13485 #define Q <
13486 $
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
13490 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
13491 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
13492 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
13493 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
13494 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
13495 information.
13496
13497 @smallexample
13498 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
13499 $
13500 @end smallexample
13501
13502 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
13503
13504 @smallexample
13505 $ gdb -nw sample
13506 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
13507 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13508 GDB is free software, @dots{}
13509 (@value{GDBP})
13510 @end smallexample
13511
13512 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
13513 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
13514 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
13515
13516 @smallexample
13517 (@value{GDBP}) list main
13518 3
13519 4 #define M 42
13520 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13521 6
13522 7 main ()
13523 8 @{
13524 9 #define N 28
13525 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13526 11 #undef N
13527 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13528 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
13529 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
13530 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13531 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
13532 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
13533 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
13534 #define Q <
13535 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
13536 expands to: (42 + 1)
13537 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
13538 expands to: once (M + 1)
13539 (@value{GDBP})
13540 @end smallexample
13541
13542 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
13543 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
13544 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
13545 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
13546
13547 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
13548 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
13549
13550 @smallexample
13551 (@value{GDBP}) break main
13552 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
13553 (@value{GDBP}) run
13554 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
13555
13556 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
13557 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13558 (@value{GDBP})
13559 @end smallexample
13560
13561 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
13562
13563 @smallexample
13564 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13565 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
13566 #define N 28
13567 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13568 expands to: 28 < 42
13569 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13570 $1 = 1
13571 (@value{GDBP})
13572 @end smallexample
13573
13574 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
13575 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
13576 thereof) in force at each point:
13577
13578 @smallexample
13579 (@value{GDBP}) next
13580 Hello, world!
13581 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13582 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13583 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13584 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13585 (@value{GDBP}) next
13586 We're so creative.
13587 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13588 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13589 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13590 #define N 1729
13591 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13592 expands to: 1729 < 42
13593 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13594 $2 = 0
13595 (@value{GDBP})
13596 @end smallexample
13597
13598 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13599 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13600 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13601 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13602
13603 @smallexample
13604 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13605 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13606 -D__STDC__=1
13607 (@value{GDBP})
13608 @end smallexample
13609
13610
13611 @node Tracepoints
13612 @chapter Tracepoints
13613 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13614 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13615
13616 @cindex tracepoints
13617 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13618 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13619 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13620 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13621 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13622 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13623 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13624
13625 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13626 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13627 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13628 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13629 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13630 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13631 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13632 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13633 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13634 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13635 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13636
13637 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13638 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13639 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13640 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13641 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13642 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13643 Packets}.
13644
13645 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13646 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13647 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13648
13649 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13650
13651 @menu
13652 * Set Tracepoints::
13653 * Analyze Collected Data::
13654 * Tracepoint Variables::
13655 * Trace Files::
13656 @end menu
13657
13658 @node Set Tracepoints
13659 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13660
13661 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13662 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13663 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13664 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13665 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13666 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13667 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13668
13669 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13670 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13671 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13672 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13673 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13674 tracepoint was hit.
13675
13676 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13677 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13678 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13679 either.
13680
13681 @cindex fast tracepoints
13682 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13683 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13684 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13685
13686 @cindex static tracepoints
13687 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13688 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13689 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13690 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13691 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13692 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13693 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13694 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13695 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13696 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13697 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13698 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13699 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13700 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13701 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13702 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13703 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13704 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13705 static tracepoint marker.
13706
13707 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13708 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13709
13710 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13711 conditions and actions.
13712
13713 @menu
13714 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13715 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13716 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13717 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13718 * Trace State Variables::
13719 * Tracepoint Actions::
13720 * Listing Tracepoints::
13721 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13722 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13723 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13724 @end menu
13725
13726 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13727 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13728
13729 @table @code
13730 @cindex set tracepoint
13731 @kindex trace
13732 @item trace @var{location}
13733 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13734 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13735 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13736 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13737 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13738 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13739 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13740 in tracing}).
13741 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13742 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13743 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13744 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13745 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13746 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13747 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13748 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13749 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13750 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13751 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13752 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13753
13754 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13755
13756 @smallexample
13757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13758
13759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13760
13761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13762
13763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13764
13765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13766 @end smallexample
13767
13768 @noindent
13769 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13770
13771 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13772 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13773 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13774 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13775 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13776 information on tracepoint conditions.
13777
13778 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13779 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13780 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13781 @kindex ftrace
13782 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13783 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13784 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13785 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13786 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13787 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13788 message.
13789
13790 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13791 @code{trace}.
13792
13793 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13794 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13795 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13796 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13797 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13798 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13799 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13800 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13801
13802 @example
13803 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13804 @end example
13805
13806 @noindent
13807 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13808 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13809
13810 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13811 @cindex set static tracepoint
13812 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13813 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13814 @kindex strace
13815 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13816 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13817 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13818 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13819 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13820
13821 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13822 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13823 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13824 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13825 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13826 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13827 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13828 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13829 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13830 tracing engine:
13831
13832 @smallexample
13833 main ()
13834 @{
13835 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13836 @}
13837 @end smallexample
13838
13839 @noindent
13840 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13841 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13842
13843 @smallexample
13844 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13845 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13846 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13847 Data: "str %s"
13848 [etc...]
13849 @end smallexample
13850
13851 @noindent
13852 so you may probe the marker above with:
13853
13854 @smallexample
13855 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13856 @end smallexample
13857
13858 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13859 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13860 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13861 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13862 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13863 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13864 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13865 the @samp{Data:} field.
13866
13867 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13868 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13869 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13870
13871 @vindex $tpnum
13872 @cindex last tracepoint number
13873 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13874 @cindex tracepoint number
13875 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13876 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13877
13878 @kindex delete tracepoint
13879 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13880 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13881 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13882 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13883 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13884
13885 Examples:
13886
13887 @smallexample
13888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13889
13890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13891 @end smallexample
13892
13893 @noindent
13894 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13895 @end table
13896
13897 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13898 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13899
13900 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13901
13902 @table @code
13903 @kindex disable tracepoint
13904 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13905 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13906 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13907 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13908 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13909 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13910 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13911 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13912 next trace experiment.
13913
13914 @kindex enable tracepoint
13915 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13916 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13917 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13918 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13919 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13920 next time a trace experiment is run.
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13924 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13925
13926 @table @code
13927 @kindex passcount
13928 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13929 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13930 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13931 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13932 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13933 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13934 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13935 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13936 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13937 user.
13938
13939 Examples:
13940
13941 @smallexample
13942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13943 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13944
13945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13946 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13947 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13953 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13954 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13955 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13956 @end smallexample
13957 @end table
13958
13959 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13960 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13961 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13962 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13963
13964 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13965 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13966 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13967 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13968 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13969 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13970 is true.
13971
13972 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13973 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13974 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13975 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13976 just as with breakpoints.
13977
13978 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13979 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13980 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13981 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13982 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13983 accesses, and so forth.
13984
13985 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13986 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13987 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13988 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13989 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13990 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13991 search through.
13992
13993 @smallexample
13994 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13995 @end smallexample
13996
13997 @node Trace State Variables
13998 @subsection Trace State Variables
13999 @cindex trace state variables
14000
14001 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
14002 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
14003 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
14004 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
14005 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
14006 integers.
14007
14008 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
14009 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
14010 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
14011 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
14012
14013 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
14014 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
14015 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
14016 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
14017 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
14018 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
14019 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
14020 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
14021 variable with the same name.
14022
14023 @table @code
14024
14025 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
14026 @kindex tvariable
14027 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
14028 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
14029 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
14030 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
14031 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
14032 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
14033 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
14034 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
14035 value. The default initial value is 0.
14036
14037 @item info tvariables
14038 @kindex info tvariables
14039 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
14040 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
14041 currently running.
14042
14043 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
14044 @kindex delete tvariable
14045 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
14046 are specified.
14047
14048 @end table
14049
14050 @node Tracepoint Actions
14051 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
14052
14053 @table @code
14054 @kindex actions
14055 @cindex tracepoint actions
14056 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14057 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
14058 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
14059 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
14060 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
14061 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
14062 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
14063 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
14064 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
14065 @code{while-stepping}.
14066
14067 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
14068 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
14069 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
14070
14071 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
14072 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
14073 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
14074
14075 @smallexample
14076 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
14077
14078 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
14079
14080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
14081 @end smallexample
14082
14083 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
14084 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
14085 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
14086 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
14087 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
14088 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
14089 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
14090 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
14091
14092 @smallexample
14093 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14094 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14095 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
14096 > collect bar,baz
14097 > collect $regs
14098 > while-stepping 12
14099 > collect $pc, arr[i]
14100 > end
14101 end
14102 @end smallexample
14103
14104 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
14105 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14106 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
14107 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
14108 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
14109 special arguments are supported:
14110
14111 @table @code
14112 @item $regs
14113 Collect all registers.
14114
14115 @item $args
14116 Collect all function arguments.
14117
14118 @item $locals
14119 Collect all local variables.
14120
14121 @item $_ret
14122 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
14123 of a backtrace.
14124
14125 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
14126 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
14127 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
14128 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
14129 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
14130 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
14131
14132 @item $_probe_argc
14133 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
14134 tracepoint is located.
14135 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14136
14137 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
14138 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
14139 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
14140 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14141
14142 @item $_sdata
14143 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
14144 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
14145 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
14146 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
14147 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
14148 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
14149 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
14150 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
14151 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
14152
14153 @smallexample
14154 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
14155 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
14156 @end smallexample
14157
14158 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
14159 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
14160 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
14161 @value{GDBN}.
14162 @end table
14163
14164 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
14165 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
14166 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
14167
14168 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
14169 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
14170 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
14171 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
14172 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
14173 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
14174 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
14175 @samp{mystr}.
14176
14177 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
14178 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
14179
14180 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
14181 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14182 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
14183 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
14184 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
14185 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
14186 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
14187 action were used.
14188
14189 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
14190 @item while-stepping @var{n}
14191 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
14192 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
14193 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
14194 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
14195
14196 @smallexample
14197 > while-stepping 12
14198 > collect $regs, myglobal
14199 > end
14200 >
14201 @end smallexample
14202
14203 @noindent
14204 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
14205 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
14206 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
14207 @code{stepping}.
14208
14209 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14210 @kindex set default-collect
14211 @cindex default collection action
14212 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
14213 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
14214 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
14215 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
14216 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
14217 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
14218
14219 @item show default-collect
14220 @kindex show default-collect
14221 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
14222 tracepoint hit.
14223
14224 @end table
14225
14226 @node Listing Tracepoints
14227 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
14228
14229 @table @code
14230 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14231 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14232 @cindex information about tracepoints
14233 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
14234 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
14235 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
14236 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
14237 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
14238 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
14239
14240 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
14241 tracing:
14242
14243 @itemize @bullet
14244 @item
14245 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
14246
14247 @item
14248 the state about installed on target of each location
14249 @end itemize
14250
14251 @smallexample
14252 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
14253 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
14254 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
14255 while-stepping 20
14256 collect globfoo, $regs
14257 end
14258 collect globfoo2
14259 end
14260 pass count 1200
14261 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
14262 collect $eip
14263 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14264 installed on target
14265 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14266 installed on target
14267 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
14268 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
14269 not installed on target
14270 (@value{GDBP})
14271 @end smallexample
14272
14273 @noindent
14274 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
14275 @end table
14276
14277 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14278 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14279
14280 @table @code
14281 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
14282 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
14283 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
14284 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
14285 program.
14286
14287 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
14288
14289 @table @emph
14290 @item Count
14291 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
14292 stable identifier.
14293 @item ID
14294 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
14295 @item Enabled or Disabled
14296 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
14297 that are not enabled.
14298 @item Address
14299 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
14300 @item What
14301 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
14302 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
14303 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
14304 will be left blank.
14305 @end table
14306
14307 @noindent
14308 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
14309
14310 @table @emph
14311 @item Data
14312 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
14313 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
14314 marker call.
14315 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
14316 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
14317 @end table
14318
14319 @smallexample
14320 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14321 Cnt ID Enb Address What
14322 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
14323 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
14324 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
14325 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
14326 Data: str %s
14327 (@value{GDBP})
14328 @end smallexample
14329 @end table
14330
14331 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14332 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14333
14334 @table @code
14335 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
14336 @cindex start a new trace experiment
14337 @cindex collected data discarded
14338 @item tstart
14339 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
14340 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
14341 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
14342 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
14343 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
14344 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
14345 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
14346 information, and so forth.
14347
14348 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
14349 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
14350 @item tstop
14351 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
14352 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
14353 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
14354 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
14355 needs to be stopped quickly.
14356
14357 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
14358 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
14359 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
14360
14361 @kindex tstatus
14362 @cindex status of trace data collection
14363 @cindex trace experiment, status of
14364 @item tstatus
14365 This command displays the status of the current trace data
14366 collection.
14367 @end table
14368
14369 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
14370
14371 @smallexample
14372 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
14373 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14374 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
14375 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
14376 > while-stepping 11
14377 > collect $regs
14378 > end
14379 > end
14380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14381 [time passes @dots{}]
14382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
14383 @end smallexample
14384
14385 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
14386 @cindex disconnected tracing
14387 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
14388 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
14389 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
14390 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
14391 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
14392 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
14393 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
14394 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
14395
14396 @table @code
14397 @item set disconnected-tracing on
14398 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
14399 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
14400 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
14401 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
14402 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
14403 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
14404 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
14405
14406 @item show disconnected-tracing
14407 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
14408 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
14409
14410 @end table
14411
14412 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
14413 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
14414 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
14415 it will continue after reconnection.
14416
14417 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
14418 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
14419 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
14420 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
14421 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
14422 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
14423 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
14424 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
14425 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
14426 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
14427
14428 @cindex circular trace buffer
14429 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
14430 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
14431 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
14432 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
14433 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
14434 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
14435 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
14436 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
14437 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
14438 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
14439 the next run.
14440
14441 @table @code
14442 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
14443 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
14444 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
14445 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
14446 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
14447 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
14448 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
14449
14450 @item show circular-trace-buffer
14451 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
14452 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
14453 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
14454 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
14455 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
14456
14457 @end table
14458
14459 @table @code
14460 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
14461 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
14462 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
14463 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
14464 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
14465 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
14466 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
14467 likes. This is also the default.
14468
14469 @item show trace-buffer-size
14470 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
14471 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
14472 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
14473 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
14474 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
14475 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
14476 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
14477 @end table
14478
14479 @table @code
14480 @item set trace-user @var{text}
14481 @kindex set trace-user
14482
14483 @item show trace-user
14484 @kindex show trace-user
14485
14486 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
14487 @kindex set trace-notes
14488 Set the trace run's notes.
14489
14490 @item show trace-notes
14491 @kindex show trace-notes
14492 Show the trace run's notes.
14493
14494 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
14495 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
14496 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
14497 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
14498 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
14499
14500 @item show trace-stop-notes
14501 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
14502 Show the trace run's stop notes.
14503
14504 @end table
14505
14506 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
14507 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
14508
14509 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
14510 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
14511 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
14512 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
14513 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
14514 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
14515 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
14516 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
14517 mentioned here.
14518
14519 @itemize @bullet
14520
14521 @item
14522 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
14523 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
14524 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
14525 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
14526 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
14527 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
14528 cannot be collected either.
14529
14530 @item
14531 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
14532 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
14533 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
14534 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
14535 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
14536 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
14537 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
14538 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
14539 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
14540 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
14541
14542 @item
14543 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
14544 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
14545 in a misleading way.
14546
14547 @item
14548 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
14549 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
14550 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
14551 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
14552 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
14553 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
14554 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
14555 by @code{ptr}.
14556
14557 @item
14558 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
14559 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
14560 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
14561 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
14562 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
14563 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
14564 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
14565 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
14566 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
14567 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
14568 invalid address.
14569
14570 @item
14571 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
14572 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
14573 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
14574 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
14575 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
14576 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
14577 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
14578 it to zero.
14579
14580 @end itemize
14581
14582 @node Analyze Collected Data
14583 @section Using the Collected Data
14584
14585 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14586 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14587 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14588 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14589 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14590 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14591 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14592 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14593 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14594 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14595 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14596 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14597 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14598 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14599 the buffer will fail.
14600
14601 @menu
14602 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14603 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14604 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14605 @end menu
14606
14607 @node tfind
14608 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14609
14610 @kindex tfind
14611 @cindex select trace snapshot
14612 @cindex find trace snapshot
14613 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14614 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14615 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14616 snapshot is selected.
14617
14618 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14619
14620 @table @code
14621 @item tfind start
14622 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14623 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14624
14625 @item tfind none
14626 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14627
14628 @item tfind end
14629 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14630
14631 @item tfind
14632 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14633 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14634
14635 @item tfind -
14636 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14637 retracing earlier steps.
14638
14639 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14640 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14641 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14642 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14643 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14644
14645 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14646 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14647 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14648 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14649 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14650
14651 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14652 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14653 addresses (exclusive).
14654
14655 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14656 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14657 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14658
14659 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14660 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14661 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14662 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14663 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14664 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14665 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14666 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14667 @end table
14668
14669 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14670 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14671 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14672 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14673 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14674 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14675 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14676 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14677 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14678 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14679 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14680 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14681 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14682 tracepoint as the current one.
14683
14684 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14685 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14686 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14687 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14688 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14689
14690 @smallexample
14691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14693 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14694 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14695 > tfind
14696 > end
14697
14698 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14699 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14700 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14701 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14702 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14703 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14704 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14705 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14706 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14707 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14708 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14709 @end smallexample
14710
14711 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14712 the buffer:
14713
14714 @smallexample
14715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14717 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14718 > tfind line
14719 > end
14720
14721 Frame 0, X = 1
14722 Frame 7, X = 2
14723 Frame 13, X = 255
14724 @end smallexample
14725
14726 @node tdump
14727 @subsection @code{tdump}
14728 @kindex tdump
14729 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14730 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14731
14732 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14733 the current trace snapshot.
14734
14735 @smallexample
14736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14738 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14739 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14740 > end
14741
14742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14743
14744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14745 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14746 at gdb_test.c:444
14747 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14748
14749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14750 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14751 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14752 d1 0x18 24
14753 d2 0x80 128
14754 d3 0x33 51
14755 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14756 d5 0x22 34
14757 d6 0xe0 224
14758 d7 0x380035 3670069
14759 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14760 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14761 a2 0x100 256
14762 a3 0x322000 3284992
14763 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14764 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14765 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14766 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14767 ps 0x0 0
14768 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14769 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14770 fpstatus 0x0 0
14771 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14772 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14773 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14774 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14775 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14776 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14777 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14778 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14779 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14780
14781 (@value{GDBP})
14782 @end smallexample
14783
14784 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14785 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14786 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14787 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14788
14789 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14790 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14791 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14792 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14793 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14794 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14795 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14796 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14797 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14798 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14799
14800 @node save tracepoints
14801 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14802 @kindex save tracepoints
14803 @kindex save-tracepoints
14804 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14805
14806 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14807 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14808 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14809 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14810 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14811 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14812
14813 @node Tracepoint Variables
14814 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14815 @cindex tracepoint variables
14816 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14817
14818 @table @code
14819 @vindex $trace_frame
14820 @item (int) $trace_frame
14821 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14822 snapshot is selected.
14823
14824 @vindex $tracepoint
14825 @item (int) $tracepoint
14826 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14827
14828 @vindex $trace_line
14829 @item (int) $trace_line
14830 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14831
14832 @vindex $trace_file
14833 @item (char []) $trace_file
14834 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14835
14836 @vindex $trace_func
14837 @item (char []) $trace_func
14838 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14839 @end table
14840
14841 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14842 use @code{output} instead.
14843
14844 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14845 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14846 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14847 which are managed by the target.
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14851
14852 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14853 > output $trace_file
14854 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14855 > tfind
14856 > end
14857 @end smallexample
14858
14859 @node Trace Files
14860 @section Using Trace Files
14861 @cindex trace files
14862
14863 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14864 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14865 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14866 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14867 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14868
14869 @table @code
14870
14871 @kindex tsave
14872 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14873 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14874 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14875 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14876 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14877 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14878 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14879 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14880 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14881 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14882 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14883 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14884 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14885 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14886 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14887
14888 @kindex target tfile
14889 @kindex tfile
14890 @kindex target ctf
14891 @kindex ctf
14892 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14893 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14894 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14895 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14896 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14897 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14898 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14899 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14900 the host.
14901
14902 @smallexample
14903 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14904 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14905 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14906 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14907 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14908 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14909 i = 0
14910 a = 0
14911 b = 1 '\001'
14912 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14913 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14914 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14915 $1 = 1
14916 @end smallexample
14917
14918 @end table
14919
14920 @node Overlays
14921 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14922 @cindex overlays
14923
14924 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14925 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14926 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14927 use overlays.
14928
14929 @menu
14930 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14931 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14932 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14933 mapped by asking the inferior.
14934 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14935 @end menu
14936
14937 @node How Overlays Work
14938 @section How Overlays Work
14939 @cindex mapped overlays
14940 @cindex unmapped overlays
14941 @cindex load address, overlay's
14942 @cindex mapped address
14943 @cindex overlay area
14944
14945 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14946 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14947 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14948 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14949 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14950
14951 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14952 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14953 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14954 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14955 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14956 largest overlay as well.
14957
14958 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14959 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14960 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14961 there.
14962
14963 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14964 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14965 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14966
14967 @smallexample
14968 @group
14969 Data Instruction Larger
14970 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14971 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14972 | | | | | |
14973 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14974 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14975 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14976 | and heap | | | | | |
14977 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14978 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14979 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14980 | | | | | |
14981 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14982 address | | | | | |
14983 | overlay | <-' | | |
14984 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14985 | | <---. | | load address
14986 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14987 | | | |
14988 +-----------+ | |
14989 +-----------+
14990 | |
14991 +-----------+
14992
14993 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14994 @end group
14995 @end smallexample
14996
14997 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14998 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14999 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
15000 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
15001 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
15002 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
15003 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
15004 program and the overlay area.
15005
15006 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
15007 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
15008 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
15009 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
15010 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
15011 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
15012 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
15013
15014 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
15015 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
15016 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
15017
15018 @itemize @bullet
15019
15020 @item
15021 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
15022 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
15023 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
15024 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
15025
15026 @item
15027 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
15028 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
15029 your program's performance.
15030
15031 @item
15032 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
15033 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
15034 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
15035 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
15036 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
15037 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
15038 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
15039
15040 @item
15041 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
15042 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
15043 instruction and data spaces.
15044
15045 @end itemize
15046
15047 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
15048 improved in many ways:
15049
15050 @itemize @bullet
15051
15052 @item
15053 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
15054 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
15055 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
15056 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
15057 area in the usual way.
15058
15059 @item
15060 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
15061 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
15062
15063 @item
15064 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
15065 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
15066 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
15067 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
15068 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
15069 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
15070 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
15071
15072 @end itemize
15073
15074
15075 @node Overlay Commands
15076 @section Overlay Commands
15077
15078 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
15079 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
15080 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
15081 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
15082 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
15083 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
15084
15085 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
15086 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
15087
15088 @table @code
15089 @item overlay off
15090 @kindex overlay
15091 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
15092 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
15093 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
15094 overlay support is disabled.
15095
15096 @item overlay manual
15097 @cindex manual overlay debugging
15098 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15099 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
15100 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
15101 commands described below.
15102
15103 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
15104 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
15105 @cindex map an overlay
15106 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
15107 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
15108 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
15109 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
15110 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
15111 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
15112
15113 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
15114 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
15115 @cindex unmap an overlay
15116 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
15117 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
15118 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
15119 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
15120
15121 @item overlay auto
15122 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15123 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
15124 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
15125 Overlay Debugging}.
15126
15127 @item overlay load-target
15128 @itemx overlay load
15129 @cindex reloading the overlay table
15130 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
15131 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
15132 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
15133 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
15134 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
15135
15136 @item overlay list-overlays
15137 @itemx overlay list
15138 @cindex listing mapped overlays
15139 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
15140 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
15141
15142 @end table
15143
15144 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
15145 of the function the address falls in:
15146
15147 @smallexample
15148 (@value{GDBP}) print main
15149 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
15150 @end smallexample
15151 @noindent
15152 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
15153 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
15154 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
15155 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
15156
15157 @smallexample
15158 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15159 No sections are mapped.
15160 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15161 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
15162 @end smallexample
15163 @noindent
15164 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
15165 name normally:
15166
15167 @smallexample
15168 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15169 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
15170 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
15171 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15172 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
15173 @end smallexample
15174
15175 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
15176 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
15177 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
15178 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
15179 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
15180
15181 @itemize @bullet
15182 @item
15183 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
15184 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
15185 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
15186 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
15187 @item
15188 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
15189 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
15190 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
15191 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
15192 breakpoints properly.
15193 @end itemize
15194
15195
15196 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
15197 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
15198 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
15199
15200 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
15201 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
15202 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
15203 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
15204 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
15205 current state of the overlays.
15206
15207 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
15208 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
15209
15210 @table @asis
15211
15212 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
15213 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
15214
15215 @smallexample
15216 struct
15217 @{
15218 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
15219 unsigned long vma;
15220
15221 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
15222 unsigned long size;
15223
15224 /* The overlay's load address. */
15225 unsigned long lma;
15226
15227 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
15228 zero otherwise. */
15229 unsigned long mapped;
15230 @}
15231 @end smallexample
15232
15233 @item @code{_novlys}:
15234 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
15235 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
15236
15237 @end table
15238
15239 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
15240 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
15241 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
15242 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
15243 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
15244 currently mapped.
15245
15246 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
15247 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
15248 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
15249 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
15250 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
15251 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
15252 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
15253 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
15254 are not being executed.
15255
15256 @node Overlay Sample Program
15257 @section Overlay Sample Program
15258 @cindex overlay example program
15259
15260 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
15261 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
15262 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
15263 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
15264 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
15265 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
15266 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
15267
15268 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
15269 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
15270 suite. The program consists of the following files from
15271 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
15272
15273 @table @file
15274 @item overlays.c
15275 The main program file.
15276 @item ovlymgr.c
15277 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
15278 @item foo.c
15279 @itemx bar.c
15280 @itemx baz.c
15281 @itemx grbx.c
15282 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
15283 @item d10v.ld
15284 @itemx m32r.ld
15285 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
15286 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
15287 @end table
15288
15289 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
15290 cross-compiler like this:
15291
15292 @smallexample
15293 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
15294 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
15295 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
15296 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
15297 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
15298 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
15299 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
15300 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
15301 @end smallexample
15302
15303 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
15304 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
15305 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
15306
15307
15308 @node Languages
15309 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
15310 @cindex languages
15311
15312 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
15313 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
15314 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
15315 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
15316 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
15317 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
15318
15319 @cindex working language
15320 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
15321 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
15322 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
15323 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
15324 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
15325 language}.
15326
15327 @menu
15328 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
15329 * Show:: Displaying the language
15330 * Checks:: Type and range checks
15331 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
15332 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
15333 @end menu
15334
15335 @node Setting
15336 @section Switching Between Source Languages
15337
15338 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
15339 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
15340 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
15341 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
15342 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
15343 are printed, etc.
15344
15345 In addition to the working language, every source file that
15346 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
15347 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
15348 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
15349 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
15350 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
15351 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
15352 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
15353 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
15354 Displaying the Language}.
15355
15356 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
15357 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
15358 another language. In that case, make the
15359 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
15360 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
15361 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
15362
15363 @menu
15364 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
15365 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
15366 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
15367 @end menu
15368
15369 @node Filenames
15370 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
15371
15372 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
15373 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
15374
15375 @table @file
15376 @item .ada
15377 @itemx .ads
15378 @itemx .adb
15379 @itemx .a
15380 Ada source file.
15381
15382 @item .c
15383 C source file
15384
15385 @item .C
15386 @itemx .cc
15387 @itemx .cp
15388 @itemx .cpp
15389 @itemx .cxx
15390 @itemx .c++
15391 C@t{++} source file
15392
15393 @item .d
15394 D source file
15395
15396 @item .m
15397 Objective-C source file
15398
15399 @item .f
15400 @itemx .F
15401 Fortran source file
15402
15403 @item .mod
15404 Modula-2 source file
15405
15406 @item .s
15407 @itemx .S
15408 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
15409 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
15410 @end table
15411
15412 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
15413 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
15414
15415 @node Manually
15416 @subsection Setting the Working Language
15417
15418 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
15419 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
15420 your program.
15421
15422 @kindex set language
15423 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
15424 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
15425 a language, such as
15426 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
15427 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
15428
15429 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
15430 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
15431 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
15432 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
15433 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
15434 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
15435 command such as:
15436
15437 @smallexample
15438 print a = b + c
15439 @end smallexample
15440
15441 @noindent
15442 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
15443 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
15444 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
15445 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
15446
15447 @node Automatically
15448 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
15449
15450 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
15451 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
15452 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
15453 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
15454 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
15455 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
15456 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
15457 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
15458 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
15459
15460 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
15461 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
15462 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
15463 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
15464 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
15465
15466 @node Show
15467 @section Displaying the Language
15468
15469 The following commands help you find out which language is the
15470 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
15471
15472 @table @code
15473 @item show language
15474 @anchor{show language}
15475 @kindex show language
15476 Display the current working language. This is the
15477 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
15478 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
15479
15480 @item info frame
15481 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
15482 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
15483 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
15484 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
15485 information listed here.
15486
15487 @item info source
15488 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
15489 Display the source language of this source file.
15490 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
15491 information listed here.
15492 @end table
15493
15494 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
15495 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
15496 with a language explicitly:
15497
15498 @table @code
15499 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
15500 @kindex set extension-language
15501 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
15502 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
15503
15504 @item info extensions
15505 @kindex info extensions
15506 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
15507 @end table
15508
15509 @node Checks
15510 @section Type and Range Checking
15511
15512 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
15513 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
15514 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
15515 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
15516 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
15517 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
15518 errors when your program is running.
15519
15520 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
15521 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
15522 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
15523 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
15524
15525 @menu
15526 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
15527 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
15528 @end menu
15529
15530 @cindex type checking
15531 @cindex checks, type
15532 @node Type Checking
15533 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
15534
15535 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
15536 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
15537 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
15538 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
15539
15540 @smallexample
15541 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
15542
15543 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
15544 $1 = 2
15545 @exdent but
15546 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
15547 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
15548 @end smallexample
15549
15550 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
15551 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
15552
15553 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15554 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
15555 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
15556 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
15557 expressions like the second example above.
15558
15559 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
15560 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
15561 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
15562 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
15563 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
15564 little sense to evaluate anyway.
15565
15566 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
15567
15568 @kindex set check type
15569 @kindex show check type
15570 @table @code
15571 @item set check type on
15572 @itemx set check type off
15573 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
15574 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
15575 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
15576
15577 @item show check type
15578 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
15579 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
15580 @end table
15581
15582 @cindex range checking
15583 @cindex checks, range
15584 @node Range Checking
15585 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15586
15587 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15588 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15589 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15590 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15591 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15592
15593 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15594 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15595 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15596 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15597
15598 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15599 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15600 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15601 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15602 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15603 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15604
15605 @smallexample
15606 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15607 @end smallexample
15608
15609 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15610 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15611 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15612
15613 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15614
15615 @kindex set check range
15616 @kindex show check range
15617 @table @code
15618 @item set check range auto
15619 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15620 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15621 each language.
15622
15623 @item set check range on
15624 @itemx set check range off
15625 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15626 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15627 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15628 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15629
15630 @item set check range warn
15631 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15632 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15633 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15634 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15635 systems).
15636
15637 @item show range
15638 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15639 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15640 @end table
15641
15642 @node Supported Languages
15643 @section Supported Languages
15644
15645 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15646 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15647 @c This is false ...
15648 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15649 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15650 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15651 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15652 language.
15653
15654 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15655 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15656 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15657 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15658 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15659 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15660 language reference or tutorial.
15661
15662 @menu
15663 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15664 * D:: D
15665 * Go:: Go
15666 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15667 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15668 * Fortran:: Fortran
15669 * Pascal:: Pascal
15670 * Rust:: Rust
15671 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15672 * Ada:: Ada
15673 @end menu
15674
15675 @node C
15676 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15677
15678 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15679 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15680
15681 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15682 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15683 together.
15684
15685 @cindex C@t{++}
15686 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15687 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15688 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15689 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15690 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15691 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15692 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15693
15694 @menu
15695 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15696 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15697 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15698 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15699 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15700 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15701 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15702 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15703 @end menu
15704
15705 @node C Operators
15706 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15707
15708 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15709
15710 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15711 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15712 often defined on groups of types.
15713
15714 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15715
15716 @itemize @bullet
15717
15718 @item
15719 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15720 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15721
15722 @item
15723 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15724 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15725
15726 @item
15727 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15728
15729 @item
15730 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15731
15732 @end itemize
15733
15734 @noindent
15735 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15736 in order of increasing precedence:
15737
15738 @table @code
15739 @item ,
15740 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15741 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15742 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15743
15744 @item =
15745 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15746 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15747
15748 @item @var{op}=
15749 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15750 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15751 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15752 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15753 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15754
15755 @item ?:
15756 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15757 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15758 should be of an integral type.
15759
15760 @item ||
15761 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15762
15763 @item &&
15764 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15765
15766 @item |
15767 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15768
15769 @item ^
15770 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15771
15772 @item &
15773 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15774
15775 @item ==@r{, }!=
15776 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15777 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15778
15779 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15780 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15781 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15782 and non-zero for true.
15783
15784 @item <<@r{, }>>
15785 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15786
15787 @item @@
15788 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15789
15790 @item +@r{, }-
15791 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15792 pointer types.
15793
15794 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15795 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15796 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15797 integral types.
15798
15799 @item ++@r{, }--
15800 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15801 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15802 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15803 operation takes place.
15804
15805 @item *
15806 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15807 @code{++}.
15808
15809 @item &
15810 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15811
15812 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15813 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15814 to examine the address
15815 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15816 stored.
15817
15818 @item -
15819 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15820 precedence as @code{++}.
15821
15822 @item !
15823 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15824 @code{++}.
15825
15826 @item ~
15827 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15828 @code{++}.
15829
15830
15831 @item .@r{, }->
15832 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15833 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15834 pointer based on the stored type information.
15835 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15836
15837 @item .*@r{, }->*
15838 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15839
15840 @item []
15841 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15842 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15843
15844 @item ()
15845 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15846
15847 @item ::
15848 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15849 and @code{class} types.
15850
15851 @item ::
15852 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15853 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15854 above.
15855 @end table
15856
15857 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15858 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15859 predefined meaning.
15860
15861 @node C Constants
15862 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15863
15864 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15865
15866 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15867 following ways:
15868
15869 @itemize @bullet
15870 @item
15871 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15872 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15873 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15874 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15875 @code{long} value.
15876
15877 @item
15878 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15879 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15880 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15881 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15882 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15883 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15884 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15885 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15886 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15887 constant.
15888
15889 @item
15890 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15891 integral equivalents.
15892
15893 @item
15894 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15895 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15896 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15897 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15898 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15899 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15900 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15901 @samp{\n} for newline.
15902
15903 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15904 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15905 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15906 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15907
15908 @item
15909 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15910 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15911 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15912 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15913 characters.
15914
15915 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15916 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15917 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15918
15919 @item
15920 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15921 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15922
15923 @item
15924 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15925 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15926 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15927 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15928 @end itemize
15929
15930 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15931 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15932
15933 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15934 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15935
15936 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15937 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15938 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15939 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15940 @quotation
15941 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15942 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15943 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15944 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15945 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15946 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15947 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15948 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15949 @end quotation
15950
15951 @enumerate
15952
15953 @cindex member functions
15954 @item
15955 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15956
15957 @smallexample
15958 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15959 @end smallexample
15960
15961 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15962 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15963 @item
15964 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15965 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15966 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15967 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15968 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15969
15970 @cindex call overloaded functions
15971 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15972 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15973 @item
15974 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15975 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15976 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15977 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15978 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15979 default arguments.
15980
15981 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15982 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15983 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15984 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15985 number of function arguments.
15986
15987 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15988 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15989 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15990
15991 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15992 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15993 @smallexample
15994 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15995 @end smallexample
15996
15997 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15998 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15999
16000 @cindex reference declarations
16001 @item
16002 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
16003 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
16004 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
16005
16006 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
16007 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
16008 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
16009 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
16010 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
16011
16012 @item
16013 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
16014 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
16015 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
16016 necessary, for example in an expression like
16017 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
16018 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
16019 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
16020
16021 @item
16022 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
16023 specification.
16024 @end enumerate
16025
16026 @node C Defaults
16027 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
16028
16029 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
16030
16031 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
16032 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
16033 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16034 selects the working language.
16035
16036 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
16037 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
16038 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
16039 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
16040 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
16041 for further details.
16042
16043 @node C Checks
16044 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
16045
16046 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
16047
16048 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
16049 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
16050 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
16051 constants to pointers.
16052
16053 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
16054 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
16055 that is not itself an array.
16056
16057 @node Debugging C
16058 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
16059
16060 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
16061 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
16062 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
16063 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
16064
16065 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
16066 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
16067 ,Expressions}.
16068
16069 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
16070 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
16071
16072 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
16073
16074 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
16075 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
16076
16077 @table @code
16078 @cindex break in overloaded functions
16079 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
16080 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
16081 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
16082 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
16083 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
16084
16085 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
16086 @item rbreak @var{regex}
16087 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
16088 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
16089 classes.
16090 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16091
16092 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
16093 @item catch throw
16094 @itemx catch rethrow
16095 @itemx catch catch
16096 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
16097 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
16098
16099 @cindex inheritance
16100 @item ptype @var{typename}
16101 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
16102 @var{typename}.
16103 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
16104
16105 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
16106 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
16107 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
16108 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
16109 multiple inheritance is in use.
16110
16111 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
16112 @item demangle @var{name}
16113 Demangle @var{name}.
16114 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
16115
16116 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
16117 @item set print demangle
16118 @itemx show print demangle
16119 @itemx set print asm-demangle
16120 @itemx show print asm-demangle
16121 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
16122 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
16123 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16124
16125 @item set print object
16126 @itemx show print object
16127 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
16128 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16129
16130 @item set print vtbl
16131 @itemx show print vtbl
16132 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
16133 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16134 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
16135 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
16136
16137 @kindex set overload-resolution
16138 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
16139 @item set overload-resolution on
16140 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
16141 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
16142 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
16143 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
16144 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
16145 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
16146
16147 @item set overload-resolution off
16148 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
16149 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16150 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
16151 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
16152 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16153 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
16154 argument types.
16155
16156 @kindex show overload-resolution
16157 @item show overload-resolution
16158 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
16159
16160 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
16161 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
16162 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
16163 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
16164 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
16165 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
16166 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
16167
16168 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
16169
16170 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
16171 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
16172 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
16173 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
16174 for more detail.
16175
16176 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
16177 function that returns a std::string:
16178
16179 @smallexample
16180 std::string function(int);
16181 @end smallexample
16182
16183 @noindent
16184 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
16185 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
16186
16187 @smallexample
16188 function[abi:cxx11](int)
16189 @end smallexample
16190
16191 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
16192 tag. For example:
16193
16194 @smallexample
16195 (gdb) b function(int)
16196 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
16197 (gdb) info breakpoints
16198 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
16199 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
16200 at main.cc:10
16201 @end smallexample
16202
16203 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
16204 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
16205 name, like:
16206
16207 @smallexample
16208 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
16209 @end smallexample
16210 @end table
16211
16212 @node Decimal Floating Point
16213 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
16214 @cindex decimal floating point format
16215
16216 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
16217 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
16218 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
16219 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
16220
16221 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
16222 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
16223 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
16224 configured target.
16225
16226 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
16227 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
16228 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
16229
16230 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
16231 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
16232 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
16233
16234 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
16235 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
16236 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
16237
16238 @node D
16239 @subsection D
16240
16241 @cindex D
16242 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
16243 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
16244 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
16245
16246 @node Go
16247 @subsection Go
16248
16249 @cindex Go (programming language)
16250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
16251 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
16252
16253 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
16254
16255 @table @code
16256 @cindex current Go package
16257 @item The current Go package
16258 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
16259 specifying global variables and functions.
16260
16261 For example, given the program:
16262
16263 @example
16264 package main
16265 var myglob = "Shall we?"
16266 func main () @{
16267 // ...
16268 @}
16269 @end example
16270
16271 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
16272
16273 @example
16274 (gdb) p myglob
16275 (gdb) p main.myglob
16276 @end example
16277
16278 @cindex builtin Go types
16279 @item Builtin Go types
16280 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
16281 as a string.
16282
16283 @cindex builtin Go functions
16284 @item Builtin Go functions
16285 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
16286 function and handles it internally.
16287
16288 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
16289 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
16290 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
16291 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
16292 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
16293 @end table
16294
16295 @node Objective-C
16296 @subsection Objective-C
16297
16298 @cindex Objective-C
16299 This section provides information about some commands and command
16300 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
16301 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
16302 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
16303
16304 @menu
16305 * Method Names in Commands::
16306 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
16307 @end menu
16308
16309 @node Method Names in Commands
16310 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
16311
16312 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
16313 names as line specifications:
16314
16315 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
16316 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
16317 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
16318 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
16319 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
16320 @itemize
16321 @item @code{clear}
16322 @item @code{break}
16323 @item @code{info line}
16324 @item @code{jump}
16325 @item @code{list}
16326 @end itemize
16327
16328 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
16329
16330 @smallexample
16331 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
16332 @end smallexample
16333
16334 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
16335 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
16336 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
16337 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
16338 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
16339 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
16340 debugged, enter:
16341
16342 @smallexample
16343 break -[Fruit create]
16344 @end smallexample
16345
16346 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
16347 enter:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 list +[NSText initialize]
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
16354 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
16355 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
16356 is also possible to specify just a method name:
16357
16358 @smallexample
16359 break create
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
16363 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
16364 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
16365 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
16366 none apply.
16367
16368 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
16369 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
16370
16371 @smallexample
16372 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
16376 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
16377 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
16378 @kindex print-object
16379 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
16380
16381 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
16382
16383 @smallexample
16384 print -[@var{object} hash]
16385 @end smallexample
16386
16387 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
16388 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
16389 @noindent
16390 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
16391 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
16392 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
16393 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
16394 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
16395 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
16396
16397 @node OpenCL C
16398 @subsection OpenCL C
16399
16400 @cindex OpenCL C
16401 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
16402
16403 @menu
16404 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
16405 * OpenCL C Expressions::
16406 * OpenCL C Operators::
16407 @end menu
16408
16409 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
16410 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
16411
16412 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
16413 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
16414 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
16415 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
16416 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
16417
16418 @node OpenCL C Expressions
16419 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
16420
16421 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
16422 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
16423 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
16424 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
16425
16426 @node OpenCL C Operators
16427 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
16428
16429 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
16430 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
16431 vector data types.
16432
16433 @node Fortran
16434 @subsection Fortran
16435 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
16436
16437 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
16438 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
16439
16440 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
16441 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
16442 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
16443 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
16444 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
16445 underscore.
16446
16447 @menu
16448 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
16449 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
16450 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
16451 @end menu
16452
16453 @node Fortran Operators
16454 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
16455
16456 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
16457
16458 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16459 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
16460 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
16461
16462 @table @code
16463 @item **
16464 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
16465 of the second one.
16466
16467 @item :
16468 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
16469 represent a section of array.
16470
16471 @item %
16472 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
16473 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
16474 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
16475 union type.
16476 @end table
16477
16478 @node Fortran Defaults
16479 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
16480
16481 @cindex Fortran Defaults
16482
16483 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
16484 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
16485 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
16486 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
16487
16488 @node Special Fortran Commands
16489 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
16490
16491 @cindex Special Fortran commands
16492
16493 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
16494 such as displaying common blocks.
16495
16496 @table @code
16497 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
16498 @kindex info common
16499 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
16500 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
16501 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
16502 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
16503 printed.
16504 @end table
16505
16506 @node Pascal
16507 @subsection Pascal
16508
16509 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
16510 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
16511 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
16512 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
16513 syntax.
16514
16515 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
16516 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
16517 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
16518
16519 @node Rust
16520 @subsection Rust
16521
16522 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
16523 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
16524 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
16525 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
16526
16527 @itemize @bullet
16528 @item
16529 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
16530 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
16531 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
16532
16533 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
16534 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
16535 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
16536 @samp{B}.
16537
16538 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
16539 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
16540
16541 @item
16542 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
16543 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
16544 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
16545 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
16546 @samp{K::x::y}.
16547
16548 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
16549 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
16550 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
16551 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
16552 scope.
16553
16554 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
16555 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
16556
16557 @item
16558 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
16559 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
16560
16561 @item
16562 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
16563
16564 @item
16565 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
16566 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
16567 never be destroyed.
16568
16569 @item
16570 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
16571 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
16572 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
16573
16574 @item
16575 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
16576 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
16577 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
16578 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
16579 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
16580 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
16581 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
16582 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16583
16584 @item
16585 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16586 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16587 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16588 @itemize @bullet
16589
16590 @item
16591 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16592
16593 @item
16594 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16595
16596 @item
16597 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16598 type names.
16599
16600 @item
16601 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16602
16603 @item
16604 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16605 available in the crate.
16606 @end itemize
16607 @end itemize
16608
16609 @node Modula-2
16610 @subsection Modula-2
16611
16612 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16613
16614 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16615 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16616 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16617 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16618 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16619 table.
16620
16621 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16622 @menu
16623 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16624 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16625 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16626 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16627 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16628 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16629 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16630 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16631 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16632 @end menu
16633
16634 @node M2 Operators
16635 @subsubsection Operators
16636 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16637
16638 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16639 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16640 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16641 following definitions hold:
16642
16643 @itemize @bullet
16644
16645 @item
16646 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16647 their subranges.
16648
16649 @item
16650 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16651
16652 @item
16653 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16654
16655 @item
16656 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16657 @var{type}}.
16658
16659 @item
16660 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16661
16662 @item
16663 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16664
16665 @item
16666 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16667 @end itemize
16668
16669 @noindent
16670 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16671 increasing precedence:
16672
16673 @table @code
16674 @item ,
16675 Function argument or array index separator.
16676
16677 @item :=
16678 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16679 @var{value}.
16680
16681 @item <@r{, }>
16682 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16683 types.
16684
16685 @item <=@r{, }>=
16686 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16687 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16688 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16689
16690 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16691 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16692 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16693 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16694 comment character.
16695
16696 @item IN
16697 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16698 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16699
16700 @item OR
16701 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16702
16703 @item AND@r{, }&
16704 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16705
16706 @item @@
16707 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16708
16709 @item +@r{, }-
16710 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16711 and difference on set types.
16712
16713 @item *
16714 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16715 on set types.
16716
16717 @item /
16718 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16719 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16720
16721 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16722 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16723 precedence as @code{*}.
16724
16725 @item -
16726 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16727
16728 @item ^
16729 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16730
16731 @item NOT
16732 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16733 @code{^}.
16734
16735 @item .
16736 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16737 precedence as @code{^}.
16738
16739 @item []
16740 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16741
16742 @item ()
16743 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16744 as @code{^}.
16745
16746 @item ::@r{, }.
16747 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16748 @end table
16749
16750 @quotation
16751 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16752 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16753 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16754 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16755 @end quotation
16756
16757
16758 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16759 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16760 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16761
16762 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16763 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16764
16765 @table @var
16766
16767 @item a
16768 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16769
16770 @item c
16771 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16772
16773 @item i
16774 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16775
16776 @item m
16777 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16778 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16779 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16780
16781 @item n
16782 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16783
16784 @item r
16785 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16786
16787 @item t
16788 represents a type.
16789
16790 @item v
16791 represents a variable.
16792
16793 @item x
16794 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16795 explanation of the function for details.
16796 @end table
16797
16798 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16799
16800 @table @code
16801 @item ABS(@var{n})
16802 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16803
16804 @item CAP(@var{c})
16805 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16806 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16807
16808 @item CHR(@var{i})
16809 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16810
16811 @item DEC(@var{v})
16812 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16813
16814 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16815 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16816 new value.
16817
16818 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16819 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16820 set.
16821
16822 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16823 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16824
16825 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16826 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16827
16828 @item INC(@var{v})
16829 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16830
16831 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16832 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16833 new value.
16834
16835 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16836 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16837 there. Returns the new set.
16838
16839 @item MAX(@var{t})
16840 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16841
16842 @item MIN(@var{t})
16843 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16844
16845 @item ODD(@var{i})
16846 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16847
16848 @item ORD(@var{x})
16849 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16850 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16851 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16852 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16853
16854 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16855 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16856 variable or a type.
16857
16858 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16859 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16860
16861 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16862 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16863 variable or a type.
16864
16865 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16866 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16867 @end table
16868
16869 @quotation
16870 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16871 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16872 an error.
16873 @end quotation
16874
16875 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16876 @node M2 Constants
16877 @subsubsection Constants
16878
16879 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16880 ways:
16881
16882 @itemize @bullet
16883
16884 @item
16885 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16886 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16887 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16888 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16889
16890 @item
16891 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16892 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16893 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16894 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16895 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16896 digits.
16897
16898 @item
16899 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16900 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16901 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16902 followed by a @samp{C}.
16903
16904 @item
16905 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16906 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16907 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16908 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16909 sequences.
16910
16911 @item
16912 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16913
16914 @item
16915 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16916 @code{FALSE}.
16917
16918 @item
16919 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16920
16921 @item
16922 Set constants are not yet supported.
16923 @end itemize
16924
16925 @node M2 Types
16926 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16927 @cindex Modula-2 types
16928
16929 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16930 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16931 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16932 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16933 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16934 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16935
16936 The first example contains the following section of code:
16937
16938 @smallexample
16939 VAR
16940 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16941 r: [20..40] ;
16942 @end smallexample
16943
16944 @noindent
16945 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16946 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16947
16948 @smallexample
16949 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16950 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16951 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16952 SET OF CHAR
16953 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16954 21
16955 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16956 [20..40]
16957 @end smallexample
16958
16959 @noindent
16960 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16961
16962 @smallexample
16963 VAR
16964 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16965 @end smallexample
16966
16967 @noindent
16968 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16969
16970 @smallexample
16971 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16972 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16973 @end smallexample
16974
16975 @noindent
16976 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16977 expressions using the debugger.
16978
16979 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16980 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16981
16982 @smallexample
16983 VAR
16984 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16985 @end smallexample
16986
16987 @smallexample
16988 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16989 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16990 @end smallexample
16991
16992 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16993 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16994 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16995 above.
16996
16997 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16998
16999 @smallexample
17000 TYPE
17001 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
17002 t = [blue..yellow] ;
17003 VAR
17004 s: t ;
17005 BEGIN
17006 s := blue ;
17007 @end smallexample
17008
17009 @noindent
17010 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
17011 and value of a variable.
17012
17013 @smallexample
17014 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17015 $1 = blue
17016 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
17017 type = [blue..yellow]
17018 @end smallexample
17019
17020 @noindent
17021 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
17022 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
17023 their @code{C} counterparts.
17024
17025 @smallexample
17026 VAR
17027 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17028 BEGIN
17029 s[1] := 1 ;
17030 @end smallexample
17031
17032 @smallexample
17033 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17034 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
17035 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17036 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17037 @end smallexample
17038
17039 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
17040 pointer types as shown in this example:
17041
17042 @smallexample
17043 VAR
17044 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17045 BEGIN
17046 NEW(s) ;
17047 s^[1] := 1 ;
17048 @end smallexample
17049
17050 @noindent
17051 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
17052
17053 @smallexample
17054 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17055 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17056 @end smallexample
17057
17058 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
17059 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
17060 types:
17061
17062 @smallexample
17063 TYPE
17064 foo = RECORD
17065 f1: CARDINAL ;
17066 f2: CHAR ;
17067 f3: myarray ;
17068 END ;
17069
17070 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
17071 myrange = [-2..2] ;
17072 VAR
17073 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
17074 @end smallexample
17075
17076 @noindent
17077 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
17078 below.
17079
17080 @smallexample
17081 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17082 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
17083 f1 : CARDINAL;
17084 f2 : CHAR;
17085 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
17086 END
17087 @end smallexample
17088
17089 @node M2 Defaults
17090 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
17091 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
17092
17093 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
17094 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
17095 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
17096 selected the working language.
17097
17098 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
17099 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
17100 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
17101 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
17102
17103 @node Deviations
17104 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
17105 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
17106
17107 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
17108 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
17109
17110 @itemize @bullet
17111 @item
17112 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
17113 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
17114 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
17115 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
17116 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
17117 returned a pointer.)
17118
17119 @item
17120 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
17121 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
17122 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
17123 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
17124
17125 @item
17126 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
17127 argument.
17128
17129 @item
17130 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
17131 @end itemize
17132
17133 @node M2 Checks
17134 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
17135 @cindex Modula-2 checks
17136
17137 @quotation
17138 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
17139 range checking.
17140 @end quotation
17141 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
17142
17143 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
17144
17145 @itemize @bullet
17146 @item
17147 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
17148 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
17149
17150 @item
17151 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
17152 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
17153 @end itemize
17154
17155 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
17156 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
17157
17158 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
17159 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
17160
17161 @node M2 Scope
17162 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17163 @cindex scope
17164 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
17165 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
17166 @ifinfo
17167 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
17168 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
17169 @end ifinfo
17170 @ifnotinfo
17171 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
17172 @end ifnotinfo
17173
17174 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
17175 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
17176 similar syntax:
17177
17178 @smallexample
17179
17180 @var{module} . @var{id}
17181 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
17182 @end smallexample
17183
17184 @noindent
17185 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
17186 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
17187 identifier within your program, except another module.
17188
17189 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
17190 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
17191 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
17192 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
17193
17194 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
17195 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
17196 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
17197 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
17198 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
17199 @var{module}.
17200
17201 @node GDB/M2
17202 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17203
17204 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
17205 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
17206 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
17207 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
17208 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
17209 analogue in Modula-2.
17210
17211 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
17212 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
17213 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
17214 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
17215 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
17216 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
17217
17218 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
17219 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
17220 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
17221
17222 @node Ada
17223 @subsection Ada
17224 @cindex Ada
17225
17226 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
17227 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
17228 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
17229 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17230 to be difficult.
17231
17232
17233 @cindex expressions in Ada
17234 @menu
17235 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
17236 and semantics supported by Ada mode
17237 in @value{GDBN}.
17238 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
17239 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
17240 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
17241 subprograms.
17242 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
17243 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
17244 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
17245 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17246 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
17247 Profile
17248 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
17249 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
17250 @end menu
17251
17252 @node Ada Mode Intro
17253 @subsubsection Introduction
17254 @cindex Ada mode, general
17255
17256 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
17257 syntax, with some extensions.
17258 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
17259
17260 @itemize @bullet
17261 @item
17262 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
17263 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
17264 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
17265 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
17266
17267 @item
17268 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
17269 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17270
17271 @item
17272 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17273 @end itemize
17274
17275 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
17276 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
17277 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
17278 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
17279 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
17280
17281 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
17282 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
17283 was translated from an Ada source file.
17284
17285 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
17286 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
17287 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
17288 middle (to allow based literals).
17289
17290 @node Omissions from Ada
17291 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
17292 @cindex Ada, omissions from
17293
17294 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
17295
17296 @itemize @bullet
17297 @item
17298 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
17299
17300 @itemize @minus
17301 @item
17302 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
17303 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
17304
17305 @item
17306 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
17307
17308 @item
17309 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
17310
17311 @item
17312 @t{'Tag}.
17313
17314 @item
17315 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
17316 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
17317
17318 @item
17319 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
17320 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
17321
17322 @item
17323 @t{'Address}.
17324 @end itemize
17325
17326 @item
17327 The names in
17328 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
17329 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
17330 not currently available.
17331
17332 @item
17333 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
17334 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
17335 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
17336 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
17337 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
17338 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
17339 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
17340 indeterminate values.
17341
17342 @item
17343 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
17344 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
17345 are not implemented.
17346
17347 @item
17348 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
17349 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
17350 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
17351 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
17352 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
17356 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
17357 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
17358 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
17359 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
17360 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
17361 @end smallexample
17362
17363 Changing a
17364 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
17365 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
17366 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
17367 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
17368 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
17369 declared to have a type such as:
17370
17371 @smallexample
17372 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
17373 Id : Integer;
17374 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
17375 end record;
17376 @end smallexample
17377
17378 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
17379 assignments:
17380
17381 @smallexample
17382 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
17383 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
17384 @end smallexample
17385
17386 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
17387 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
17388 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
17389 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
17390 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
17391 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
17392 redundant component associations, although which component values are
17393 assigned in such cases is not defined.
17394
17395 @item
17396 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
17397
17398 @item
17399 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
17400 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
17401 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
17402 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
17403 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
17404 the proper resolution.
17405
17406 @item
17407 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
17408
17409 @item
17410 Entry calls are not implemented.
17411
17412 @item
17413 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
17414 formats are not supported.
17415
17416 @item
17417 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
17418
17419 @item
17420 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
17421 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
17422 context.
17423 Should your program
17424 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
17425 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
17426 @end itemize
17427
17428 @node Additions to Ada
17429 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
17430 @cindex Ada, deviations from
17431
17432 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
17433 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
17434
17435 @itemize @bullet
17436 @item
17437 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
17438 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
17439 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
17440 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
17441 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
17442 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
17443 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
17444 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
17445
17446 @item
17447 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
17448 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
17449 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
17450
17451 @item
17452 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
17453 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
17454
17455 @item
17456 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
17457 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
17458 @end itemize
17459
17460 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
17461 additions specific to Ada:
17462
17463 @itemize @bullet
17464 @item
17465 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
17466 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
17467
17468 @smallexample
17469 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
17470 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
17471 @end smallexample
17472
17473 @item
17474 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
17475 the value of its right-hand operand.
17476 This allows, for example,
17477 complex conditional breaks:
17478
17479 @smallexample
17480 (@value{GDBP}) break f
17481 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
17482 @end smallexample
17483
17484 @item
17485 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
17486 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
17487 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
17488 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
17489 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
17490 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
17491 in strings. For example,
17492 @smallexample
17493 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
17494 @end smallexample
17495 @noindent
17496 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
17497 after each period.
17498
17499 @item
17500 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
17501 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
17502 to write
17503
17504 @smallexample
17505 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
17506 @end smallexample
17507
17508 @item
17509 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
17510 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
17511 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
17512 of 3 might print as
17513
17514 @smallexample
17515 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
17516 @end smallexample
17517
17518 @noindent
17519 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
17520 clause.
17521
17522 @item
17523 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
17524 multi-character subsequence of
17525 their names (an exact match gets preference).
17526 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
17527 in place of @t{a'length}.
17528
17529 @item
17530 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
17531 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
17532 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
17533 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
17534 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
17535 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
17536 For example,
17537 @smallexample
17538 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 @item
17542 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
17543 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
17544 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
17545 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
17546 object.
17547
17548 @end itemize
17549
17550 @node Overloading support for Ada
17551 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
17552 @cindex overloading, Ada
17553
17554 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
17555 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
17556 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
17557 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
17558 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
17559 functions to procedures elsewhere.
17560
17561 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
17562 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
17563 use, for instance:
17564
17565 @smallexample
17566 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
17567 Multiple matches for f
17568 [0] cancel
17569 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
17570 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
17571 >
17572 @end smallexample
17573
17574 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
17575 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
17576 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
17577
17578 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
17579 case:
17580
17581 @table @code
17582
17583 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17584 @item set ada print-signatures
17585 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17586 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17587 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17588
17589 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17590 @item show ada print-signatures
17591 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17592 overloads selection menu.
17593 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17594
17595 @end table
17596
17597 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17598 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17599
17600 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17601 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17602 before reaching the main procedure.
17603 As defined in the Ada Reference
17604 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17605 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17606 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17607 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17608
17609 @node Ada Exceptions
17610 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17611
17612 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17613
17614 @table @code
17615 @kindex info exceptions
17616 @item info exceptions
17617 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17618 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17619 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17620 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17621 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17622 @end table
17623
17624 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17625 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17626 argument.
17627
17628 @smallexample
17629 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17630 All defined Ada exceptions:
17631 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17632 program_error: 0x613d20
17633 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17634 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17635 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17636 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17637 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17638 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17639 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17640 @end smallexample
17641
17642 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17643 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17644
17645 @node Ada Tasks
17646 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17647 @cindex Ada, tasking
17648
17649 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17650 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17651
17652 @table @code
17653 @kindex info tasks
17654 @item info tasks
17655 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17656
17657
17658 @smallexample
17659 @iftex
17660 @leftskip=0.5cm
17661 @end iftex
17662 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17663 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17664 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17665 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17666 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17667 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17668
17669 @end smallexample
17670
17671 @noindent
17672 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17673 task currently being inspected.
17674
17675 @table @asis
17676 @item ID
17677 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17678
17679 @item TID
17680 The Ada task ID.
17681
17682 @item P-ID
17683 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17684
17685 @item Pri
17686 The base priority of the task.
17687
17688 @item State
17689 Current state of the task.
17690
17691 @table @code
17692 @item Unactivated
17693 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17694 executing.
17695
17696 @item Runnable
17697 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17698 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17699
17700 @item Terminated
17701 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17702 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17703 terminated themselves.
17704
17705 @item Child Activation Wait
17706 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17707
17708 @item Accept Statement
17709 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17710
17711 @item Waiting on entry call
17712 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17713
17714 @item Async Select Wait
17715 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17716 select statement.
17717
17718 @item Delay Sleep
17719 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17720 alternative open.
17721
17722 @item Child Termination Wait
17723 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17724 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17725 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17726
17727 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17728 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17729 finish terminating.
17730
17731 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17732 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17733 @end table
17734
17735 @item Name
17736 Name of the task in the program.
17737
17738 @end table
17739
17740 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17741 @item info task @var{taskno}
17742 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17743 the following example:
17744 @smallexample
17745 @iftex
17746 @leftskip=0.5cm
17747 @end iftex
17748 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17749 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17750 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17751 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17752 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17753 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17754 Name: "task_1"
17755 Thread: 0
17756 LWP: 0x1fac
17757 Parent: 1 ("main_task")
17758 Base Priority: 15
17759 State: Runnable
17760 @end smallexample
17761
17762 @item task
17763 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17764 @cindex current Ada task ID
17765 This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
17766
17767 @smallexample
17768 @iftex
17769 @leftskip=0.5cm
17770 @end iftex
17771 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17772 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17773 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17774 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17775 (@value{GDBP}) task
17776 [Current task is 2 "some_task"]
17777 @end smallexample
17778
17779 @item task @var{taskno}
17780 @cindex Ada task switching
17781 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17782 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17783 from the current task to the given task.
17784
17785 @smallexample
17786 @iftex
17787 @leftskip=0.5cm
17788 @end iftex
17789 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17790 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17791 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17792 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17793 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17794 [Switching to task 1 "main_task"]
17795 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17796 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17797 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17798 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17799 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17800 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17801 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17802 @end smallexample
17803
17804 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17805 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17806 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17807 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17808 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17809 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17810 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17811 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17812 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17813
17814 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17815 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17816 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17817 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17818 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17819
17820 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17821 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17822 program.
17823
17824 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17825 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17826 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17827
17828 For example,
17829
17830 @smallexample
17831 @iftex
17832 @leftskip=0.5cm
17833 @end iftex
17834 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17835 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17836 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17837 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17838 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17839 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17840 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17841 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17842 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17843 Continuing.
17844 task # 1 running
17845 task # 2 running
17846
17847 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17848 15 flush;
17849 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17850 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17851 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17852 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17853 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17854 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17855 @end smallexample
17856 @end table
17857
17858 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17859 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17860 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17861
17862 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17863 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17864 the platform being used.
17865 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17866 switching is not supported.
17867
17868 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17869 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17870 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17871 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17872 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17873 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17874
17875 @node Ravenscar Profile
17876 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17877 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17878
17879 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17880 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17881 requirements.
17882
17883 @table @code
17884 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17885 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17886 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17887 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17888 Profile. This is the default.
17889
17890 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17891 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17892 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17893 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17894 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17895 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17896 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17897
17898 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17899 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17900 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17901 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17902
17903 @end table
17904
17905 @node Ada Settings
17906 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17907 @cindex Ada settings
17908
17909 @table @code
17910 @kindex set varsize-limit
17911 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17912 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17913 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17914 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17915 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17916 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17917 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17918
17919 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17920 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17921 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17922 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17923 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17924 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17925 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17926 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17927 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17928 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17929 size is less than @var{size}.
17930
17931 @kindex show varsize-limit
17932 @item show varsize-limit
17933 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17934 @end table
17935
17936 @node Ada Glitches
17937 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17938 @cindex Ada, problems
17939
17940 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17941 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17942 @value{GDBN},
17943 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17944 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17945
17946 @itemize @bullet
17947 @item
17948 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17949 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17950
17951 @item
17952 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17953 argument lists are treated as positional).
17954
17955 @item
17956 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17957
17958 @item
17959 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17960 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17961 the host machine.
17962
17963 @item
17964 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17965 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17966 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17967 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17968 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17969 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17970 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17971 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17972 you can usually resolve the confusion
17973 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17974 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17975 @end itemize
17976
17977 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17978 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17979 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17980 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17981 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17982 enabled.
17983
17984 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17985 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17986 @table @code
17987
17988 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17989 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17990 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17991 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17992 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17993 This is the default.
17994
17995 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17996 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17997 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17998 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17999 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
18000 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
18001 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
18002
18003 @end table
18004
18005 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
18006 @cindex GNAT encoding
18007 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
18008 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
18009 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
18010 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
18011 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
18012 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
18013
18014 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
18015 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
18016 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
18017 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
18018 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
18019 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
18020 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
18021 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
18022
18023 @table @code
18024
18025 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
18026 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
18027 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
18028 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
18029
18030 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18031 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18032 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
18033
18034 @end table
18035
18036 @node Unsupported Languages
18037 @section Unsupported Languages
18038
18039 @cindex unsupported languages
18040 @cindex minimal language
18041 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
18042 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
18043 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
18044 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
18045 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
18046 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
18047
18048 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
18049 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
18050 language.
18051
18052 @node Symbols
18053 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
18054
18055 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
18056 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
18057 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
18058 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
18059 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
18060 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
18061 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18062
18063 @cindex symbol names
18064 @cindex names of symbols
18065 @cindex quoting names
18066 @anchor{quoting names}
18067 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
18068 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
18069 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
18070 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
18071 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
18072 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
18073 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
18074 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
18075
18076 @smallexample
18077 p 'foo.c'::x
18078 @end smallexample
18079
18080 @noindent
18081 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
18082
18083 @table @code
18084 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
18085 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
18086 @kindex set case-sensitive
18087 @item set case-sensitive on
18088 @itemx set case-sensitive off
18089 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
18090 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
18091 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
18092 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
18093 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
18094 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
18095 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
18096 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
18097 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
18098 case-insensitive matches.
18099
18100 @kindex show case-sensitive
18101 @item show case-sensitive
18102 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
18103 lookups.
18104
18105 @kindex set print type methods
18106 @item set print type methods
18107 @itemx set print type methods on
18108 @itemx set print type methods off
18109 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
18110 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18111 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18112 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18113 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
18114 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
18115
18116 @kindex show print type methods
18117 @item show print type methods
18118 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
18119 classes.
18120
18121 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
18122 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
18123 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
18124 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
18125 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
18126 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
18127 types defined in classes.
18128
18129 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
18130 @item show print type nested-type-limit
18131 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
18132 printing classes.
18133
18134 @kindex set print type typedefs
18135 @item set print type typedefs
18136 @itemx set print type typedefs on
18137 @itemx set print type typedefs off
18138
18139 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
18140 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18141 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18142 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18143 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
18144 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
18145 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
18146 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
18147 types.
18148
18149 @kindex show print type typedefs
18150 @item show print type typedefs
18151 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
18152 printing classes.
18153
18154 @kindex info address
18155 @cindex address of a symbol
18156 @item info address @var{symbol}
18157 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
18158 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
18159 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
18160 is always stored.
18161
18162 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
18163 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
18164 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
18165
18166 @kindex info symbol
18167 @cindex symbol from address
18168 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
18169 @item info symbol @var{addr}
18170 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
18171 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
18172 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
18173
18174 @smallexample
18175 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
18176 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
18177 @end smallexample
18178
18179 @noindent
18180 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
18181 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
18182
18183 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
18184 library containing the symbol is also printed:
18185
18186 @smallexample
18187 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
18188 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
18189 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
18190 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
18191 @end smallexample
18192
18193 @kindex demangle
18194 @cindex demangle
18195 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
18196 Demangle @var{name}.
18197 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
18198 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
18199
18200 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
18201 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
18202
18203 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
18204 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
18205
18206 @kindex whatis
18207 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18208 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
18209 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
18210 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18211
18212 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
18213 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
18214 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
18215
18216 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
18217 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
18218 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
18219 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
18220 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
18221 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
18222 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
18223 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
18224 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
18225
18226 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
18227 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
18228 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
18229 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
18230 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
18231 unroll it.
18232
18233 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
18234 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
18235 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
18236
18237 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
18238 Available flags are:
18239
18240 @table @code
18241 @item r
18242 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
18243 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
18244 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
18245
18246 @item m
18247 Do not print methods defined in the class.
18248
18249 @item M
18250 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18251 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
18252
18253 @item t
18254 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
18255 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
18256 names are substituted when printing other types.
18257
18258 @item T
18259 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18260 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
18261
18262 @item o
18263 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
18264 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
18265
18266 For example, given the following declarations:
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 struct tuv
18270 @{
18271 int a1;
18272 char *a2;
18273 int a3;
18274 @};
18275
18276 struct xyz
18277 @{
18278 int f1;
18279 char f2;
18280 void *f3;
18281 struct tuv f4;
18282 @};
18283
18284 union qwe
18285 @{
18286 struct tuv fff1;
18287 struct xyz fff2;
18288 @};
18289
18290 struct tyu
18291 @{
18292 int a1 : 1;
18293 int a2 : 3;
18294 int a3 : 23;
18295 char a4 : 2;
18296 int64_t a5;
18297 int a6 : 5;
18298 int64_t a7 : 3;
18299 @};
18300 @end smallexample
18301
18302 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
18303
18304 @smallexample
18305 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
18306 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
18307 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18308 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18309 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18310 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18311
18312 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18313 @}
18314 @end smallexample
18315
18316 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
18317 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
18318 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
18319 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
18320 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
18321 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
18322 its fields.
18323
18324 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
18325
18326 @smallexample
18327 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
18328 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
18329 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
18330 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18331 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18332 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18333 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18334
18335 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18336 @} fff1;
18337 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
18338 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
18339 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
18340 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
18341 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
18342 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
18343 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
18344 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18345 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
18346 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
18347
18348 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18349 @} f4;
18350
18351 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18352 @} fff2;
18353
18354 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18355 @}
18356 @end smallexample
18357
18358 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
18359 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
18360 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
18361 of these structures' fields.
18362
18363 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
18364 bitfields:
18365
18366 @smallexample
18367 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
18368 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
18369 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
18370 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
18371 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
18372 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
18373 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
18374 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18375 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
18376 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
18377 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
18378 "/* XXX 7-byte padding */
18379
18380 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18381 @}
18382 @end smallexample
18383
18384 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
18385 first bit of the bitfield.
18386 @end table
18387
18388 @kindex ptype
18389 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18390 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
18391 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
18392 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
18393
18394 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
18395 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
18396 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
18397 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
18398 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
18399 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
18400 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
18401 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
18402
18403 For example, for this variable declaration:
18404
18405 @smallexample
18406 typedef double real_t;
18407 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
18408 typedef struct complex complex_t;
18409 complex_t var;
18410 real_t *real_pointer_var;
18411 @end smallexample
18412
18413 @noindent
18414 the two commands give this output:
18415
18416 @smallexample
18417 @group
18418 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
18419 type = complex_t
18420 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18421 type = struct complex @{
18422 real_t real;
18423 double imag;
18424 @}
18425 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
18426 type = struct complex
18427 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
18428 type = struct complex
18429 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
18430 type = struct complex @{
18431 real_t real;
18432 double imag;
18433 @}
18434 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
18435 type = real_t *
18436 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
18437 type = double *
18438 @end group
18439 @end smallexample
18440
18441 @noindent
18442 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
18443 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18444
18445 @cindex incomplete type
18446 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
18447 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
18448 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
18449 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
18450 given these declarations:
18451
18452 @smallexample
18453 struct foo;
18454 struct foo *fooptr;
18455 @end smallexample
18456
18457 @noindent
18458 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
18459
18460 @smallexample
18461 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
18462 $1 = <incomplete type>
18463 @end smallexample
18464
18465 @noindent
18466 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
18467 completely specified.
18468
18469 @cindex unknown type
18470 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
18471 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
18472 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
18473 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
18474 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
18475 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
18476 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
18477 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
18478
18479 @smallexample
18480 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18481 type = <data variable, no debug info>
18482 @end smallexample
18483
18484 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
18485 of such variables.
18486
18487 @kindex info types
18488 @item info types [-q] [@var{regexp}]
18489 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
18490 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
18491 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
18492 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
18493 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
18494 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
18495 name is @code{value}.
18496
18497 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18498 to print the type description according to the
18499 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18500 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18501 language of the type, other values mean to use
18502 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18503
18504 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
18505 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
18506 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
18507
18508 The output from @samp{into types} is proceeded with a header line
18509 describing what types are being listed. The optional flag @samp{-q},
18510 which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables printing this header
18511 information.
18512
18513 @kindex info type-printers
18514 @item info type-printers
18515 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
18516 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
18517 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
18518 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
18519 type printers.
18520
18521 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
18522
18523 @kindex enable type-printer
18524 @kindex disable type-printer
18525 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18526 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18527 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
18528
18529 @kindex info scope
18530 @cindex local variables
18531 @item info scope @var{location}
18532 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
18533 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
18534 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
18535 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
18536 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
18537
18538 @smallexample
18539 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
18540 Scope for command_line_handler:
18541 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
18542 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
18543 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
18544 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
18545 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
18546 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
18547 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
18548 @end smallexample
18549
18550 @noindent
18551 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
18552 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
18553 collect}.
18554
18555 @kindex info source
18556 @item info source
18557 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
18558 the function containing the current point of execution:
18559 @itemize @bullet
18560 @item
18561 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
18562 @item
18563 the directory it was compiled in,
18564 @item
18565 its length, in lines,
18566 @item
18567 which programming language it is written in,
18568 @item
18569 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
18570 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
18571 @item
18572 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
18573 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
18574 @item
18575 whether the debugging information includes information about
18576 preprocessor macros.
18577 @end itemize
18578
18579
18580 @kindex info sources
18581 @item info sources
18582 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
18583 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
18584 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
18585
18586 @item info sources [-dirname | -basename] [--] [@var{regexp}]
18587 Like @samp{info sources}, but only print the names of the files
18588 matching the provided @var{regexp}.
18589 By default, the @var{regexp} is used to match anywhere in the filename.
18590 If @code{-dirname}, only files having a dirname matching @var{regexp} are shown.
18591 If @code{-basename}, only files having a basename matching @var{regexp}
18592 are shown.
18593 The matching is case-sensitive, except on operating systems that
18594 have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows).
18595
18596 @kindex info functions
18597 @item info functions [-q] [-n]
18598 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18599 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18600 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18601 number.
18602
18603 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18604 to print the function name and type according to the
18605 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18606 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18607 language of the function, other values mean to use
18608 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18609
18610 The @samp{-n} flag excludes @dfn{non-debugging symbols} from the
18611 results. A non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the
18612 executable's symbol table, not from the debug information (for
18613 example, DWARF) associated with the executable.
18614
18615 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18616 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18617 have been printed.
18618
18619 @item info functions [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18620 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18621 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18622
18623 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18624 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18625 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18626 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18627 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18628 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18629 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18630
18631 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18632 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18633 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18634 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18635 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18636 of special characters or quotes.
18637 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18638 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18639 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18640 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18641 int.
18642
18643 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18644 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18645 @var{type_regexp}.
18646
18647
18648 @kindex info variables
18649 @item info variables [-q] [-n]
18650 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18651 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18652 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18653 their respective source line numbers.
18654
18655 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18656 to print the variable name and type according to the
18657 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18658 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18659 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18660 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18661
18662 The @samp{-n} flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
18663
18664 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18665 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18666 have been printed.
18667
18668 @item info variables [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18669 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18670 with the provided regexp(s).
18671
18672 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18673 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18674
18675 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18676 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18677 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18678 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18679 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18680 of special characters or quotes.
18681
18682 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18683 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18684 @var{type_regexp}.
18685
18686 @kindex info classes
18687 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18688 @item info classes
18689 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18690 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18691 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18692 expression.
18693
18694 @kindex info selectors
18695 @item info selectors
18696 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18697 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18698 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18699 expression.
18700
18701 @ignore
18702 This was never implemented.
18703 @kindex info methods
18704 @item info methods
18705 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18706 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18707 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18708 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18709 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18710 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18711 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18712 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18713 @end ignore
18714
18715 @cindex opaque data types
18716 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18717 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18718 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18719 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18720 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18721 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18722 another source file. The default is on.
18723
18724 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18725 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18726
18727 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18728 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18729 is printed as follows:
18730 @smallexample
18731 @{<no data fields>@}
18732 @end smallexample
18733
18734 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18735 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18736 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18737
18738 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18739 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18740 @item set print symbol-loading
18741 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18742 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18743 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18744 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18745 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18746 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18747 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18748 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18749 can be annoying.
18750 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18751 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18752 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18753 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18754
18755 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18756 @item show print symbol-loading
18757 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18758 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18759
18760 @kindex maint print symbols
18761 @cindex symbol dump
18762 @kindex maint print psymbols
18763 @cindex partial symbol dump
18764 @kindex maint print msymbols
18765 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18766 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18767 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18768 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18769 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18770 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18771 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18772 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18773 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18774 that objfile.
18775 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18776 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18777 @code{main}.
18778 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18779 source file.
18780
18781 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18782 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18783 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18784 tables.
18785 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18786 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18787 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18788 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18789 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18790 ``ELF symbols''.
18791
18792 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18793 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18794
18795 @kindex maint info symtabs
18796 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18797 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18798 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18799 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18800 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18801 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18802 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18803
18804 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18805 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18806 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18807 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18808 structure in more detail. For example:
18809
18810 @smallexample
18811 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18812 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18813 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18814 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18815 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18816 readin no
18817 fullname (null)
18818 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18819 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18820 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18821 dependencies (none)
18822 @}
18823 @}
18824 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18825 (@value{GDBP})
18826 @end smallexample
18827 @noindent
18828 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18829 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18830 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18831 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18832 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18836 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18837 line 1574.
18838 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18839 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18840 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18841 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18842 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18843 dirname (null)
18844 fullname (null)
18845 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18846 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18847 debugformat DWARF 2
18848 @}
18849 @}
18850 (@value{GDBP})
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 @kindex maint info line-table
18854 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18855 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18856 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18857
18858 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18859 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18860 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18861
18862 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18863 @cindex symbol cache size
18864 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18865 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18866 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18867 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18868 with different sizes.
18869
18870 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18871 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18872 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18873
18874 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18875 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18876 @item maint print symbol-cache
18877 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18878 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18879
18880 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18881 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18882 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18883 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18884 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18885
18886 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18887 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18888 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18889 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18890 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18891 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18892
18893 @end table
18894
18895 @node Altering
18896 @chapter Altering Execution
18897
18898 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18899 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18900 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18901 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18902 program.
18903
18904 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18905 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18906 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18907
18908 @menu
18909 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18910 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18911 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18912 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18913 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18914 * Patching:: Patching your program
18915 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18916 @end menu
18917
18918 @node Assignment
18919 @section Assignment to Variables
18920
18921 @cindex assignment
18922 @cindex setting variables
18923 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18924 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18925
18926 @smallexample
18927 print x=4
18928 @end smallexample
18929
18930 @noindent
18931 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18932 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18933 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18934 information on operators in supported languages.
18935
18936 @kindex set variable
18937 @cindex variables, setting
18938 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18939 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18940 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18941 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18942 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18943
18944 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18945 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18946 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18947 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18948 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18949 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18950 command @code{set width}:
18951
18952 @smallexample
18953 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18954 type = double
18955 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18956 $4 = 13
18957 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18958 Invalid syntax in expression.
18959 @end smallexample
18960
18961 @noindent
18962 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18963 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18964
18965 @smallexample
18966 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18967 @end smallexample
18968
18969 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18970 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18971 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18972 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18973 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18974 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18975
18976 @smallexample
18977 @group
18978 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18979 type = double
18980 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18981 $1 = 1
18982 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18983 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18984 $2 = 1
18985 (@value{GDBP}) r
18986 The program being debugged has been started already.
18987 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18988 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18989 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18990 Invalid bfd target.
18991 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18992 The current BFD target is "=4".
18993 @end group
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 @noindent
18997 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18998 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18999 @code{g}, use
19000
19001 @smallexample
19002 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
19003 @end smallexample
19004
19005 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
19006 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
19007 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
19008 same length or shorter.
19009 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
19010 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
19011
19012 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
19013 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
19014 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
19015 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
19016 and representation in memory), and
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
19020 @end smallexample
19021
19022 @noindent
19023 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
19024
19025 @node Jumping
19026 @section Continuing at a Different Address
19027
19028 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
19029 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
19030 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
19031
19032 @table @code
19033 @kindex jump
19034 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
19035 @item jump @var{location}
19036 @itemx j @var{location}
19037 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
19038 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
19039 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
19040 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
19041 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
19042
19043 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
19044 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
19045 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
19046 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
19047 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
19048 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
19049 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
19050 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
19051 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
19052 @end table
19053
19054 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
19055 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
19056 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
19057 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
19058 example,
19059
19060 @smallexample
19061 set $pc = 0x485
19062 @end smallexample
19063
19064 @noindent
19065 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
19066 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
19067 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
19068
19069 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
19070 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
19071 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
19072 detail.
19073
19074 @c @group
19075 @node Signaling
19076 @section Giving your Program a Signal
19077 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
19078
19079 @table @code
19080 @kindex signal
19081 @item signal @var{signal}
19082 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
19083 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
19084 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
19085 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19086
19087 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
19088 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
19089 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19090 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
19091 signal.
19092
19093 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
19094 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
19095 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
19096 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
19097 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
19098 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
19099 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
19100 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
19101
19102 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
19103 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
19104 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
19105 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
19106 passes the signal directly to your program.
19107
19108 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
19109 after executing the command.
19110
19111 @kindex queue-signal
19112 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
19113 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
19114 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
19115 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
19116 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19117 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
19118 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
19119 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
19120 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
19121
19122 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
19123 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
19124 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
19125 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19126 @code{continue} command.
19127
19128 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
19129 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
19130 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
19131 (@pxref{Signals}).
19132 @end table
19133 @c @end group
19134
19135 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
19136 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
19137
19138 @node Returning
19139 @section Returning from a Function
19140
19141 @table @code
19142 @cindex returning from a function
19143 @kindex return
19144 @item return
19145 @itemx return @var{expression}
19146 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
19147 command. If you give an
19148 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
19149 value.
19150 @end table
19151
19152 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
19153 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
19154 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
19155 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
19156
19157 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
19158 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
19159 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
19160 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
19161 of functions.
19162
19163 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
19164 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
19165 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
19166 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
19167 selected stack frame returns naturally.
19168
19169 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
19170 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
19171 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
19172 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
19173 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
19174 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
19175 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
19176 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
19177 assignment into the right register(s).
19178
19179 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
19180 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
19181 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
19182 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
19183 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
19184 into a @code{long long int}:
19185
19186 @smallexample
19187 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
19188 29 return 31;
19189 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19190 Make func return now? (y or n) y
19191 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
19192 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
19193 (@value{GDBP})
19194 @end smallexample
19195
19196 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
19197 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
19198 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
19199 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
19200 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
19201 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
19202 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
19203 an appropriate cast explicitly:
19204
19205 @smallexample
19206 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
19207 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19208 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
19209 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
19210 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
19211 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
19212 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
19213 (@value{GDBP})
19214 @end smallexample
19215
19216 @node Calling
19217 @section Calling Program Functions
19218
19219 @table @code
19220 @cindex calling functions
19221 @cindex inferior functions, calling
19222 @item print @var{expr}
19223 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
19224 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
19225 debugged.
19226
19227 @kindex call
19228 @item call @var{expr}
19229 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
19230 returned values.
19231
19232 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
19233 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
19234 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
19235 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
19236 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
19237 value history.
19238 @end table
19239
19240 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
19241 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
19242 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
19243 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
19244
19245 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
19246 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
19247 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
19248 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
19249 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
19250 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
19251 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
19252 in that case is controlled by the
19253 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
19254
19255 @table @code
19256 @item set unwindonsignal
19257 @kindex set unwindonsignal
19258 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
19259 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
19260 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
19261 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
19262 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
19263 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
19264 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
19265 received.
19266
19267 @item show unwindonsignal
19268 @kindex show unwindonsignal
19269 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19270 @value{GDBN}.
19271
19272 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19273 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19274 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
19275 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
19276 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
19277 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
19278 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
19279 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
19280 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
19281 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
19282
19283 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19284 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19285 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19286 @value{GDBN}.
19287
19288 @item set may-call-functions
19289 @kindex set may-call-functions
19290 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
19291 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
19292 Set permission to call functions in the program.
19293 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
19294 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
19295 defaults to @code{on}.
19296
19297 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
19298 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
19299 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
19300 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
19301 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
19302 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
19303 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
19304 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
19305
19306 @item show may-call-functions
19307 @kindex show may-call-functions
19308 Show permission to call functions in the program.
19309
19310 @end table
19311
19312 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
19313
19314 @cindex no debug info functions
19315 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
19316 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
19317 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
19318 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
19319 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
19320 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
19321
19322 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
19323 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
19324 declared return type. For example:
19325
19326 @smallexample
19327 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
19328 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
19329 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
19330 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
19331 @end smallexample
19332
19333 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
19334 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
19335 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
19336 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
19337
19338 @smallexample
19339 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
19340 @end smallexample
19341
19342 @noindent
19343 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
19344
19345 @smallexample
19346 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 @noindent
19350 these calls are equivalent:
19351
19352 @smallexample
19353 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
19354 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19355 @end smallexample
19356
19357 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
19358 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
19359 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
19360 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
19361 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
19362 float parameters, and no debug info:
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 float
19366 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
19367 float v1, v2;
19368 @{
19369 return v1 * v2;
19370 @}
19371 @end smallexample
19372
19373 @noindent
19374 you call it like this:
19375
19376 @smallexample
19377 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380 @node Patching
19381 @section Patching Programs
19382
19383 @cindex patching binaries
19384 @cindex writing into executables
19385 @cindex writing into corefiles
19386
19387 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
19388 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
19389 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
19390 patching your program's binary.
19391
19392 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
19393 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
19394 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
19395 repairs.
19396
19397 @table @code
19398 @kindex set write
19399 @item set write on
19400 @itemx set write off
19401 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
19402 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
19403 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
19404
19405 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
19406 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
19407 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
19408
19409 @item show write
19410 @kindex show write
19411 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
19412 as well as reading.
19413 @end table
19414
19415 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
19416 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19417 @cindex injecting code
19418 @cindex writing into executables
19419 @cindex compiling code
19420
19421 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
19422 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
19423 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
19424 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
19425
19426 @table @code
19427 @kindex compile code
19428 @item compile code @var{source-code}
19429 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
19430 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
19431 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
19432 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
19433 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
19434 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
19435 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
19436 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
19437 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
19438 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
19439 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
19440
19441 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
19442 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
19443 E.g.:
19444
19445 @smallexample
19446 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
19447 @end smallexample
19448
19449 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
19450 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
19451 from actual source code. E.g.:
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
19455 @end smallexample
19456
19457 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
19458 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
19459 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
19460 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
19461 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
19462 editor.
19463
19464 @smallexample
19465 compile code
19466 >printf ("hello\n");
19467 >printf ("world\n");
19468 >end
19469 @end smallexample
19470
19471 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
19472 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
19473 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
19474 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
19475 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
19476 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
19477 inferior symbols otherwise.
19478
19479 @kindex compile file
19480 @item compile file @var{filename}
19481 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
19482 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
19483
19484 @smallexample
19485 compile file /home/user/example.c
19486 @end smallexample
19487 @end table
19488
19489 @table @code
19490 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
19491 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
19492 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
19493 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
19494 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
19495 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
19496 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
19497 Formats}. The @code{compile print} command accepts the same options
19498 as the @code{print} command; see @ref{print options}.
19499
19500 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --]
19501 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f}
19502 @cindex reprint the last value
19503 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
19504 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
19505 command without any text following the command. This will start the
19506 multiple-line editor.
19507 @end table
19508
19509 @noindent
19510 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
19511
19512 @table @code
19513 @anchor{set debug compile}
19514 @item set debug compile
19515 @cindex compile command debugging info
19516 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
19517 injecting the code. The default is off.
19518
19519 @item show debug compile
19520 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
19521 compiling and injecting the code.
19522
19523 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
19524 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
19525 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
19526 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
19527 The default is off.
19528
19529 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
19530 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
19531 C@t{++} type conversion.
19532 @end table
19533
19534 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
19535
19536 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
19537 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
19538 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
19539 injecting process.
19540
19541 @noindent
19542 The options used, in increasing precedence:
19543
19544 @table @asis
19545 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
19546 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
19547 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
19548 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
19549
19550 @item compilation options recorded in the target
19551 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
19552 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
19553 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
19554 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
19555 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
19556 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
19557 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
19558
19559 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
19560 @end table
19561
19562 @noindent
19563 You can override compilation options using the following command:
19564
19565 @table @code
19566 @item set compile-args
19567 @cindex compile command options override
19568 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
19569 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
19570 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
19571 compilation.
19572
19573 @item show compile-args
19574 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
19575 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
19576 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
19577 @end table
19578
19579 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
19580
19581 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
19582 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
19583 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
19584
19585 @table @asis
19586 @item C code examples and caveats
19587 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
19588 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
19589 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
19590 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
19591 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
19592
19593 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
19594 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
19595 much like any other normal debugging session.
19596
19597 @smallexample
19598 void function1 (void)
19599 @{
19600 int i = 42;
19601 printf ("function 1\n");
19602 @}
19603
19604 void function2 (void)
19605 @{
19606 int j = 12;
19607 function1 ();
19608 @}
19609
19610 int main(void)
19611 @{
19612 int k = 6;
19613 int *p;
19614 function2 ();
19615 return 0;
19616 @}
19617 @end smallexample
19618
19619 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
19620 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
19621 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
19622
19623 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
19624 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
19625 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
19626 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
19627 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19628
19629 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19630 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19631 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19632 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19633 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19634 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19635 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19636 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19637 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19638 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19639
19640 @smallexample
19641 compile code k = 3;
19642 @end smallexample
19643
19644 @noindent
19645 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19646 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19647 @code{compile} command changes it.
19648
19649 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19650 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19651 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19652 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19653 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19654
19655 @smallexample
19656 compile code j = 3;
19657 @end smallexample
19658
19659 @noindent
19660 will result in a compilation error message.
19661
19662 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19663 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19664 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19665
19666 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19667 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19668 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19669 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19670
19671 @smallexample
19672 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19673 @end smallexample
19674
19675 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19676 command has completed:
19677
19678 @smallexample
19679 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19680 @end smallexample
19681
19682 @noindent
19683 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19684 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19685 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19686 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19687 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19688
19689 @smallexample
19690 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19691 @end smallexample
19692
19693 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19694 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19695 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19696 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19697 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19698 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19699 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19700 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19701
19702 @smallexample
19703 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19704 @end smallexample
19705
19706 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19707 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19708 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19709 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19710 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19711 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19712 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19713
19714 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19715 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19716 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19717 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19718 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19719 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19720
19721 @smallexample
19722 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19723 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19724 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19725 Compilation failed.
19726 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19727 42
19728 @end smallexample
19729
19730 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19731 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19732 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19733 will print to the console.
19734 @end table
19735
19736 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19737
19738 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19739 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19740 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19741 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19742 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19743 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19744 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19745 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19746
19747
19748 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19749 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19750 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19751 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19752 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19753 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19754 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19755
19756 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19757 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19758 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19759 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19760 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19761 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19762 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19763
19764 @table @code
19765 @item set compile-gcc
19766 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19767 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19768 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19769 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19770 default.
19771
19772 @item show compile-gcc
19773 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19774 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19775 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19776 @end table
19777
19778 @node GDB Files
19779 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19780
19781 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19782 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19783 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19784 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19785
19786 @menu
19787 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19788 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19789 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19790 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19791 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19792 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19793 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19794 @end menu
19795
19796 @node Files
19797 @section Commands to Specify Files
19798
19799 @cindex symbol table
19800 @cindex core dump file
19801
19802 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19803 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19804 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19805 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19806
19807 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19808 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19809 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19810 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19811 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19812 new files are useful.
19813
19814 @table @code
19815 @cindex executable file
19816 @kindex file
19817 @item file @var{filename}
19818 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19819 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19820 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19821 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19822 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19823 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19824 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19825 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19826
19827 @cindex unlinked object files
19828 @cindex patching object files
19829 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19830 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19831 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19832 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19833 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19834 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19835 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19836 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19837
19838 @item file
19839 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19840 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19841
19842 @kindex exec-file
19843 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19844 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19845 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19846 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19847 discard information on the executable file.
19848
19849 @kindex symbol-file
19850 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19851 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19852 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19853 table and program to run from the same file.
19854
19855 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19856 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19857 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19858 enabled.
19859
19860 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19861 program's symbol table.
19862
19863 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19864 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19865 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19866 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19867 @value{GDBN}.
19868
19869 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19870 executing it once.
19871
19872 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19873 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19874 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19875 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19876 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19877 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19878 optimized code.
19879
19880 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19881 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19882 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19883 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19884 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19885
19886 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19887 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19888 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19889 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19890 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19891 Warnings and Messages}.)
19892
19893 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19894 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19895 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19896 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19897 in stabs format.
19898
19899 @kindex readnow
19900 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19901 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19902 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19903 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19904 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19905 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19906 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19907 entire symbol table available.
19908
19909 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19910 @cindex never read symbols
19911 @cindex symbols, never read
19912 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19913 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19914 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19915 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19916 @xref{--readnever}.
19917
19918 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19919 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19920 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19921 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19922 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19923 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19924 @c files.
19925
19926 @kindex core-file
19927 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19928 @itemx core
19929 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19930 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19931 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19932 executable file itself for other parts.
19933
19934 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19935 to be used.
19936
19937 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19938 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19939 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19940 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19941 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19942
19943 @kindex add-symbol-file
19944 @cindex dynamic linking
19945 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19946 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19947 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19948 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19949 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19950 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19951 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19952 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19953 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19954 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19955 can be given as an expression.
19956
19957 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19958 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19959 specified explicitly.
19960
19961 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19962 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19963 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19964 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19965
19966 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19967
19968 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19969 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19970 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19971 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19972 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19973 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19974 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19975 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19976 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19977
19978 @itemize @bullet
19979 @item
19980 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19981 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19982 @item
19983 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19984 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19985 @item
19986 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19987 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19988 @end itemize
19989
19990 @noindent
19991 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19992 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19993 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19994 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19995 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19996 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19997 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19998 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19999 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
20000 way.
20001
20002 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20003
20004 @kindex remove-symbol-file
20005 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
20006 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
20007 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
20008 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
20009 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
20010
20011 @smallexample
20012 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
20013 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
20014 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
20015 (y or n) y
20016 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
20017 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
20018 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
20019 (gdb)
20020 @end smallexample
20021
20022
20023 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20024
20025 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
20026 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
20027 @cindex load symbols from memory
20028 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
20029 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
20030 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
20031 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
20032 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
20033 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
20034 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
20035 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
20036 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
20037
20038 @kindex section
20039 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
20040 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
20041 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
20042 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
20043 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
20044 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
20045 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
20046 their addresses.
20047
20048 @kindex info files
20049 @kindex info target
20050 @item info files
20051 @itemx info target
20052 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
20053 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
20054 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
20055 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
20056 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
20057 current ones.
20058
20059 @kindex maint info sections
20060 @item maint info sections
20061 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
20062 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
20063 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
20064 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
20065 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
20066 may be arbitrarily combined):
20067
20068 @table @code
20069 @item ALLOBJ
20070 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
20071 @item @var{sections}
20072 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
20073 @item @var{section-flags}
20074 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
20075 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
20076 @table @code
20077 @item ALLOC
20078 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
20079 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
20080 @item LOAD
20081 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
20082 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
20083 @item RELOC
20084 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
20085 @item READONLY
20086 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
20087 @item CODE
20088 Section contains executable code only.
20089 @item DATA
20090 Section contains data only (no executable code).
20091 @item ROM
20092 Section will reside in ROM.
20093 @item CONSTRUCTOR
20094 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
20095 @item HAS_CONTENTS
20096 Section is not empty.
20097 @item NEVER_LOAD
20098 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
20099 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
20100 A notification to the linker that the section contains
20101 COFF shared library information.
20102 @item IS_COMMON
20103 Section contains common symbols.
20104 @end table
20105 @end table
20106 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
20107 @cindex read-only sections
20108 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
20109 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
20110 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
20111 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
20112 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
20113 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
20114 enhancement to debugging performance.
20115
20116 The default is off.
20117
20118 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
20119 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
20120 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
20121 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
20122
20123 @item show trust-readonly-sections
20124 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
20125 @end table
20126
20127 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
20128 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
20129 name and remembers it that way.
20130
20131 @cindex shared libraries
20132 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
20133 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
20134 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
20135 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
20136
20137 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
20138 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
20139
20140 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
20141 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
20142 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
20143 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
20144 debugging a core file).
20145
20146 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
20147 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
20148 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
20149
20150 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
20151 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
20152 particularly large or there are many of them.
20153
20154 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
20155 commands:
20156
20157 @table @code
20158 @kindex set auto-solib-add
20159 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
20160 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
20161 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
20162 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
20163 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
20164 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
20165 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
20166
20167 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
20168 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
20169 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
20170 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
20171 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
20172 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
20173 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
20174 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
20175 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
20176
20177 @kindex show auto-solib-add
20178 @item show auto-solib-add
20179 Display the current autoloading mode.
20180 @end table
20181
20182 @cindex load shared library
20183 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
20184 command:
20185
20186 @table @code
20187 @kindex info sharedlibrary
20188 @kindex info share
20189 @item info share @var{regex}
20190 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20191 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
20192 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
20193 all shared libraries that are loaded.
20194
20195 @kindex info dll
20196 @item info dll @var{regex}
20197 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
20198
20199 @kindex sharedlibrary
20200 @kindex share
20201 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20202 @itemx share @var{regex}
20203 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
20204 Unix regular expression.
20205 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
20206 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
20207 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
20208 loaded.
20209
20210 @item nosharedlibrary
20211 @kindex nosharedlibrary
20212 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
20213 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
20214 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
20215 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
20216 discarded.
20217 @end table
20218
20219 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
20220 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
20221 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
20222 Catchpoints}).
20223
20224 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
20225 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
20226 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
20227 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
20228
20229 @table @code
20230 @item set stop-on-solib-events
20231 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
20232 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
20233 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
20234 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
20235 shared library.
20236
20237 @item show stop-on-solib-events
20238 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
20239 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
20240 library events happen.
20241 @end table
20242
20243 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
20244 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
20245 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
20246 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
20247 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
20248 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
20249 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
20250 not.
20251
20252 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
20253 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
20254 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
20255 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
20256 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
20257
20258 @table @code
20259 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
20260 @cindex system root, alternate
20261 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
20262 @kindex set sysroot
20263 @item set sysroot @var{path}
20264 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
20265 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
20266 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
20267 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
20268 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
20269 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
20270 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
20271 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
20272 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
20273 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
20274 @var{path}.
20275
20276 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
20277 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
20278 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
20279 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
20280 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
20281 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
20282 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
20283 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
20284 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
20285 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
20286 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
20287 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
20288 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
20289 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
20290
20291 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
20292 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
20293 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
20294 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
20295 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
20296
20297 @smallexample
20298 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
20299 @end smallexample
20300
20301 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
20302 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
20303 system:
20304
20305 @smallexample
20306 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
20307 @end smallexample
20308
20309 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
20310 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
20311 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
20312 colons:
20313
20314 @smallexample
20315 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
20316 @end smallexample
20317
20318 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
20319 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
20320 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
20321 @samp{z}):
20322
20323 @smallexample
20324 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
20325 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20326 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20327 @end smallexample
20328
20329 @noindent
20330 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
20331 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
20332 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
20333
20334 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
20335 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
20336
20337 @smallexample
20338 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
20339 @end smallexample
20340
20341 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
20342 if you don't want or need to.
20343
20344 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
20345 sysroot}.
20346
20347 @cindex default system root
20348 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
20349 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
20350 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
20351 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20352 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
20353 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20354 location.
20355
20356 @kindex show sysroot
20357 @item show sysroot
20358 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
20359
20360 @kindex set solib-search-path
20361 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
20362 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20363 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
20364 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
20365 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
20366 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
20367 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
20368 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
20369 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
20370 of shared library symbols.
20371
20372 @kindex show solib-search-path
20373 @item show solib-search-path
20374 Display the current shared library search path.
20375
20376 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
20377 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
20378 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
20379 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
20380 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
20381
20382 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
20383 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
20384 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
20385 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
20386 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
20387 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
20388 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
20389 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
20390 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
20391 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
20392 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
20393 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
20394 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
20395 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
20396 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
20397 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
20398 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
20399 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
20400 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
20401 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
20402 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
20403 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
20404
20405 @table @code
20406 @item unix
20407 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
20408 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
20409 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
20410 the forward slash.
20411
20412 @item dos-based
20413 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
20414 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
20415 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
20416 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
20417 considered directory separators.
20418
20419 @item auto
20420 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
20421 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
20422 This is the default.
20423 @end table
20424 @end table
20425
20426 @cindex file name canonicalization
20427 @cindex base name differences
20428 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
20429 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
20430 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
20431 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
20432 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
20433 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
20434 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
20435 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
20436 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
20437 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
20438 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
20439 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
20440 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
20441 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
20442 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
20443
20444 @table @code
20445 @item set basenames-may-differ
20446 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
20447 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20448
20449 @item show basenames-may-differ
20450 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
20451 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20452 @end table
20453
20454 @node File Caching
20455 @section File Caching
20456 @cindex caching of opened files
20457 @cindex caching of bfd objects
20458
20459 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
20460 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
20461 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
20462 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
20463
20464 @table @code
20465 @kindex maint info bfds
20466 @item maint info bfds
20467 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
20468 @value{GDBN}.
20469
20470 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
20471 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
20472 @kindex bfd caching
20473 @item maint set bfd-sharing
20474 @item maint show bfd-sharing
20475 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
20476 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
20477 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
20478 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
20479 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
20480 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
20481 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
20482
20483 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20484 @kindex bfd caching
20485 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20486 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
20487
20488 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
20489 @kindex bfd caching
20490 @item show debug bfd-cache
20491 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
20492 @end table
20493
20494 @node Separate Debug Files
20495 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
20496 @cindex separate debugging information files
20497 @cindex debugging information in separate files
20498 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
20499 @cindex debugging information directory, global
20500 @cindex global debugging information directories
20501 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
20502 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
20503
20504 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
20505 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
20506 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
20507 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
20508 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
20509 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
20510 install only when they need to debug a problem.
20511
20512 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
20513 file:
20514
20515 @itemize @bullet
20516 @item
20517 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
20518 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
20519 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
20520 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
20521 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
20522 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
20523 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
20524 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
20525
20526 @item
20527 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
20528 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
20529 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
20530 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
20531 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
20532 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
20533 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
20534 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
20535 below.
20536 @end itemize
20537
20538 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
20539 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
20540
20541 @itemize @bullet
20542 @item
20543 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
20544 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
20545 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
20546 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
20547 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
20548 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
20549 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
20550 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
20551 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
20552
20553 @item
20554 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
20555 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
20556 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
20557 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
20558 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
20559 hex characters, not 10.)
20560 @end itemize
20561
20562 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
20563 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
20564 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
20565 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
20566 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
20567 debug information files, in the indicated order:
20568
20569 @itemize @minus
20570 @item
20571 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
20572 @item
20573 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
20574 @item
20575 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
20576 @item
20577 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
20578 @end itemize
20579
20580 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
20581 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
20582 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
20583 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
20584 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
20585
20586 @table @code
20587
20588 @kindex set debug-file-directory
20589 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
20590 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20591 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
20592 concatenating them by a path separator.
20593
20594 @kindex show debug-file-directory
20595 @item show debug-file-directory
20596 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20597 information files.
20598
20599 @end table
20600
20601 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
20602 @cindex debug link sections
20603 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
20604 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
20605
20606 @itemize
20607 @item
20608 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
20609 a zero byte,
20610 @item
20611 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
20612 boundary within the section, and
20613 @item
20614 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
20615 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
20616 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
20617 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
20618 @end itemize
20619
20620 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
20621 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
20622 described above.
20623
20624 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
20625 @cindex build ID sections
20626 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
20627 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
20628 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
20629 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
20630 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
20631 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20632 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20633 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20634 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20635
20636 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20637 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20638 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20639 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20640 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20641 in an ordinary executable.
20642
20643 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20644 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20645 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20646 following commands:
20647
20648 @smallexample
20649 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20650 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20651 @end smallexample
20652
20653 @noindent
20654 These commands remove the debugging
20655 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20656 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20657 two files:
20658
20659 @itemize @bullet
20660 @item
20661 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20662 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20666 @end smallexample
20667
20668 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20669 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20670 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20671 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20672
20673 @item
20674 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20675 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20676 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20677 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20678 @end itemize
20679
20680 @noindent
20681
20682 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20683 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20684 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20685
20686 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20687 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20688 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20689 @c different ways!
20690 @ifhtml
20691 @display
20692 @html
20693 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20694 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20695 @end html
20696 @end display
20697 @end ifhtml
20698 @ifnothtml
20699 @display
20700 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20701 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20702 @end display
20703 @end ifnothtml
20704
20705 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20706 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20707 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20708 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20709 CRC.
20710
20711 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20712 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20713 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20714 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20715 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20716
20717 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20718 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20719 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20720 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20721 @code{0xffffffff}.
20722
20723 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20724 @smallexample
20725 unsigned long
20726 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20727 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20728 @{
20729 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20730 @{
20731 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20732 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20733 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20734 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20735 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20736 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20737 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20738 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20739 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20740 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20741 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20742 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20743 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20744 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20745 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20746 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20747 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20748 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20749 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20750 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20751 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20752 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20753 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20754 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20755 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20756 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20757 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20758 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20759 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20760 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20761 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20762 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20763 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20764 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20765 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20766 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20767 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20768 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20769 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20770 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20771 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20772 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20773 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20774 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20775 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20776 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20777 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20778 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20779 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20780 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20781 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20782 0x2d02ef8d
20783 @};
20784 unsigned char *end;
20785
20786 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20787 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20788 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20789 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20790 @}
20791 @end smallexample
20792
20793 @noindent
20794 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20795
20796 @node MiniDebugInfo
20797 @section Debugging information in a special section
20798 @cindex separate debug sections
20799 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20800
20801 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20802 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20803 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20804 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20805
20806 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20807 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20808 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20809 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20810 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20811 debugging information might be included in the section.
20812
20813 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20814 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20815 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20816
20817 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20818 standard utilities:
20819
20820 @smallexample
20821 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20822 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20823 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20824 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20825
20826 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20827 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20828 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20829 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20830 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20831 | sort > funcsyms
20832
20833 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20834 # table.
20835 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20836
20837 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20838 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20839
20840 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20841 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20842 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20843 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20844
20845 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20846 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20847
20848 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20849 # original binary.
20850 xz mini_debuginfo
20851 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20852 @end smallexample
20853
20854 @node Index Files
20855 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20856 @cindex index files
20857 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20858
20859 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20860 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20861 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20862 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20863 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20864 startup.
20865
20866 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20867 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20868 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20869
20870 @smallexample
20871 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20875
20876 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20877 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20878
20879 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20880 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20881 using @command{objcopy}.
20882
20883 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20884
20885 @table @code
20886 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20887 @kindex save gdb-index
20888 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20889 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20890 default creates it produces a single file
20891 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20892 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20893 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20894 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20895 given @var{directory}.
20896 @end table
20897
20898 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20899 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20900
20901 @smallexample
20902 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20903 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20904 @end smallexample
20905
20906 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20907
20908 @smallexample
20909 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20910 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20911 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20912 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20913 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20914 @end smallexample
20915
20916 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20917 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20918 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20919 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20920 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20921 The default is @code{off}.
20922 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20923 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20924
20925 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20926 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20927
20928 @smallexample
20929 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20930 @end smallexample
20931
20932 Instead you must do, for example,
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20939 using DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, only the
20940 @code{-dwarf-5} index works for programs using Ada.
20941
20942 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20943
20944 @cindex automatic symbol index cache
20945 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20946 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20947 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20948 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20949
20950 @table @code
20951
20952 @kindex set index-cache
20953 @item set index-cache on
20954 @itemx set index-cache off
20955 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20956
20957 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20958 @kindex show index-cache
20959 @itemx show index-cache directory
20960 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20961
20962 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20963 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20964 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20965 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20966 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20967 differ according to local convention.
20968
20969 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20970 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20971
20972 @item show index-cache stats
20973 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20974
20975 @end table
20976
20977 @node Symbol Errors
20978 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20979
20980 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20981 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20982 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20983 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20984 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20985 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20986 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20987 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20988 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20989 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20990 Messages}).
20991
20992 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20993
20994 @table @code
20995 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20996
20997 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20998 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20999 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
21000 in its outer scope blocks.
21001
21002 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
21003 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
21004 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
21005 function.
21006
21007 @item block at @var{address} out of order
21008
21009 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
21010 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
21011 do so.
21012
21013 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
21014 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
21015 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
21016 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21017 Messages}.)
21018
21019 @item bad block start address patched
21020
21021 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
21022 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
21023 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
21024
21025 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
21026 starting on the previous source line.
21027
21028 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
21029
21030 @cindex foo
21031 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
21032 larger than the size of the string table.
21033
21034 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
21035 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
21036 with this name.
21037
21038 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
21039
21040 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
21041 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
21042 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
21043
21044 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
21045 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
21046 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
21047 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
21048 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
21049 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
21050
21051 @item stub type has NULL name
21052
21053 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
21054
21055 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
21056 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
21057 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
21058 it.
21059
21060 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
21061
21062 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
21063
21064 @end table
21065
21066 @node Data Files
21067 @section GDB Data Files
21068
21069 @cindex prefix for data files
21070 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
21071 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
21072
21073 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
21074 is currently using.
21075
21076 @table @code
21077 @kindex set data-directory
21078 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
21079 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
21080 to @var{directory}.
21081
21082 @kindex show data-directory
21083 @item show data-directory
21084 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
21085 @end table
21086
21087 @cindex default data directory
21088 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
21089 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
21090 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
21091 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
21092 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
21093 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
21094 location.
21095
21096 The data directory may also be specified with the
21097 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
21098 @xref{Mode Options}.
21099
21100 @node Targets
21101 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
21102
21103 @cindex debugging target
21104 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
21105
21106 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
21107 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
21108 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
21109 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
21110 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
21111 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
21112 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
21113 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
21114
21115 @cindex target architecture
21116 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
21117 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
21118 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
21119 command.
21120
21121 @table @code
21122 @kindex set architecture
21123 @kindex show architecture
21124 @item set architecture @var{arch}
21125 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
21126 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
21127 supported architectures.
21128
21129 @item show architecture
21130 Show the current target architecture.
21131
21132 @item set processor
21133 @itemx processor
21134 @kindex set processor
21135 @kindex show processor
21136 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
21137 and @code{show architecture}.
21138 @end table
21139
21140 @menu
21141 * Active Targets:: Active targets
21142 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
21143 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
21144 @end menu
21145
21146 @node Active Targets
21147 @section Active Targets
21148
21149 @cindex stacking targets
21150 @cindex active targets
21151 @cindex multiple targets
21152
21153 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
21154 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
21155 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
21156 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
21157 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
21158 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
21159 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
21160 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
21161 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
21162
21163 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
21164 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
21165 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
21166 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
21167
21168 @node Target Commands
21169 @section Commands for Managing Targets
21170
21171 @table @code
21172 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
21173 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
21174 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
21175 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
21176 protocol of the target machine.
21177
21178 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
21179 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
21180 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
21181
21182 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
21183 after executing the command.
21184
21185 @kindex help target
21186 @item help target
21187 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
21188 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
21189 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
21190
21191 @item help target @var{name}
21192 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
21193 select it.
21194
21195 @kindex set gnutarget
21196 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
21197 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
21198 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
21199 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
21200 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
21201 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
21202
21203 @quotation
21204 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
21205 you must know the actual BFD name.
21206 @end quotation
21207
21208 @noindent
21209 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
21210
21211 @kindex show gnutarget
21212 @item show gnutarget
21213 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
21214 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
21215 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
21216 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
21217 @end table
21218
21219 @cindex common targets
21220 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
21221 configuration):
21222
21223 @table @code
21224 @kindex target
21225 @item target exec @var{program}
21226 @cindex executable file target
21227 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
21228 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
21229
21230 @item target core @var{filename}
21231 @cindex core dump file target
21232 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
21233 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
21234
21235 @item target remote @var{medium}
21236 @cindex remote target
21237 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
21238 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
21239 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
21240
21241 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
21242 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
21243
21244 @smallexample
21245 target remote /dev/ttya
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
21249 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
21250 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
21251 clobbered by the download.
21252
21253 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21254 @cindex built-in simulator target
21255 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
21256 In general,
21257 @smallexample
21258 target sim
21259 load
21260 run
21261 @end smallexample
21262 @noindent
21263 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
21264 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
21265 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
21266 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
21267 Processors}.
21268
21269 @item target native
21270 @cindex native target
21271 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
21272 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
21273 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
21274 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
21275
21276 @end table
21277
21278 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
21279 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
21280
21281 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
21282 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
21283 various aspects of this process.
21284
21285 @table @code
21286
21287 @item set hash
21288 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21289 @cindex hash mark while downloading
21290 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
21291 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
21292 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
21293 monitor.
21294
21295 @item show hash
21296 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21297 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
21298
21299 @item set debug monitor
21300 @kindex set debug monitor
21301 @cindex display remote monitor communications
21302 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
21303 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21304
21305 @item show debug monitor
21306 @kindex show debug monitor
21307 Show the current status of displaying communications between
21308 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21309 @end table
21310
21311 @table @code
21312
21313 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21314 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21315 @anchor{load}
21316 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
21317 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
21318 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
21319 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
21320 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
21321 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
21322
21323 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
21324 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
21325 target is @dots{}}''
21326
21327 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
21328 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
21329 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
21330 specifies a fixed address.
21331 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
21332
21333 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
21334 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
21335 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
21336
21337 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
21338 load programs into flash memory.
21339
21340 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
21341 @end table
21342
21343 @table @code
21344
21345 @kindex flash-erase
21346 @item flash-erase
21347 @anchor{flash-erase}
21348
21349 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
21350
21351 @end table
21352
21353 @node Byte Order
21354 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
21355
21356 @cindex choosing target byte order
21357 @cindex target byte order
21358
21359 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
21360 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
21361 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
21362 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
21363 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
21364 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
21365
21366 @table @code
21367 @kindex set endian
21368 @item set endian big
21369 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
21370
21371 @item set endian little
21372 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
21373
21374 @item set endian auto
21375 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
21376 executable.
21377
21378 @item show endian
21379 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
21380
21381 @end table
21382
21383 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
21384 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
21385 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
21386 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
21387 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
21388 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
21389 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
21390 and @code{big} otherwise.
21391
21392 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
21393 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
21394 target system.
21395
21396
21397 @node Remote Debugging
21398 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
21399 @cindex remote debugging
21400
21401 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
21402 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
21403 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
21404 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
21405 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
21406
21407 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
21408 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
21409 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
21410 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
21411 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
21412 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
21413
21414 Other remote targets may be available in your
21415 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
21416
21417 @menu
21418 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
21419 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
21420 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
21421 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
21422 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
21423 @end menu
21424
21425 @node Connecting
21426 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
21427 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
21428 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
21429 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
21430 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
21431 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
21432 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
21433
21434 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
21435 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
21436 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
21437 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
21438
21439 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
21440
21441 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
21442 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
21443 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
21444 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
21445
21446 @table @asis
21447
21448 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
21449 @item Result of detach or program exit
21450 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
21451 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
21452 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
21453
21454 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
21455 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
21456 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
21457 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
21458
21459 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
21460 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
21461 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
21462 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
21463
21464 @item Specifying the program to debug
21465 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
21466 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
21467 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
21468 target.
21469
21470 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
21471 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
21472 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
21473
21474 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
21475 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
21476 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
21477 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
21478
21479 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
21480 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
21481 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
21482 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
21483 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
21484 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
21485 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
21486 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
21487 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
21488
21489 @item The @code{run} command
21490 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
21491 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
21492 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
21493 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
21494 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
21495
21496 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
21497 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
21498 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
21499 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
21500 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
21501
21502 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
21503 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
21504 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
21505 @code{target remote} mode.
21506
21507 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
21508 @item Attaching
21509 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
21510 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
21511 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21512
21513 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
21514 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
21515 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
21516 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
21517 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21518
21519 @end table
21520
21521 @anchor{Host and target files}
21522 @subsection Host and Target Files
21523 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
21524 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
21525
21526 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
21527 information for your program running on the target. This requires
21528 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
21529 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
21530 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
21531
21532 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
21533 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
21534 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
21535 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
21536 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
21537
21538 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
21539 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
21540 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
21541 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
21542 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
21543 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
21544 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
21545 target libraries.
21546
21547 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
21548 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
21549 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
21550 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
21551 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
21552 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
21553 programs.
21554
21555 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
21556 @cindex remote connection commands
21557 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
21558 local Unix domain socket, or
21559 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
21560 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
21561 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
21562 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
21563 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
21564 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
21565
21566 @table @code
21567
21568 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
21569 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
21570 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
21571 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
21572 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
21573
21574 @smallexample
21575 target remote /dev/ttyb
21576 @end smallexample
21577
21578 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
21579 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
21580 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
21581 @code{target} command.
21582
21583 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
21584 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
21585 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
21586 @cindex Unix domain socket
21587 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
21588 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
21589
21590 @smallexample
21591 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
21592 @end smallexample
21593
21594 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
21595 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
21596 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
21597 of connection.
21598 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
21599 Unix domain sockets.
21600
21601 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21602 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21603 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21604 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21605 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21606 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21607 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21608 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21609 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21610 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21611 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21612 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21613 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21614 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21615 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
21616 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
21617 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
21618 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
21619 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
21620 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
21621 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
21622 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
21623
21624 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
21625 @code{manyfarms}:
21626
21627 @smallexample
21628 target remote manyfarms:2828
21629 @end smallexample
21630
21631 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
21632 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
21633 square bracket syntax:
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21637 @end smallexample
21638
21639 @noindent
21640 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21641
21642 @smallexample
21643 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21644 @end smallexample
21645
21646 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21647 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21648 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21649 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21650 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21651 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21652
21653 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21654 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21655 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21656 port 1234 on your local machine:
21657
21658 @smallexample
21659 target remote :1234
21660 @end smallexample
21661 @noindent
21662
21663 Note that the colon is still required here.
21664
21665 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21666 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21667 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21668 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21669 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21670 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21671 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21672 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21673 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21674 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21675 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21676 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21677 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21678
21679 @smallexample
21680 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21681 @end smallexample
21682
21683 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21684 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21685 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21686 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21687
21688 @item target remote | @var{command}
21689 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21690 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21691 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21692 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21693 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21694 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21695 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21696 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21697 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21698
21699 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21700 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21701 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21702
21703 @end table
21704
21705 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21706 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21707 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21708 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21709 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21710 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21711 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21712
21713 @smallexample
21714 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21715 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21716 @end smallexample
21717
21718 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21719 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21720 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21721 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21722
21723 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21724 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21725
21726 @table @code
21727 @kindex detach (remote)
21728 @item detach
21729 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21730 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21731 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21732 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21733 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21734 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21735 still connected to the target.
21736
21737 @kindex disconnect
21738 @item disconnect
21739 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21740 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21741 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21742 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21743 another target.
21744
21745 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21746 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21747 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21748 @kindex monitor
21749 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21750 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21751 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21752 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21753 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21754 and implement.
21755 @end table
21756
21757 @node File Transfer
21758 @section Sending files to a remote system
21759 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21760 @cindex file transfer
21761 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21762
21763 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21764 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21765 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21766 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21767 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21768 the only way to upload or download files.
21769
21770 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21771
21772 @table @code
21773 @kindex remote put
21774 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21775 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21776 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21777
21778 @kindex remote get
21779 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21780 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21781 on the host system.
21782
21783 @kindex remote delete
21784 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21785 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21786
21787 @end table
21788
21789 @node Server
21790 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21791
21792 @kindex gdbserver
21793 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21794 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21795 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21796 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21797 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21798
21799 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21800 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21801 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21802 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21803 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21804 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21805 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21806 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21807 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21808 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21809 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21810 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21811 choice for debugging.
21812
21813 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21814 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21815 protocol.
21816
21817 @quotation
21818 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21819 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21820 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21821 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21822 @code{gdbserver}.
21823 @end quotation
21824
21825 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21826 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21827 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21828 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21829
21830 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21831 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21832 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21833 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21834 system does all the symbol handling.
21835
21836 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21837 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21838 syntax is:
21839
21840 @smallexample
21841 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21842 @end smallexample
21843
21844 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21845 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21846 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21847 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21848 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21849 @file{/dev/com1}:
21850
21851 @smallexample
21852 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21853 @end smallexample
21854
21855 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21856 with it.
21857
21858 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21859
21860 @smallexample
21861 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21862 @end smallexample
21863
21864 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21865 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21866 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21867 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21868 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21869 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21870 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21871 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21872 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21873 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21874 @code{target remote} command.
21875
21876 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21877 with ssh:
21878
21879 @smallexample
21880 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21881 @end smallexample
21882
21883 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21884 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21885 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21886 You could elide it if you want to.
21887
21888 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21889 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21890 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21891 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21892
21893 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21894 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21895 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21896 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21897
21898 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21899 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21900
21901 @smallexample
21902 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21903 @end smallexample
21904
21905 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21906 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21907
21908 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21909 @value{GDBN} attach command
21910 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21911
21912 @pindex pidof
21913 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21914 @code{pidof} utility:
21915
21916 @smallexample
21917 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21918 @end smallexample
21919
21920 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21921 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21922 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21923
21924 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21925
21926 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21927 port.
21928
21929 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21930 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21931 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21932 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21933 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21934 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21935 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21936 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21937
21938 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21939 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21940 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21941
21942 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21943 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21944 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21945 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21946 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21947 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21948 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21949 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21950 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21951 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21952 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21953 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21954
21955 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21956 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21957
21958 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21959 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21960 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21961 program. For more information,
21962 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21963
21964 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21965 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21966 status information about the debugging process.
21967 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21968 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21969 remote protocol debug output.
21970 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
21971 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
21972 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
21973 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
21974 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21975
21976 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21977 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21978 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21979 Possible options are:
21980
21981 @table @code
21982 @item none
21983 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21984 @item all
21985 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21986 @item timestamps
21987 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21988 @end table
21989
21990 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21991 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21992
21993 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21994 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21995 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21996 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21997 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21998
21999 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
22000 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
22001 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
22002 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
22003
22004 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
22005 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
22006 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
22007 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
22008
22009 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
22010 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
22011 environment:
22012
22013 @smallexample
22014 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
22015 @end smallexample
22016
22017 @cindex @option{--selftest}
22018 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
22019
22020 @smallexample
22021 $ gdbserver --selftest
22022 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
22023 @end smallexample
22024
22025 These tests are disabled in release.
22026 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
22027
22028 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
22029 @itemize
22030
22031 @item
22032 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
22033
22034 @item
22035 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
22036 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
22037 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
22038 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
22039 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
22040 @code{--with-sysroot}).
22041
22042 @item
22043 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22044 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
22045 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
22046 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
22047 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
22048 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
22049 program is already on the target.
22050
22051 @end itemize
22052
22053 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
22054 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
22055 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
22056
22057 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
22058 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
22059 Here are the available commands.
22060
22061 @table @code
22062 @item monitor help
22063 List the available monitor commands.
22064
22065 @item monitor set debug 0
22066 @itemx monitor set debug 1
22067 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
22068
22069 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
22070 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
22071 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
22072 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
22073
22074 @item monitor set debug-file filename
22075 @itemx monitor set debug-file
22076 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
22077
22078 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
22079 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
22080 Possible options are:
22081
22082 @table @code
22083 @item none
22084 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22085 @item all
22086 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22087 @item timestamps
22088 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22089 @end table
22090
22091 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22092 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22093
22094 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
22095 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
22096 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
22097 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
22098 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
22099 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
22100
22101 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
22102 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
22103
22104 @item monitor exit
22105 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
22106 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
22107 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
22108 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
22109 of a multi-process mode debug session.
22110
22111 @end table
22112
22113 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22114 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22115
22116 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
22117 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
22118
22119 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
22120 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
22121 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
22122 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
22123 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
22124 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
22125 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
22126 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
22127 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
22128 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
22129 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
22130 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
22131
22132 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
22133
22134 @table @code
22135 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
22136
22137 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
22138 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
22139 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
22140
22141 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
22142
22143 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
22144 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
22145 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
22146 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
22147 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
22148 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
22149
22150 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
22151
22152 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
22153 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
22154 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
22155 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
22156 command for that. For example:
22157
22158 @smallexample
22159 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
22160 @end smallexample
22161
22162 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
22163 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
22164 @end table
22165
22166 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
22167 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
22168 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
22169 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
22170 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
22171 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
22172 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
22173 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
22174 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
22175 @code{gdbserver} like so:
22176
22177 @smallexample
22178 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
22179 @end smallexample
22180
22181 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
22182
22183 @smallexample
22184 $ gdb myprogram
22185 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
22186 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
22187 (@value{GDBP}) b main
22188 (@value{GDBP}) continue
22189 @end smallexample
22190
22191 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
22192 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
22193 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
22194 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
22195 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
22196 tracing.
22197
22198 @node Remote Configuration
22199 @section Remote Configuration
22200
22201 @kindex set remote
22202 @kindex show remote
22203 This section documents the configuration options available when
22204 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
22205 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
22206 system-call-allowed}.
22207
22208 @table @code
22209 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
22210 @cindex address size for remote targets
22211 @cindex bits in remote address
22212 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
22213 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
22214 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
22215 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
22216
22217 @item show remoteaddresssize
22218 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
22219
22220 @item set serial baud @var{n}
22221 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
22222 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
22223 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
22224 remote targets.
22225
22226 @item show serial baud
22227 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
22228
22229 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
22230 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
22231 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
22232
22233 @item show serial parity
22234 Show the current parity of the serial port.
22235
22236 @item set remotebreak
22237 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22238 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
22239 @anchor{set remotebreak}
22240 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
22241 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
22242 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
22243 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
22244 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
22245
22246 @item show remotebreak
22247 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
22248 interrupt the remote program.
22249
22250 @item set remoteflow on
22251 @itemx set remoteflow off
22252 @kindex set remoteflow
22253 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
22254 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
22255
22256 @item show remoteflow
22257 @kindex show remoteflow
22258 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
22259
22260 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
22261 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
22262 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
22263 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
22264 @code{ascii}.
22265
22266 @item show remotelogbase
22267 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
22268 protocol.
22269
22270 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
22271 @cindex record serial communications on file
22272 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
22273 default is not to record at all.
22274
22275 @item show remotelogfile
22276 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
22277 serial communications.
22278
22279 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
22280 @cindex timeout for serial communications
22281 @cindex remote timeout
22282 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
22283 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
22284
22285 @item show remotetimeout
22286 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
22287 responses.
22288
22289 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
22290 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
22291 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
22292 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
22293 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
22294 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
22295 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
22296 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
22297 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
22298 watchpoints or breakpoints.
22299
22300 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
22301 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
22302 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
22303 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
22304
22305 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
22306 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
22307 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
22308 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
22309 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
22310 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
22311 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
22312 length.
22313
22314 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
22315 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
22316 a remote hardware watchpoint.
22317
22318 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
22319 @itemx show remote exec-file
22320 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
22321 @cindex executable file, for remote target
22322 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
22323 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
22324 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
22325 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
22326
22327 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
22328 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22329 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
22330 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
22331 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
22332 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
22333 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
22334 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
22335 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
22336 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
22337
22338 @item show interrupt-sequence
22339 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
22340 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
22341 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
22342 also known as Magic SysRq g.
22343
22344 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
22345 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
22346 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
22347 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
22348 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
22349 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
22350
22351 @item show interrupt-on-connect
22352 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
22353 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
22354
22355 @kindex set tcp
22356 @kindex show tcp
22357 @item set tcp auto-retry on
22358 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
22359 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
22360 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
22361 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
22362 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
22363 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
22364 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
22365 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
22366
22367 @item set tcp auto-retry off
22368 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
22369
22370 @item show tcp auto-retry
22371 Show the current auto-retry setting.
22372
22373 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
22374 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
22375 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
22376 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
22377 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
22378 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
22379 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
22380 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
22381 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
22382 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
22383 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
22384
22385 @item show tcp connect-timeout
22386 Show the current connection timeout setting.
22387 @end table
22388
22389 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
22390 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
22391 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
22392 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
22393 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
22394 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
22395 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
22396 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
22397 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
22398
22399 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
22400 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
22401 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
22402 @value{GDBN} developers.
22403
22404 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
22405 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
22406 are:
22407
22408 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
22409 @item Command Name
22410 @tab Remote Packet
22411 @tab Related Features
22412
22413 @item @code{fetch-register}
22414 @tab @code{p}
22415 @tab @code{info registers}
22416
22417 @item @code{set-register}
22418 @tab @code{P}
22419 @tab @code{set}
22420
22421 @item @code{binary-download}
22422 @tab @code{X}
22423 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
22424
22425 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
22426 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
22427 @tab @code{info auxv}
22428
22429 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
22430 @tab @code{qSymbol}
22431 @tab Detecting multiple threads
22432
22433 @item @code{attach}
22434 @tab @code{vAttach}
22435 @tab @code{attach}
22436
22437 @item @code{verbose-resume}
22438 @tab @code{vCont}
22439 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
22440
22441 @item @code{run}
22442 @tab @code{vRun}
22443 @tab @code{run}
22444
22445 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
22446 @tab @code{Z0}
22447 @tab @code{break}
22448
22449 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
22450 @tab @code{Z1}
22451 @tab @code{hbreak}
22452
22453 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
22454 @tab @code{Z2}
22455 @tab @code{watch}
22456
22457 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
22458 @tab @code{Z3}
22459 @tab @code{rwatch}
22460
22461 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
22462 @tab @code{Z4}
22463 @tab @code{awatch}
22464
22465 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
22466 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
22467 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
22468
22469 @item @code{target-features}
22470 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
22471 @tab @code{set architecture}
22472
22473 @item @code{library-info}
22474 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
22475 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
22476
22477 @item @code{memory-map}
22478 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
22479 @tab @code{info mem}
22480
22481 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
22482 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
22483 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
22484
22485 @item @code{read-spu-object}
22486 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
22487 @tab @code{info spu}
22488
22489 @item @code{write-spu-object}
22490 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
22491 @tab @code{info spu}
22492
22493 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
22494 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
22495 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
22496
22497 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
22498 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
22499 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
22500
22501 @item @code{threads}
22502 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
22503 @tab @code{info threads}
22504
22505 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
22506 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
22507 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
22508
22509 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
22510 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
22511 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
22512
22513 @item @code{search-memory}
22514 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
22515 @tab @code{find}
22516
22517 @item @code{supported-packets}
22518 @tab @code{qSupported}
22519 @tab Remote communications parameters
22520
22521 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
22522 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
22523 @tab @code{catch syscall}
22524
22525 @item @code{pass-signals}
22526 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
22527 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22528
22529 @item @code{program-signals}
22530 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
22531 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22532
22533 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
22534 @tab @code{vFile:close}
22535 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22536
22537 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
22538 @tab @code{vFile:open}
22539 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22540
22541 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
22542 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
22543 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22544
22545 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
22546 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
22547 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22548
22549 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
22550 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
22551 @tab @code{remote delete}
22552
22553 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
22554 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
22555 @tab Host I/O
22556
22557 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
22558 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
22559 @tab Host I/O
22560
22561 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
22562 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
22563 @tab Host I/O
22564
22565 @item @code{noack-packet}
22566 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
22567 @tab Packet acknowledgment
22568
22569 @item @code{osdata}
22570 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
22571 @tab @code{info os}
22572
22573 @item @code{query-attached}
22574 @tab @code{qAttached}
22575 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
22576
22577 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
22578 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
22579 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
22580
22581 @item @code{trace-status}
22582 @tab @code{qTStatus}
22583 @tab @code{tstatus}
22584
22585 @item @code{traceframe-info}
22586 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
22587 @tab Traceframe info
22588
22589 @item @code{install-in-trace}
22590 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
22591 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
22592
22593 @item @code{disable-randomization}
22594 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
22595 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
22596
22597 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
22598 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
22599 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
22600
22601 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
22602 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
22603 @tab @code{set environment}
22604
22605 @item @code{environment-unset}
22606 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
22607 @tab @code{unset environment}
22608
22609 @item @code{environment-reset}
22610 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
22611 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
22612
22613 @item @code{set-working-dir}
22614 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
22615 @tab @code{set cwd}
22616
22617 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
22618 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
22619 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
22620
22621 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
22622 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
22623 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
22624
22625 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
22626 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
22627 @tab @code{break}
22628
22629 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
22630 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
22631 @tab @code{hbreak}
22632
22633 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
22634 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
22635 @tab @code{fork}
22636
22637 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
22638 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
22639 @tab @code{vfork}
22640
22641 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
22642 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22643 @tab @code{exec}
22644
22645 @item @code{thread-events}
22646 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22647 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22648
22649 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22650 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22651 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22652
22653 @end multitable
22654
22655 @node Remote Stub
22656 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22657
22658 @cindex debugging stub, example
22659 @cindex remote stub, example
22660 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22661 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22662 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22663 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22664 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22665 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22666 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22667 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22668
22669 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22670 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22671 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22672 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22673 program, you need:
22674
22675 @enumerate
22676 @item
22677 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22678 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22679 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22680
22681 @item
22682 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22683 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22684
22685 @item
22686 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22687 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22688 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22689 documentation.
22690 @end enumerate
22691
22692 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22693 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22694 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22695
22696 @table @emph
22697 @item On the host,
22698 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22699 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22700 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22701
22702 @item On the target,
22703 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22704 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22705 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22706
22707 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22708 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22709 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22710 @end table
22711
22712 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22713 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22714 @sc{sparc} boards.
22715
22716 @cindex remote serial stub list
22717 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22718
22719 @table @code
22720
22721 @item i386-stub.c
22722 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22723 @cindex Intel
22724 @cindex i386
22725 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22726
22727 @item m68k-stub.c
22728 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22729 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22730 @cindex m680x0
22731 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22732
22733 @item sh-stub.c
22734 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22735 @cindex Renesas
22736 @cindex SH
22737 For Renesas SH architectures.
22738
22739 @item sparc-stub.c
22740 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22741 @cindex Sparc
22742 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22743
22744 @item sparcl-stub.c
22745 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22746 @cindex Fujitsu
22747 @cindex SparcLite
22748 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22749
22750 @end table
22751
22752 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22753 recently added stubs.
22754
22755 @menu
22756 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22757 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22758 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22759 @end menu
22760
22761 @node Stub Contents
22762 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22763
22764 @cindex remote serial stub
22765 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22766 subroutines:
22767
22768 @table @code
22769 @item set_debug_traps
22770 @findex set_debug_traps
22771 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22772 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22773 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22774 program's startup code.
22775
22776 @item handle_exception
22777 @findex handle_exception
22778 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22779 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22780 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22781 run when a trap is triggered.
22782
22783 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22784 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22785 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22786 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22787 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22788 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22789 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22790 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22791 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22792 machine.
22793
22794 @item breakpoint
22795 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22796 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22797 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22798 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22799 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22800 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22801 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22802 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22803 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22804 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22805 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22806
22807 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22808 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22809 start of your debugging session.
22810 @end table
22811
22812 @node Bootstrapping
22813 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22814
22815 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22816 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22817 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22818 debugging target machine.
22819
22820 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22821 serial port.
22822
22823 @table @code
22824 @item int getDebugChar()
22825 @findex getDebugChar
22826 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22827 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22828 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22829
22830 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22831 @findex putDebugChar
22832 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22833 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22834 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22835 @end table
22836
22837 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22838 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22839 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22840 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22841 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22842 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22843 remote system to stop.
22844
22845 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22846 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22847 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22848 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22849
22850 Other routines you need to supply are:
22851
22852 @table @code
22853 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22854 @findex exceptionHandler
22855 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22856 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22857 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22858 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22859 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22860 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22861 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22862 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22863 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22864 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22865 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22866 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22867 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22868
22869 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22870 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22871 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22872 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22873 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22874
22875 @item void flush_i_cache()
22876 @findex flush_i_cache
22877 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22878 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22879 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22880
22881 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22882 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22883 @end table
22884
22885 @noindent
22886 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22887
22888 @table @code
22889 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22890 @findex memset
22891 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22892 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22893 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22894 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22895 @end table
22896
22897 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22898 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22899 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22900 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22901
22902
22903 @node Debug Session
22904 @subsection Putting it All Together
22905
22906 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22907 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22908 steps.
22909
22910 @enumerate
22911 @item
22912 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22913 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22914 @display
22915 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22916 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22917 @end display
22918
22919 @item
22920 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22921 procedure is called:
22922
22923 @smallexample
22924 set_debug_traps();
22925 breakpoint();
22926 @end smallexample
22927
22928 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22929 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22930 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22931 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22932 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22933 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22934 progress.
22935
22936 @item
22937 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22938 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22939
22940 @smallexample
22941 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22942 @end smallexample
22943
22944 @noindent
22945 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22946 function in your program, that function is called when
22947 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22948 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22949 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22950
22951 @item
22952 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22953 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22954
22955 @item
22956 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22957 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22958
22959 @item
22960 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22961 @c document that. FIXME.
22962 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22963 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22964
22965 @item
22966 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22967 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22968
22969 @end enumerate
22970
22971 @node Configurations
22972 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22973
22974 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22975 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22976 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22977
22978 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22979 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22980 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22981 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22982 are quite different from each other.
22983
22984 @menu
22985 * Native::
22986 * Embedded OS::
22987 * Embedded Processors::
22988 * Architectures::
22989 @end menu
22990
22991 @node Native
22992 @section Native
22993
22994 This section describes details specific to particular native
22995 configurations.
22996
22997 @menu
22998 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22999 * Process Information:: Process information
23000 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
23001 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
23002 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
23003 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
23004 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
23005 @end menu
23006
23007 @node BSD libkvm Interface
23008 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
23009
23010 @cindex libkvm
23011 @cindex kernel memory image
23012 @cindex kernel crash dump
23013
23014 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
23015 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
23016 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
23017 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
23018 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
23019 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
23020 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
23021 @code{kvm} target:
23022
23023 @smallexample
23024 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
23025 @end smallexample
23026
23027 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
23028 argument:
23029
23030 @smallexample
23031 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
23032 @end smallexample
23033
23034 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
23035 available:
23036
23037 @table @code
23038 @kindex kvm
23039 @item kvm pcb
23040 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
23041
23042 @item kvm proc
23043 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
23044 modern FreeBSD systems.
23045 @end table
23046
23047 @node Process Information
23048 @subsection Process Information
23049 @cindex /proc
23050 @cindex examine process image
23051 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
23052
23053 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
23054 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
23055 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
23056 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
23057 to report information about the process running your program, or about
23058 any process running on your system.
23059
23060 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
23061 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
23062 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
23063 systems.
23064
23065 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
23066 information.
23067
23068 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
23069 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
23070 information available from a live process. Process information is
23071 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
23072 systems.
23073
23074 @table @code
23075 @kindex info proc
23076 @cindex process ID
23077 @item info proc
23078 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
23079 Summarize available information about a process. If a
23080 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
23081 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
23082 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
23083 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
23084 executable file's absolute file name.
23085
23086 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
23087 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
23088 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
23089 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
23090 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
23091 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
23092
23093 @item info proc cmdline
23094 @cindex info proc cmdline
23095 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
23096 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23097
23098 @item info proc cwd
23099 @cindex info proc cwd
23100 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
23101 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23102
23103 @item info proc exe
23104 @cindex info proc exe
23105 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
23106 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23107
23108 @item info proc files
23109 @cindex info proc files
23110 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
23111 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
23112 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
23113 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
23114 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
23115 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
23116 FreeBSD.
23117
23118 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
23119 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
23120
23121 @smallexample
23122 (gdb) info proc files 22136
23123 process 22136
23124 Open files:
23125
23126 FD Type Offset Flags Name
23127 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
23128 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
23129 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
23130 root dir - r-------- /
23131 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23132 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23133 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23134 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
23135 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
23136 @end smallexample
23137
23138 @item info proc mappings
23139 @cindex memory address space mappings
23140 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
23141 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
23142 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
23143 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
23144 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
23145
23146 @item info proc stat
23147 @itemx info proc status
23148 @cindex process detailed status information
23149 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
23150 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
23151 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
23152 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
23153 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23154
23155 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
23156 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
23157
23158 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
23159 proc status}.
23160
23161 @item info proc all
23162 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
23163 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
23164
23165 @ignore
23166 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
23167 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
23168 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
23169 @kindex info proc times
23170 @item info proc times
23171 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
23172 its children.
23173
23174 @kindex info proc id
23175 @item info proc id
23176 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
23177 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
23178 @end ignore
23179
23180 @item set procfs-trace
23181 @kindex set procfs-trace
23182 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
23183 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
23184
23185 @item show procfs-trace
23186 @kindex show procfs-trace
23187 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
23188
23189 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
23190 @kindex set procfs-file
23191 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
23192 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
23193 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
23194 standard output.
23195
23196 @item show procfs-file
23197 @kindex show procfs-file
23198 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
23199
23200 @item proc-trace-entry
23201 @itemx proc-trace-exit
23202 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
23203 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
23204 @kindex proc-trace-entry
23205 @kindex proc-trace-exit
23206 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
23207 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
23208 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
23209 from the @code{syscall} interface.
23210
23211 @item info pidlist
23212 @kindex info pidlist
23213 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
23214 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
23215 processes and all the threads within each process.
23216
23217 @item info meminfo
23218 @kindex info meminfo
23219 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
23220 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
23221 @end table
23222
23223 @node DJGPP Native
23224 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
23225 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
23226 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
23227 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
23228
23229 @cindex DPMI
23230 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
23231 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
23232 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
23233 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
23234
23235 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
23236 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
23237 subsection describes those commands.
23238
23239 @table @code
23240 @kindex info dos
23241 @item info dos
23242 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
23243 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23244
23245 @kindex sysinfo
23246 @cindex MS-DOS system info
23247 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
23248 @item info dos sysinfo
23249 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
23250 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
23251 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
23252
23253 @cindex GDT
23254 @cindex LDT
23255 @cindex IDT
23256 @cindex segment descriptor tables
23257 @cindex descriptor tables display
23258 @item info dos gdt
23259 @itemx info dos ldt
23260 @itemx info dos idt
23261 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
23262 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
23263 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
23264 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
23265 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
23266 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
23267 rights.
23268
23269 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
23270 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
23271 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
23272 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
23273 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
23274
23275 @cindex garbled pointers
23276 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
23277 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
23278 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
23279 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
23280 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
23281 debugged program's data segment:
23282
23283 @smallexample
23284 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
23285 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
23286 @end smallexample
23287
23288 @noindent
23289 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
23290 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
23291
23292 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
23293 @item info dos pde
23294 @itemx info dos pte
23295 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
23296 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
23297 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
23298 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
23299 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
23300 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
23301 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
23302 that is currently in use.
23303
23304 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
23305 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
23306 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
23307 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
23308 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
23309 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
23310 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
23311
23312 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
23313 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
23314 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
23315 controller.
23316
23317 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
23318
23319 @cindex physical address from linear address
23320 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
23321 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
23322 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
23323 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
23324 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
23325 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
23326 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
23327
23328 @smallexample
23329 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
23330 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
23331 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
23332 @end smallexample
23333
23334 @noindent
23335 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
23336 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
23337 attributes of that page.
23338
23339 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
23340 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
23341 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
23342 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
23343 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
23344 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
23345
23346 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
23347 transfer buffer:
23348
23349 @smallexample
23350 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
23351 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
23352 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
23353 @end smallexample
23354
23355 @noindent
23356 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
23357 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
23358 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
23359 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
23360 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
23361
23362 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
23363 @end table
23364
23365 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
23366 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
23367 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
23368 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
23369
23370 @table @code
23371 @kindex set com1base
23372 @kindex set com1irq
23373 @kindex set com2base
23374 @kindex set com2irq
23375 @kindex set com3base
23376 @kindex set com3irq
23377 @kindex set com4base
23378 @kindex set com4irq
23379 @item set com1base @var{addr}
23380 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
23381 port.
23382
23383 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
23384 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
23385 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
23386
23387 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
23388 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
23389 other 3 COM ports.
23390
23391 @kindex show com1base
23392 @kindex show com1irq
23393 @kindex show com2base
23394 @kindex show com2irq
23395 @kindex show com3base
23396 @kindex show com3irq
23397 @kindex show com4base
23398 @kindex show com4irq
23399 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
23400 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
23401 lines used by the COM ports.
23402
23403 @item info serial
23404 @kindex info serial
23405 @cindex DOS serial port status
23406 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
23407 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
23408 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
23409 counts of various errors encountered so far.
23410 @end table
23411
23412
23413 @node Cygwin Native
23414 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
23415 @cindex MS Windows debugging
23416 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
23417 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
23418
23419 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
23420 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
23421
23422 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
23423 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
23424 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
23425 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
23426 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
23427 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
23428 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
23429 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
23430
23431 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
23432 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
23433 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
23434
23435 @table @code
23436 @kindex info w32
23437 @item info w32
23438 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
23439 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23440
23441 @item info w32 selector
23442 This command displays information returned by
23443 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
23444 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
23445 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
23446 Without argument, this command displays information
23447 about the six segment registers.
23448
23449 @item info w32 thread-information-block
23450 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
23451 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
23452 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
23453
23454 @kindex signal-event
23455 @item signal-event @var{id}
23456 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
23457 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
23458
23459 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
23460 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
23461 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
23462 (for x86_64 versions):
23463
23464 @itemize @minus
23465 @item
23466 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
23467 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
23468 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
23469
23470 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
23471 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
23472 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
23473 to attach.
23474
23475 @item
23476 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
23477 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
23478 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
23479 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
23480 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
23481 @end itemize
23482
23483 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
23484 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
23485 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
23486 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
23487 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
23488 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
23489 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
23490 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
23491 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
23492 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
23493 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
23494
23495 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
23496 @item show cygwin-exceptions
23497 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
23498 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
23499
23500 @kindex set new-console
23501 @item set new-console @var{mode}
23502 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
23503 be started in a new console on next start.
23504 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
23505 be started in the same console as the debugger.
23506
23507 @kindex show new-console
23508 @item show new-console
23509 Displays whether a new console is used
23510 when the debuggee is started.
23511
23512 @kindex set new-group
23513 @item set new-group @var{mode}
23514 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
23515 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
23516 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
23517 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
23518
23519 @kindex show new-group
23520 @item show new-group
23521 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
23522
23523 @kindex set debugevents
23524 @item set debugevents
23525 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
23526 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
23527 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
23528 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
23529 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
23530
23531 @kindex set debugexec
23532 @item set debugexec
23533 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
23534 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
23535
23536 @kindex set debugexceptions
23537 @item set debugexceptions
23538 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
23539 debuggee seen by the debugger.
23540
23541 @kindex set debugmemory
23542 @item set debugmemory
23543 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
23544 and writes by the debugger.
23545
23546 @kindex set shell
23547 @item set shell
23548 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
23549 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
23550
23551 @kindex show shell
23552 @item show shell
23553 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
23554
23555 @end table
23556
23557 @menu
23558 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
23559 @end menu
23560
23561 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
23562 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
23563 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
23564 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
23565
23566 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
23567 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
23568 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
23569 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
23570 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
23571 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
23572 ``minimal symbols''.
23573
23574 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
23575 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
23576 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
23577 program run once to completion.
23578
23579 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
23580
23581 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
23582 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
23583 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
23584 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
23585 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
23586 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
23587 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
23588 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
23589 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
23590
23591 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
23592 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
23593 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
23594 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
23595 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
23596 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
23597
23598 @smallexample
23599 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
23600 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
23601
23602 Non-debugging symbols:
23603 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
23604 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
23605 @end smallexample
23606
23607 @smallexample
23608 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
23609 All functions matching regular expression "!":
23610
23611 Non-debugging symbols:
23612 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
23613 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
23614 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
23615 [etc...]
23616 @end smallexample
23617
23618 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
23619
23620 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
23621 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
23622 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
23623 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
23624 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
23625 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
23626 a function within a DLL without a running program.
23627
23628 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
23629 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
23630 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
23631 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
23632 problem:
23633
23634 @smallexample
23635 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
23636 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23637 @end smallexample
23638
23639 @smallexample
23640 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
23641 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23642 @end smallexample
23643
23644 And two possible solutions:
23645
23646 @smallexample
23647 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23648 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23649 @end smallexample
23650
23651 @smallexample
23652 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23653 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23654 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23655 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23656 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23657 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23658 @end smallexample
23659
23660 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23661 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23662 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23663 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23664 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23665
23666 @smallexample
23667 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23668 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23669 @end smallexample
23670
23671 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23672 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23673 safe.
23674
23675 @node Hurd Native
23676 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23677 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23678
23679 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23680 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23681
23682 @table @code
23683 @item set signals
23684 @itemx set sigs
23685 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23686 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23687 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23688 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23689 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23690 @code{signals}.
23691
23692 @item show signals
23693 @itemx show sigs
23694 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23695 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23696 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23697
23698 @item set signal-thread
23699 @itemx set sigthread
23700 @kindex set signal-thread
23701 @kindex set sigthread
23702 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23703 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23704 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23705 signal-thread}.
23706
23707 @item show signal-thread
23708 @itemx show sigthread
23709 @kindex show signal-thread
23710 @kindex show sigthread
23711 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23712 delivered a signal.
23713
23714 @item set stopped
23715 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23716 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23717 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23718 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23719
23720 @item show stopped
23721 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23722 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23723 stopped.
23724
23725 @item set exceptions
23726 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23727 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23728 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23729 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23730 trapping on.
23731
23732 @item show exceptions
23733 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23734 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23735
23736 @item set task pause
23737 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23738 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23739 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23740 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23741 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23742 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23743 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23744 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23745 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23746
23747 @item show task pause
23748 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23749 Show the current state of task suspension.
23750
23751 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23752 @cindex task suspend count
23753 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23754 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23755 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23756
23757 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23758 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23759
23760 @item set task exception-port
23761 @itemx set task excp
23762 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23763 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23764 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23765 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23766
23767 @item set noninvasive
23768 @cindex noninvasive task options
23769 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23770 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23771 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23772 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23773
23774 @item info send-rights
23775 @itemx info receive-rights
23776 @itemx info port-rights
23777 @itemx info port-sets
23778 @itemx info dead-names
23779 @itemx info ports
23780 @itemx info psets
23781 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23782 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23783 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23784 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23785 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23786 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23787 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23788 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23789 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23790
23791 @item set thread pause
23792 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23793 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23794 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23795 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23796 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23797 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23798 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23799 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23800 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23801 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23802 only the current thread.
23803
23804 @item show thread pause
23805 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23806 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23807
23808 @item set thread run
23809 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23810
23811 @item show thread run
23812 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23813
23814 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23815 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23816 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23817 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23818 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23819 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23820 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23821
23822 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23823 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23824 detaching.
23825
23826 @item set thread exception-port
23827 @itemx set thread excp
23828 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23829 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23830 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23831
23832 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23833 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23834 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23835 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23836
23837 @item set thread default
23838 @itemx show thread default
23839 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23840 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23841 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23842 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23843 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23844 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23845 the non-default commands.
23846 @end table
23847
23848 @node Darwin
23849 @subsection Darwin
23850 @cindex Darwin
23851
23852 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23853
23854 @table @code
23855 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23856 @kindex set debug darwin
23857 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23858 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23859
23860 @item show debug darwin
23861 @kindex show debug darwin
23862 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23863
23864 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23865 @kindex set debug mach-o
23866 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23867 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23868 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23869 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23870 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23871 usage.
23872
23873 @item show debug mach-o
23874 @kindex show debug mach-o
23875 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23876
23877 @item set mach-exceptions on
23878 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23879 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23880 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23881 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23882 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23883 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23884
23885 @item show mach-exceptions
23886 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23887 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23888 @end table
23889
23890 @node FreeBSD
23891 @subsection FreeBSD
23892 @cindex FreeBSD
23893
23894 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23895 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23896 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23897 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23898 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23899 are also caught.
23900
23901 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23902 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23903 both variants:
23904
23905 @smallexample
23906 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23907 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23908 (@value{GDBP})
23909 @end smallexample
23910
23911
23912 @node Embedded OS
23913 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23914
23915 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23916 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23917 architectures.
23918
23919 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23920 various real-time operating systems.
23921
23922 @node Embedded Processors
23923 @section Embedded Processors
23924
23925 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23926 configurations.
23927
23928 @cindex send command to simulator
23929 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23930 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23931
23932 @table @code
23933 @item sim @var{command}
23934 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23935 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23936 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23937 acceptable commands.
23938 @end table
23939
23940
23941 @menu
23942 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23943 * ARM:: ARM
23944 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23945 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23946 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23947 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23948 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23949 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23950 * CRIS:: CRIS
23951 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23952 @end menu
23953
23954 @node ARC
23955 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23956 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23957 @cindex ARC specific commands
23958 @cindex ARC600
23959 @cindex ARC700
23960 @cindex ARC EM
23961 @cindex ARC HS
23962
23963 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23964
23965 @table @code
23966 @item set debug arc
23967 @kindex set debug arc
23968 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23969 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23970
23971 @item show debug arc
23972 @kindex show debug arc
23973 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23974
23975 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23976 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23977 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23978
23979 @end table
23980
23981 @node ARM
23982 @subsection ARM
23983
23984 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23985
23986 @table @code
23987 @item set arm disassembler
23988 @kindex set arm
23989 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23990 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23991
23992 @item show arm disassembler
23993 @kindex show arm
23994 Show the current disassembly style.
23995
23996 @item set arm apcs32
23997 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23998 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23999
24000 @item show arm apcs32
24001 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
24002
24003 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
24004 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
24005 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
24006
24007 @table @code
24008 @item auto
24009 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
24010 @item softfpa
24011 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
24012 processors.
24013 @item fpa
24014 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
24015 @item softvfp
24016 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
24017 @item vfp
24018 VFP co-processor.
24019 @end table
24020
24021 @item show arm fpu
24022 Show the current type of the FPU.
24023
24024 @item set arm abi
24025 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
24026
24027 @item show arm abi
24028 Show the currently used ABI.
24029
24030 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24031 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
24032 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
24033 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
24034 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
24035 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
24036 register).
24037
24038 @item show arm fallback-mode
24039 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
24040
24041 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24042 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
24043 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
24044 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
24045 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
24046
24047 @item show arm force-mode
24048 Show the current forced instruction mode.
24049
24050 @item set debug arm
24051 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
24052 target support subsystem.
24053
24054 @item show debug arm
24055 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24056 @end table
24057
24058 @table @code
24059 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
24060 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
24061
24062 @table @code
24063 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
24064 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
24065 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
24066 The default value is @code{all}.
24067
24068 @table @code
24069 @item none
24070 @item demon
24071 @item angel
24072 @item redboot
24073 @item all
24074 @end table
24075 @end table
24076 @end table
24077
24078 @node M68K
24079 @subsection M68k
24080
24081 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
24082
24083 @node MicroBlaze
24084 @subsection MicroBlaze
24085 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
24086 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
24087
24088 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
24089 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
24090 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
24091 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
24092 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
24093 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
24094 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
24095 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
24096 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
24097 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
24098 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
24099
24100 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
24101
24102 @table @code
24103 @item target remote :1234
24104 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
24105 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
24106
24107 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
24108 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
24109 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
24110
24111 @item load
24112 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
24113
24114 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
24115 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
24116
24117 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
24118 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
24119 @end table
24120
24121 @node MIPS Embedded
24122 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
24123
24124 @noindent
24125 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
24126
24127 @table @code
24128 @item set mipsfpu double
24129 @itemx set mipsfpu single
24130 @itemx set mipsfpu none
24131 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
24132 @itemx show mipsfpu
24133 @kindex set mipsfpu
24134 @kindex show mipsfpu
24135 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
24136 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
24137 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
24138 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
24139 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
24140 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
24141 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
24142 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
24143 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
24144 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
24145 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
24146 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
24147 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
24148
24149 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
24150 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
24151 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
24152
24153 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
24154 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
24155 @end table
24156
24157 @node OpenRISC 1000
24158 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
24159 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
24160
24161 @noindent
24162 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
24163 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
24164 FPGA's.
24165
24166 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
24167 a target:
24168
24169 @table @code
24170
24171 @kindex target sim
24172 @item target sim
24173
24174 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
24175 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
24176 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
24177 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
24178
24179 Example: @code{target sim}
24180
24181 @item set debug or1k
24182 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
24183 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
24184
24185 @item show debug or1k
24186 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24187 @end table
24188
24189 @node PowerPC Embedded
24190 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
24191
24192 @cindex DVC register
24193 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
24194 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
24195
24196 @smallexample
24197 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
24198 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
24199 @end smallexample
24200
24201 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
24202 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
24203 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
24204 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
24205 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
24206 or newer.
24207
24208 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
24209 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
24210 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
24211 watching variables of scalar types.
24212
24213 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
24214 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
24215
24216 @smallexample
24217 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
24218 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
24219 @end smallexample
24220
24221 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
24222 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
24223
24224 @cindex ranged breakpoint
24225 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
24226 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
24227 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
24228 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
24229 use the @code{break-range} command.
24230
24231 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
24232
24233 @table @code
24234 @kindex break-range
24235 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
24236 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
24237 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
24238 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
24239 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
24240 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
24241 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
24242 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
24243 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
24244
24245 @kindex set powerpc
24246 @item set powerpc soft-float
24247 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
24248 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
24249 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
24250 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24251
24252 @item set powerpc vector-abi
24253 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
24254 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
24255 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
24256 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
24257 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
24258 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
24259 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24260
24261 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
24262 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
24263 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
24264 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
24265 address of its first byte.
24266
24267 @end table
24268
24269 @node AVR
24270 @subsection Atmel AVR
24271 @cindex AVR
24272
24273 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
24274 following AVR-specific commands:
24275
24276 @table @code
24277 @item info io_registers
24278 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
24279 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
24280 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
24281 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
24282 @end table
24283
24284 @node CRIS
24285 @subsection CRIS
24286 @cindex CRIS
24287
24288 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
24289 following CRIS-specific commands:
24290
24291 @table @code
24292 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
24293 @cindex CRIS version
24294 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
24295 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
24296 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
24297
24298 @item show cris-version
24299 Show the current CRIS version.
24300
24301 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
24302 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
24303 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
24304 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
24305 @code{R59}.
24306
24307 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
24308 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
24309
24310 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
24311 @cindex CRIS mode
24312 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
24313 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
24314 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
24315
24316 @item show cris-mode
24317 Show the current CRIS mode.
24318 @end table
24319
24320 @node Super-H
24321 @subsection Renesas Super-H
24322 @cindex Super-H
24323
24324 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
24325 commands:
24326
24327 @table @code
24328 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
24329 @kindex set sh calling-convention
24330 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
24331 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
24332 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
24333 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
24334 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
24335 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
24336 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
24337 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
24338 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
24339 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
24340
24341 @item show sh calling-convention
24342 @kindex show sh calling-convention
24343 Show the current calling convention setting.
24344
24345 @end table
24346
24347
24348 @node Architectures
24349 @section Architectures
24350
24351 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
24352 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
24353
24354 @menu
24355 * AArch64::
24356 * i386::
24357 * Alpha::
24358 * MIPS::
24359 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
24360 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24361 * PowerPC::
24362 * Nios II::
24363 * Sparc64::
24364 * S12Z::
24365 @end menu
24366
24367 @node AArch64
24368 @subsection AArch64
24369 @cindex AArch64 support
24370
24371 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
24372 following special commands:
24373
24374 @table @code
24375 @item set debug aarch64
24376 @kindex set debug aarch64
24377 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
24378 messages are to be displayed.
24379
24380 @item show debug aarch64
24381 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
24382
24383 @end table
24384
24385 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
24386 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
24387
24388 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
24389 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
24390 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
24391 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
24392 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
24393 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
24394
24395 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
24396 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
24397 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
24398 target process.
24399
24400 @subsubsection AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24401 @cindex AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24402
24403 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, and the program is
24404 using the v8.3-A feature Pointer Authentication (PAC), then whenever the link
24405 register @code{$lr} is pointing to an PAC function its value will be masked.
24406 When GDB prints a backtrace, any addresses that required unmasking will be
24407 postfixed with the marker [PAC]. When using the MI, this is printed as part
24408 of the @code{addr_flags} field.
24409
24410 @node i386
24411 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
24412
24413 @table @code
24414 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
24415 @kindex set struct-convention
24416 @cindex struct return convention
24417 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
24418 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
24419 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
24420 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
24421 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
24422 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
24423 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
24424 be returned in a register.
24425
24426 @item show struct-convention
24427 @kindex show struct-convention
24428 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
24429 from functions.
24430 @end table
24431
24432
24433 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
24434 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
24435
24436 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
24437 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
24438 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
24439 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
24440 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
24441 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
24442 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
24443
24444 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
24445 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
24446 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
24447 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
24448 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
24449 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
24450
24451 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
24452 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
24453 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
24454
24455 @smallexample
24456 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
24457 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
24458 @end smallexample
24459
24460 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
24461 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
24462 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
24463 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
24464 the pointer.
24465
24466 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
24467 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
24468 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
24469 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
24470 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
24471
24472 @table @code
24473 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
24474 @kindex show mpx bound
24475 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
24476
24477 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
24478 @kindex set mpx bound
24479 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
24480 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
24481 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
24482 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
24483 @end table
24484
24485 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
24486 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
24487 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
24488 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
24489
24490 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
24491 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
24492 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
24493 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
24494 function.
24495
24496 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
24497 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
24498 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
24499 continuing the execution. For example:
24500
24501 @smallexample
24502 $ break *upper
24503 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
24504 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
24505 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
24506 $ print $bnd0
24507 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
24508 @end smallexample
24509
24510 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
24511 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
24512 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
24513
24514 @node Alpha
24515 @subsection Alpha
24516
24517 See the following section.
24518
24519 @node MIPS
24520 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
24521
24522 @cindex stack on Alpha
24523 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
24524 @cindex Alpha stack
24525 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
24526 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
24527 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
24528 find the beginning of a function.
24529
24530 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
24531 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
24532 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
24533 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
24534 commands:
24535
24536 @table @code
24537 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
24538 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
24539 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
24540 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
24541 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
24542 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
24543 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
24544 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
24545
24546 @item show heuristic-fence-post
24547 Display the current limit.
24548 @end table
24549
24550 @noindent
24551 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
24552 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
24553
24554 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
24555 programs:
24556
24557 @table @code
24558 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
24559 @kindex set mips abi
24560 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
24561 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
24562 values of @var{arg} are:
24563
24564 @table @samp
24565 @item auto
24566 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
24567 default).
24568 @item o32
24569 @item o64
24570 @item n32
24571 @item n64
24572 @item eabi32
24573 @item eabi64
24574 @end table
24575
24576 @item show mips abi
24577 @kindex show mips abi
24578 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24579
24580 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
24581 @kindex set mips compression
24582 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
24583 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
24584 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
24585 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
24586 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
24587 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
24588 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
24589 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
24590 provided by the executable.
24591
24592 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
24593 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
24594 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
24595 identified as such.
24596
24597 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
24598 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
24599 implicitly from an executable.
24600
24601 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
24602 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
24603 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
24604 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
24605 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
24606
24607 @item show mips compression
24608 @kindex show mips compression
24609 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
24610 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24611
24612 @item set mipsfpu
24613 @itemx show mipsfpu
24614 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
24615
24616 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
24617 @kindex set mips mask-address
24618 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
24619 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
24620 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
24621 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
24622 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
24623
24624 @item show mips mask-address
24625 @kindex show mips mask-address
24626 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
24627 not.
24628
24629 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24630 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24631 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
24632 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
24633 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
24634 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
24635
24636 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24637 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24638 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
24639
24640 @item set debug mips
24641 @kindex set debug mips
24642 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
24643 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24644
24645 @item show debug mips
24646 @kindex show debug mips
24647 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
24648 @end table
24649
24650
24651 @node HPPA
24652 @subsection HPPA
24653 @cindex HPPA support
24654
24655 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24656 following special commands:
24657
24658 @table @code
24659 @item set debug hppa
24660 @kindex set debug hppa
24661 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24662 messages are to be displayed.
24663
24664 @item show debug hppa
24665 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24666
24667 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24668 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24669 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24670 given @var{address}.
24671
24672 @end table
24673
24674
24675 @node SPU
24676 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24677 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24678 @cindex SPU
24679
24680 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24681 it provides the following special commands:
24682
24683 @table @code
24684 @item info spu event
24685 @kindex info spu
24686 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24687 and pending event status.
24688
24689 @item info spu signal
24690 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24691 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24692 notification channels.
24693
24694 @item info spu mailbox
24695 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24696 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24697 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24698
24699 @item info spu dma
24700 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24701 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24702 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24703
24704 @item info spu proxydma
24705 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24706 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24707 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24708
24709 @end table
24710
24711 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24712 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24713 special commands:
24714
24715 @table @code
24716 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24717 @kindex set spu
24718 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24719 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24720 function. The default is @code{off}.
24721
24722 @item show spu stop-on-load
24723 @kindex show spu
24724 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24725
24726 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24727 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24728 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24729 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24730 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24731 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24732
24733 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24734 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24735
24736 @end table
24737
24738 @node PowerPC
24739 @subsection PowerPC
24740 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24741
24742 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24743 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24744 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24745 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24746 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24747
24748 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24749 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24750 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24751
24752 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24753 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24754
24755 @node Nios II
24756 @subsection Nios II
24757 @cindex Nios II architecture
24758
24759 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24760 it provides the following special commands:
24761
24762 @table @code
24763
24764 @item set debug nios2
24765 @kindex set debug nios2
24766 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24767 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24768
24769 @item show debug nios2
24770 @kindex show debug nios2
24771 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24772 @end table
24773
24774 @node Sparc64
24775 @subsection Sparc64
24776 @cindex Sparc64 support
24777 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24778 @subsubsection ADI Support
24779
24780 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24781 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24782 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24783 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24784 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24785 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24786 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24787 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24788 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24789 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24790 signal.
24791
24792 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24793 ADI-enabled.
24794
24795 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24796 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24797
24798
24799 @table @code
24800 @kindex adi examine
24801 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24802
24803 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24804 cacheline.
24805
24806 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24807 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24808 block size, to display.
24809
24810 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24811 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24812
24813 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24814
24815 @smallexample
24816 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24817 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24818 @end smallexample
24819
24820 @kindex adi assign
24821 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24822
24823 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24824 to an address.
24825
24826 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24827 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24828 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24829
24830 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24831 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24832
24833 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24834
24835 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24836 variable "shmaddr":
24837
24838 @smallexample
24839 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24840 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24841 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24842 @end smallexample
24843
24844 @end table
24845
24846 @node S12Z
24847 @subsection S12Z
24848 @cindex S12Z support
24849
24850 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24851 it provides the following special command:
24852
24853 @table @code
24854 @item maint info bdccsr
24855 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24856 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24857 BDCCSR register.
24858 @end table
24859
24860
24861 @node Controlling GDB
24862 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24863
24864 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24865 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24866 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24867 described here.
24868
24869 @menu
24870 * Prompt:: Prompt
24871 * Editing:: Command editing
24872 * Command History:: Command history
24873 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24874 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24875 * Numbers:: Numbers
24876 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24877 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24878 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24879 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24880 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24881 @end menu
24882
24883 @node Prompt
24884 @section Prompt
24885
24886 @cindex prompt
24887
24888 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24889 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24890 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24891 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24892 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24893 which one you are talking to.
24894
24895 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24896 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24897 or a prompt that does not.
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @kindex set prompt
24901 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24902 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24903
24904 @kindex show prompt
24905 @item show prompt
24906 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24907 @end table
24908
24909 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24910 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24911 are:
24912
24913 @table @code
24914 @kindex set extended-prompt
24915 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24916 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24917 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24918 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24919 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24920 is displayed.
24921
24922 For example:
24923
24924 @smallexample
24925 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24926 @end smallexample
24927
24928 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24929 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24930
24931 @kindex show extended-prompt
24932 @item show extended-prompt
24933 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24934 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24935 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24936 @end table
24937
24938 @node Editing
24939 @section Command Editing
24940 @cindex readline
24941 @cindex command line editing
24942
24943 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24944 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24945 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24946 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24947 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24948 debugging sessions.
24949
24950 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24951 command @code{set}.
24952
24953 @table @code
24954 @kindex set editing
24955 @cindex editing
24956 @item set editing
24957 @itemx set editing on
24958 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24959
24960 @item set editing off
24961 Disable command line editing.
24962
24963 @kindex show editing
24964 @item show editing
24965 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24966 @end table
24967
24968 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24969 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24970 @end ifset
24971 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24972 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24973 @end ifclear
24974 for more details about the Readline
24975 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24976 encouraged to read that chapter.
24977
24978 @node Command History
24979 @section Command History
24980 @cindex command history
24981
24982 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24983 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24984 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24985 history facility.
24986
24987 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24988 package, to provide the history facility.
24989 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24990 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24991 @end ifset
24992 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24993 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24994 @end ifclear
24995 for the detailed description of the History library.
24996
24997 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24998 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24999 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
25000 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
25001 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
25002 pressed on a line by itself.
25003
25004 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
25005 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
25006 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
25007 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
25008
25009 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
25010 history.
25011
25012 @table @code
25013 @cindex history substitution
25014 @cindex history file
25015 @kindex set history filename
25016 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
25017 @item set history filename @var{fname}
25018 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
25019 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
25020 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
25021 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
25022 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
25023 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
25024 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
25025 is not set.
25026
25027 @cindex save command history
25028 @kindex set history save
25029 @item set history save
25030 @itemx set history save on
25031 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
25032 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
25033
25034 @item set history save off
25035 Stop recording command history in a file.
25036
25037 @cindex history size
25038 @kindex set history size
25039 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
25040 @item set history size @var{size}
25041 @itemx set history size unlimited
25042 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
25043 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
25044 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
25045 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
25046 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
25047 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
25048
25049 @cindex remove duplicate history
25050 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
25051 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
25052 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
25053 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
25054 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
25055 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
25056 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
25057 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
25058 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
25059
25060 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
25061 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
25062
25063 @end table
25064
25065 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
25066 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25067 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
25068 @end ifset
25069 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25070 @xref{Event Designators},
25071 @end ifclear
25072 for more details.
25073
25074 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
25075 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
25076 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
25077 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
25078 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
25079 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
25080 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
25081 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
25082
25083 The commands to control history expansion are:
25084
25085 @table @code
25086 @item set history expansion on
25087 @itemx set history expansion
25088 @kindex set history expansion
25089 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
25090
25091 @item set history expansion off
25092 Disable history expansion.
25093
25094 @c @group
25095 @kindex show history
25096 @item show history
25097 @itemx show history filename
25098 @itemx show history save
25099 @itemx show history size
25100 @itemx show history expansion
25101 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
25102 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
25103 @c @end group
25104 @end table
25105
25106 @table @code
25107 @kindex show commands
25108 @cindex show last commands
25109 @cindex display command history
25110 @item show commands
25111 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
25112
25113 @item show commands @var{n}
25114 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
25115
25116 @item show commands +
25117 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
25118 @end table
25119
25120 @node Screen Size
25121 @section Screen Size
25122 @cindex size of screen
25123 @cindex screen size
25124 @cindex pagination
25125 @cindex page size
25126 @cindex pauses in output
25127
25128 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
25129 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
25130 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
25131 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
25132 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
25133 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
25134 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
25135 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
25136 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
25137 following line.
25138
25139 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
25140 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
25141 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
25142 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
25143 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
25144 width} commands:
25145
25146 @table @code
25147 @kindex set height
25148 @kindex set width
25149 @kindex show width
25150 @kindex show height
25151 @item set height @var{lpp}
25152 @itemx set height unlimited
25153 @itemx show height
25154 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
25155 @itemx set width unlimited
25156 @itemx show width
25157 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
25158 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
25159 commands display the current settings.
25160
25161 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
25162 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
25163 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
25164 buffer.
25165
25166 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
25167 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
25168
25169 @item set pagination on
25170 @itemx set pagination off
25171 @kindex set pagination
25172 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
25173 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
25174 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
25175 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
25176
25177 @item show pagination
25178 @kindex show pagination
25179 Show the current pagination mode.
25180 @end table
25181
25182 @node Output Styling
25183 @section Output Styling
25184 @cindex styling
25185 @cindex colors
25186
25187 @kindex set style
25188 @kindex show style
25189 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
25190 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
25191 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
25192 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
25193
25194 @table @code
25195 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
25196 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
25197 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
25198
25199 @item show style enabled
25200 Show the current state of styling.
25201
25202 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
25203 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
25204 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
25205 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
25206 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
25207 default is @samp{on}.
25208
25209 @item show style sources
25210 Show the current state of source code styling.
25211 @end table
25212
25213 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
25214 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
25215 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
25216 intensity.
25217
25218 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
25219 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
25220
25221 @table @code
25222 @item set style filename background @var{color}
25223 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25224 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25225 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25226 and@samp{white}.
25227
25228 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
25229 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25230 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25231 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25232 and@samp{white}.
25233
25234 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
25235 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
25236 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
25237 @end table
25238
25239 The @code{show style} command and its subcommands are styling
25240 a style name in their output using its own style.
25241 So, use @command{show style} to see the complete list of styles,
25242 their characteristics and the visual aspect of each style.
25243
25244 The style-able objects are:
25245 @table @code
25246 @item filename
25247 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
25248 foreground color is green.
25249
25250 @item function
25251 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
25252 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
25253 style's foreground color is yellow.
25254
25255 @item variable
25256 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
25257 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
25258 foreground color is cyan.
25259
25260 @item address
25261 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
25262 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
25263 foreground color is blue.
25264
25265 @item title
25266 Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the
25267 @code{set style title} family of commands. By default, this style's
25268 intensity is bold. Commands are using the title style to improve
25269 the readibility of large output. For example, the commands
25270 @command{apropos} and @command{help} are using the title style
25271 for the command names.
25272
25273 @item highlight
25274 Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the
25275 @code{set style highlight} family of commands. By default, this style's
25276 foreground color is red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw
25277 the user attention to some specific parts of their output. For example,
25278 the command @command{apropos -v REGEXP} uses the highlight style to
25279 mark the documentation parts matching @var{regexp}.
25280
25281 @end table
25282
25283 @node Numbers
25284 @section Numbers
25285 @cindex number representation
25286 @cindex entering numbers
25287
25288 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
25289 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
25290 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
25291 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
25292 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
25293 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
25294 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
25295 both input and output with the commands described below.
25296
25297 @table @code
25298 @kindex set input-radix
25299 @item set input-radix @var{base}
25300 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
25301 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25302 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
25303 example, any of
25304
25305 @smallexample
25306 set input-radix 012
25307 set input-radix 10.
25308 set input-radix 0xa
25309 @end smallexample
25310
25311 @noindent
25312 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
25313 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
25314 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
25315 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
25316 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
25317 change the radix.
25318
25319 @kindex set output-radix
25320 @item set output-radix @var{base}
25321 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
25322 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25323 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
25324
25325 @kindex show input-radix
25326 @item show input-radix
25327 Display the current default base for numeric input.
25328
25329 @kindex show output-radix
25330 @item show output-radix
25331 Display the current default base for numeric display.
25332
25333 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
25334 @itemx show radix
25335 @kindex set radix
25336 @kindex show radix
25337 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
25338 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
25339 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
25340 default value of 10.
25341
25342 @end table
25343
25344 @node ABI
25345 @section Configuring the Current ABI
25346
25347 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
25348 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
25349 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
25350 current ABI.
25351
25352 @cindex OS ABI
25353 @kindex set osabi
25354 @kindex show osabi
25355 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
25356
25357 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
25358 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
25359 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
25360 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
25361 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
25362 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
25363 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
25364 platform provides.
25365
25366 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
25367 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
25368 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
25369 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
25370
25371 @table @code
25372 @item show osabi
25373 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
25374
25375 @item set osabi
25376 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
25377
25378 @item set osabi @var{abi}
25379 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
25380 @end table
25381
25382 @cindex float promotion
25383
25384 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
25385 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
25386 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
25387 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
25388 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
25389 @code{double} and then passed.
25390
25391 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
25392 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
25393 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
25394
25395 @table @code
25396 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
25397 @item set coerce-float-to-double
25398 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
25399 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
25400 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
25401
25402 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
25403 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
25404 functions.
25405
25406 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
25407 @item show coerce-float-to-double
25408 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
25409 @end table
25410
25411 @kindex set cp-abi
25412 @kindex show cp-abi
25413 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
25414 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
25415 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
25416 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
25417 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
25418 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
25419 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
25420 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
25421 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
25422 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
25423 ``auto''.
25424
25425 @table @code
25426 @item show cp-abi
25427 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
25428
25429 @item set cp-abi
25430 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
25431
25432 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
25433 @itemx set cp-abi auto
25434 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
25435 @end table
25436
25437 @node Auto-loading
25438 @section Automatically loading associated files
25439 @cindex auto-loading
25440
25441 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
25442 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
25443 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
25444 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
25445 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
25446 sources).
25447
25448 @menu
25449 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25450 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
25451
25452 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
25453 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
25454 @end menu
25455
25456 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
25457 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
25458 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25459
25460 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
25461 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
25462 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25463
25464 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
25465 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
25466
25467 @table @code
25468 @anchor{set auto-load off}
25469 @kindex set auto-load off
25470 @item set auto-load off
25471 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
25472 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
25473 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
25474 @smallexample
25475 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
25476 @end smallexample
25477
25478 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
25479 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
25480 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
25481 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
25482 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
25483 @code{set auto-load no}.
25484
25485 @anchor{show auto-load}
25486 @kindex show auto-load
25487 @item show auto-load
25488 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
25489 or disabled.
25490
25491 @smallexample
25492 (gdb) show auto-load
25493 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
25494 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
25495 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
25496 is on.
25497 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
25498 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25499 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25500 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
25501 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25502 @end smallexample
25503
25504 @anchor{info auto-load}
25505 @kindex info auto-load
25506 @item info auto-load
25507 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
25508 not.
25509
25510 @smallexample
25511 (gdb) info auto-load
25512 gdb-scripts:
25513 Loaded Script
25514 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
25515 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
25516 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
25517 loaded.
25518 python-scripts:
25519 Loaded Script
25520 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
25521 @end smallexample
25522 @end table
25523
25524 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
25525
25526 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
25527 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
25528 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
25529 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
25530 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
25531 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
25532 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
25533 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25534 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25535 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25536 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25537 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25538 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25539 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
25540 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25541 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
25542 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25543 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
25544 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25545 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
25546 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25547 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
25548 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25549 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
25550 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25551 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25552 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25553 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
25554 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25555 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
25556 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
25557 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25558 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
25559 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25560 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
25561 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25562 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
25563 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
25564 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
25565 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
25566 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
25567 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
25568 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
25569 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
25570 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
25571 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
25572 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
25573 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
25574 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
25575 @end multitable
25576
25577 @node Init File in the Current Directory
25578 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
25579 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
25580
25581 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
25582 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
25583 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
25584
25585 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
25586 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25587
25588 @table @code
25589 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
25590 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
25591 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
25592 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
25593 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
25594
25595 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
25596 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
25597 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
25598 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25599 current directory is enabled or disabled.
25600
25601 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25602 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
25603 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
25604 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25605 current directory have been auto-loaded.
25606 @end table
25607
25608 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
25609 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
25610 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
25611
25612 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
25613
25614 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
25615 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
25616
25617 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
25618 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
25619 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
25620 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
25621 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
25622 library.
25623
25624 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
25625 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25626
25627 @table @code
25628 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
25629 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
25630 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
25631 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
25632
25633 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
25634 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
25635 @item show auto-load libthread-db
25636 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
25637 enabled or disabled.
25638
25639 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
25640 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
25641 @item info auto-load libthread-db
25642 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
25643 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
25644 @end table
25645
25646 @node Auto-loading safe path
25647 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
25648 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
25649
25650 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
25651 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
25652 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
25653 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
25654 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
25655
25656 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
25657 get loaded:
25658
25659 @smallexample
25660 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
25661 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
25662 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
25663 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25664 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25665 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
25666 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25667 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25668 @end smallexample
25669
25670 @noindent
25671 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
25672 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
25673
25674 @smallexample
25675 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
25676 @end smallexample
25677
25678 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
25679
25680 @table @code
25681 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
25682 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
25683 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25684 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25685 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25686 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25687 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25688 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25689 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25690 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25691
25692 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25693 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25694 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25695
25696 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25697 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25698 @item show auto-load safe-path
25699 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25700 scripts.
25701
25702 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25703 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25704 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25705 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25706 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25707 by the host platform path separator in use.
25708 @end table
25709
25710 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25711 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25712 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25713 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25714 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25715
25716 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25717 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25718 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25719 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25720 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25721 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25722 init file in the current directory
25723 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25724
25725 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25726 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25727
25728 @table @asis
25729 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25730 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25731 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25732 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25733
25734 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25735 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25736 @value{GDBN} session.
25737
25738 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25739 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25740 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25741 from trusted sources.
25742
25743 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25744 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25745 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25746 trusted sources.
25747 @end table
25748
25749 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25750 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25751
25752 @table @asis
25753 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25754 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25755
25756 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25757 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25758 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25759 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25760 @end table
25761
25762 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25763 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25764 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25765 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25766 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25767 recommended to be entered.
25768
25769 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25770 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25771 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25772
25773 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25774 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25775 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25776 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25777 be printed.
25778
25779 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25780 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25781 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25782
25783 @smallexample
25784 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25785 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25786 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25787 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25788 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25789 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25790 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25791 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25792 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25793 @end smallexample
25794
25795 @table @code
25796 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25797 @kindex set debug auto-load
25798 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25799 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25800
25801 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25802 @kindex show debug auto-load
25803 @item show debug auto-load
25804 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25805 on or off.
25806 @end table
25807
25808 @node Messages/Warnings
25809 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25810
25811 @cindex verbose operation
25812 @cindex optional warnings
25813 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25814 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25815 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25816 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25817
25818 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25819 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25820 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25821
25822 @table @code
25823 @kindex set verbose
25824 @item set verbose on
25825 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25826
25827 @item set verbose off
25828 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25829
25830 @kindex show verbose
25831 @item show verbose
25832 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25833 @end table
25834
25835 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25836 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25837 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25838 Symbol Files}).
25839
25840 @table @code
25841
25842 @kindex set complaints
25843 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25844 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25845 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25846 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25847 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25848
25849 @kindex show complaints
25850 @item show complaints
25851 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25852
25853 @end table
25854
25855 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25856 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25857 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25858 you try to run a program which is already running:
25859
25860 @smallexample
25861 (@value{GDBP}) run
25862 The program being debugged has been started already.
25863 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25864 @end smallexample
25865
25866 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25867 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25868
25869 @table @code
25870
25871 @kindex set confirm
25872 @cindex flinching
25873 @cindex confirmation
25874 @cindex stupid questions
25875 @item set confirm off
25876 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25877 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25878 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25879
25880 @item set confirm on
25881 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25882
25883 @kindex show confirm
25884 @item show confirm
25885 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25886
25887 @end table
25888
25889 @cindex command tracing
25890 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25891 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25892 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25893 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25894
25895 @table @code
25896 @kindex set trace-commands
25897 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25898 @item set trace-commands on
25899 Enable command tracing.
25900 @item set trace-commands off
25901 Disable command tracing.
25902 @item show trace-commands
25903 Display the current state of command tracing.
25904 @end table
25905
25906 @node Debugging Output
25907 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25908 @cindex optional debugging messages
25909
25910 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25911 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25912 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25913 section documents those commands.
25914
25915 @table @code
25916 @kindex set exec-done-display
25917 @item set exec-done-display
25918 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25919 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25920 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25921 @kindex show exec-done-display
25922 @item show exec-done-display
25923 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25924 notification.
25925 @kindex set debug
25926 @cindex ARM AArch64
25927 @item set debug aarch64
25928 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25929 The default is off.
25930 @kindex show debug
25931 @item show debug aarch64
25932 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25933 ARM AArch64.
25934 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25935 @cindex architecture debugging info
25936 @item set debug arch
25937 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25938 @item show debug arch
25939 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25940 @item set debug aix-solib
25941 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25942 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25943 support module. The default is off.
25944 @item show debug aix-thread
25945 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25946 @item set debug aix-thread
25947 @cindex AIX threads
25948 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25949 module.
25950 @item show debug aix-thread
25951 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25952 @item set debug check-physname
25953 @cindex physname
25954 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25955 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25956 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25957 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25958 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25959 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25960 @item show debug check-physname
25961 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25962 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25963 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25964 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25965 exported symbols. The default is off.
25966 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25967 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25968 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25969 @item set debug dwarf-die
25970 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25971 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25972 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25973 A value of zero turns off the display.
25974 @item show debug dwarf-die
25975 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25976 @item set debug dwarf-line
25977 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25978 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25979 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25980 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25981 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25982 @item show debug dwarf-line
25983 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25984 @item set debug dwarf-read
25985 @cindex DWARF Reading
25986 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25987 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25988 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25989 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25990 @item show debug dwarf-read
25991 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25992 @item set debug displaced
25993 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25994 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25995 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25996 @item show debug displaced
25997 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25998 related to displaced stepping.
25999 @item set debug event
26000 @cindex event debugging info
26001 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
26002 default is off.
26003 @item show debug event
26004 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
26005 info.
26006 @item set debug expression
26007 @cindex expression debugging info
26008 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
26009 expression parsing. The default is off.
26010 @item show debug expression
26011 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
26012 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
26013 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
26014 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
26015 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
26016 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
26017 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
26018 @item set debug fbsd-nat
26019 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
26020 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
26021 @item show debug fbsd-nat
26022 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
26023 @item set debug frame
26024 @cindex frame debugging info
26025 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
26026 default is off.
26027 @item show debug frame
26028 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
26029 info.
26030 @item set debug gnu-nat
26031 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
26032 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
26033 @item show debug gnu-nat
26034 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
26035 @item set debug infrun
26036 @cindex inferior debugging info
26037 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
26038 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
26039 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
26040 @item show debug infrun
26041 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
26042 @item set debug jit
26043 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
26044 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
26045 @item show debug jit
26046 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
26047 @item set debug lin-lwp
26048 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
26049 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
26050 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
26051 @item show debug lin-lwp
26052 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
26053 @item set debug linux-namespaces
26054 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
26055 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
26056 @item show debug linux-namespaces
26057 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
26058 @item set debug mach-o
26059 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
26060 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
26061 processing. The default is off.
26062 @item show debug mach-o
26063 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26064 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26065 @item set debug notification
26066 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
26067 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
26068 The default is off.
26069 @item show debug notification
26070 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
26071 @item set debug observer
26072 @cindex observer debugging info
26073 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
26074 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
26075 @item show debug observer
26076 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
26077 @item set debug overload
26078 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
26079 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
26080 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
26081 is off.
26082 @item show debug overload
26083 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
26084 debugging info.
26085 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
26086 @cindex debug expression parser
26087 @item set debug parser
26088 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
26089 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
26090 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
26091 details. The default is off.
26092 @item show debug parser
26093 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
26094 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
26095 @cindex serial connections, debugging
26096 @cindex debug remote protocol
26097 @cindex remote protocol debugging
26098 @cindex display remote packets
26099 @item set debug remote
26100 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
26101 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
26102 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
26103 @item show debug remote
26104 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
26105
26106 @item set debug separate-debug-file
26107 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
26108 @item show debug separate-debug-file
26109 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
26110
26111 @item set debug serial
26112 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
26113 default is off.
26114 @item show debug serial
26115 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
26116 info.
26117 @item set debug solib-frv
26118 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
26119 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
26120 @item show debug solib-frv
26121 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
26122 messages.
26123 @item set debug symbol-lookup
26124 @cindex symbol lookup
26125 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
26126 The default is 0 (off).
26127 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26128 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26129 @item show debug symbol-lookup
26130 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
26131 @item set debug symfile
26132 @cindex symbol file functions
26133 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
26134 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
26135 @item show debug symfile
26136 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
26137 @item set debug symtab-create
26138 @cindex symbol table creation
26139 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
26140 The default is 0 (off).
26141 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26142 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26143 @item show debug symtab-create
26144 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
26145 @item set debug target
26146 @cindex target debugging info
26147 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
26148 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
26149 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
26150 value of large memory transfers.
26151 @item show debug target
26152 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
26153 info.
26154 @item set debug timestamp
26155 @cindex timestampping debugging info
26156 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
26157 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
26158 message.
26159 @item show debug timestamp
26160 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
26161 debugging info.
26162 @item set debug varobj
26163 @cindex variable object debugging info
26164 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
26165 info. The default is off.
26166 @item show debug varobj
26167 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
26168 debugging info.
26169 @item set debug xml
26170 @cindex XML parser debugging
26171 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
26172 @item show debug xml
26173 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
26174 @end table
26175
26176 @node Other Misc Settings
26177 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
26178 @cindex miscellaneous settings
26179
26180 @table @code
26181 @kindex set interactive-mode
26182 @item set interactive-mode
26183 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
26184 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
26185 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
26186 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
26187 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
26188 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
26189 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
26190 is, non-interactively otherwise.
26191
26192 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
26193 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
26194 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
26195 inside a cygwin window.
26196
26197 @kindex show interactive-mode
26198 @item show interactive-mode
26199 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
26200 @end table
26201
26202 @node Extending GDB
26203 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
26204 @cindex extending GDB
26205
26206 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
26207 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
26208 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
26209 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
26210 being debugged.
26211
26212 @menu
26213 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
26214 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
26215 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
26216 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
26217 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
26218 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
26219 @end menu
26220
26221 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
26222 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
26223 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
26224 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
26225 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26226 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
26227
26228 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
26229 setting:
26230
26231 @table @code
26232 @kindex set script-extension
26233 @kindex show script-extension
26234 @item set script-extension off
26235 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26236
26237 @item set script-extension soft
26238 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26239 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
26240 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
26241 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
26242
26243 @item set script-extension strict
26244 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26245 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
26246 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
26247
26248 @item show script-extension
26249 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
26250
26251 @end table
26252
26253 @node Sequences
26254 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
26255
26256 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
26257 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
26258 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
26259 files.
26260
26261 @menu
26262 * Define:: How to define your own commands
26263 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
26264 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
26265 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
26266 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
26267 @end menu
26268
26269 @node Define
26270 @subsection User-defined Commands
26271
26272 @cindex user-defined command
26273 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
26274 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
26275 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
26276 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
26277 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
26278 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
26279
26280 @smallexample
26281 define adder
26282 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26283 end
26284 @end smallexample
26285
26286 @noindent
26287 To execute the command use:
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 adder 1 2 3
26291 @end smallexample
26292
26293 @noindent
26294 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
26295 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
26296 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
26297 functions calls.
26298
26299 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
26300 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
26301 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
26302 been passed.
26303
26304 @smallexample
26305 define adder
26306 if $argc == 2
26307 print $arg0 + $arg1
26308 end
26309 if $argc == 3
26310 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26311 end
26312 end
26313 @end smallexample
26314
26315 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
26316 to process a variable number of arguments:
26317
26318 @smallexample
26319 define adder
26320 set $i = 0
26321 set $sum = 0
26322 while $i < $argc
26323 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
26324 set $i = $i + 1
26325 end
26326 print $sum
26327 end
26328 @end smallexample
26329
26330 @table @code
26331
26332 @kindex define
26333 @item define @var{commandname}
26334 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
26335 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
26336 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
26337 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
26338 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
26339 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
26340
26341 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
26342 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
26343 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26344
26345 @kindex document
26346 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
26347 @item document @var{commandname}
26348 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
26349 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
26350 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
26351 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
26352 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
26353 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
26354
26355 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
26356 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
26357 does not change the documentation.
26358
26359 @kindex dont-repeat
26360 @cindex don't repeat command
26361 @item dont-repeat
26362 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
26363 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
26364 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
26365
26366 @kindex help user-defined
26367 @item help user-defined
26368 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
26369 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
26370 included (if any).
26371
26372 @kindex show user
26373 @item show user
26374 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
26375 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
26376 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
26377 definitions for all user-defined commands.
26378 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
26379
26380 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
26381 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
26382 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
26383 @item show max-user-call-depth
26384 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
26385 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
26386 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
26387 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
26388 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
26389 @end table
26390
26391 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
26392 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
26393
26394 When user-defined commands are executed, the
26395 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
26396 stops execution of the user-defined command.
26397
26398 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
26399 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
26400 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
26401 messages when used in a user-defined command.
26402
26403 @node Hooks
26404 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
26405 @cindex command hooks
26406 @cindex hooks, for commands
26407 @cindex hooks, pre-command
26408
26409 @kindex hook
26410 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
26411 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
26412 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
26413 before that command.
26414
26415 @cindex hooks, post-command
26416 @kindex hookpost
26417 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
26418 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
26419 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
26420 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
26421 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
26422
26423 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
26424 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
26425
26426 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
26427 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
26428
26429 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
26430 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
26431 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
26432 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
26433 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
26434
26435 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
26436 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
26437 you could define:
26438
26439 @smallexample
26440 define hook-stop
26441 handle SIGALRM nopass
26442 end
26443
26444 define hook-run
26445 handle SIGALRM pass
26446 end
26447
26448 define hook-continue
26449 handle SIGALRM pass
26450 end
26451 @end smallexample
26452
26453 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
26454 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
26455 you could define:
26456
26457 @smallexample
26458 define hook-echo
26459 echo <<<---
26460 end
26461
26462 define hookpost-echo
26463 echo --->>>\n
26464 end
26465
26466 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
26467 <<<---Hello World--->>>
26468 (@value{GDBP})
26469
26470 @end smallexample
26471
26472 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
26473 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
26474 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
26475 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
26476 @c or not?
26477 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
26478 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
26479 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
26480
26481 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
26482 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
26483 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
26484
26485 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
26486 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
26487
26488 @node Command Files
26489 @subsection Command Files
26490
26491 @cindex command files
26492 @cindex scripting commands
26493 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
26494 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
26495 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
26496 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
26497 terminal.
26498
26499 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
26500 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
26501 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
26502 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
26503 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
26504
26505 @table @code
26506 @kindex source
26507 @cindex execute commands from a file
26508 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
26509 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
26510 @end table
26511
26512 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
26513 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
26514 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
26515 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
26516 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
26517
26518 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
26519 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
26520 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
26521 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
26522 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
26523 is not relevant to scripts.
26524
26525 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
26526 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
26527 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
26528 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
26529 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26530 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
26531 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
26532 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
26533 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26534 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
26535 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
26536 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
26537 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
26538 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
26539
26540 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
26541 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
26542 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
26543
26544 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
26545 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
26546 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
26547 when called from command files.
26548
26549 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
26550 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
26551 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
26552 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
26553 the next command.
26554
26555 @smallexample
26556 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
26557 @end smallexample
26558
26559 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
26560 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
26561 would be directed to @file{log}.
26562
26563 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
26564 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
26565 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
26566 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
26567 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
26568 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
26569 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
26570 conditionally, etc.
26571
26572 @table @code
26573 @kindex if
26574 @kindex else
26575 @item if
26576 @itemx else
26577 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
26578 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
26579 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
26580 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
26581 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
26582 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
26583 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26584
26585 @kindex while
26586 @item while
26587 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
26588 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
26589 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
26590 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
26591 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
26592 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
26593
26594 @kindex loop_break
26595 @item loop_break
26596 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
26597 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
26598 line.
26599
26600 @kindex loop_continue
26601 @item loop_continue
26602 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
26603 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
26604 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
26605 the controlling expression.
26606
26607 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
26608 @item end
26609 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
26610 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
26611 @end table
26612
26613
26614 @node Output
26615 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
26616
26617 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
26618 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
26619 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
26620 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
26621 want.
26622
26623 @table @code
26624 @kindex echo
26625 @item echo @var{text}
26626 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
26627 @c because it is not in ANSI.
26628 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
26629 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
26630 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
26631 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
26632 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
26633 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
26634 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
26635 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
26636 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
26637
26638 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
26639 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
26640
26641 @smallexample
26642 echo This is some text\n\
26643 which is continued\n\
26644 onto several lines.\n
26645 @end smallexample
26646
26647 produces the same output as
26648
26649 @smallexample
26650 echo This is some text\n
26651 echo which is continued\n
26652 echo onto several lines.\n
26653 @end smallexample
26654
26655 @kindex output
26656 @item output @var{expression}
26657 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
26658 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
26659 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
26660 on expressions.
26661
26662 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
26663 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
26664 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
26665 Formats}, for more information.
26666
26667 @kindex printf
26668 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26669 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26670 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
26671 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
26672 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
26673 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
26674 executing the code below:
26675
26676 @smallexample
26677 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
26678 @end smallexample
26679
26680 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
26681 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
26682 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
26683 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26684 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26685 printed.
26686
26687 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26688
26689 @smallexample
26690 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26691 @end smallexample
26692
26693 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26694 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26695 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26696
26697 @itemize @bullet
26698 @item
26699 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26700
26701 @item
26702 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26703 width.
26704
26705 @item
26706 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26707 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26708
26709 @item
26710 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26711 supported.
26712
26713 @item
26714 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26715
26716 @item
26717 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26718 @end itemize
26719
26720 @noindent
26721 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26722 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26723 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26724 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26725
26726 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26727 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26728 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26729 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26730 supported.
26731
26732 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26733 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26734 together with a floating point specifier.
26735 letters:
26736
26737 @itemize @bullet
26738 @item
26739 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26740
26741 @item
26742 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26743
26744 @item
26745 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26746 @end itemize
26747
26748 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26749 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26750 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26751
26752 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26753 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26754
26755 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26756 @smallexample
26757 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26758 @end smallexample
26759
26760 @anchor{eval}
26761 @kindex eval
26762 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26763 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26764 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26765
26766 @end table
26767
26768 @node Auto-loading sequences
26769 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26770 @cindex native script auto-loading
26771
26772 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26773 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26774 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26775 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26776
26777 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26778 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26779
26780 @table @code
26781 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26782 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26783 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26784 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26785
26786 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26787 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26788 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26789 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26790 disabled.
26791
26792 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26793 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26794 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26795 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26796 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26797 auto-loaded.
26798 @end table
26799
26800 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26801 matching names are printed.
26802
26803 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26804 @include python.texi
26805
26806 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26807 @include guile.texi
26808
26809 @node Auto-loading extensions
26810 @section Auto-loading extensions
26811 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26812
26813 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26814 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26815 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26816 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26817 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26818
26819 @menu
26820 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26821 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26822 * Which flavor to choose?::
26823 @end menu
26824
26825 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26826 debugging commands and features.
26827
26828 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26829 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26830 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26831 for more information.
26832 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26833 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26834
26835 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26836 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26837
26838 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26839 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26840 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26841 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26842 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26843
26844 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26845 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26846 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26847 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26848
26849 @table @code
26850 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26851 GDB's own command language
26852 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26853 Python
26854 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26855 Guile
26856 @end table
26857
26858 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26859 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26860 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26861 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26862 script in the specified extension language.
26863
26864 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26865 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26866
26867 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26868 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26869
26870 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26871 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26872 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26873 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26874 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26875 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26876
26877 @table @code
26878 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26879 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26880 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26881 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26882 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26883 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26884
26885 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26886 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26887
26888 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26889 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26890 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26891 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26892
26893 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26894 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26895 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26896 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26897 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26898 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26899 platform.
26900
26901 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26902 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26903 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26904
26905 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26906 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26907 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26908 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26909
26910 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26911 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26912 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26913 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26914 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26915 @end table
26916
26917 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26918 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26919 @var{objfile} is opened.
26920 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26921 is evaluated more than once.
26922
26923 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26924 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26925 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26926
26927 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26928 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26929 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26930 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26931 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26932 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26933 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26934
26935 The following entries are supported:
26936
26937 @table @code
26938 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26939 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26940 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26941 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26942 @end table
26943
26944 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26945
26946 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26947 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26948 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26949 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26950 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26951
26952 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26953 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26954
26955 @example
26956 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26957 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26958 asm("\
26959 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26960 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26961 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26962 .popsection \n\
26963 ");
26964 @end example
26965
26966 @noindent
26967 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26968 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26969
26970 @example
26971 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26972 @end example
26973
26974 The script name may include directories if desired.
26975
26976 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26977 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26978
26979 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26980 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26981 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26982 will remove duplicates.
26983
26984 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26985
26986 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26987 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26988 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26989 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26990 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26991 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26992 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26993 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26994 on its name.
26995
26996 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26997 testsuite.
26998
26999 @example
27000 #include "symcat.h"
27001 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
27002 asm(
27003 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
27004 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
27005 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
27006 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
27007 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
27008 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
27009 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
27010 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
27011 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
27012 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
27013 ".byte 0\n"
27014 ".popsection\n"
27015 );
27016 @end example
27017
27018 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
27019 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27020 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
27021 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
27022
27023 @node Which flavor to choose?
27024 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
27025
27026 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
27027 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
27028
27029 @noindent
27030 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
27031
27032 @itemize @bullet
27033 @item
27034 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
27035
27036 @item
27037 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
27038
27039 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
27040 in the source search path.
27041 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
27042 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
27043
27044 @item
27045 Doesn't require source code additions.
27046 @end itemize
27047
27048 @noindent
27049 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
27050
27051 @itemize @bullet
27052 @item
27053 Works with static linking.
27054
27055 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
27056 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
27057 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
27058 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
27059 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
27060
27061 @item
27062 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
27063
27064 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
27065 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
27066
27067 @item
27068 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
27069
27070 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
27071 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
27072 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
27073 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
27074 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
27075 top of the source tree to the source search path.
27076 @end itemize
27077
27078 @node Multiple Extension Languages
27079 @section Multiple Extension Languages
27080
27081 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
27082 and generally do not interfere with each other.
27083 There are some things to be aware of, however.
27084
27085 @subsection Python comes first
27086
27087 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
27088 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
27089 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
27090 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
27091 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
27092 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
27093 pretty-printed form of a value).
27094 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
27095 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
27096 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
27097
27098 @node Aliases
27099 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
27100 @cindex aliases for commands
27101
27102 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
27103 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
27104 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
27105 that involves less typing.
27106
27107 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
27108 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
27109 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
27110
27111 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
27112 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
27113 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
27114
27115 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
27116
27117 @table @code
27118
27119 @kindex alias
27120 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
27121
27122 @end table
27123
27124 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
27125 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
27126 underscores.
27127
27128 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
27129 that is being aliased.
27130
27131 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
27132 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
27133 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
27134
27135 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
27136 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
27137
27138 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
27139 of a command so that there is less to type.
27140 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
27141 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
27142 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
27143 The following will accomplish this.
27144
27145 @smallexample
27146 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
27147 @end smallexample
27148
27149 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
27150 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
27151 for it with the @samp{document} command.
27152 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
27153
27154 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
27155 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
27156 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
27157 of a command.
27158
27159 @smallexample
27160 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
27161 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
27162 (gdb) set p elms 20
27163 (gdb) show p elms
27164 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
27168 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
27169 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
27170
27171 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
27172 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
27173
27174 @smallexample
27175 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
27176 @end smallexample
27177
27178 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
27179 alias for a more complex command.
27180 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
27181
27182 @smallexample
27183 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
27184 (gdb) spe 20
27185 @end smallexample
27186
27187 @node Interpreters
27188 @chapter Command Interpreters
27189 @cindex command interpreters
27190
27191 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
27192 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
27193 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
27194
27195 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
27196 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
27197 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
27198 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
27199
27200 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
27201 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
27202 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
27203 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
27204
27205 @table @code
27206 @item console
27207 @cindex console interpreter
27208 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
27209 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
27210 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
27211
27212 @item mi
27213 @cindex mi interpreter
27214 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
27215 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
27216 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
27217 Interface}.
27218
27219 @item mi3
27220 @cindex mi3 interpreter
27221 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
27222
27223 @item mi2
27224 @cindex mi2 interpreter
27225 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
27226
27227 @item mi1
27228 @cindex mi1 interpreter
27229 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
27230
27231 @end table
27232
27233 @cindex invoke another interpreter
27234
27235 @kindex interpreter-exec
27236 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
27237 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
27238 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
27239
27240 @smallexample
27241 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
27242 @end smallexample
27243
27244 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
27245 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
27246
27247 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
27248 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
27249 permanently.
27250
27251 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
27252
27253 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
27254 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
27255 device (usually a tty).
27256
27257 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
27258 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
27259 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
27260 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
27261 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
27262 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
27263 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
27264 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
27265 the separate MI interpreter.
27266
27267 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
27268 @code{new-ui} command:
27269
27270 @kindex new-ui
27271 @cindex new user interface
27272 @smallexample
27273 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
27274 @end smallexample
27275
27276 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
27277 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
27278 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
27279 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
27280 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
27281 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
27282
27283 @smallexample
27284 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
27285 @end smallexample
27286
27287 @noindent
27288 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
27289
27290 @node TUI
27291 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
27292 @cindex TUI
27293 @cindex Text User Interface
27294
27295 @menu
27296 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
27297 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
27298 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
27299 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
27300 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
27301 @end menu
27302
27303 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
27304 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
27305 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
27306 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
27307 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
27308 is available.
27309
27310 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
27311 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
27312 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
27313 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
27314 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
27315 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
27316
27317 @node TUI Overview
27318 @section TUI Overview
27319
27320 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
27321
27322 @table @emph
27323 @item command
27324 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
27325 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
27326 managed using readline.
27327
27328 @item source
27329 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
27330 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
27331
27332 @item assembly
27333 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
27334
27335 @item register
27336 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
27337 when their values change.
27338 @end table
27339
27340 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
27341 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
27342 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
27343 indicates the breakpoint type:
27344
27345 @table @code
27346 @item B
27347 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27348
27349 @item b
27350 Breakpoint which was never hit.
27351
27352 @item H
27353 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27354
27355 @item h
27356 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
27357 @end table
27358
27359 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
27360
27361 @table @code
27362 @item +
27363 Breakpoint is enabled.
27364
27365 @item -
27366 Breakpoint is disabled.
27367 @end table
27368
27369 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
27370 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
27371 changes.
27372
27373 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
27374 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
27375 layouts:
27376
27377 @itemize @bullet
27378 @item
27379 source only,
27380
27381 @item
27382 assembly only,
27383
27384 @item
27385 source and assembly,
27386
27387 @item
27388 source and registers, or
27389
27390 @item
27391 assembly and registers.
27392 @end itemize
27393
27394 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
27395
27396 @table @emph
27397 @item target
27398 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
27399 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
27400
27401 @item process
27402 Gives the current process or thread number.
27403 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
27404
27405 @item function
27406 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
27407 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
27408 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
27409 the string @code{??} is displayed.
27410
27411 @item line
27412 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
27413 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
27414
27415 @item pc
27416 Indicates the current program counter address.
27417 @end table
27418
27419 @node TUI Keys
27420 @section TUI Key Bindings
27421 @cindex TUI key bindings
27422
27423 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
27424 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
27425 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
27426 @end ifset
27427 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
27428 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
27429 @end ifclear
27430 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
27431 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
27432
27433 @table @kbd
27434 @kindex C-x C-a
27435 @item C-x C-a
27436 @kindex C-x a
27437 @itemx C-x a
27438 @kindex C-x A
27439 @itemx C-x A
27440 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
27441 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
27442 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
27443 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
27444 The screen is then refreshed.
27445
27446 @kindex C-x 1
27447 @item C-x 1
27448 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
27449 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
27450 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
27451
27452 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
27453
27454 @kindex C-x 2
27455 @item C-x 2
27456 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
27457 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
27458 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
27459 previous layout and the new one.
27460
27461 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
27462
27463 @kindex C-x o
27464 @item C-x o
27465 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
27466 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
27467 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
27468
27469 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
27470
27471 @kindex C-x s
27472 @item C-x s
27473 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
27474 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
27475 @end table
27476
27477 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
27478
27479 @table @asis
27480 @kindex PgUp
27481 @item @key{PgUp}
27482 Scroll the active window one page up.
27483
27484 @kindex PgDn
27485 @item @key{PgDn}
27486 Scroll the active window one page down.
27487
27488 @kindex Up
27489 @item @key{Up}
27490 Scroll the active window one line up.
27491
27492 @kindex Down
27493 @item @key{Down}
27494 Scroll the active window one line down.
27495
27496 @kindex Left
27497 @item @key{Left}
27498 Scroll the active window one column left.
27499
27500 @kindex Right
27501 @item @key{Right}
27502 Scroll the active window one column right.
27503
27504 @kindex C-L
27505 @item @kbd{C-L}
27506 Refresh the screen.
27507 @end table
27508
27509 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
27510 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
27511 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
27512 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
27513 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
27514
27515 @node TUI Single Key Mode
27516 @section TUI Single Key Mode
27517 @cindex TUI single key mode
27518
27519 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
27520 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
27521 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
27522
27523 @table @kbd
27524 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27525 @item c
27526 continue
27527
27528 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27529 @item d
27530 down
27531
27532 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27533 @item f
27534 finish
27535
27536 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27537 @item n
27538 next
27539
27540 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27541 @item o
27542 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
27543
27544 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27545 @item q
27546 exit the SingleKey mode.
27547
27548 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27549 @item r
27550 run
27551
27552 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27553 @item s
27554 step
27555
27556 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27557 @item i
27558 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
27559
27560 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27561 @item u
27562 up
27563
27564 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27565 @item v
27566 info locals
27567
27568 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27569 @item w
27570 where
27571 @end table
27572
27573 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
27574 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
27575 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
27576 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
27577 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
27578 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
27579
27580
27581 @node TUI Commands
27582 @section TUI-specific Commands
27583 @cindex TUI commands
27584
27585 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
27586 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
27587 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
27588 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
27589
27590 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
27591 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
27592 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
27593 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
27594 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
27595
27596 @table @code
27597 @item tui enable
27598 @kindex tui enable
27599 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
27600 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
27601 otherwise a default layout is used.
27602
27603 @item tui disable
27604 @kindex tui disable
27605 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
27606
27607 @item info win
27608 @kindex info win
27609 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
27610
27611 @item layout @var{name}
27612 @kindex layout
27613 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
27614 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
27615 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
27616
27617 @table @code
27618 @item next
27619 Display the next layout.
27620
27621 @item prev
27622 Display the previous layout.
27623
27624 @item src
27625 Display the source and command windows.
27626
27627 @item asm
27628 Display the assembly and command windows.
27629
27630 @item split
27631 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
27632
27633 @item regs
27634 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
27635 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
27636 register, assembler, and command windows.
27637 @end table
27638
27639 @item focus @var{name}
27640 @kindex focus
27641 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
27642 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
27643
27644 @table @code
27645 @item next
27646 Make the next window active for scrolling.
27647
27648 @item prev
27649 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
27650
27651 @item src
27652 Make the source window active for scrolling.
27653
27654 @item asm
27655 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
27656
27657 @item regs
27658 Make the register window active for scrolling.
27659
27660 @item cmd
27661 Make the command window active for scrolling.
27662 @end table
27663
27664 @item refresh
27665 @kindex refresh
27666 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
27667
27668 @item tui reg @var{group}
27669 @kindex tui reg
27670 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
27671 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
27672 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
27673 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
27674 following groups are available on most targets:
27675 @table @code
27676 @item next
27677 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27678 through all of the available register groups.
27679
27680 @item prev
27681 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27682 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
27683 @var{next}.
27684
27685 @item general
27686 Display the general registers.
27687 @item float
27688 Display the floating point registers.
27689 @item system
27690 Display the system registers.
27691 @item vector
27692 Display the vector registers.
27693 @item all
27694 Display all registers.
27695 @end table
27696
27697 @item update
27698 @kindex update
27699 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27700
27701 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27702 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27703 @kindex winheight
27704 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27705 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27706 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27707 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27708 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27709 @end table
27710
27711 @node TUI Configuration
27712 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27713 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27714
27715 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27716
27717 @table @code
27718 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27719 @kindex set tui border-kind
27720 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27721 The possible values are the following:
27722 @table @code
27723 @item space
27724 Use a space character to draw the border.
27725
27726 @item ascii
27727 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27728
27729 @item acs
27730 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27731 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27732 @end table
27733
27734 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27735 @kindex set tui border-mode
27736 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27737 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27738 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27739 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27740 @table @code
27741 @item normal
27742 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27743
27744 @item standout
27745 Use standout mode.
27746
27747 @item reverse
27748 Use reverse video mode.
27749
27750 @item half
27751 Use half bright mode.
27752
27753 @item half-standout
27754 Use half bright and standout mode.
27755
27756 @item bold
27757 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27758
27759 @item bold-standout
27760 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27761 @end table
27762
27763 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27764 @kindex set tui tab-width
27765 @kindex tabset
27766 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27767 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27768 assembly windows.
27769 @end table
27770
27771 @node Emacs
27772 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27773
27774 @cindex Emacs
27775 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27776 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27777 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27778 @value{GDBN}.
27779
27780 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27781 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27782 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27783 created Emacs buffer.
27784 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27785
27786 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27787 things:
27788
27789 @itemize @bullet
27790 @item
27791 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27792 the GUD buffer.
27793
27794 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27795 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27796
27797 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27798 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27799 in this way.
27800
27801 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27802 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27803 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27804 stop.
27805
27806 @item
27807 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27808
27809 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27810 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27811 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27812 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27813 and the source.
27814
27815 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27816 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27817 @end itemize
27818
27819 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27820 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27821 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27822 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27823
27824 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27825 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27826 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27827 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27828 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27829 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27830 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27831 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27832 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27833
27834 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27835 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27836 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27837 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27838
27839 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27840 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27841 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27842 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27843 one you want.
27844
27845 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27846 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27847
27848 @table @kbd
27849 @item C-h m
27850 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27851
27852 @item C-c C-s
27853 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27854 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27855
27856 @item C-c C-n
27857 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27858 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27859 to show the current file and location.
27860
27861 @item C-c C-i
27862 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27863 display window accordingly.
27864
27865 @item C-c C-f
27866 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27867 @code{finish} command.
27868
27869 @item C-c C-r
27870 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27871 command.
27872
27873 @item C-c <
27874 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27875 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27876 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27877
27878 @item C-c >
27879 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27880 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27881 @end table
27882
27883 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27884 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27885
27886 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27887 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27888 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27889 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27890 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27891 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27892 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27893
27894 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27895 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27896 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27897 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27898 frame.
27899
27900 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27901 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27902 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27903 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27904 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27905 to correspond properly with the code.
27906
27907 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27908 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27909 Emacs Manual}).
27910
27911 @node GDB/MI
27912 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27913
27914 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27915
27916 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27917 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27918 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27919 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27920 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27921 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27922
27923 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27924 in the form of a reference manual.
27925
27926 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27927 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27928 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27929
27930 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27931
27932 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27933 This chapter uses the following notation:
27934
27935 @itemize @bullet
27936 @item
27937 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27938
27939 @item
27940 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27941 it may or may not be given.
27942
27943 @item
27944 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27945 may repeat zero or more times.
27946
27947 @item
27948 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27949 may repeat one or more times.
27950
27951 @item
27952 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27953 @end itemize
27954
27955 @ignore
27956 @heading Dependencies
27957 @end ignore
27958
27959 @menu
27960 * GDB/MI General Design::
27961 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27962 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27963 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27964 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27965 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27966 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27967 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27968 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27969 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27970 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27971 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27972 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27973 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27974 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27975 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27976 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27977 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27978 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27979 @ignore
27980 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27981 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27982 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27983 @end ignore
27984 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27985 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27986 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27987 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27988 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27989 @end menu
27990
27991 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27992 @node GDB/MI General Design
27993 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27994 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27995
27996 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27997 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27998 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27999 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28000 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28001 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28002 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28003 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28004 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28005 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28006
28007 The important examples of notifications are:
28008 @itemize @bullet
28009
28010 @item
28011 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28012 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28013 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28014 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28015 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28016 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28017 command itself was successfully executed.
28018
28019 @item
28020 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28021 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28022 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28023 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28024 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28025 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28026
28027 @item
28028 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28029 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28030 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28031 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28032 orthogonal frontend design.
28033
28034 @end itemize
28035
28036 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28037 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28038 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28039 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28040 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28041 the user interface.
28042
28043
28044 @menu
28045 * Context management::
28046 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28047 * Thread groups::
28048 @end menu
28049
28050 @node Context management
28051 @subsection Context management
28052
28053 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
28054
28055 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28056 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28057 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28058 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28059 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28060 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28061 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28062 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28063 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28064
28065 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28066 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28067 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28068 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28069 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28070 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28071 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28072 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28073 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28074 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
28075 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
28076
28077 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28078 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28079 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28080 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
28081 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
28082 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
28083 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
28084 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
28085 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
28086 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28087
28088 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28089 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28090 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
28091 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
28092 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
28093 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
28094 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
28095 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
28096 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
28097 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
28098 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
28099 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
28100 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
28101 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
28102 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
28103 @samp{--frame} options.
28104
28105 @subsubsection Language
28106
28107 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
28108 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
28109 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
28110 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
28111 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
28112 For instance:
28113
28114 @smallexample
28115 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
28116 ^done,value="4"
28117 (gdb)
28118 @end smallexample
28119
28120 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
28121 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
28122 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
28123
28124 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
28125 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
28126
28127 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
28128 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
28129 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
28130 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
28131 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
28132 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
28133 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
28134 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
28135 @code{-list-target-features} command.
28136
28137 @table @code
28138 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
28139 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
28140 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
28141
28142 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
28143 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
28144 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
28145
28146 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
28147 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
28148 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
28149 MI commands even while the target is running.
28150
28151 @item -gdb-show mi-async
28152 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
28153 @end table
28154
28155 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
28156 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
28157 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
28158 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
28159 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
28160 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
28161
28162 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
28163 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
28164 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
28165 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
28166 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
28167 are running.
28168
28169 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
28170 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
28171 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
28172 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
28173 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
28174 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
28175 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
28176 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
28177 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
28178 @samp{--thread} option).
28179
28180 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
28181 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
28182 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
28183 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
28184
28185 @node Thread groups
28186 @subsection Thread groups
28187 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
28188 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
28189 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
28190 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
28191 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
28192
28193 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
28194 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
28195 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
28196 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
28197 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
28198 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
28199 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
28200 into processes.
28201
28202 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
28203 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
28204 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
28205 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
28206 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
28207 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
28208 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
28209 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
28210 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
28211 the members of specific thread group.
28212
28213 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
28214 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
28215 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
28216 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
28217 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
28218 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
28219 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
28220 after attaching to that thread group.
28221
28222 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
28223 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
28224 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
28225 such thread groups.
28226
28227 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28228 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
28229 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
28230
28231 @menu
28232 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
28233 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
28234 @end menu
28235
28236 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
28237 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
28238
28239 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
28240 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
28241 @table @code
28242 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
28243 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
28244
28245 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
28246 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
28247 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
28248
28249 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
28250 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
28251 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
28252
28253 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28254 "any sequence of digits"
28255
28256 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
28257 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
28258
28259 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
28260 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
28261
28262 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
28263 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
28264
28265 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
28266 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
28267 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
28268
28269 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
28270 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
28271
28272 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28273 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28274 @end table
28275
28276 @noindent
28277 Notes:
28278
28279 @itemize @bullet
28280 @item
28281 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
28282 output is described below.
28283
28284 @item
28285 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
28286 finishes.
28287
28288 @item
28289 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
28290 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
28291 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
28292 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
28293 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
28294 @end itemize
28295
28296 Pragmatics:
28297
28298 @itemize @bullet
28299 @item
28300 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
28301
28302 @item
28303 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
28304 @end itemize
28305
28306 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
28307 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
28308
28309 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
28310 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
28311 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
28312 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
28313 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
28314 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
28315
28316 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
28317 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
28318 @var{token}.
28319
28320 @table @code
28321 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
28322 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
28323
28324 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
28325 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
28326
28327 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
28328 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
28329
28330 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
28331 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
28332
28333 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
28334 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
28335
28336 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
28337 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
28338
28339 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
28340 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
28341
28342 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
28343 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
28344
28345 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
28346 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
28347
28348 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
28349 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
28350 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
28351
28352 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
28353 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
28354
28355 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
28356 @code{ @var{string} }
28357
28358 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
28359 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
28360
28361 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
28362 @code{@var{c-string}}
28363
28364 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
28365 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
28366
28367 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
28368 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
28369 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
28370
28371 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
28372 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
28373
28374 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
28375 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
28376
28377 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
28378 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
28379
28380 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
28381 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
28382
28383 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28384 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28385
28386 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28387 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
28388 @end table
28389
28390 @noindent
28391 Notes:
28392
28393 @itemize @bullet
28394 @item
28395 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
28396
28397 @item
28398 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
28399 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
28400 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
28401 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
28402 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
28403 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
28404 prior command.
28405
28406 @item
28407 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28408 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
28409 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
28410 prefixed by @samp{+}.
28411
28412 @item
28413 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28414 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
28415 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
28416 @samp{*}.
28417
28418 @item
28419 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28420 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
28421 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
28422 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
28423
28424 @item
28425 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28426 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
28427 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
28428 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
28429
28430 @item
28431 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28432 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
28433 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
28434
28435 @item
28436 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28437 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
28438 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
28439 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
28440
28441 @item
28442 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28443 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
28444 @var{values}.
28445
28446
28447 @end itemize
28448
28449 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
28450 details about the various output records.
28451
28452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28453 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
28454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
28455
28456 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
28457 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
28458
28459 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
28460 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
28461 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
28462 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
28463 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
28464 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
28465
28466 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
28467 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
28468 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
28469
28470 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28471 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
28472 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
28473 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
28474
28475 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
28476 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
28477
28478 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
28479 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
28480 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
28481 does.
28482
28483 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
28484 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
28485 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
28486 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
28487
28488 @itemize @bullet
28489 @item
28490 New MI commands may be added.
28491
28492 @item
28493 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
28494
28495 @item
28496 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
28497 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
28498
28499 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
28500 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
28501
28502 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
28503 @c resolve inconsistencies.
28504 @end itemize
28505
28506 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
28507 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
28508 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
28509 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
28510
28511 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
28512 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
28513 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
28514 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
28515
28516 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
28517 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
28518 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
28519
28520 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
28521 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
28522
28523 @item
28524 @center 1
28525 @tab
28526 @center 5.1
28527 @tab
28528 None
28529
28530 @item
28531 @center 2
28532 @tab
28533 @center 6.0
28534 @tab
28535
28536 @itemize
28537 @item
28538 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
28539 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
28540 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
28541
28542 @item
28543 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
28544 than a tuple.
28545
28546 @item
28547 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
28548 a tuple.
28549 @end itemize
28550
28551 @item
28552 @center 3
28553 @tab
28554 @center 9.1
28555 @tab
28556
28557 @itemize
28558 @item
28559 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
28560 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
28561 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
28562 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
28563 is a list.
28564 @end itemize
28565
28566 @end multitable
28567
28568 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
28569 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
28570 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
28571
28572 @table @code
28573
28574 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
28575 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
28576 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
28577 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
28578
28579 @end table
28580
28581 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
28582 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
28583 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
28584 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
28585 @cindex mailing lists
28586
28587 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28588 @node GDB/MI Output Records
28589 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
28590
28591 @menu
28592 * GDB/MI Result Records::
28593 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
28594 * GDB/MI Async Records::
28595 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
28596 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
28597 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
28598 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
28599 @end menu
28600
28601 @node GDB/MI Result Records
28602 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
28603
28604 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28605 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
28606 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
28607 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
28608
28609 @table @code
28610 @findex ^done
28611 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
28612 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
28613 values.
28614
28615 @item "^running"
28616 @findex ^running
28617 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
28618 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
28619 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
28620 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
28621 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
28622 which threads are resumed.
28623
28624 @item "^connected"
28625 @findex ^connected
28626 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
28627
28628 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
28629 @findex ^error
28630 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
28631 the corresponding error message.
28632
28633 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
28634 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
28635 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
28636
28637 @table @samp
28638 @item "undefined-command"
28639 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
28640 @end table
28641
28642 @item "^exit"
28643 @findex ^exit
28644 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
28645
28646 @end table
28647
28648 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
28649 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
28650
28651 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
28652 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28653 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
28654 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
28655 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
28656
28657 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
28658 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
28659 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
28660 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
28661 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
28662
28663 @table @code
28664 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28665 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28666 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28667
28668 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28669 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28670 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28671 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28672
28673 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28674 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28675 internals.
28676 @end table
28677
28678 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28679 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28680
28681 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28682 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28683 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28684 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28685 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28686 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28687
28688 The following is the list of possible async records:
28689
28690 @table @code
28691
28692 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28693 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28694 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28695 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28696 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28697 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28698 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28699 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28700 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28701 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28702 it run freely.
28703
28704 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28705 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28706 following values:
28707
28708 @table @code
28709 @item breakpoint-hit
28710 A breakpoint was reached.
28711 @item watchpoint-trigger
28712 A watchpoint was triggered.
28713 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28714 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28715 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28716 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28717 @item function-finished
28718 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28719 @item location-reached
28720 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28721 @item watchpoint-scope
28722 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28723 @item end-stepping-range
28724 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28725 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28726 @item exited-signalled
28727 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28728 @item exited
28729 The inferior exited.
28730 @item exited-normally
28731 The inferior exited normally.
28732 @item signal-received
28733 A signal was received by the inferior.
28734 @item solib-event
28735 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28736 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28737 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28738 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28739 @item fork
28740 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28741 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28742 @item vfork
28743 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28744 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28745 @item syscall-entry
28746 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28747 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28748 @item syscall-return
28749 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28750 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28751 @item exec
28752 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28753 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28754 @end table
28755
28756 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28757 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28758 Depending on whether all-stop
28759 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28760 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28761 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28762 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28763 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28764 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28765 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28766 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28767 if such information is not available.
28768
28769 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28770 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28771 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28772 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28773 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28774 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28775 cannot be used in any way.
28776
28777 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28778 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28779 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28780 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28781 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28782 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28783
28784 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28785 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28786 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28787 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28788 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28789 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28790
28791 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28792 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28793 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28794 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28795 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28796
28797 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28798 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28799 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28800 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28801 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28802 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28803 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28804 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28805 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28806
28807 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28808 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28809
28810 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28811 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28812 that thread.
28813
28814 @item =library-loaded,...
28815 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28816 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28817 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28818 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28819 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28820 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28821 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28822 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28823 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28824 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28825 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28826 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28827 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28828 to this library.
28829
28830 @item =library-unloaded,...
28831 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28832 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28833 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28834 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28835 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28836 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28837 thread groups.
28838
28839 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28840 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28841 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28842 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28843 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28844
28845 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28846 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28847 initial value @var{initial}.
28848
28849 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28850 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28851 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28852 trace state variables are deleted.
28853
28854 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28855 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28856 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28857 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28858 value of trace state variable is known.
28859
28860 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28861 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28862 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28863 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28864 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28865 user.
28866
28867 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28868 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28869 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28870
28871 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28872 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28873
28874 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28875 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28876 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28877 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28878 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28879
28880 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28881 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28882 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28883 for existing method and format values.
28884
28885 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28886 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28887 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28888 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28889 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28890 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28891
28892 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28893 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28894 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28895 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28896 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28897 executable code.
28898 @end table
28899
28900 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28901 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28902
28903 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28904 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28905 following fields:
28906
28907 @table @code
28908 @item number
28909 The breakpoint number.
28910
28911 @item type
28912 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28913 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28914
28915 @item catch-type
28916 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28917 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28918
28919 @item disp
28920 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28921 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28922 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28923
28924 @item enabled
28925 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28926 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28927 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28928
28929 @item addr
28930 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28931 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28932 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28933 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28934 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28935
28936 @item addr_flags
28937 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
28938 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
28939 particular CPU.
28940
28941 @item func
28942 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28943 If not known, this field is not present.
28944
28945 @item filename
28946 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28947 If not known, this field is not present.
28948
28949 @item fullname
28950 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28951 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28952
28953 @item line
28954 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28955 If not known, this field is not present.
28956
28957 @item at
28958 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28959 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28960 by a symbol name.
28961
28962 @item pending
28963 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28964 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28965
28966 @item evaluated-by
28967 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28968 @samp{target}.
28969
28970 @item thread
28971 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28972 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28973
28974 @item task
28975 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28976 field will hold the task identifier.
28977
28978 @item cond
28979 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28980
28981 @item ignore
28982 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28983
28984 @item enable
28985 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28986
28987 @item traceframe-usage
28988 FIXME.
28989
28990 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28991 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28992
28993 @item mask
28994 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28995
28996 @item pass
28997 A tracepoint's pass count.
28998
28999 @item original-location
29000 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29001 This field is optional.
29002
29003 @item times
29004 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29005
29006 @item installed
29007 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29008 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29009 is not.
29010
29011 @item what
29012 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29013
29014 @item locations
29015 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
29016 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
29017 location.
29018
29019 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
29020
29021 @end table
29022
29023 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
29024 following fields:
29025
29026 @table @code
29027
29028 @item number
29029 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
29030 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
29031 location within that breakpoint.
29032
29033 @item enabled
29034 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
29035 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29036 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29037
29038 @item addr
29039 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
29040
29041 @item addr_flags
29042 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29043 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29044 particular CPU.
29045
29046 @item func
29047 If known, the function in which the location appears.
29048 If not known, this field is not present.
29049
29050 @item file
29051 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
29052 If not known, this field is not present.
29053
29054 @item fullname
29055 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
29056 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29057
29058 @item line
29059 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
29060 If not known, this field is not present.
29061
29062 @item thread-groups
29063 The thread groups this location is in.
29064
29065 @end table
29066
29067 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29068 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29069
29070 @smallexample
29071 -> -break-insert main
29072 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29073 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29074 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29075 times="0"@}
29076 <- (gdb)
29077 @end smallexample
29078
29079 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29080 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29081
29082 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29083 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29084 fields:
29085
29086 @table @code
29087 @item level
29088 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29089 zero. This field is always present.
29090
29091 @item func
29092 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29093 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29094
29095 @item addr
29096 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29097
29098 @item addr_flags
29099 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29100 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29101 particular CPU.
29102
29103 @item file
29104 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29105 address. This field may be absent.
29106
29107 @item line
29108 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29109 may be absent.
29110
29111 @item from
29112 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29113 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29114
29115 @end table
29116
29117 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29118 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29119
29120 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29121 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
29122 stated otherwise.
29123
29124 @table @code
29125 @item id
29126 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
29127
29128 @item target-id
29129 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
29130
29131 @item details
29132 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29133 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29134 frontend. This field is optional.
29135
29136 @item name
29137 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
29138 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
29139 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
29140 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
29141 field is omitted.
29142
29143 @item state
29144 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
29145 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
29146
29147 @item frame
29148 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
29149 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
29150 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
29151
29152 @item core
29153 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29154 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29155 @end table
29156
29157 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29158 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29159
29160 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
29161 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
29162 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
29163 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
29164 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
29165 the @code{exception-message} field.
29166
29167 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29168 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
29169 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
29170 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
29171
29172 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
29173 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
29174 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
29175 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
29176
29177 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
29178 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
29179
29180 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
29181
29182 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
29183 information of the breakpoint.
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 -> -break-insert main
29187 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29188 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29189 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29190 times="0"@}
29191 <- (gdb)
29192 @end smallexample
29193
29194 @subheading Program Execution
29195
29196 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
29197 reason that execution stopped.
29198
29199 @smallexample
29200 -> -exec-run
29201 <- ^running
29202 <- (gdb)
29203 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29204 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
29205 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
29206 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
29207 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29208 <- (gdb)
29209 -> -exec-continue
29210 <- ^running
29211 <- (gdb)
29212 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29213 <- (gdb)
29214 @end smallexample
29215
29216 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
29217
29218 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
29219
29220 @smallexample
29221 -> (gdb)
29222 <- -gdb-exit
29223 <- ^exit
29224 @end smallexample
29225
29226 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
29227 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
29228 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
29229 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
29230 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
29231 fails to exit in reasonable time.
29232
29233 @subheading A Bad Command
29234
29235 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
29236
29237 @smallexample
29238 -> -rubbish
29239 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
29240 <- (gdb)
29241 @end smallexample
29242
29243
29244 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29245 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
29246 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
29247
29248 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
29249 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
29250
29251 @subheading Motivation
29252
29253 The motivation for this collection of commands.
29254
29255 @subheading Introduction
29256
29257 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
29258
29259 @subheading Commands
29260
29261 For each command in the block, the following is described:
29262
29263 @subsubheading Synopsis
29264
29265 @smallexample
29266 -command @var{args}@dots{}
29267 @end smallexample
29268
29269 @subsubheading Result
29270
29271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29272
29273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
29274
29275 @subsubheading Example
29276
29277 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
29278 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
29279
29280
29281 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29282 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
29283 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
29284
29285 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
29286 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
29287 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29288 breakpoints.
29289
29290 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
29291 @findex -break-after
29292
29293 @subsubheading Synopsis
29294
29295 @smallexample
29296 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
29297 @end smallexample
29298
29299 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
29300 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
29301 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
29302 @samp{-break-list} command below.
29303
29304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29305
29306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
29307
29308 @subsubheading Example
29309
29310 @smallexample
29311 (gdb)
29312 -break-insert main
29313 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29314 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29315 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29316 times="0"@}
29317 (gdb)
29318 -break-after 1 3
29319 ~
29320 ^done
29321 (gdb)
29322 -break-list
29323 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29324 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29325 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29326 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29327 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29328 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29329 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29330 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29331 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29332 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29333 (gdb)
29334 @end smallexample
29335
29336 @ignore
29337 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
29338 @findex -break-catch
29339 @end ignore
29340
29341 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
29342 @findex -break-commands
29343
29344 @subsubheading Synopsis
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
29348 @end smallexample
29349
29350 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
29351 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
29352 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
29353 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
29354 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
29355 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
29356
29357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29358
29359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
29360
29361 @subsubheading Example
29362
29363 @smallexample
29364 (gdb)
29365 -break-insert main
29366 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29367 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29368 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29369 times="0"@}
29370 (gdb)
29371 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
29372 ^done
29373 (gdb)
29374 @end smallexample
29375
29376 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
29377 @findex -break-condition
29378
29379 @subsubheading Synopsis
29380
29381 @smallexample
29382 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
29383 @end smallexample
29384
29385 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
29386 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
29387 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
29388 command below).
29389
29390 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29391
29392 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
29393
29394 @subsubheading Example
29395
29396 @smallexample
29397 (gdb)
29398 -break-condition 1 1
29399 ^done
29400 (gdb)
29401 -break-list
29402 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29403 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29404 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29405 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29406 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29407 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29408 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29409 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29410 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29411 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29412 (gdb)
29413 @end smallexample
29414
29415 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
29416 @findex -break-delete
29417
29418 @subsubheading Synopsis
29419
29420 @smallexample
29421 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29422 @end smallexample
29423
29424 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
29425 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
29426
29427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29428
29429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
29430
29431 @subsubheading Example
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 (gdb)
29435 -break-delete 1
29436 ^done
29437 (gdb)
29438 -break-list
29439 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29440 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29441 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29442 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29443 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29444 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29445 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29446 body=[]@}
29447 (gdb)
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
29451 @findex -break-disable
29452
29453 @subsubheading Synopsis
29454
29455 @smallexample
29456 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29457 @end smallexample
29458
29459 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
29460 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
29461
29462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29463
29464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
29465
29466 @subsubheading Example
29467
29468 @smallexample
29469 (gdb)
29470 -break-disable 2
29471 ^done
29472 (gdb)
29473 -break-list
29474 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29475 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29476 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29477 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29478 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29479 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29480 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29481 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29482 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29483 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29484 (gdb)
29485 @end smallexample
29486
29487 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
29488 @findex -break-enable
29489
29490 @subsubheading Synopsis
29491
29492 @smallexample
29493 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
29497
29498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29499
29500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
29501
29502 @subsubheading Example
29503
29504 @smallexample
29505 (gdb)
29506 -break-enable 2
29507 ^done
29508 (gdb)
29509 -break-list
29510 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29511 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29512 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29513 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29514 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29515 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29516 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29517 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29518 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29519 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29520 (gdb)
29521 @end smallexample
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
29524 @findex -break-info
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 @c REDUNDANT???
29533 Get information about a single breakpoint.
29534
29535 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
29536 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
29537 table.
29538
29539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29540
29541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
29542
29543 @subsubheading Example
29544 N.A.
29545
29546 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
29547 @findex -break-insert
29548 @anchor{-break-insert}
29549
29550 @subsubheading Synopsis
29551
29552 @smallexample
29553 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
29554 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29555 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
29556 @end smallexample
29557
29558 @noindent
29559 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
29560
29561 @table @var
29562 @item linespec location
29563 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
29564
29565 @item explicit location
29566 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
29567 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
29568 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
29569
29570 @table @samp
29571 @item --source @var{filename}
29572 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
29573 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
29574
29575 @item --function @var{function}
29576 The name of a function or method.
29577
29578 @item --label @var{label}
29579 The name of a label.
29580
29581 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
29582 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
29583 @end table
29584
29585 @item address location
29586 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
29587 @end table
29588
29589 @noindent
29590 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29591
29592 @table @samp
29593 @item -t
29594 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29595 @item -h
29596 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
29597 @item -f
29598 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
29599 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29600 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29601 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29602 cannot be parsed.
29603 @item -d
29604 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29605 @item -a
29606 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
29607 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
29608 @item -c @var{condition}
29609 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29610 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29611 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
29612 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29613 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29614 @var{thread-id}.
29615 @end table
29616
29617 @subsubheading Result
29618
29619 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29620 resulting breakpoint.
29621
29622 Note: this format is open to change.
29623 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29624
29625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29626
29627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
29628 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
29629
29630 @subsubheading Example
29631
29632 @smallexample
29633 (gdb)
29634 -break-insert main
29635 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
29636 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29637 times="0"@}
29638 (gdb)
29639 -break-insert -t foo
29640 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
29641 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29642 times="0"@}
29643 (gdb)
29644 -break-list
29645 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29646 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29647 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29648 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29649 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29650 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29651 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29652 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29653 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
29654 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29655 times="0"@},
29656 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29657 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
29658 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29659 times="0"@}]@}
29660 (gdb)
29661 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
29662 @c ~int foo(int, int);
29663 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
29664 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29665 @c times="0"@}
29666 @c (gdb)
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
29670 @findex -dprintf-insert
29671
29672 @subsubheading Synopsis
29673
29674 @smallexample
29675 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
29676 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29677 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
29678 [ @var{argument} ]
29679 @end smallexample
29680
29681 @noindent
29682 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
29683 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
29684
29685 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29686
29687 @table @samp
29688 @item -t
29689 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29690 @item -f
29691 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29692 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29693 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29694 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29695 cannot be parsed.
29696 @item -d
29697 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29698 @item -c @var{condition}
29699 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29700 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29701 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29702 to @var{ignore-count}.
29703 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29704 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29705 @var{thread-id}.
29706 @end table
29707
29708 @subsubheading Result
29709
29710 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29711 resulting breakpoint.
29712
29713 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29714
29715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29716
29717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29718
29719 @subsubheading Example
29720
29721 @smallexample
29722 (gdb)
29723 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29724 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29725 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29726 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29727 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29728 original-location="foo"@}
29729 (gdb)
29730 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29731 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29732 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29733 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29734 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29735 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29736 (gdb)
29737 @end smallexample
29738
29739 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29740 @findex -break-list
29741
29742 @subsubheading Synopsis
29743
29744 @smallexample
29745 -break-list
29746 @end smallexample
29747
29748 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29749
29750 @table @samp
29751 @item Number
29752 number of the breakpoint
29753 @item Type
29754 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29755 @item Disposition
29756 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29757 or @samp{nokeep}
29758 @item Enabled
29759 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29760 @item Address
29761 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29762 @item What
29763 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29764 name, line number
29765 @item Thread-groups
29766 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29767 @item Times
29768 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29769 @end table
29770
29771 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29772 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29773
29774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29775
29776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29777
29778 @subsubheading Example
29779
29780 @smallexample
29781 (gdb)
29782 -break-list
29783 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29784 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29785 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29786 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29787 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29788 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29789 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29790 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29791 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29792 times="0"@},
29793 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29794 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29795 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29796 (gdb)
29797 @end smallexample
29798
29799 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29800
29801 @smallexample
29802 (gdb)
29803 -break-list
29804 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29805 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29806 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29807 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29808 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29809 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29810 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29811 body=[]@}
29812 (gdb)
29813 @end smallexample
29814
29815 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29816 @findex -break-passcount
29817
29818 @subsubheading Synopsis
29819
29820 @smallexample
29821 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29822 @end smallexample
29823
29824 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29825 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29826 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29827 command @samp{passcount}.
29828
29829 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29830 @findex -break-watch
29831
29832 @subsubheading Synopsis
29833
29834 @smallexample
29835 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29839 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29840 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29841 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29842 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29843 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29844 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29845 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29846
29847 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29848 breakpoints inserted.
29849
29850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29851
29852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29853 @samp{rwatch}.
29854
29855 @subsubheading Example
29856
29857 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 (gdb)
29861 -break-watch x
29862 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29863 (gdb)
29864 -exec-continue
29865 ^running
29866 (gdb)
29867 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29868 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29869 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29870 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29871 (gdb)
29872 @end smallexample
29873
29874 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29875 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29876 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29877
29878 @smallexample
29879 (gdb)
29880 -break-watch C
29881 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29882 (gdb)
29883 -exec-continue
29884 ^running
29885 (gdb)
29886 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29887 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29888 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29889 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29890 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29891 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29892 (gdb)
29893 -exec-continue
29894 ^running
29895 (gdb)
29896 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29897 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29898 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29899 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29900 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29901 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29902 (gdb)
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29906 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29907 deleted.
29908
29909 @smallexample
29910 (gdb)
29911 -break-watch C
29912 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29913 (gdb)
29914 -break-list
29915 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29916 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29917 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29918 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29919 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29920 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29921 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29922 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29923 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29924 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29925 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29926 times="1"@},
29927 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29928 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29929 (gdb)
29930 -exec-continue
29931 ^running
29932 (gdb)
29933 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29934 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29935 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29936 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29937 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29938 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29939 (gdb)
29940 -break-list
29941 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29942 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29943 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29944 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29945 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29946 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29947 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29948 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29949 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29950 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29951 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29952 times="1"@},
29953 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29954 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29955 (gdb)
29956 -exec-continue
29957 ^running
29958 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29959 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29960 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29961 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29962 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29963 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29964 (gdb)
29965 -break-list
29966 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29967 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29968 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29969 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29970 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29971 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29972 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29973 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29974 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29975 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29976 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29977 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29978 (gdb)
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981
29982 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29983 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29984 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29985
29986 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29987 catchpoints.
29988
29989 @menu
29990 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29991 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29992 * C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29993 @end menu
29994
29995 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29996 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29997
29998 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29999 @findex -catch-load
30000
30001 @subsubheading Synopsis
30002
30003 @smallexample
30004 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30005 @end smallexample
30006
30007 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30008 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30009 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30010 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30011 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30012
30013
30014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30015
30016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30017
30018 @subsubheading Example
30019
30020 @smallexample
30021 -catch-load -t foo.so
30022 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30023 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30024 (gdb)
30025 @end smallexample
30026
30027
30028 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30029 @findex -catch-unload
30030
30031 @subsubheading Synopsis
30032
30033 @smallexample
30034 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30035 @end smallexample
30036
30037 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30038 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30039 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30040 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30041 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30042
30043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30044
30045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30046
30047 @subsubheading Example
30048
30049 @smallexample
30050 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30051 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30052 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30053 (gdb)
30054 @end smallexample
30055
30056 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30057 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30058
30059 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30060 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
30061
30062 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
30063 @findex -catch-assert
30064
30065 @subsubheading Synopsis
30066
30067 @smallexample
30068 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
30069 @end smallexample
30070
30071 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
30072
30073 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30074
30075 @table @samp
30076 @item -c @var{condition}
30077 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30078 @item -d
30079 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30080 @item -t
30081 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30082 @end table
30083
30084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30085
30086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
30087
30088 @subsubheading Example
30089
30090 @smallexample
30091 -catch-assert
30092 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30093 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
30094 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
30095 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
30096 (gdb)
30097 @end smallexample
30098
30099 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
30100 @findex -catch-exception
30101
30102 @subsubheading Synopsis
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30106 [ -t ] [ -u ]
30107 @end smallexample
30108
30109 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
30110 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30111 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30112 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30113 catchpoints.
30114
30115 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30116
30117 @table @samp
30118 @item -c @var{condition}
30119 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30120 @item -d
30121 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30122 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30123 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
30124 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
30125 @item -t
30126 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30127 @item -u
30128 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
30129 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
30130 @end table
30131
30132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30133
30134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
30135 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
30136
30137 @subsubheading Example
30138
30139 @smallexample
30140 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
30141 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30142 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
30143 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
30144 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
30145 (gdb)
30146 @end smallexample
30147
30148 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
30149 @findex -catch-handlers
30150
30151 @subsubheading Synopsis
30152
30153 @smallexample
30154 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30155 [ -t ]
30156 @end smallexample
30157
30158 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
30159 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30160 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30161 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30162 catchpoints.
30163
30164 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30165
30166 @table @samp
30167 @item -c @var{condition}
30168 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30169 @item -d
30170 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30171 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30172 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
30173 @item -t
30174 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30175 @end table
30176
30177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30178
30179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
30180
30181 @subsubheading Example
30182
30183 @smallexample
30184 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
30185 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30186 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
30187 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
30188 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
30189 (gdb)
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192 @node C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30193 @subsection C@t{++} Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30194
30195 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30196 that stop the execution when C@t{++} exceptions are being throw, rethrown,
30197 or caught.
30198
30199 @subheading The @code{-catch-throw} Command
30200 @findex -catch-throw
30201
30202 @subsubheading Synopsis
30203
30204 @smallexample
30205 -catch-throw [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30206 @end smallexample
30207
30208 Stop when the debuggee throws a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp} is
30209 given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression
30210 will be caught.
30211
30212 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30213 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after stopping once for
30214 the event.
30215
30216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30217
30218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch throw}
30219 and @samp{tcatch throw} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30220
30221 @subsubheading Example
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 -catch-throw -r exception_type
30225 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30226 what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
30227 thread-groups=["i1"],
30228 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30229 (gdb)
30230 -exec-run
30231 ^running
30232 (gdb)
30233 ~"\n"
30234 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception thrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30235 in __cxa_throw () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30236 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30237 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_throw",
30238 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30239 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30240 (gdb)
30241 @end smallexample
30242
30243 @subheading The @code{-catch-rethrow} Command
30244 @findex -catch-rethrow
30245
30246 @subsubheading Synopsis
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 -catch-rethrow [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252 Stop when a C@t{++} exception is re-thrown. If @var{regexp} is given,
30253 then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression will be
30254 caught.
30255
30256 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30257 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30258 caught.
30259
30260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30261
30262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch rethrow}
30263 and @samp{tcatch rethrow} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30264
30265 @subsubheading Example
30266
30267 @smallexample
30268 -catch-rethrow -r exception_type
30269 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30270 what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
30271 thread-groups=["i1"],
30272 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30273 (gdb)
30274 -exec-run
30275 ^running
30276 (gdb)
30277 ~"\n"
30278 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30279 in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30280 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30281 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
30282 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30283 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30284 (gdb)
30285 @end smallexample
30286
30287 @subheading The @code{-catch-catch} Command
30288 @findex -catch-catch
30289
30290 @subsubheading Synopsis
30291
30292 @smallexample
30293 -catch-catch [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30294 @end smallexample
30295
30296 Stop when the debuggee catches a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp}
30297 is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular
30298 expression will be caught.
30299
30300 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30301 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30302 caught.
30303
30304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30305
30306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch catch}
30307 and @samp{tcatch catch} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30308
30309 @subsubheading Example
30310
30311 @smallexample
30312 -catch-catch -r exception_type
30313 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30314 what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
30315 thread-groups=["i1"],
30316 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30317 (gdb)
30318 -exec-run
30319 ^running
30320 (gdb)
30321 ~"\n"
30322 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30323 in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30324 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30325 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
30326 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30327 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30328 (gdb)
30329 @end smallexample
30330
30331 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30332 @node GDB/MI Program Context
30333 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
30334
30335 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
30336 @findex -exec-arguments
30337
30338
30339 @subsubheading Synopsis
30340
30341 @smallexample
30342 -exec-arguments @var{args}
30343 @end smallexample
30344
30345 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
30346 @samp{-exec-run}.
30347
30348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30349
30350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
30351
30352 @subsubheading Example
30353
30354 @smallexample
30355 (gdb)
30356 -exec-arguments -v word
30357 ^done
30358 (gdb)
30359 @end smallexample
30360
30361
30362 @ignore
30363 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
30364 @findex -exec-show-arguments
30365
30366 @subsubheading Synopsis
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 -exec-show-arguments
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 Print the arguments of the program.
30373
30374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30375
30376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
30377
30378 @subsubheading Example
30379 N.A.
30380 @end ignore
30381
30382
30383 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
30384 @findex -environment-cd
30385
30386 @subsubheading Synopsis
30387
30388 @smallexample
30389 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
30390 @end smallexample
30391
30392 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
30393
30394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30395
30396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
30397
30398 @subsubheading Example
30399
30400 @smallexample
30401 (gdb)
30402 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30403 ^done
30404 (gdb)
30405 @end smallexample
30406
30407
30408 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
30409 @findex -environment-directory
30410
30411 @subsubheading Synopsis
30412
30413 @smallexample
30414 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30415 @end smallexample
30416
30417 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
30418 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
30419 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
30420 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30421 occurs as normal.
30422 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30423 multiple directories in a single command
30424 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30425 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30426 If blanks are needed as
30427 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30428 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30429 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30430 character must not be used
30431 in any directory name.
30432 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
30433
30434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30435
30436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
30437
30438 @subsubheading Example
30439
30440 @smallexample
30441 (gdb)
30442 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30443 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30444 (gdb)
30445 -environment-directory ""
30446 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30447 (gdb)
30448 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
30449 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
30450 (gdb)
30451 -environment-directory -r
30452 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
30453 (gdb)
30454 @end smallexample
30455
30456
30457 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
30458 @findex -environment-path
30459
30460 @subsubheading Synopsis
30461
30462 @smallexample
30463 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30464 @end smallexample
30465
30466 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
30467 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
30468 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
30469 supplied in addition to the
30470 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30471 occurs as normal.
30472 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30473 multiple directories in a single command
30474 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30475 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30476 If blanks are needed as
30477 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30478 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30479 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30480 character must not be used
30481 in any directory name.
30482 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
30483
30484
30485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30486
30487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
30488
30489 @subsubheading Example
30490
30491 @smallexample
30492 (gdb)
30493 -environment-path
30494 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
30495 (gdb)
30496 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
30497 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
30498 (gdb)
30499 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
30500 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
30501 (gdb)
30502 @end smallexample
30503
30504
30505 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
30506 @findex -environment-pwd
30507
30508 @subsubheading Synopsis
30509
30510 @smallexample
30511 -environment-pwd
30512 @end smallexample
30513
30514 Show the current working directory.
30515
30516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30517
30518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
30519
30520 @subsubheading Example
30521
30522 @smallexample
30523 (gdb)
30524 -environment-pwd
30525 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
30526 (gdb)
30527 @end smallexample
30528
30529 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30530 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
30531 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
30532
30533
30534 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
30535 @findex -thread-info
30536
30537 @subsubheading Synopsis
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
30544 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
30545 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
30546 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
30547 current thread.
30548
30549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30550
30551 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
30552 about all threads.
30553
30554 @subsubheading Result
30555
30556 The result contains the following attributes:
30557
30558 @table @samp
30559 @item threads
30560 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
30561 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
30562
30563 @item current-thread-id
30564 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
30565 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
30566 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
30567 the command.
30568
30569 @end table
30570
30571 @subsubheading Example
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 -thread-info
30575 ^done,threads=[
30576 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
30577 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
30578 args=[]@},state="running"@},
30579 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
30580 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
30581 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
30582 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30583 state="running"@}],
30584 current-thread-id="1"
30585 (gdb)
30586 @end smallexample
30587
30588 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
30589 @findex -thread-list-ids
30590
30591 @subsubheading Synopsis
30592
30593 @smallexample
30594 -thread-list-ids
30595 @end smallexample
30596
30597 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
30598 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
30599 threads.
30600
30601 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
30602 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
30603
30604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30605
30606 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
30607
30608 @subsubheading Example
30609
30610 @smallexample
30611 (gdb)
30612 -thread-list-ids
30613 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30614 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
30615 (gdb)
30616 @end smallexample
30617
30618
30619 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
30620 @findex -thread-select
30621
30622 @subsubheading Synopsis
30623
30624 @smallexample
30625 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
30626 @end smallexample
30627
30628 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
30629 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
30630 topmost frame for that thread.
30631
30632 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
30633 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
30634
30635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30636
30637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
30638
30639 @subsubheading Example
30640
30641 @smallexample
30642 (gdb)
30643 -exec-next
30644 ^running
30645 (gdb)
30646 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
30647 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
30648 (gdb)
30649 -thread-list-ids
30650 ^done,
30651 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30652 number-of-threads="3"
30653 (gdb)
30654 -thread-select 3
30655 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
30656 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
30657 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
30658 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30659 (gdb)
30660 @end smallexample
30661
30662 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30663 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
30664 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
30665
30666 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
30667 @findex -ada-task-info
30668
30669 @subsubheading Synopsis
30670
30671 @smallexample
30672 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
30673 @end smallexample
30674
30675 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
30676 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
30677
30678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30679
30680 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
30681 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
30682
30683 @subsubheading Result
30684
30685 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
30686 defined for each Ada task:
30687
30688 @table @samp
30689 @item current
30690 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
30691
30692 @item id
30693 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
30694
30695 @item task-id
30696 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
30697
30698 @item thread-id
30699 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
30700 task.
30701
30702 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
30703 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
30704 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
30705
30706 @item parent-id
30707 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
30708 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
30709
30710 @item priority
30711 The base priority of the task.
30712
30713 @item state
30714 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
30715 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
30716
30717 @item name
30718 The name of the task.
30719
30720 @end table
30721
30722 @subsubheading Example
30723
30724 @smallexample
30725 -ada-task-info
30726 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
30727 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
30728 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
30729 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
30730 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
30731 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
30732 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
30733 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
30734 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
30735 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
30736 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
30737 (gdb)
30738 @end smallexample
30739
30740 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30741 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
30742 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
30743
30744 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
30745 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
30746 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
30747 other cases.
30748
30749 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
30750 @findex -exec-continue
30751
30752 @subsubheading Synopsis
30753
30754 @smallexample
30755 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
30756 @end smallexample
30757
30758 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
30759 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
30760 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
30761 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
30762 @itemize @bullet
30763 @item
30764 breakpoints or watchpoints
30765 @item
30766 signals or exceptions
30767 @item
30768 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
30769 @item
30770 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
30771 @end itemize
30772 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
30773 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
30774 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
30775 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
30776 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
30777 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
30778
30779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30780
30781 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
30782
30783 @subsubheading Example
30784
30785 @smallexample
30786 -exec-continue
30787 ^running
30788 (gdb)
30789 @@Hello world
30790 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
30791 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
30792 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30793 (gdb)
30794 @end smallexample
30795
30796
30797 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
30798 @findex -exec-finish
30799
30800 @subsubheading Synopsis
30801
30802 @smallexample
30803 -exec-finish [--reverse]
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
30807 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
30808 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
30809 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
30810 function was called.
30811
30812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30813
30814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
30815
30816 @subsubheading Example
30817
30818 Function returning @code{void}.
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 -exec-finish
30822 ^running
30823 (gdb)
30824 @@hello from foo
30825 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30826 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30827 (gdb)
30828 @end smallexample
30829
30830 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30831 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30832 value itself.
30833
30834 @smallexample
30835 -exec-finish
30836 ^running
30837 (gdb)
30838 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30839 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30840 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30841 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30842 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30843 (gdb)
30844 @end smallexample
30845
30846
30847 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30848 @findex -exec-interrupt
30849
30850 @subsubheading Synopsis
30851
30852 @smallexample
30853 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30854 @end smallexample
30855
30856 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30857 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30858 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30859 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30860 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30861
30862 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30863 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30864 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30865 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30866
30867 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30868 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30869 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30870 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30871
30872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30873
30874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30875
30876 @subsubheading Example
30877
30878 @smallexample
30879 (gdb)
30880 111-exec-continue
30881 111^running
30882
30883 (gdb)
30884 222-exec-interrupt
30885 222^done
30886 (gdb)
30887 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30888 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30889 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30890 (gdb)
30891
30892 (gdb)
30893 -exec-interrupt
30894 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30895 (gdb)
30896 @end smallexample
30897
30898 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30899 @findex -exec-jump
30900
30901 @subsubheading Synopsis
30902
30903 @smallexample
30904 -exec-jump @var{location}
30905 @end smallexample
30906
30907 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30908 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30909 different forms of @var{location}.
30910
30911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30912
30913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30914
30915 @subsubheading Example
30916
30917 @smallexample
30918 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30919 *running,thread-id="all"
30920 ^running
30921 @end smallexample
30922
30923
30924 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30925 @findex -exec-next
30926
30927 @subsubheading Synopsis
30928
30929 @smallexample
30930 -exec-next [--reverse]
30931 @end smallexample
30932
30933 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30934 of the next source line is reached.
30935
30936 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30937 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30938 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30939 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30940 source line where the function was called.
30941
30942
30943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30944
30945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30946
30947 @subsubheading Example
30948
30949 @smallexample
30950 -exec-next
30951 ^running
30952 (gdb)
30953 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30954 (gdb)
30955 @end smallexample
30956
30957
30958 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30959 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30960
30961 @subsubheading Synopsis
30962
30963 @smallexample
30964 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30965 @end smallexample
30966
30967 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30968 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30969 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30970 printed as well.
30971
30972 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30973 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30974 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30975 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30976 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30977
30978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30979
30980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30981
30982 @subsubheading Example
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 (gdb)
30986 -exec-next-instruction
30987 ^running
30988
30989 (gdb)
30990 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30991 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30992 (gdb)
30993 @end smallexample
30994
30995
30996 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30997 @findex -exec-return
30998
30999 @subsubheading Synopsis
31000
31001 @smallexample
31002 -exec-return
31003 @end smallexample
31004
31005 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
31006 Displays the new current frame.
31007
31008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31009
31010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
31011
31012 @subsubheading Example
31013
31014 @smallexample
31015 (gdb)
31016 200-break-insert callee4
31017 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
31018 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31019 (gdb)
31020 000-exec-run
31021 000^running
31022 (gdb)
31023 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31024 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
31025 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31026 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31027 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31028 (gdb)
31029 205-break-delete
31030 205^done
31031 (gdb)
31032 111-exec-return
31033 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
31034 args=[@{name="strarg",
31035 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
31036 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31037 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
31038 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31039 (gdb)
31040 @end smallexample
31041
31042
31043 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
31044 @findex -exec-run
31045
31046 @subsubheading Synopsis
31047
31048 @smallexample
31049 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
31050 @end smallexample
31051
31052 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
31053 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
31054 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
31055 the program has exited exceptionally.
31056
31057 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
31058 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
31059 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
31060 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
31061 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
31062
31063 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
31064 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
31065 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
31066 (@pxref{Starting}).
31067
31068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31069
31070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
31071
31072 @subsubheading Examples
31073
31074 @smallexample
31075 (gdb)
31076 -break-insert main
31077 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31078 (gdb)
31079 -exec-run
31080 ^running
31081 (gdb)
31082 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31083 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
31084 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31085 (gdb)
31086 @end smallexample
31087
31088 @noindent
31089 Program exited normally:
31090
31091 @smallexample
31092 (gdb)
31093 -exec-run
31094 ^running
31095 (gdb)
31096 x = 55
31097 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31098 (gdb)
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 @noindent
31102 Program exited exceptionally:
31103
31104 @smallexample
31105 (gdb)
31106 -exec-run
31107 ^running
31108 (gdb)
31109 x = 55
31110 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31111 (gdb)
31112 @end smallexample
31113
31114 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31115 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31116
31117 @smallexample
31118 (gdb)
31119 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31120 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31121 @end smallexample
31122
31123
31124 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31125
31126
31127 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31128 @findex -exec-step
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -exec-step [--reverse]
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31137 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31138 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31139 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31140 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31141 previously executed source line.
31142
31143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31144
31145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31146
31147 @subsubheading Example
31148
31149 Stepping into a function:
31150
31151 @smallexample
31152 -exec-step
31153 ^running
31154 (gdb)
31155 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31156 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
31157 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
31158 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31159 (gdb)
31160 @end smallexample
31161
31162 Regular stepping:
31163
31164 @smallexample
31165 -exec-step
31166 ^running
31167 (gdb)
31168 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
31169 (gdb)
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172
31173 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
31174 @findex -exec-step-instruction
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
31183 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
31184 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
31185 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
31186 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
31187 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
31188 as well.
31189
31190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31191
31192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
31193
31194 @subsubheading Example
31195
31196 @smallexample
31197 (gdb)
31198 -exec-step-instruction
31199 ^running
31200
31201 (gdb)
31202 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31203 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31204 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31205 (gdb)
31206 -exec-step-instruction
31207 ^running
31208
31209 (gdb)
31210 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31211 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31212 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31213 (gdb)
31214 @end smallexample
31215
31216
31217 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
31218 @findex -exec-until
31219
31220 @subsubheading Synopsis
31221
31222 @smallexample
31223 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
31224 @end smallexample
31225
31226 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
31227 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
31228 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
31229 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
31230
31231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31232
31233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
31234
31235 @subsubheading Example
31236
31237 @smallexample
31238 (gdb)
31239 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
31240 ^running
31241 (gdb)
31242 x = 55
31243 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31244 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
31245 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31246 (gdb)
31247 @end smallexample
31248
31249 @ignore
31250 @subheading -file-clear
31251 Is this going away????
31252 @end ignore
31253
31254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31255 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
31256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
31257
31258 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
31259 @findex -enable-frame-filters
31260
31261 @smallexample
31262 -enable-frame-filters
31263 @end smallexample
31264
31265 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
31266 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
31267 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31268 request that this functionality be enabled.
31269
31270 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31271
31272 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31273 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31274
31275 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
31276 @findex -stack-info-frame
31277
31278 @subsubheading Synopsis
31279
31280 @smallexample
31281 -stack-info-frame
31282 @end smallexample
31283
31284 Get info on the selected frame.
31285
31286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31287
31288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
31289 (without arguments).
31290
31291 @subsubheading Example
31292
31293 @smallexample
31294 (gdb)
31295 -stack-info-frame
31296 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31297 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31298 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31299 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31300 (gdb)
31301 @end smallexample
31302
31303 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
31304 @findex -stack-info-depth
31305
31306 @subsubheading Synopsis
31307
31308 @smallexample
31309 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
31310 @end smallexample
31311
31312 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
31313 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
31314
31315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31316
31317 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31318
31319 @subsubheading Example
31320
31321 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 (gdb)
31325 -stack-info-depth
31326 ^done,depth="12"
31327 (gdb)
31328 -stack-info-depth 4
31329 ^done,depth="4"
31330 (gdb)
31331 -stack-info-depth 12
31332 ^done,depth="12"
31333 (gdb)
31334 -stack-info-depth 11
31335 ^done,depth="11"
31336 (gdb)
31337 -stack-info-depth 13
31338 ^done,depth="12"
31339 (gdb)
31340 @end smallexample
31341
31342 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
31343 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
31344 @findex -stack-list-arguments
31345
31346 @subsubheading Synopsis
31347
31348 @smallexample
31349 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31350 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31351 @end smallexample
31352
31353 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
31354 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
31355 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
31356 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
31357 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
31358 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
31359 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
31360 which case only existing frames will be returned.
31361
31362 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31363 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31364 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31365 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31366 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31367 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31368
31369 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
31370 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
31371 are still displayed, however.
31372
31373 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
31374 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31375
31376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31377
31378 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
31379 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
31380 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
31381
31382 @subsubheading Example
31383
31384 @smallexample
31385 (gdb)
31386 -stack-list-frames
31387 ^done,
31388 stack=[
31389 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
31390 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31391 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31392 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31393 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31394 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31395 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31396 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31397 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
31398 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31399 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
31400 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31401 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
31402 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31403 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
31404 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31405 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
31406 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31407 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
31408 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31409 (gdb)
31410 -stack-list-arguments 0
31411 ^done,
31412 stack-args=[
31413 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31414 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
31415 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
31416 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
31417 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31418 (gdb)
31419 -stack-list-arguments 1
31420 ^done,
31421 stack-args=[
31422 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31423 frame=@{level="1",
31424 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31425 frame=@{level="2",args=[
31426 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31427 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31428 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
31429 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31430 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
31431 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
31432 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31433 (gdb)
31434 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
31435 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
31436 (gdb)
31437 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
31438 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
31439 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31440 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
31441 (gdb)
31442 @end smallexample
31443
31444 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
31445
31446
31447 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
31448 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
31449 @findex -stack-list-frames
31450
31451 @subsubheading Synopsis
31452
31453 @smallexample
31454 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31455 @end smallexample
31456
31457 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
31458 following info:
31459
31460 @table @samp
31461 @item @var{level}
31462 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
31463 @item @var{addr}
31464 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
31465 @item @var{func}
31466 Function name.
31467 @item @var{file}
31468 File name of the source file where the function lives.
31469 @item @var{fullname}
31470 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
31471 @item @var{line}
31472 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
31473 @item @var{from}
31474 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
31475 if the frame's function is not known.
31476 @item @var{arch}
31477 Frame's architecture.
31478 @end table
31479
31480 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
31481 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
31482 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
31483 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
31484 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
31485 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
31486 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
31487 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31488 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31489
31490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31491
31492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
31493
31494 @subsubheading Example
31495
31496 Full stack backtrace:
31497
31498 @smallexample
31499 (gdb)
31500 -stack-list-frames
31501 ^done,stack=
31502 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
31503 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
31504 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31505 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31506 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31507 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31508 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31509 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31510 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31511 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31512 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31513 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31514 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31515 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31516 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31517 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31518 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31519 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31520 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31521 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31522 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31523 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31524 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31525 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31526 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31528 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31529 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31530 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31531 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31532 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31533 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31534 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31535 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
31536 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
31537 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31538 (gdb)
31539 @end smallexample
31540
31541 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
31542
31543 @smallexample
31544 (gdb)
31545 -stack-list-frames 3 5
31546 ^done,stack=
31547 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31548 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31549 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31550 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31551 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31552 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31553 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31554 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31555 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31556 (gdb)
31557 @end smallexample
31558
31559 Show a single frame:
31560
31561 @smallexample
31562 (gdb)
31563 -stack-list-frames 3 3
31564 ^done,stack=
31565 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31566 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31567 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31568 (gdb)
31569 @end smallexample
31570
31571
31572 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
31573 @findex -stack-list-locals
31574 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
31575
31576 @subsubheading Synopsis
31577
31578 @smallexample
31579 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31580 @end smallexample
31581
31582 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
31583 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31584 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31585 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31586 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31587 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
31588 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
31589 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
31590 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31591 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31592
31593 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31594 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
31595 variables are still displayed, however.
31596
31597 This command is deprecated in favor of the
31598 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31599
31600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31601
31602 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
31603
31604 @subsubheading Example
31605
31606 @smallexample
31607 (gdb)
31608 -stack-list-locals 0
31609 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
31610 (gdb)
31611 -stack-list-locals --all-values
31612 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
31613 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
31614 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
31615 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
31616 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
31617 (gdb)
31618 @end smallexample
31619
31620 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
31621 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
31622 @findex -stack-list-variables
31623
31624 @subsubheading Synopsis
31625
31626 @smallexample
31627 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
31631 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31632 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31633 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31634 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31635 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31636 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31637
31638 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31639 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
31640 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
31641
31642 @subsubheading Example
31643
31644 @smallexample
31645 (gdb)
31646 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
31647 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
31648 (gdb)
31649 @end smallexample
31650
31651
31652 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
31653 @findex -stack-select-frame
31654
31655 @subsubheading Synopsis
31656
31657 @smallexample
31658 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
31659 @end smallexample
31660
31661 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
31662 the stack.
31663
31664 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
31665 option to every command.
31666
31667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31668
31669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
31670 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
31671
31672 @subsubheading Example
31673
31674 @smallexample
31675 (gdb)
31676 -stack-select-frame 2
31677 ^done
31678 (gdb)
31679 @end smallexample
31680
31681 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31682 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
31683 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
31684
31685 @ignore
31686
31687 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31688
31689 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
31690 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
31691 used by @code{Insight}.
31692
31693 The two main reasons for that are:
31694
31695 @enumerate 1
31696 @item
31697 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
31698
31699 @item
31700 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
31701 now).
31702 @end enumerate
31703
31704 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
31705 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
31706 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
31707 hints about their use.
31708
31709 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
31710 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
31711 least, the following operations:
31712
31713 @itemize @bullet
31714 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
31715 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
31716 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
31717 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
31718 @end itemize
31719
31720 @end ignore
31721
31722 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
31723
31724 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31725
31726 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
31727 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
31728 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
31729 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
31730 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
31731 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
31732 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
31733 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
31734 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
31735 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
31736 object, or to change display format.
31737
31738 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
31739 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
31740 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
31741 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
31742 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
31743 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
31744 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
31745 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
31746 child will be created.
31747
31748 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
31749 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
31750 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
31751 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
31752 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
31753
31754 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
31755 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
31756 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
31757 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
31758 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
31759 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
31760 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
31761 variables that frontend has created.
31762
31763 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
31764 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
31765 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
31766 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
31767 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
31768 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
31769 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
31770 implicitly updated.
31771
31772 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
31773 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
31774 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
31775 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
31776 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
31777 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
31778 frame. Consider this example:
31779
31780 @smallexample
31781 void do_work(...)
31782 @{
31783 struct work_state state;
31784
31785 if (...)
31786 do_work(...);
31787 @}
31788 @end smallexample
31789
31790 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
31791 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
31792 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
31793 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
31794 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
31795
31796 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
31797 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
31798 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
31799 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
31800 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
31801 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
31802
31803 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
31804 access this functionality:
31805
31806 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
31807 @item @strong{Operation}
31808 @tab @strong{Description}
31809
31810 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
31811 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
31812 @item @code{-var-create}
31813 @tab create a variable object
31814 @item @code{-var-delete}
31815 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
31816 @item @code{-var-set-format}
31817 @tab set the display format of this variable
31818 @item @code{-var-show-format}
31819 @tab show the display format of this variable
31820 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31821 @tab tells how many children this object has
31822 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31823 @tab return a list of the object's children
31824 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31825 @tab show the type of this variable object
31826 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31827 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31828 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31829 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31830 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31831 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31832 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31833 @tab get the value of this variable
31834 @item @code{-var-assign}
31835 @tab set the value of this variable
31836 @item @code{-var-update}
31837 @tab update the variable and its children
31838 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31839 @tab set frozeness attribute
31840 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31841 @tab set range of children to display on update
31842 @end multitable
31843
31844 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31845 how it can be used.
31846
31847 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31848
31849 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31850 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31851
31852 @smallexample
31853 -enable-pretty-printing
31854 @end smallexample
31855
31856 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31857 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31858 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31859 request that this functionality be enabled.
31860
31861 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31862
31863 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31864 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31865
31866 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31867 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31868
31869 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31870 @findex -var-create
31871
31872 @subsubheading Synopsis
31873
31874 @smallexample
31875 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31876 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31877 @end smallexample
31878
31879 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31880 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31881 register.
31882
31883 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31884 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31885 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31886 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31887 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31888
31889 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31890 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31891 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31892 object must be created.
31893
31894 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31895 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31896
31897 @itemize @bullet
31898 @item
31899 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31900
31901 @item
31902 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31903
31904 @item
31905 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31906 @end itemize
31907
31908 @cindex dynamic varobj
31909 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31910 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31911 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31912 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31913 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31914 compatibility for existing clients.
31915
31916 @subsubheading Result
31917
31918 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31919 are:
31920
31921 @table @samp
31922 @item name
31923 The name of the varobj.
31924
31925 @item numchild
31926 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31927 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31928 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31929
31930 @item value
31931 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31932 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31933 will not be interesting.
31934
31935 @item type
31936 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31937 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31938 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31939 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31940 @emph{declared} one.
31941
31942 @item thread-id
31943 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31944 thread's global identifier.
31945
31946 @item has_more
31947 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31948 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31949
31950 @item dynamic
31951 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31952 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31953 then this attribute will not be present.
31954
31955 @item displayhint
31956 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31957 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31958 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31959 @end table
31960
31961 Typical output will look like this:
31962
31963 @smallexample
31964 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31965 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31966 @end smallexample
31967
31968
31969 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31970 @findex -var-delete
31971
31972 @subsubheading Synopsis
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31976 @end smallexample
31977
31978 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31979 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31980
31981 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31982
31983
31984 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31985 @findex -var-set-format
31986
31987 @subsubheading Synopsis
31988
31989 @smallexample
31990 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31991 @end smallexample
31992
31993 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31994 @var{format-spec}.
31995
31996 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31997 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31998
31999 @smallexample
32000 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
32001 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
32002 @end smallexample
32003
32004 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
32005 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
32006 for pointers, etc.).
32007
32008 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
32009 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
32010 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
32011 zero-hexadecimal format.
32012
32013 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
32014 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
32015
32016 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
32017 @findex -var-show-format
32018
32019 @subsubheading Synopsis
32020
32021 @smallexample
32022 -var-show-format @var{name}
32023 @end smallexample
32024
32025 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
32026
32027 @smallexample
32028 @var{format} @expansion{}
32029 @var{format-spec}
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032
32033 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
32034 @findex -var-info-num-children
32035
32036 @subsubheading Synopsis
32037
32038 @smallexample
32039 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
32043
32044 @smallexample
32045 numchild=@var{n}
32046 @end smallexample
32047
32048 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
32049 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
32050 be available.
32051
32052
32053 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
32054 @findex -var-list-children
32055
32056 @subsubheading Synopsis
32057
32058 @smallexample
32059 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
32060 @end smallexample
32061 @anchor{-var-list-children}
32062
32063 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
32064 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
32065 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
32066 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
32067 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
32068 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
32069 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
32070 and unions.
32071
32072 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
32073 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
32074 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
32075 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
32076 reported.
32077
32078 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
32079 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
32080 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
32081 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
32082 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
32083 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
32084 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
32085 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
32086 the visible items.
32087
32088 For each child the following results are returned:
32089
32090 @table @var
32091
32092 @item name
32093 Name of the variable object created for this child.
32094
32095 @item exp
32096 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
32097 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
32098
32099 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
32100 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
32101
32102 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
32103 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
32104 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
32105 type and value are not present.
32106
32107 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
32108 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
32109 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
32110
32111 @item numchild
32112 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
32113 0.
32114
32115 @item type
32116 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
32117 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32118 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32119 @emph{declared} one.
32120
32121 @item value
32122 If values were requested, this is the value.
32123
32124 @item thread-id
32125 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
32126 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
32127
32128 @item frozen
32129 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
32130
32131 @item displayhint
32132 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32133 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32134 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32135
32136 @item dynamic
32137 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32138 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32139 then this attribute will not be present.
32140
32141 @end table
32142
32143 The result may have its own attributes:
32144
32145 @table @samp
32146 @item displayhint
32147 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32148 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32149 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32150
32151 @item has_more
32152 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
32153 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32154 @end table
32155
32156 @subsubheading Example
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 (gdb)
32160 -var-list-children n
32161 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32162 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32163 (gdb)
32164 -var-list-children --all-values n
32165 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32166 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32167 @end smallexample
32168
32169
32170 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
32171 @findex -var-info-type
32172
32173 @subsubheading Synopsis
32174
32175 @smallexample
32176 -var-info-type @var{name}
32177 @end smallexample
32178
32179 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
32180 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
32181 @value{GDBN} CLI:
32182
32183 @smallexample
32184 type=@var{typename}
32185 @end smallexample
32186
32187
32188 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
32189 @findex -var-info-expression
32190
32191 @subsubheading Synopsis
32192
32193 @smallexample
32194 -var-info-expression @var{name}
32195 @end smallexample
32196
32197 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
32198 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
32199 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
32200
32201 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
32202 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
32203
32204 @smallexample
32205 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
32206 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
32207 @end smallexample
32208
32209 @noindent
32210 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
32211 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
32212
32213 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
32214 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
32215 is of limited use.
32216
32217 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
32218 @findex -var-info-path-expression
32219
32220 @subsubheading Synopsis
32221
32222 @smallexample
32223 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
32224 @end smallexample
32225
32226 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
32227 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
32228 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
32229 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
32230 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
32231 watchpoint from a variable object.
32232
32233 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
32234 and will give an error when invoked on one.
32235
32236 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
32237 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
32238 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
32239 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
32240 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
32241 @smallexample
32242 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
32243 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
32244 @end smallexample
32245
32246 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
32247 @findex -var-show-attributes
32248
32249 @subsubheading Synopsis
32250
32251 @smallexample
32252 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
32253 @end smallexample
32254
32255 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261 @noindent
32262 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
32263
32264 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
32265 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
32266
32267 @subsubheading Synopsis
32268
32269 @smallexample
32270 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
32271 @end smallexample
32272
32273 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
32274 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
32275 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
32276 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
32277 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
32278 the current display format will be used. The current display format
32279 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
32280
32281 @smallexample
32282 value=@var{value}
32283 @end smallexample
32284
32285 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
32286 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
32287
32288 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
32289 @findex -var-assign
32290
32291 @subsubheading Synopsis
32292
32293 @smallexample
32294 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
32298 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
32299 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
32300 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
32301
32302 @subsubheading Example
32303
32304 @smallexample
32305 (gdb)
32306 -var-assign var1 3
32307 ^done,value="3"
32308 (gdb)
32309 -var-update *
32310 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
32311 (gdb)
32312 @end smallexample
32313
32314 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
32315 @findex -var-update
32316
32317 @subsubheading Synopsis
32318
32319 @smallexample
32320 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
32321 @end smallexample
32322
32323 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
32324 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
32325 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
32326 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
32327 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
32328 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
32329 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
32330 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
32331 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
32332 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
32333 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
32334 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
32335 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
32336
32337 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
32338 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
32339 diagnostic.
32340
32341 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
32342 only the selected range of children will be reported.
32343
32344 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
32345 @samp{changelist}.
32346
32347 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
32348
32349 @table @samp
32350 @item name
32351 The name of the varobj.
32352
32353 @item value
32354 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
32355 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
32356
32357 @item in_scope
32358 @anchor{-var-update}
32359 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
32360
32361 @table @code
32362 @item "true"
32363 The variable object's current value is valid.
32364
32365 @item "false"
32366 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
32367 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
32368 scope.
32369
32370 @item "invalid"
32371 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
32372 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
32373 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
32374 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
32375 objects.
32376 @end table
32377
32378 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
32379 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
32380
32381 @item type_changed
32382 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
32383 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
32384 be @samp{false}.
32385
32386 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
32387 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
32388 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
32389 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
32390 unset.
32391
32392 @item new_type
32393 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
32394 hold the new type.
32395
32396 @item new_num_children
32397 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
32398 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
32399
32400 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
32401 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
32402 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
32403 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
32404 children which may be available.
32405
32406 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
32407 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
32408 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
32409 only happen at the end of the update range).
32410
32411 @item displayhint
32412 The display hint, if any.
32413
32414 @item has_more
32415 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
32416 available outside the varobj's update range.
32417
32418 @item dynamic
32419 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32420 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32421 then this attribute will not be present.
32422
32423 @item new_children
32424 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
32425 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
32426 be listed in this attribute.
32427 @end table
32428
32429 @subsubheading Example
32430
32431 @smallexample
32432 (gdb)
32433 -var-assign var1 3
32434 ^done,value="3"
32435 (gdb)
32436 -var-update --all-values var1
32437 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
32438 type_changed="false"@}]
32439 (gdb)
32440 @end smallexample
32441
32442 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
32443 @findex -var-set-frozen
32444 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
32445
32446 @subsubheading Synopsis
32447
32448 @smallexample
32449 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
32450 @end smallexample
32451
32452 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
32453 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
32454 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
32455 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
32456 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
32457 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
32458 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
32459 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
32460 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
32461 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
32462 @code{-var-update} does.
32463
32464 @subsubheading Example
32465
32466 @smallexample
32467 (gdb)
32468 -var-set-frozen V 1
32469 ^done
32470 (gdb)
32471 @end smallexample
32472
32473 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
32474 @findex -var-set-update-range
32475 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
32476
32477 @subsubheading Synopsis
32478
32479 @smallexample
32480 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
32481 @end smallexample
32482
32483 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
32484 @code{-var-update}.
32485
32486 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
32487 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
32488 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
32489 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
32490
32491 @subsubheading Example
32492
32493 @smallexample
32494 (gdb)
32495 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
32496 ^done
32497 @end smallexample
32498
32499 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
32500 @findex -var-set-visualizer
32501 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
32502
32503 @subsubheading Synopsis
32504
32505 @smallexample
32506 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
32507 @end smallexample
32508
32509 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
32510
32511 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
32512 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
32513
32514 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
32515 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
32516 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
32517 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
32518 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
32519 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
32520 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
32521
32522 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
32523 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
32524 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
32525 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
32526
32527 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
32528 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
32529 can be used to check this.
32530
32531 @subsubheading Example
32532
32533 Resetting the visualizer:
32534
32535 @smallexample
32536 (gdb)
32537 -var-set-visualizer V None
32538 ^done
32539 @end smallexample
32540
32541 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
32542
32543 @smallexample
32544 (gdb)
32545 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
32546 ^done
32547 @end smallexample
32548
32549 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
32550 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
32551
32552 @smallexample
32553 (gdb)
32554 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
32555 ^done
32556 @end smallexample
32557
32558 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32559 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
32560 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
32561
32562 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
32563 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
32564 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
32565 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
32566
32567 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
32568 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
32569
32570 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
32571 @c @subheading -data-assign
32572 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
32573 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
32574 @c set variable
32575 @c @subsubheading Example
32576 @c N.A.
32577
32578 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
32579 @findex -data-disassemble
32580
32581 @subsubheading Synopsis
32582
32583 @smallexample
32584 -data-disassemble
32585 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
32586 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
32587 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
32588 -- @var{mode}
32589 @end smallexample
32590
32591 @noindent
32592 Where:
32593
32594 @table @samp
32595 @item @var{start-addr}
32596 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
32597 @item @var{end-addr}
32598 is the end address
32599 @item @var{addr}
32600 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
32601 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
32602 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
32603 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
32604 @item @var{filename}
32605 is the name of the file to disassemble
32606 @item @var{linenum}
32607 is the line number to disassemble around
32608 @item @var{lines}
32609 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
32610 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
32611 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
32612 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
32613 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
32614 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
32615 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
32616 are displayed.
32617 @item @var{mode}
32618 is one of:
32619 @itemize @bullet
32620 @item 0 disassembly only
32621 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
32622 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
32623 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
32624 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
32625 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
32626 @end itemize
32627
32628 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
32629 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
32630 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
32631 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
32632 @end table
32633
32634 @subsubheading Result
32635
32636 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
32637 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
32638 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
32639
32640 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
32641 following fields:
32642
32643 @table @code
32644 @item address
32645 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
32646
32647 @item func-name
32648 The name of the function this instruction is within.
32649
32650 @item offset
32651 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
32652
32653 @item inst
32654 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
32655
32656 @item opcodes
32657 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
32658 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
32659
32660 @end table
32661
32662 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
32663 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
32664
32665 @table @code
32666 @item line
32667 The line number within @samp{file}.
32668
32669 @item file
32670 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
32671 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
32672 used.
32673
32674 @item fullname
32675 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
32676 using the source file search path
32677 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
32678 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
32679
32680 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
32681 present in the debug information.
32682
32683 @item line_asm_insn
32684 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
32685 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
32686 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
32687 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
32688 @samp{opcodes}.
32689
32690 @end table
32691
32692 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
32693 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
32694 adjust its format.
32695
32696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32697
32698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
32699
32700 @subsubheading Example
32701
32702 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
32703
32704 @smallexample
32705 (gdb)
32706 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
32707 ^done,
32708 asm_insns=[
32709 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32710 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32711 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32712 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32713 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
32714 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
32715 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
32716 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32717 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
32718 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
32719 (gdb)
32720 @end smallexample
32721
32722 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
32723 @code{main}.
32724
32725 @smallexample
32726 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
32727 ^done,asm_insns=[
32728 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32729 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32730 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32731 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32732 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32733 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32734 [@dots{}]
32735 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
32736 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
32737 (gdb)
32738 @end smallexample
32739
32740 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
32741
32742 @smallexample
32743 (gdb)
32744 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
32745 ^done,asm_insns=[
32746 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32747 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32748 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32749 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32750 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32751 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
32752 (gdb)
32753 @end smallexample
32754
32755 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
32756
32757 @smallexample
32758 (gdb)
32759 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
32760 ^done,asm_insns=[
32761 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
32762 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32763 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32764 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
32765 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
32766 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
32767 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32768 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32769 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
32770 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32771 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32772 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
32773 (gdb)
32774 @end smallexample
32775
32776
32777 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
32778 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
32779
32780 @subsubheading Synopsis
32781
32782 @smallexample
32783 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
32784 @end smallexample
32785
32786 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
32787 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
32788 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
32789
32790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32791
32792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
32793 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
32794 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
32795
32796 @subsubheading Example
32797
32798 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
32799 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
32800 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
32801 output.
32802
32803 @smallexample
32804 211-data-evaluate-expression A
32805 211^done,value="1"
32806 (gdb)
32807 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
32808 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
32809 (gdb)
32810 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
32811 411^done,value="4"
32812 (gdb)
32813 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
32814 511^done,value="4"
32815 (gdb)
32816 @end smallexample
32817
32818
32819 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32820 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32821
32822 @subsubheading Synopsis
32823
32824 @smallexample
32825 -data-list-changed-registers
32826 @end smallexample
32827
32828 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32829
32830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32831
32832 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32833 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32834
32835 @subsubheading Example
32836
32837 On a PPC MBX board:
32838
32839 @smallexample
32840 (gdb)
32841 -exec-continue
32842 ^running
32843
32844 (gdb)
32845 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32846 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32847 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32848 (gdb)
32849 -data-list-changed-registers
32850 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32851 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32852 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32853 (gdb)
32854 @end smallexample
32855
32856
32857 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32858 @findex -data-list-register-names
32859
32860 @subsubheading Synopsis
32861
32862 @smallexample
32863 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32864 @end smallexample
32865
32866 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32867 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32868 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32869 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32870 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32871 include empty register names.
32872
32873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32874
32875 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32876 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32877 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32878
32879 @subsubheading Example
32880
32881 For the PPC MBX board:
32882 @smallexample
32883 (gdb)
32884 -data-list-register-names
32885 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32886 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32887 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32888 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32889 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32890 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32891 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32892 (gdb)
32893 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32894 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32895 (gdb)
32896 @end smallexample
32897
32898 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32899 @findex -data-list-register-values
32900
32901 @subsubheading Synopsis
32902
32903 @smallexample
32904 -data-list-register-values
32905 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32906 @end smallexample
32907
32908 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32909 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32910 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32911 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32912 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32913 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32914
32915 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32916
32917 @table @code
32918 @item x
32919 Hexadecimal
32920 @item o
32921 Octal
32922 @item t
32923 Binary
32924 @item d
32925 Decimal
32926 @item r
32927 Raw
32928 @item N
32929 Natural
32930 @end table
32931
32932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32933
32934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32935 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32936
32937 @subsubheading Example
32938
32939 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32940 don't appear in the actual output):
32941
32942 @smallexample
32943 (gdb)
32944 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32945 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32946 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32947 (gdb)
32948 -data-list-register-values x
32949 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32950 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32951 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32952 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32953 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32954 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32955 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32956 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32957 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32958 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32959 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32960 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32961 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32962 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32963 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32964 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32965 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32966 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32967 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32968 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32969 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32970 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32971 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32972 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32973 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32974 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32975 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32976 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32977 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32978 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32979 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32980 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32981 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32982 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32983 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32984 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32985 (gdb)
32986 @end smallexample
32987
32988
32989 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32990 @findex -data-read-memory
32991
32992 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32993
32994 @subsubheading Synopsis
32995
32996 @smallexample
32997 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32998 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32999 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
33000 @end smallexample
33001
33002 @noindent
33003 where:
33004
33005 @table @samp
33006 @item @var{address}
33007 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33008 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33009 quoted using the C convention.
33010
33011 @item @var{word-format}
33012 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
33013 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
33014 ,Output Formats}).
33015
33016 @item @var{word-size}
33017 The size of each memory word in bytes.
33018
33019 @item @var{nr-rows}
33020 The number of rows in the output table.
33021
33022 @item @var{nr-cols}
33023 The number of columns in the output table.
33024
33025 @item @var{aschar}
33026 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
33027 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
33028 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
33029 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
33030
33031 @item @var{byte-offset}
33032 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
33033 @end table
33034
33035 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
33036 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
33037 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
33038 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
33039 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
33040 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
33041 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
33042 @samp{addr}.
33043
33044 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
33045 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
33046 @samp{prev-page}.
33047
33048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33049
33050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
33051 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
33052
33053 @subsubheading Example
33054
33055 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
33056 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
33057 word. Display each word in hex.
33058
33059 @smallexample
33060 (gdb)
33061 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
33062 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
33063 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
33064 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
33065 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
33066 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
33067 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
33068 (gdb)
33069 @end smallexample
33070
33071 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
33072 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
33073
33074 @smallexample
33075 (gdb)
33076 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
33077 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
33078 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
33079 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
33080 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
33081 (gdb)
33082 @end smallexample
33083
33084 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
33085 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
33086 used as the non-printable character.
33087
33088 @smallexample
33089 (gdb)
33090 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
33091 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
33092 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
33093 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
33094 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33095 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33096 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33097 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33098 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
33099 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
33100 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
33101 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
33102 (gdb)
33103 @end smallexample
33104
33105 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
33106 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
33107
33108 @subsubheading Synopsis
33109
33110 @smallexample
33111 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
33112 @var{address} @var{count}
33113 @end smallexample
33114
33115 @noindent
33116 where:
33117
33118 @table @samp
33119 @item @var{address}
33120 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33121 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33122 quoted using the C convention.
33123
33124 @item @var{count}
33125 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
33126 literal.
33127
33128 @item @var{offset}
33129 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
33130 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
33131 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
33132 arithmetics itself.
33133
33134 @end table
33135
33136 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
33137 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
33138 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
33139 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
33140 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
33141 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
33142
33143 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
33144 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
33145 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
33146 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
33147 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
33148 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
33149 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
33150 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
33151
33152 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
33153 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
33154 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
33155 and has the following fields:
33156
33157 @table @code
33158 @item begin
33159 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33160
33161 @item end
33162 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33163
33164 @item offset
33165 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
33166 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
33167
33168 @item contents
33169 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
33170
33171 @end table
33172
33173
33174
33175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33176
33177 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
33178
33179 @subsubheading Example
33180
33181 @smallexample
33182 (gdb)
33183 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
33184 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
33185 end="0xbffff15e",
33186 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
33187 (gdb)
33188 @end smallexample
33189
33190
33191 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
33192 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
33193
33194 @subsubheading Synopsis
33195
33196 @smallexample
33197 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
33198 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
33199 @end smallexample
33200
33201 @noindent
33202 where:
33203
33204 @table @samp
33205 @item @var{address}
33206 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33207 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
33208 be quoted using the C convention.
33209
33210 @item @var{contents}
33211 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
33212 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
33213
33214 @item @var{count}
33215 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
33216 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
33217 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
33218 @var{count} memory units.
33219
33220 @end table
33221
33222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33223
33224 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33225
33226 @subsubheading Example
33227
33228 @smallexample
33229 (gdb)
33230 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
33231 ^done
33232 (gdb)
33233 @end smallexample
33234
33235 @smallexample
33236 (gdb)
33237 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
33238 ^done
33239 (gdb)
33240 @end smallexample
33241
33242 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33243 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
33244 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
33245
33246 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
33247 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
33248
33249 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
33250 @findex -trace-find
33251
33252 @subsubheading Synopsis
33253
33254 @smallexample
33255 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
33256 @end smallexample
33257
33258 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
33259 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
33260 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
33261
33262 @table @samp
33263
33264 @item none
33265 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
33266
33267 @item frame-number
33268 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
33269 that index.
33270
33271 @item tracepoint-number
33272 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
33273 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
33274
33275 @item pc
33276 An address is required as parameter. Finds
33277 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
33278 address.
33279
33280 @item pc-inside-range
33281 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
33282 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
33283 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33284
33285 @item pc-outside-range
33286 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
33287 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
33288 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33289
33290 @item line
33291 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
33292 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
33293 the specified location.
33294
33295 @end table
33296
33297 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
33298 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
33299
33300 @table @samp
33301 @item found
33302 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
33303 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
33304
33305 @item traceframe
33306 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
33307 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33308
33309 @item tracepoint
33310 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
33311 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33312
33313 @item frame
33314 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
33315 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
33316 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
33317
33318 @end table
33319
33320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33321
33322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
33323
33324 @subheading -trace-define-variable
33325 @findex -trace-define-variable
33326
33327 @subsubheading Synopsis
33328
33329 @smallexample
33330 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
33331 @end smallexample
33332
33333 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
33334 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
33335 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
33336 with the @samp{$} character.
33337
33338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33339
33340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
33341
33342 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
33343 @findex -trace-frame-collected
33344
33345 @subsubheading Synopsis
33346
33347 @smallexample
33348 -trace-frame-collected
33349 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
33350 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
33351 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
33352 [--memory-contents]
33353 @end smallexample
33354
33355 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
33356 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
33357 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
33358 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
33359 See the output description table below for more details.
33360
33361 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
33362 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
33363 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
33364 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
33365 memory range and which is a computed expression.
33366
33367 For instance, if the actions were
33368 @smallexample
33369 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
33370 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
33371 @end smallexample
33372
33373 @noindent
33374 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
33375 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
33376 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
33377 objects would be computed expressions.
33378
33379 An example output would be:
33380
33381 @smallexample
33382 (gdb)
33383 -trace-frame-collected
33384 ^done,
33385 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
33386 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
33387 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
33388 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
33389 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
33390 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
33391 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
33392 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
33393 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
33394 ...
33395 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
33396 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
33397 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
33398 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
33399 (gdb)
33400 @end smallexample
33401
33402 Where:
33403
33404 @table @code
33405 @item explicit-variables
33406 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
33407 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
33408 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
33409 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
33410 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
33411 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
33412 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
33413 arrays, structures and unions.
33414
33415 @item computed-expressions
33416 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
33417 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
33418 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
33419 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
33420
33421 @item registers
33422 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
33423 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
33424 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
33425 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
33426 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
33427
33428 @item tvars
33429 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
33430 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
33431 current value are returned.
33432
33433 @item memory
33434 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
33435 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
33436 collected memory range and has the following fields:
33437
33438 @table @code
33439 @item address
33440 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
33441
33442 @item length
33443 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
33444
33445 @item contents
33446 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
33447 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
33448
33449 @end table
33450
33451 @end table
33452
33453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33454
33455 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33456
33457 @subsubheading Example
33458
33459 @subheading -trace-list-variables
33460 @findex -trace-list-variables
33461
33462 @subsubheading Synopsis
33463
33464 @smallexample
33465 -trace-list-variables
33466 @end smallexample
33467
33468 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
33469 table has the following fields:
33470
33471 @table @samp
33472 @item name
33473 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
33474
33475 @item initial
33476 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
33477 field is always present.
33478
33479 @item current
33480 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
33481 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
33482 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
33483 presently running.
33484
33485 @end table
33486
33487 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33488
33489 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
33490
33491 @subsubheading Example
33492
33493 @smallexample
33494 (gdb)
33495 -trace-list-variables
33496 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
33497 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33498 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
33499 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
33500 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
33501 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
33502 (gdb)
33503 @end smallexample
33504
33505 @subheading -trace-save
33506 @findex -trace-save
33507
33508 @subsubheading Synopsis
33509
33510 @smallexample
33511 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
33512 @end smallexample
33513
33514 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
33515 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
33516 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
33517 to perform the save.
33518
33519 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
33520 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
33521 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
33522
33523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33524
33525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
33526
33527
33528 @subheading -trace-start
33529 @findex -trace-start
33530
33531 @subsubheading Synopsis
33532
33533 @smallexample
33534 -trace-start
33535 @end smallexample
33536
33537 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
33538 have any fields.
33539
33540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33541
33542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
33543
33544 @subheading -trace-status
33545 @findex -trace-status
33546
33547 @subsubheading Synopsis
33548
33549 @smallexample
33550 -trace-status
33551 @end smallexample
33552
33553 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
33554 the following fields:
33555
33556 @table @samp
33557
33558 @item supported
33559 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
33560 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
33561 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
33562 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
33563 started. This field is always present.
33564
33565 @item running
33566 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
33567 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
33568 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33569
33570 @item stop-reason
33571 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
33572 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
33573 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
33574 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
33575 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
33576 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
33577 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
33578 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
33579 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33580
33581 @item stopping-tracepoint
33582 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
33583 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
33584 @samp{passcount}.
33585
33586 @item frames
33587 @itemx frames-created
33588 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
33589 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
33590 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
33591 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
33592
33593 @item buffer-size
33594 @itemx buffer-free
33595 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
33596 remaining space. These fields are optional.
33597
33598 @item circular
33599 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33600 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33601 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33602 and may fill up.
33603
33604 @item disconnected
33605 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33606 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33607 that the trace run will stop.
33608
33609 @item trace-file
33610 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
33611 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
33612
33613 @end table
33614
33615 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33616
33617 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
33618
33619 @subheading -trace-stop
33620 @findex -trace-stop
33621
33622 @subsubheading Synopsis
33623
33624 @smallexample
33625 -trace-stop
33626 @end smallexample
33627
33628 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
33629 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
33630 @samp{running} fields are not output.
33631
33632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33633
33634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
33635
33636
33637 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33638 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
33639 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
33640
33641
33642 @ignore
33643 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
33644 @findex -symbol-info-address
33645
33646 @subsubheading Synopsis
33647
33648 @smallexample
33649 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
33650 @end smallexample
33651
33652 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
33653
33654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33655
33656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
33657
33658 @subsubheading Example
33659 N.A.
33660
33661
33662 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
33663 @findex -symbol-info-file
33664
33665 @subsubheading Synopsis
33666
33667 @smallexample
33668 -symbol-info-file
33669 @end smallexample
33670
33671 Show the file for the symbol.
33672
33673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33674
33675 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
33676 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
33677
33678 @subsubheading Example
33679 N.A.
33680
33681
33682 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
33683 @findex -symbol-info-function
33684
33685 @subsubheading Synopsis
33686
33687 @smallexample
33688 -symbol-info-function
33689 @end smallexample
33690
33691 Show which function the symbol lives in.
33692
33693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33694
33695 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
33696
33697 @subsubheading Example
33698 N.A.
33699
33700
33701 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
33702 @findex -symbol-info-line
33703
33704 @subsubheading Synopsis
33705
33706 @smallexample
33707 -symbol-info-line
33708 @end smallexample
33709
33710 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
33711
33712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33713
33714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
33715 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
33716
33717 @subsubheading Example
33718 N.A.
33719
33720
33721 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
33722 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
33723
33724 @subsubheading Synopsis
33725
33726 @smallexample
33727 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
33728 @end smallexample
33729
33730 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
33731
33732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33733
33734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
33735
33736 @subsubheading Example
33737 N.A.
33738
33739
33740 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
33741 @findex -symbol-list-functions
33742
33743 @subsubheading Synopsis
33744
33745 @smallexample
33746 -symbol-list-functions
33747 @end smallexample
33748
33749 List the functions in the executable.
33750
33751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33752
33753 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
33754 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33755
33756 @subsubheading Example
33757 N.A.
33758 @end ignore
33759
33760
33761 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
33762 @findex -symbol-list-lines
33763
33764 @subsubheading Synopsis
33765
33766 @smallexample
33767 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
33768 @end smallexample
33769
33770 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
33771 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
33772 ascending PC order.
33773
33774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33775
33776 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33777
33778 @subsubheading Example
33779 @smallexample
33780 (gdb)
33781 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
33782 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
33783 (gdb)
33784 @end smallexample
33785
33786
33787 @ignore
33788 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
33789 @findex -symbol-list-types
33790
33791 @subsubheading Synopsis
33792
33793 @smallexample
33794 -symbol-list-types
33795 @end smallexample
33796
33797 List all the type names.
33798
33799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33800
33801 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
33802 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33803
33804 @subsubheading Example
33805 N.A.
33806
33807
33808 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
33809 @findex -symbol-list-variables
33810
33811 @subsubheading Synopsis
33812
33813 @smallexample
33814 -symbol-list-variables
33815 @end smallexample
33816
33817 List all the global and static variable names.
33818
33819 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33820
33821 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33822
33823 @subsubheading Example
33824 N.A.
33825
33826
33827 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33828 @findex -symbol-locate
33829
33830 @subsubheading Synopsis
33831
33832 @smallexample
33833 -symbol-locate
33834 @end smallexample
33835
33836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33837
33838 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33839
33840 @subsubheading Example
33841 N.A.
33842
33843
33844 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33845 @findex -symbol-type
33846
33847 @subsubheading Synopsis
33848
33849 @smallexample
33850 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33851 @end smallexample
33852
33853 Show type of @var{variable}.
33854
33855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33856
33857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33858 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33859
33860 @subsubheading Example
33861 N.A.
33862 @end ignore
33863
33864
33865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33866 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33867 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33868
33869 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33870 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33871
33872 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33873 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33874
33875 @subsubheading Synopsis
33876
33877 @smallexample
33878 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33879 @end smallexample
33880
33881 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33882 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33883 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33884 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33885 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33886 notification.
33887
33888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33889
33890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33891
33892 @subsubheading Example
33893
33894 @smallexample
33895 (gdb)
33896 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33897 ^done
33898 (gdb)
33899 @end smallexample
33900
33901
33902 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33903 @findex -file-exec-file
33904
33905 @subsubheading Synopsis
33906
33907 @smallexample
33908 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33909 @end smallexample
33910
33911 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33912 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33913 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33914 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33915 notification.
33916
33917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33918
33919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33920
33921 @subsubheading Example
33922
33923 @smallexample
33924 (gdb)
33925 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33926 ^done
33927 (gdb)
33928 @end smallexample
33929
33930
33931 @ignore
33932 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33933 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33934
33935 @subsubheading Synopsis
33936
33937 @smallexample
33938 -file-list-exec-sections
33939 @end smallexample
33940
33941 List the sections of the current executable file.
33942
33943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33944
33945 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33946 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33947 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33948
33949 @subsubheading Example
33950 N.A.
33951 @end ignore
33952
33953
33954 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33955 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33956
33957 @subsubheading Synopsis
33958
33959 @smallexample
33960 -file-list-exec-source-file
33961 @end smallexample
33962
33963 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33964 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33965 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33966 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33967
33968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33969
33970 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33971
33972 @subsubheading Example
33973
33974 @smallexample
33975 (gdb)
33976 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33977 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33978 (gdb)
33979 @end smallexample
33980
33981
33982 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33983 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33984
33985 @subsubheading Synopsis
33986
33987 @smallexample
33988 -file-list-exec-source-files
33989 @end smallexample
33990
33991 List the source files for the current executable.
33992
33993 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33994 name) of a source file.
33995
33996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33997
33998 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33999 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
34000
34001 @subsubheading Example
34002 @smallexample
34003 (gdb)
34004 -file-list-exec-source-files
34005 ^done,files=[
34006 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
34007 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
34008 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
34009 (gdb)
34010 @end smallexample
34011
34012 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
34013 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
34014
34015 @subsubheading Synopsis
34016
34017 @smallexample
34018 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
34019 @end smallexample
34020
34021 List the shared libraries in the program.
34022 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
34023 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34024
34025 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34026
34027 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
34028 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
34029 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
34030 library. Each range has the following fields:
34031
34032 @table @samp
34033 @item from
34034 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
34035 @item to
34036 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
34037 @end table
34038
34039 @subsubheading Example
34040 @smallexample
34041 (gdb)
34042 -file-list-exec-source-files
34043 ^done,shared-libraries=[
34044 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
34045 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
34046 (gdb)
34047 @end smallexample
34048
34049
34050 @ignore
34051 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
34052 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
34053
34054 @subsubheading Synopsis
34055
34056 @smallexample
34057 -file-list-symbol-files
34058 @end smallexample
34059
34060 List symbol files.
34061
34062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34063
34064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
34065
34066 @subsubheading Example
34067 N.A.
34068 @end ignore
34069
34070
34071 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
34072 @findex -file-symbol-file
34073
34074 @subsubheading Synopsis
34075
34076 @smallexample
34077 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
34078 @end smallexample
34079
34080 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
34081 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
34082 produced, except for a completion notification.
34083
34084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34085
34086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
34087
34088 @subsubheading Example
34089
34090 @smallexample
34091 (gdb)
34092 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34093 ^done
34094 (gdb)
34095 @end smallexample
34096
34097 @ignore
34098 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34099 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
34100 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
34101
34102 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
34103
34104 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
34105
34106 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
34107
34108 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
34109
34110 @c @subheading -overlay-map
34111
34112 @c @subheading -overlay-off
34113
34114 @c @subheading -overlay-on
34115
34116 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
34117
34118 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34119 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
34120 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
34121
34122 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
34123
34124 @c @subheading -signal-handle
34125
34126 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
34127
34128 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
34129 @end ignore
34130
34131
34132 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34133 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
34134 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
34135
34136
34137 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
34138 @findex -target-attach
34139
34140 @subsubheading Synopsis
34141
34142 @smallexample
34143 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
34144 @end smallexample
34145
34146 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
34147 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
34148 group, the id previously returned by
34149 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
34150
34151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34152
34153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
34154
34155 @subsubheading Example
34156 @smallexample
34157 (gdb)
34158 -target-attach 34
34159 =thread-created,id="1"
34160 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
34161 ^done
34162 (gdb)
34163 @end smallexample
34164
34165 @ignore
34166 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
34167 @findex -target-compare-sections
34168
34169 @subsubheading Synopsis
34170
34171 @smallexample
34172 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
34173 @end smallexample
34174
34175 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
34176 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
34177
34178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34179
34180 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
34181
34182 @subsubheading Example
34183 N.A.
34184 @end ignore
34185
34186
34187 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
34188 @findex -target-detach
34189
34190 @subsubheading Synopsis
34191
34192 @smallexample
34193 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
34194 @end smallexample
34195
34196 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
34197 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
34198 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
34199
34200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34201
34202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
34203
34204 @subsubheading Example
34205
34206 @smallexample
34207 (gdb)
34208 -target-detach
34209 ^done
34210 (gdb)
34211 @end smallexample
34212
34213
34214 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
34215 @findex -target-disconnect
34216
34217 @subsubheading Synopsis
34218
34219 @smallexample
34220 -target-disconnect
34221 @end smallexample
34222
34223 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
34224 generally not resumed.
34225
34226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34227
34228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
34229
34230 @subsubheading Example
34231
34232 @smallexample
34233 (gdb)
34234 -target-disconnect
34235 ^done
34236 (gdb)
34237 @end smallexample
34238
34239
34240 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
34241 @findex -target-download
34242
34243 @subsubheading Synopsis
34244
34245 @smallexample
34246 -target-download
34247 @end smallexample
34248
34249 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
34250 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
34251
34252 @table @samp
34253 @item section
34254 The name of the section.
34255 @item section-sent
34256 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
34257 @item section-size
34258 The size of the section.
34259 @item total-sent
34260 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
34261 @item total-size
34262 The size of the overall executable to download.
34263 @end table
34264
34265 @noindent
34266 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
34267 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
34268
34269 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
34270 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
34271
34272 @table @samp
34273 @item section
34274 The name of the section.
34275 @item section-size
34276 The size of the section.
34277 @item total-size
34278 The size of the overall executable to download.
34279 @end table
34280
34281 @noindent
34282 At the end, a summary is printed.
34283
34284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34285
34286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
34287
34288 @subsubheading Example
34289
34290 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
34291 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
34292
34293 @smallexample
34294 (gdb)
34295 -target-download
34296 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
34297 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
34298 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
34299 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
34300 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
34301 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
34302 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
34303 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
34304 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
34305 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
34306 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
34307 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
34308 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
34309 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
34310 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
34311 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
34312 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
34313 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
34314 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
34315 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
34316 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
34317 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
34318 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
34319 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
34320 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
34321 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
34322 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
34323 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34324 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34325 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
34326 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
34327 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
34328 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
34329 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
34330 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
34331 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
34332 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
34333 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
34334 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
34335 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
34336 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
34337 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
34338 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
34339 write-rate="429"
34340 (gdb)
34341 @end smallexample
34342
34343
34344 @ignore
34345 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
34346 @findex -target-exec-status
34347
34348 @subsubheading Synopsis
34349
34350 @smallexample
34351 -target-exec-status
34352 @end smallexample
34353
34354 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
34355 not, for instance).
34356
34357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34358
34359 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
34360
34361 @subsubheading Example
34362 N.A.
34363
34364
34365 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
34366 @findex -target-list-available-targets
34367
34368 @subsubheading Synopsis
34369
34370 @smallexample
34371 -target-list-available-targets
34372 @end smallexample
34373
34374 List the possible targets to connect to.
34375
34376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34377
34378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
34379
34380 @subsubheading Example
34381 N.A.
34382
34383
34384 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
34385 @findex -target-list-current-targets
34386
34387 @subsubheading Synopsis
34388
34389 @smallexample
34390 -target-list-current-targets
34391 @end smallexample
34392
34393 Describe the current target.
34394
34395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34396
34397 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
34398 other things).
34399
34400 @subsubheading Example
34401 N.A.
34402
34403
34404 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
34405 @findex -target-list-parameters
34406
34407 @subsubheading Synopsis
34408
34409 @smallexample
34410 -target-list-parameters
34411 @end smallexample
34412
34413 @c ????
34414 @end ignore
34415
34416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34417
34418 No equivalent.
34419
34420 @subsubheading Example
34421 N.A.
34422
34423 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
34424 @findex -target-flash-erase
34425
34426 @subsubheading Synopsis
34427
34428 @smallexample
34429 -target-flash-erase
34430 @end smallexample
34431
34432 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
34433
34434 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
34435
34436 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
34437 addresses and memory region sizes.
34438
34439 @smallexample
34440 (gdb)
34441 -target-flash-erase
34442 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
34443 (gdb)
34444 @end smallexample
34445
34446 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
34447 @findex -target-select
34448
34449 @subsubheading Synopsis
34450
34451 @smallexample
34452 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
34453 @end smallexample
34454
34455 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
34456
34457 @table @samp
34458 @item @var{type}
34459 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
34460 @item @var{parameters}
34461 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
34462 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
34463 @end table
34464
34465 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
34466 which the target program is, in the following form:
34467
34468 @smallexample
34469 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
34470 args=[@var{arg list}]
34471 @end smallexample
34472
34473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34474
34475 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
34476
34477 @subsubheading Example
34478
34479 @smallexample
34480 (gdb)
34481 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
34482 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
34483 (gdb)
34484 @end smallexample
34485
34486 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34487 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
34488 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
34489
34490
34491 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
34492 @findex -target-file-put
34493
34494 @subsubheading Synopsis
34495
34496 @smallexample
34497 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
34498 @end smallexample
34499
34500 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
34501 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
34502
34503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34504
34505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
34506
34507 @subsubheading Example
34508
34509 @smallexample
34510 (gdb)
34511 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
34512 ^done
34513 (gdb)
34514 @end smallexample
34515
34516
34517 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
34518 @findex -target-file-get
34519
34520 @subsubheading Synopsis
34521
34522 @smallexample
34523 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
34524 @end smallexample
34525
34526 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
34527 on the host system.
34528
34529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34530
34531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
34532
34533 @subsubheading Example
34534
34535 @smallexample
34536 (gdb)
34537 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
34538 ^done
34539 (gdb)
34540 @end smallexample
34541
34542
34543 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
34544 @findex -target-file-delete
34545
34546 @subsubheading Synopsis
34547
34548 @smallexample
34549 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
34550 @end smallexample
34551
34552 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
34553
34554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34555
34556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
34557
34558 @subsubheading Example
34559
34560 @smallexample
34561 (gdb)
34562 -target-file-delete remotefile
34563 ^done
34564 (gdb)
34565 @end smallexample
34566
34567
34568 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34569 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
34570 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34571
34572 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
34573 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
34574
34575 @subsubheading Synopsis
34576
34577 @smallexample
34578 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
34579 @end smallexample
34580
34581 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
34582 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
34583 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34584
34585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34586
34587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
34588
34589 @subsubheading Result
34590
34591 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
34592 defined for each exception:
34593
34594 @table @samp
34595 @item name
34596 The name of the exception.
34597
34598 @item address
34599 The address of the exception.
34600
34601 @end table
34602
34603 @subsubheading Example
34604
34605 @smallexample
34606 -info-ada-exceptions aint
34607 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
34608 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
34609 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
34610 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
34611 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
34612 @end smallexample
34613
34614 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
34615
34616 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
34617 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
34618 Catchpoint Commands}.
34619
34620
34621 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34622 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
34623 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
34624
34625 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
34626 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
34627 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
34628 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
34629
34630 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
34631 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
34632 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
34633
34634 @subsubheading Synopsis
34635
34636 @smallexample
34637 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
34638 @end smallexample
34639
34640 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
34641
34642 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
34643 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
34644 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
34645 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
34646 dash.
34647
34648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34649
34650 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34651
34652 @subsubheading Result
34653
34654 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
34655
34656 @table @samp
34657 @item exists
34658 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
34659 @code{"false"} otherwise.
34660
34661 @end table
34662
34663 @subsubheading Example
34664
34665 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
34666
34667 @smallexample
34668 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
34669 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
34670 @end smallexample
34671
34672 @noindent
34673 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
34674 to the debugger:
34675
34676 @smallexample
34677 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
34678 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
34679 @end smallexample
34680
34681 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
34682 @findex -list-features
34683 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
34684
34685 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
34686 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
34687 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
34688 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
34689 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
34690 startup.
34691
34692 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
34693 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
34694 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
34695 is given below.
34696
34697 Example output:
34698
34699 @smallexample
34700 (gdb) -list-features
34701 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
34702 @end smallexample
34703
34704 The current list of features is:
34705
34706 @ftable @samp
34707 @item frozen-varobjs
34708 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
34709 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
34710 of @code{-varobj-create}.
34711 @item pending-breakpoints
34712 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
34713 command.
34714 @item python
34715 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
34716 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
34717 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
34718 @item thread-info
34719 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
34720 @item data-read-memory-bytes
34721 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
34722 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
34723 @item breakpoint-notifications
34724 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
34725 CLI will be announced via async records.
34726 @item ada-task-info
34727 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
34728 @item language-option
34729 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
34730 option (@pxref{Context management}).
34731 @item info-gdb-mi-command
34732 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
34733 @item undefined-command-error-code
34734 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
34735 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
34736 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
34737 @item exec-run-start-option
34738 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
34739 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
34740 @item data-disassemble-a-option
34741 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
34742 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
34743 @end ftable
34744
34745 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
34746 @findex -list-target-features
34747
34748 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
34749 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
34750 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
34751 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
34752 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
34753 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
34754 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
34755 Example output:
34756
34757 @smallexample
34758 (gdb) -list-target-features
34759 ^done,result=["async"]
34760 @end smallexample
34761
34762 The current list of features is:
34763
34764 @table @samp
34765 @item async
34766 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
34767 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
34768 while the target is running.
34769
34770 @item reverse
34771 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
34772 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34773
34774 @end table
34775
34776 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34777 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
34778 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34779
34780 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
34781
34782 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
34783 @findex -gdb-exit
34784
34785 @subsubheading Synopsis
34786
34787 @smallexample
34788 -gdb-exit
34789 @end smallexample
34790
34791 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
34792
34793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34794
34795 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
34796
34797 @subsubheading Example
34798
34799 @smallexample
34800 (gdb)
34801 -gdb-exit
34802 ^exit
34803 @end smallexample
34804
34805
34806 @ignore
34807 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
34808 @findex -exec-abort
34809
34810 @subsubheading Synopsis
34811
34812 @smallexample
34813 -exec-abort
34814 @end smallexample
34815
34816 Kill the inferior running program.
34817
34818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34819
34820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34821
34822 @subsubheading Example
34823 N.A.
34824 @end ignore
34825
34826
34827 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34828 @findex -gdb-set
34829
34830 @subsubheading Synopsis
34831
34832 @smallexample
34833 -gdb-set
34834 @end smallexample
34835
34836 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34837 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34838
34839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34840
34841 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34842
34843 @subsubheading Example
34844
34845 @smallexample
34846 (gdb)
34847 -gdb-set $foo=3
34848 ^done
34849 (gdb)
34850 @end smallexample
34851
34852
34853 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34854 @findex -gdb-show
34855
34856 @subsubheading Synopsis
34857
34858 @smallexample
34859 -gdb-show
34860 @end smallexample
34861
34862 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34863
34864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34865
34866 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34867
34868 @subsubheading Example
34869
34870 @smallexample
34871 (gdb)
34872 -gdb-show annotate
34873 ^done,value="0"
34874 (gdb)
34875 @end smallexample
34876
34877 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34878
34879
34880 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34881 @findex -gdb-version
34882
34883 @subsubheading Synopsis
34884
34885 @smallexample
34886 -gdb-version
34887 @end smallexample
34888
34889 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34890
34891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34892
34893 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34894 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34895
34896 @subsubheading Example
34897
34898 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34899 @c box in TeX.
34900 @smallexample
34901 (gdb)
34902 -gdb-version
34903 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34904 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34905 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34906 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34907 ~ certain conditions.
34908 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34909 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34910 ~ details.
34911 ~This GDB was configured as
34912 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34913 ^done
34914 (gdb)
34915 @end smallexample
34916
34917 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34918 @findex -list-thread-groups
34919
34920 @subheading Synopsis
34921
34922 @smallexample
34923 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34924 @end smallexample
34925
34926 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34927 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34928 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34929 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34930 top-level thread groups.
34931
34932 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34933 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34934 available on the target.
34935
34936 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34937 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34938 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34939 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34940 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34941 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34942 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34943 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34944
34945 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34946 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34947 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34948 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34949 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34950 @samp{threads} field.
34951
34952 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34953 the following caveats:
34954
34955 @itemize @bullet
34956 @item
34957 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34958 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34959 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34960
34961 @item
34962 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34963 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34964 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34965 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34966 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34967 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34968
34969 @end itemize
34970
34971 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34972 have the following fields:
34973
34974 @table @code
34975 @item id
34976 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34977 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34978 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34979
34980 @item type
34981 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34982 valid type.
34983
34984 @item pid
34985 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34986 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34987
34988 @item exit-code
34989 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34990 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34991 only if the process is not running.
34992
34993 @item num_children
34994 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34995 absent for an available thread group.
34996
34997 @item threads
34998 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34999 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
35000 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
35001
35002 @item cores
35003 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
35004 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
35005 such information is not available.
35006
35007 @item executable
35008 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
35009 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
35010 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
35011
35012 @end table
35013
35014 @subheading Example
35015
35016 @smallexample
35017 @value{GDBP}
35018 -list-thread-groups
35019 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
35020 -list-thread-groups 17
35021 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
35022 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
35023 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
35024 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
35025 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
35026 -list-thread-groups --available
35027 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
35028 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
35029 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35030 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35031 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
35032 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
35033 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35034 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35035 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
35036 @end smallexample
35037
35038 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
35039 @findex -info-os
35040
35041 @subsubheading Synopsis
35042
35043 @smallexample
35044 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
35045 @end smallexample
35046
35047 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
35048 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
35049 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
35050 of data of that type.
35051
35052 The types of information available depend on the target operating
35053 system.
35054
35055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35056
35057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
35058
35059 @subsubheading Example
35060
35061 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
35062 like this:
35063
35064 @smallexample
35065 @value{GDBP}
35066 -info-os
35067 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
35068 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
35069 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
35070 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
35071 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
35072 col2="CPUs"@},
35073 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
35074 col2="File descriptors"@},
35075 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
35076 col2="Kernel modules"@},
35077 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
35078 col2="Message queues"@},
35079 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
35080 col2="Processes"@},
35081 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
35082 col2="Process groups"@},
35083 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
35084 col2="Semaphores"@},
35085 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
35086 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
35087 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
35088 col2="Sockets"@},
35089 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
35090 col2="Threads"@}]
35091 @value{GDBP}
35092 -info-os processes
35093 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
35094 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
35095 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
35096 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
35097 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
35098 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
35099 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
35100 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
35101 ...
35102 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
35103 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
35104 (gdb)
35105 @end smallexample
35106
35107 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
35108 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
35109 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
35110 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
35111 @code{info os} omits it.)
35112
35113 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
35114 @findex -add-inferior
35115
35116 @subheading Synopsis
35117
35118 @smallexample
35119 -add-inferior
35120 @end smallexample
35121
35122 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
35123 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
35124 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
35125 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
35126 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
35127 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
35128
35129 @subheading Example
35130
35131 @smallexample
35132 @value{GDBP}
35133 -add-inferior
35134 ^done,inferior="i3"
35135 @end smallexample
35136
35137 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
35138 @findex -interpreter-exec
35139
35140 @subheading Synopsis
35141
35142 @smallexample
35143 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
35144 @end smallexample
35145 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
35146
35147 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
35148
35149 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35150
35151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
35152
35153 @subheading Example
35154
35155 @smallexample
35156 (gdb)
35157 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
35158 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
35159 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
35160 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
35161 ^done
35162 (gdb)
35163 @end smallexample
35164
35165 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
35166 @findex -inferior-tty-set
35167
35168 @subheading Synopsis
35169
35170 @smallexample
35171 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35172 @end smallexample
35173
35174 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
35175
35176 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35177
35178 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
35179
35180 @subheading Example
35181
35182 @smallexample
35183 (gdb)
35184 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35185 ^done
35186 (gdb)
35187 @end smallexample
35188
35189 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
35190 @findex -inferior-tty-show
35191
35192 @subheading Synopsis
35193
35194 @smallexample
35195 -inferior-tty-show
35196 @end smallexample
35197
35198 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
35199
35200 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35201
35202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
35203
35204 @subheading Example
35205
35206 @smallexample
35207 (gdb)
35208 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35209 ^done
35210 (gdb)
35211 -inferior-tty-show
35212 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
35213 (gdb)
35214 @end smallexample
35215
35216 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
35217 @findex -enable-timings
35218
35219 @subheading Synopsis
35220
35221 @smallexample
35222 -enable-timings [yes | no]
35223 @end smallexample
35224
35225 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
35226 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
35227 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
35228 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
35229
35230 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35231
35232 No equivalent.
35233
35234 @subheading Example
35235
35236 @smallexample
35237 (gdb)
35238 -enable-timings
35239 ^done
35240 (gdb)
35241 -break-insert main
35242 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
35243 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
35244 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
35245 times="0"@},
35246 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
35247 (gdb)
35248 -enable-timings no
35249 ^done
35250 (gdb)
35251 -exec-run
35252 ^running
35253 (gdb)
35254 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
35255 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
35256 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
35257 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
35258 (gdb)
35259 @end smallexample
35260
35261 @subheading The @code{-complete} Command
35262 @findex -complete
35263
35264 @subheading Synopsis
35265
35266 @smallexample
35267 -complete @var{command}
35268 @end smallexample
35269
35270 Show a list of completions for partially typed CLI @var{command}.
35271
35272 This command is intended for @sc{gdb/mi} frontends that cannot use two separate
35273 CLI and MI channels --- for example: because of lack of PTYs like on Windows or
35274 because @value{GDBN} is used remotely via a SSH connection.
35275
35276 @subheading Result
35277
35278 The result consists of two or three fields:
35279
35280 @table @samp
35281 @item completion
35282 This field contains the completed @var{command}. If @var{command}
35283 has no known completions, this field is omitted.
35284
35285 @item matches
35286 This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
35287
35288 @item max_completions_reached
35289 This field contains @code{1} if number of known completions is above
35290 @code{max-completions} limit (@pxref{Completion}), otherwise it contains
35291 @code{0}. It is always present.
35292
35293 @end table
35294
35295 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35296
35297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{complete}.
35298
35299 @subheading Example
35300
35301 @smallexample
35302 (gdb)
35303 -complete br
35304 ^done,completion="break",
35305 matches=["break","break-range"],
35306 max_completions_reached="0"
35307 (gdb)
35308 -complete "b ma"
35309 ^done,completion="b ma",
35310 matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
35311 (gdb)
35312 -complete "b push_b"
35313 ^done,completion="b push_back(",
35314 matches=[
35315 "b A::push_back(void*)",
35316 "b std::string::push_back(char)",
35317 "b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
35318 max_completions_reached="0"
35319 (gdb)
35320 -complete "nonexist"
35321 ^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
35322 (gdb)
35323
35324 @end smallexample
35325
35326 @node Annotations
35327 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
35328
35329 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
35330 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
35331 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
35332 relatively high level.
35333
35334 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
35335 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35336
35337 @ignore
35338 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
35339 @end ignore
35340
35341 @menu
35342 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
35343 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
35344 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
35345 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
35346 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
35347 * Annotations for Running::
35348 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
35349 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
35350 @end menu
35351
35352 @node Annotations Overview
35353 @section What is an Annotation?
35354 @cindex annotations
35355
35356 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
35357 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
35358 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
35359 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
35360 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
35361 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
35362 cannot contain newline characters.
35363
35364 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
35365 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
35366 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
35367 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
35368 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
35369 means those three characters as output.
35370
35371 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
35372 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
35373 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
35374 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
35375 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
35376 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
35377 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
35378 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
35379 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
35380
35381 @table @code
35382 @kindex set annotate
35383 @item set annotate @var{level}
35384 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
35385 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
35386
35387 @item show annotate
35388 @kindex show annotate
35389 Show the current annotation level.
35390 @end table
35391
35392 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
35393
35394 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
35395
35396 @smallexample
35397 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
35398 GNU gdb 6.0
35399 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
35400 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
35401 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
35402 under certain conditions.
35403 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
35404 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
35405 for details.
35406 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
35407
35408 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35409 (@value{GDBP})
35410 ^Z^Zprompt
35411 @kbd{quit}
35412
35413 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35414 $
35415 @end smallexample
35416
35417 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
35418 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
35419 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
35420 output from @value{GDBN}.
35421
35422 @node Server Prefix
35423 @section The Server Prefix
35424 @cindex server prefix
35425
35426 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
35427 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
35428 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
35429 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
35430 a transparent manner.
35431
35432 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
35433 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
35434 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
35435 @code{print} command.
35436
35437 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
35438 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
35439
35440 @node Prompting
35441 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
35442
35443 @cindex annotations for prompts
35444 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
35445 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
35446 over, etc.
35447
35448 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
35449 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
35450 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
35451 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
35452 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
35453 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
35454 features the following annotations:
35455
35456 @smallexample
35457 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35458 ^Z^Zprompt
35459 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35460 @end smallexample
35461
35462 The input types are
35463
35464 @table @code
35465 @findex pre-prompt annotation
35466 @findex prompt annotation
35467 @findex post-prompt annotation
35468 @item prompt
35469 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
35470
35471 @findex pre-commands annotation
35472 @findex commands annotation
35473 @findex post-commands annotation
35474 @item commands
35475 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
35476 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
35477
35478 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
35479 @findex overload-choice annotation
35480 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
35481 @item overload-choice
35482 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
35483
35484 @findex pre-query annotation
35485 @findex query annotation
35486 @findex post-query annotation
35487 @item query
35488 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
35489
35490 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
35491 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
35492 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
35493 @item prompt-for-continue
35494 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
35495 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
35496 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
35497 presence of annotations.
35498 @end table
35499
35500 @node Errors
35501 @section Errors
35502 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
35503
35504 @findex quit annotation
35505 @smallexample
35506 ^Z^Zquit
35507 @end smallexample
35508
35509 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
35510
35511 @findex error annotation
35512 @smallexample
35513 ^Z^Zerror
35514 @end smallexample
35515
35516 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
35517
35518 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
35519 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
35520 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
35521 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
35522 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
35523 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
35524 to the top level.
35525
35526 @findex error-begin annotation
35527 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
35528
35529 @smallexample
35530 ^Z^Zerror-begin
35531 @end smallexample
35532
35533 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
35534 message.
35535
35536 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
35537 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
35538 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
35539
35540 @node Invalidation
35541 @section Invalidation Notices
35542
35543 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
35544 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
35545 changed.
35546
35547 @table @code
35548 @findex frames-invalid annotation
35549 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
35550
35551 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
35552 have changed.
35553
35554 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
35555 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
35556
35557 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
35558 deleted a breakpoint.
35559 @end table
35560
35561 @node Annotations for Running
35562 @section Running the Program
35563 @cindex annotations for running programs
35564
35565 @findex starting annotation
35566 @findex stopping annotation
35567 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
35568 @code{step} or @code{continue},
35569
35570 @smallexample
35571 ^Z^Zstarting
35572 @end smallexample
35573
35574 is output. When the program stops,
35575
35576 @smallexample
35577 ^Z^Zstopped
35578 @end smallexample
35579
35580 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
35581 annotations describe how the program stopped.
35582
35583 @table @code
35584 @findex exited annotation
35585 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
35586 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
35587 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
35588
35589 @findex signalled annotation
35590 @findex signal-name annotation
35591 @findex signal-name-end annotation
35592 @findex signal-string annotation
35593 @findex signal-string-end annotation
35594 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
35595 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
35596 annotation continues:
35597
35598 @smallexample
35599 @var{intro-text}
35600 ^Z^Zsignal-name
35601 @var{name}
35602 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
35603 @var{middle-text}
35604 ^Z^Zsignal-string
35605 @var{string}
35606 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
35607 @var{end-text}
35608 @end smallexample
35609
35610 @noindent
35611 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
35612 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
35613 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
35614 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
35615 user's benefit and have no particular format.
35616
35617 @findex signal annotation
35618 @item ^Z^Zsignal
35619 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
35620 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
35621 terminated with it.
35622
35623 @findex breakpoint annotation
35624 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
35625 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
35626
35627 @findex watchpoint annotation
35628 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
35629 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
35630 @end table
35631
35632 @node Source Annotations
35633 @section Displaying Source
35634 @cindex annotations for source display
35635
35636 @findex source annotation
35637 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
35638
35639 @smallexample
35640 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
35641 @end smallexample
35642
35643 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
35644 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
35645 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
35646 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
35647 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
35648 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
35649 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
35650 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
35651 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
35652 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
35653 depend on the language).
35654
35655 @node JIT Interface
35656 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
35657 @cindex just-in-time compilation
35658 @cindex JIT compilation interface
35659
35660 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
35661 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
35662 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
35663 performance while maintaining platform independence.
35664
35665 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
35666 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
35667 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
35668 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
35669 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
35670 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
35671
35672 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
35673 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
35674 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
35675 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
35676 LLVM JIT.
35677
35678 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
35679 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
35680 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
35681 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
35682 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
35683 out about additional code.
35684
35685 @menu
35686 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
35687 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
35688 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
35689 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
35690 @end menu
35691
35692 @node Declarations
35693 @section JIT Declarations
35694
35695 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
35696 implement the interface:
35697
35698 @smallexample
35699 typedef enum
35700 @{
35701 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
35702 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
35703 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
35704 @} jit_actions_t;
35705
35706 struct jit_code_entry
35707 @{
35708 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
35709 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
35710 const char *symfile_addr;
35711 uint64_t symfile_size;
35712 @};
35713
35714 struct jit_descriptor
35715 @{
35716 uint32_t version;
35717 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
35718 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
35719 uint32_t action_flag;
35720 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
35721 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
35722 @};
35723
35724 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
35725 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
35726
35727 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
35728 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
35729 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
35730 @end smallexample
35731
35732 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
35733 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
35734 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
35735
35736 @node Registering Code
35737 @section Registering Code
35738
35739 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
35740
35741 @itemize @bullet
35742 @item
35743 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
35744 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
35745
35746 @item
35747 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
35748 file.
35749
35750 @item
35751 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
35752
35753 @item
35754 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
35755
35756 @item
35757 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
35758 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35759 @end itemize
35760
35761 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
35762 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
35763 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
35764 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
35765
35766 @node Unregistering Code
35767 @section Unregistering Code
35768
35769 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
35770
35771 @itemize @bullet
35772 @item
35773 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
35774
35775 @item
35776 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
35777
35778 @item
35779 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
35780 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35781 @end itemize
35782
35783 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
35784 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
35785
35786 @node Custom Debug Info
35787 @section Custom Debug Info
35788 @cindex custom JIT debug info
35789 @cindex JIT debug info reader
35790
35791 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
35792 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
35793 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
35794 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
35795 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
35796 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
35797 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
35798 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
35799 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
35800
35801 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
35802 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
35803 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
35804 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
35805 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
35806 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
35807 compiler.
35808
35809 @menu
35810 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
35811 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
35812 @end menu
35813
35814 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35815 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35816 @kindex jit-reader-load
35817 @kindex jit-reader-unload
35818
35819 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
35820 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
35821
35822 @table @code
35823 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
35824 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
35825 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
35826 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
35827 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
35828 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
35829 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
35830
35831 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
35832 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
35833 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
35834 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
35835 @code{jit-reader-load}.
35836
35837 @item jit-reader-unload
35838 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
35839
35840 @end table
35841
35842 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35843 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35844 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
35845
35846 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
35847 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
35848
35849 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
35850 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
35851 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
35852 the system include directory.
35853
35854 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
35855 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
35856 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
35857
35858 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
35859 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
35860
35861 @findex gdb_init_reader
35862 @smallexample
35863 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
35864 @end smallexample
35865
35866 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
35867
35868 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
35869 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
35870 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
35871 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
35872 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
35873 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
35874
35875 @smallexample
35876 struct gdb_reader_funcs
35877 @{
35878 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
35879 int reader_version;
35880
35881 /* For use by the reader. */
35882 void *priv_data;
35883
35884 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35885 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35886 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35887 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35888 @};
35889 @end smallexample
35890
35891 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35892 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35893
35894 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35895 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35896 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35897 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35898 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35899 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35900 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35901 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35902 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35903 target's address space.
35904
35905 @node In-Process Agent
35906 @chapter In-Process Agent
35907 @cindex debugging agent
35908 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35909 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35910 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35911 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35912 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35913 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35914 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35915 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35916 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35917 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35918 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35919 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35920 behavior without interrupting it.
35921
35922 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35923 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35924 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35925 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35926 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35927 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35928 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35929 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35930 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35931
35932 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35933 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35934 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35935 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35936
35937 @anchor{Control Agent}
35938 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35939 debugging with the following commands:
35940
35941 @table @code
35942 @kindex set agent on
35943 @item set agent on
35944 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35945 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35946 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35947 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35948 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35949 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35950
35951 @kindex set agent off
35952 @item set agent off
35953 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35954 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35955
35956 @kindex show agent
35957 @item show agent
35958 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35959 the in-process agent.
35960 @end table
35961
35962 @menu
35963 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35964 @end menu
35965
35966 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35967 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35968 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35969
35970 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35971 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35972 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35973 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35974 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35975 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35976 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35977 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35978 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35979
35980 @menu
35981 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35982 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35983 @end menu
35984
35985 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35986 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35987 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35988
35989 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35990 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35991
35992 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35993 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35994 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35995 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35996
35997 @enumerate
35998 @item
35999 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
36000 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
36001 @item
36002 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
36003 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
36004 the other one.
36005 @end enumerate
36006
36007 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
36008
36009 @enumerate
36010 @item
36011 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
36012 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
36013 @anchor{agent expression object}
36014 @item
36015 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
36016 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
36017 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
36018 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
36019 @item
36020 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36021 @anchor{tracepoint object}
36022
36023 @end enumerate
36024
36025 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
36026 object:
36027
36028 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
36029 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
36030 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
36031 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
36032 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
36033 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
36034 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36035 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
36036 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
36037 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
36038 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
36039 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
36040 memory address for collecting.
36041 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
36042 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36043 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
36044 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36045 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
36046 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36047 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
36048 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
36049 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
36050 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
36051 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
36052 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
36053 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
36054 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
36055 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
36056 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
36057 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
36058 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
36059 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
36060 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
36061 @ref{agent expression object}
36062 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
36063 @ref{agent expression object}
36064 @item actions @tab variable
36065 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
36066 @end multitable
36067
36068 @node IPA Protocol Commands
36069 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
36070 @cindex ipa protocol commands
36071
36072 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
36073 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
36074
36075 @table @samp
36076
36077 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
36078 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
36079 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
36080 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
36081 in IPA finally.
36082
36083 Replies:
36084 @table @samp
36085 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
36086 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
36087 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
36088 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
36089 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
36090 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
36091 @item E @var{NN}
36092 for an error
36093
36094 @end table
36095
36096 @item close
36097 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
36098 is about to kill inferiors.
36099
36100 @item qTfSTM
36101 @xref{qTfSTM}.
36102 @item qTsSTM
36103 @xref{qTsSTM}.
36104 @item qTSTMat
36105 @xref{qTSTMat}.
36106 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
36107 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
36108
36109 Replies:
36110 @table @samp
36111 @item E @var{NN}
36112 for an error
36113 @end table
36114 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
36115 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
36116 @end table
36117
36118 @node GDB Bugs
36119 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
36120 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
36121 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
36122
36123 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
36124
36125 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
36126 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
36127 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
36128 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
36129
36130 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
36131 information that enables us to fix the bug.
36132
36133 @menu
36134 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
36135 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
36136 @end menu
36137
36138 @node Bug Criteria
36139 @section Have You Found a Bug?
36140 @cindex bug criteria
36141
36142 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
36143
36144 @itemize @bullet
36145 @cindex fatal signal
36146 @cindex debugger crash
36147 @cindex crash of debugger
36148 @item
36149 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
36150 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
36151
36152 @cindex error on valid input
36153 @item
36154 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
36155 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
36156 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
36157
36158 @cindex invalid input
36159 @item
36160 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
36161 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
36162 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
36163 for traditional practice''.
36164
36165 @item
36166 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
36167 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
36168 @end itemize
36169
36170 @node Bug Reporting
36171 @section How to Report Bugs
36172 @cindex bug reports
36173 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
36174
36175 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
36176 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
36177 contact that organization first.
36178
36179 You can find contact information for many support companies and
36180 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
36181 distribution.
36182 @c should add a web page ref...
36183
36184 @ifset BUGURL
36185 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
36186 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36187 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
36188 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
36189 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
36190 be used.
36191
36192 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
36193 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
36194 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
36195 @samp{bug-gdb}.
36196
36197 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
36198 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
36199 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
36200 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
36201 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
36202 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
36203 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
36204 bug reports to the mailing list.
36205 @end ifset
36206 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
36207 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36208 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
36209 @end ifclear
36210 @end ifset
36211
36212 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
36213 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
36214 fact or leave it out, state it!
36215
36216 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
36217 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
36218 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
36219 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
36220 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
36221 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
36222 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
36223 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
36224 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
36225
36226 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
36227 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
36228 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
36229 self-contained.
36230
36231 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36232 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
36233 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
36234 bugs properly.
36235
36236 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
36237
36238 @itemize @bullet
36239 @item
36240 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
36241 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
36242 version}.
36243
36244 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
36245 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
36246
36247 @item
36248 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
36249 version number.
36250
36251 @item
36252 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
36253 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
36254 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
36255 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
36256
36257 @item
36258 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
36259 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
36260
36261 @item
36262 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
36263 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
36264 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
36265 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
36266 those compilers.
36267
36268 @item
36269 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
36270 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
36271 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
36272 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
36273
36274 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
36275 and then we might not encounter the bug.
36276
36277 @item
36278 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
36279 reproduce the bug.
36280
36281 @item
36282 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
36283 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
36284
36285 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
36286 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
36287 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
36288 a chance to make a mistake.
36289
36290 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
36291 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
36292 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
36293 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
36294 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
36295 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
36296 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
36297 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
36298
36299 @pindex script
36300 @cindex recording a session script
36301 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
36302 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
36303 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
36304 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
36305
36306 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
36307 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
36308
36309 @item
36310 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
36311 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
36312 it by context, not by line number.
36313
36314 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
36315 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
36316
36317 @end itemize
36318
36319 Here are some things that are not necessary:
36320
36321 @itemize @bullet
36322 @item
36323 A description of the envelope of the bug.
36324
36325 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
36326 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
36327 changes will not affect it.
36328
36329 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
36330 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
36331 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
36332 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
36333
36334 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
36335 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
36336 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
36337 less time, and so on.
36338
36339 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
36340 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
36341
36342 @item
36343 A patch for the bug.
36344
36345 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
36346 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
36347 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
36348 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
36349
36350 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
36351 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
36352 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
36353 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
36354
36355 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
36356 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
36357 help us to understand.
36358
36359 @item
36360 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
36361
36362 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
36363 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
36364 @end itemize
36365
36366 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
36367 @c and consists of the two following files:
36368 @c rluser.texi
36369 @c hsuser.texi
36370 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
36371 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
36372 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
36373 @include rluser.texi
36374 @include hsuser.texi
36375 @end ifclear
36376
36377 @node In Memoriam
36378 @appendix In Memoriam
36379
36380 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
36381 contributors:
36382
36383 @table @code
36384 @item Fred Fish
36385 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
36386 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
36387 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
36388
36389 @item Michael Snyder
36390 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
36391 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
36392 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
36393 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
36394 @end table
36395
36396 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
36397 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
36398
36399 @node Formatting Documentation
36400 @appendix Formatting Documentation
36401
36402 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
36403 @cindex reference card
36404 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
36405 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
36406 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
36407 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
36408 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
36409 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
36410
36411 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
36412 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
36413
36414 @smallexample
36415 make refcard.dvi
36416 @end smallexample
36417
36418 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
36419 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
36420 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
36421 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
36422 your @sc{dvi} output program.
36423
36424 @cindex documentation
36425
36426 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
36427 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
36428 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
36429 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
36430 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
36431 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
36432
36433 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
36434 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
36435 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
36436 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
36437 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
36438 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
36439 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
36440 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
36441
36442 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
36443 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
36444 @code{makeinfo}.
36445
36446 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
36447 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
36448 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
36449
36450 @smallexample
36451 cd gdb
36452 make gdb.info
36453 @end smallexample
36454
36455 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
36456 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
36457 Texinfo definitions file.
36458
36459 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
36460 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
36461 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
36462 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
36463 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
36464 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
36465 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
36466
36467 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
36468 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
36469 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
36470 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
36471 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
36472 directory.
36473
36474 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
36475 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
36476 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
36477 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
36478
36479 @smallexample
36480 make gdb.dvi
36481 @end smallexample
36482
36483 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
36484
36485 @node Installing GDB
36486 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
36487 @cindex installation
36488
36489 @menu
36490 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
36491 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
36492 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
36493 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
36494 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
36495 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
36496 @end menu
36497
36498 @node Requirements
36499 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
36500 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
36501
36502 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
36503 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
36504
36505 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
36506 @table @asis
36507 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
36508 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
36509 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
36510
36511 @item GNU make
36512 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
36513 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
36514 @end table
36515
36516 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
36517 @table @asis
36518 @item Expat
36519 @anchor{Expat}
36520 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
36521 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
36522 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
36523 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
36524 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
36525 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
36526
36527 Expat is used for:
36528
36529 @itemize @bullet
36530 @item
36531 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
36532 @item
36533 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
36534 @item
36535 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
36536 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
36537 @item
36538 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
36539 @item
36540 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
36541 @item
36542 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
36543 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
36544 @end itemize
36545
36546 @item Guile
36547 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
36548 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
36549 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36550 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
36551 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
36552 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
36553
36554 @item iconv
36555 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
36556 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
36557 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
36558 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
36559
36560 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
36561 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
36562 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
36563 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
36564 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
36565
36566 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
36567 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
36568 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
36569 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
36570 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
36571
36572 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
36573 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
36574 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
36575 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
36576 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
36577 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
36578 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
36579 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
36580 code to @samp{libiconv}.
36581
36582 @item lzma
36583 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
36584 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
36585 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
36586 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
36587 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
36588 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
36589 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
36590
36591 @item MPFR
36592 @anchor{MPFR}
36593 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
36594 library. This library may be included with your operating system
36595 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36596 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
36597 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
36598 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
36599 option to specify its location.
36600
36601 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
36602 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
36603 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
36604 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
36605
36606 @item Python
36607 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
36608 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
36609 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36610 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
36611 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
36612 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
36613 installation of Python.
36614
36615 @item zlib
36616 @cindex compressed debug sections
36617 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
36618 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
36619 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
36620 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
36621 information in such binaries.
36622
36623 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
36624 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36625 @url{http://zlib.net}.
36626 @end table
36627
36628 @node Running Configure
36629 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
36630 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
36631 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
36632 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
36633 build the @code{gdb} program.
36634 @iftex
36635 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
36636 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
36637 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
36638 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
36639 @end iftex
36640
36641 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
36642 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
36643 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
36644
36645 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
36646 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
36647
36648 @table @code
36649 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
36650 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
36651
36652 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
36653 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
36654
36655 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
36656 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
36657
36658 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
36659 @sc{gnu} include files
36660
36661 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
36662 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
36663
36664 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
36665 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
36666
36667 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
36668 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
36669 @end table
36670
36671 There may be other subdirectories as well.
36672
36673 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
36674 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
36675 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
36676
36677 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
36678 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
36679 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
36680 argument.
36681
36682 For example:
36683
36684 @smallexample
36685 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36686 ./configure
36687 make
36688 @end smallexample
36689
36690 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
36691 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
36692 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
36693 directories.
36694
36695 @need 750
36696 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
36697 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
36698 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
36699
36700 @smallexample
36701 sh configure
36702 @end smallexample
36703
36704 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
36705 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
36706 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
36707 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
36708 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
36709 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
36710 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
36711 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
36712 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36713
36714 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
36715 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
36716 install it with @code{make install}.
36717
36718 @node Separate Objdir
36719 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
36720
36721 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
36722 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
36723 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
36724 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
36725 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
36726 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
36727 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
36728 program specified there.
36729
36730 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
36731 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
36732 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
36733 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
36734 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
36735 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
36736
36737 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
36738 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
36739
36740 @smallexample
36741 @group
36742 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36743 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
36744 cd ../gdb-sun4
36745 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
36746 make
36747 @end group
36748 @end smallexample
36749
36750 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
36751 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
36752 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
36753 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
36754 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
36755 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
36756
36757 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
36758 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
36759 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
36760 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
36761 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36762
36763 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
36764 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
36765 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
36766 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
36767 You specify a cross-debugging target by
36768 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
36769
36770 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
36771 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
36772 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
36773
36774 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
36775 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
36776 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
36777 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
36778 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
36779
36780 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
36781 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
36782 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
36783 with each other.
36784
36785 @node Config Names
36786 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
36787
36788 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
36789 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
36790 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
36791 of information in the following pattern:
36792
36793 @smallexample
36794 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
36795 @end smallexample
36796
36797 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
36798 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
36799 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
36800
36801 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
36802 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
36803 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
36804 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
36805 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
36806 abbreviations---for example:
36807
36808 @smallexample
36809 % sh config.sub i386-linux
36810 i386-pc-linux-gnu
36811 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
36812 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
36813 % sh config.sub hp9k700
36814 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
36815 % sh config.sub sun4
36816 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
36817 % sh config.sub sun3
36818 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
36819 % sh config.sub i986v
36820 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
36821 @end smallexample
36822
36823 @noindent
36824 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
36825 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
36826
36827 @node Configure Options
36828 @section @file{configure} Options
36829
36830 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
36831 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
36832 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
36833 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
36834 explanation of @file{configure}.
36835
36836 @smallexample
36837 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
36838 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36839 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36840 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
36841 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
36842 @end smallexample
36843
36844 @noindent
36845 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
36846 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
36847 @samp{--}.
36848
36849 @table @code
36850 @item --help
36851 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
36852
36853 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
36854 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
36855 @file{@var{dir}}.
36856
36857 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
36858 Configure the source to install programs under directory
36859 @file{@var{dir}}.
36860
36861 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
36862 @need 2000
36863 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
36864 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
36865 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
36866 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
36867 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
36868 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
36869 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
36870 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
36871 @var{dirname}.
36872
36873 @item --target=@var{target}
36874 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
36875 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
36876 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
36877
36878 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
36879 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
36880 @end table
36881
36882 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
36883 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
36884 options not described here.
36885
36886 @table @code
36887 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
36888 @itemx --enable-targets=all
36889 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
36890 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
36891 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
36892
36893 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
36894 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
36895 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
36896 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
36897 @code{--datadir}).
36898
36899 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
36900 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
36901 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
36902 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
36903 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36904 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36905 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36906 after it is built.
36907
36908 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36909 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36910
36911 @item --disable-gdbmi
36912 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36913 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36914
36915 @item --enable-tui
36916 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36917 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36918 supported).
36919
36920 @item --with-curses
36921 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
36922 terminal operations.
36923
36924 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36925 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36926 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36927 details.
36928
36929 @item --with-system-readline
36930 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36931 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}. Readline 7 or newer is
36932 required; this is enforced by the build system.
36933
36934 @item --with-system-zlib
36935 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36936 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36937
36938 @item --with-expat
36939 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36940 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36941 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36942 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36943 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36944 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36945 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36946 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36947
36948 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36949
36950 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36951 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36952 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36953 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36954 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36955
36956 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36957 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36958
36959 @item --with-lzma
36960 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36961 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36962 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
36963 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
36964 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
36965 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
36966
36967 @item --with-mpfr
36968 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
36969 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
36970 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
36971 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
36972 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
36973 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
36974 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
36975 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
36976 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
36977
36978 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
36979 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
36980 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
36981 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
36982 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
36983 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
36984 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
36985 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
36986 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
36987 Python is installed.
36988
36989 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
36990 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
36991 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
36992 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
36993 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
36994 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
36995 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
36996 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
36997 compile and link against Guile.
36998
36999 @item --without-included-regex
37000 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
37001 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
37002 the GNU C library.
37003
37004 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
37005 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
37006 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
37007 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
37008 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
37009 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
37010 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
37011 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
37012
37013 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37014 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
37015 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
37016 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
37017 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
37018 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
37019
37020 @item --enable-build-warnings
37021 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
37022 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
37023 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
37024 compiler you are using.
37025
37026 @item --enable-werror
37027 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
37028 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
37029 outputs any warning messages.
37030
37031 @item --enable-ubsan
37032 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
37033 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
37034 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
37035 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
37036 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
37037 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
37038 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
37039 @end table
37040
37041 @node System-wide configuration
37042 @section System-wide configuration and settings
37043 @cindex system-wide init file
37044
37045 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
37046 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
37047 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
37048
37049 Here is the corresponding configure option:
37050
37051 @table @code
37052 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37053 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
37054 @var{file}.
37055 @end table
37056
37057 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
37058 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
37059
37060 @itemize @bullet
37061 @item
37062 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
37063 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
37064 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
37065 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
37066 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
37067 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
37068
37069 @item
37070 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
37071 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
37072 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37073 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37074 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
37075 @end itemize
37076
37077 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
37078 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
37079 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
37080 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
37081 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
37082 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
37083 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
37084 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
37085 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
37086 reread.
37087
37088 @menu
37089 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37090 @end menu
37091
37092 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
37093 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37094 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
37095
37096 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
37097 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
37098 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
37099 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
37100 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
37101 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
37102
37103 The following scripts are currently available:
37104 @itemize @bullet
37105
37106 @item @file{elinos.py}
37107 @pindex elinos.py
37108 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
37109 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
37110 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
37111 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
37112 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
37113 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
37114
37115 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
37116 @pindex wrs-linux.py
37117 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
37118 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
37119 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
37120 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
37121
37122 @end itemize
37123
37124 @node Maintenance Commands
37125 @appendix Maintenance Commands
37126 @cindex maintenance commands
37127 @cindex internal commands
37128
37129 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
37130 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
37131 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
37132 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
37133 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
37134
37135 @table @code
37136 @kindex maint agent
37137 @kindex maint agent-eval
37138 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37139 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37140 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
37141 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
37142 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
37143 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
37144 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
37145 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
37146 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
37147 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
37148 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
37149 addition and return the sum.
37150 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
37151 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
37152
37153 @kindex maint agent-printf
37154 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
37155 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
37156 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
37157 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
37158 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
37159
37160 @kindex maint info breakpoints
37161 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
37162 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
37163 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
37164 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
37165 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
37166 is shown:
37167
37168 @table @code
37169 @item breakpoint
37170 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
37171
37172 @item watchpoint
37173 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
37174
37175 @item longjmp
37176 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
37177 @code{longjmp} calls.
37178
37179 @item longjmp resume
37180 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
37181
37182 @item until
37183 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
37184
37185 @item finish
37186 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
37187
37188 @item shlib events
37189 Shared library events.
37190
37191 @end table
37192
37193 @kindex maint info btrace
37194 @item maint info btrace
37195 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
37196
37197 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
37198 @item maint btrace packet-history
37199 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
37200 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
37201 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
37202 recording format.
37203
37204 @table @code
37205 @item bts
37206 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
37207 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
37208
37209 @table @asis
37210 @item Block number
37211 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
37212 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
37213 @item Highest @samp{PC}
37214 @end table
37215
37216 @item pt
37217 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
37218 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
37219 information is printed:
37220
37221 @table @asis
37222 @item Packet number
37223 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
37224 @item Trace offset
37225 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
37226 @item Packet opcode and payload
37227 @end table
37228 @end table
37229
37230 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
37231 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
37232 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
37233 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
37234 needed.
37235
37236 @kindex maint btrace clear
37237 @item maint btrace clear
37238 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
37239 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
37240
37241 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
37242 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
37243 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
37244 buffer.
37245
37246 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37247 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37248 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37249 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37250 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
37251 packet history.
37252
37253 @kindex set displaced-stepping
37254 @kindex show displaced-stepping
37255 @cindex displaced stepping support
37256 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
37257 @item set displaced-stepping
37258 @itemx show displaced-stepping
37259 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
37260 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
37261 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
37262 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
37263 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
37264
37265 @table @code
37266 @item set displaced-stepping on
37267 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
37268 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
37269
37270 @item set displaced-stepping off
37271 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
37272 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
37273
37274 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
37275 @item set displaced-stepping auto
37276 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
37277 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
37278 architecture supports displaced stepping.
37279 @end table
37280
37281 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
37282 @item maint check-psymtabs
37283 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
37284 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
37285
37286 @kindex maint check-symtabs
37287 @item maint check-symtabs
37288 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
37289
37290 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
37291 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
37292 Expand symbol tables.
37293 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
37294 names matching @var{regexp}.
37295
37296 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
37297 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37298 @cindex demangler crashes
37299 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
37300 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37301 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
37302 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
37303 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
37304 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
37305 option to terminate the current session.
37306
37307 @kindex maint cplus first_component
37308 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
37309 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
37310
37311 @kindex maint cplus namespace
37312 @item maint cplus namespace
37313 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
37314
37315 @kindex maint deprecate
37316 @kindex maint undeprecate
37317 @cindex deprecated commands
37318 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
37319 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
37320 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
37321 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
37322 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
37323 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
37324 the replacement as part of the warning.
37325
37326 @kindex maint dump-me
37327 @item maint dump-me
37328 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
37329 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
37330 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
37331 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
37332
37333 @kindex maint internal-error
37334 @kindex maint internal-warning
37335 @kindex maint demangler-warning
37336 @cindex demangler crashes
37337 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37338 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37339 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37340
37341 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
37342 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
37343 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
37344 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
37345 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
37346 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
37347 @value{GDBN} session.
37348
37349 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
37350 used as the text of the error or warning message.
37351
37352 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
37353
37354 @smallexample
37355 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
37356 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
37357 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
37358 debugging may prove unreliable.
37359 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37360 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37361 (@value{GDBP})
37362 @end smallexample
37363
37364 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
37365 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
37366 @cindex demangler crashes
37367
37368 @kindex maint set internal-error
37369 @kindex maint show internal-error
37370 @kindex maint set internal-warning
37371 @kindex maint show internal-warning
37372 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
37373 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
37374 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37375 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
37376 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37377 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
37378 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37379 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
37380 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
37381 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
37382 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
37383 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
37384 described in the table below.
37385
37386 @table @samp
37387 @item quit
37388 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37389 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
37390
37391 @item corefile
37392 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37393 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
37394 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
37395 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
37396 disabled.
37397 @end table
37398
37399 @kindex maint packet
37400 @item maint packet @var{text}
37401 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
37402 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
37403 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
37404 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
37405 checksum.
37406
37407 @kindex maint print architecture
37408 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37409 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
37410 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
37411
37412 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37413 @item maint print c-tdesc
37414 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
37415 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
37416 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
37417 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
37418 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
37419 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
37420 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
37421 modify XML target descriptions.
37422
37423 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
37424 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
37425 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
37426 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
37427
37428 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
37429 @kindex maint check libthread-db
37430 @item maint check libthread-db
37431 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
37432 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
37433 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
37434 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
37435 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
37436 on some platforms when debugging core files.
37437
37438 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
37439 @item maint print dummy-frames
37440 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
37441
37442 @smallexample
37443 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
37444 @dots{}
37445 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
37446 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
37447 58 return (a + b);
37448 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
37449 @dots{}
37450 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
37451 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
37452 (@value{GDBP})
37453 @end smallexample
37454
37455 Takes an optional file parameter.
37456
37457 @kindex maint print registers
37458 @kindex maint print raw-registers
37459 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
37460 @kindex maint print register-groups
37461 @kindex maint print remote-registers
37462 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37463 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37464 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37465 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37466 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37467 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
37468
37469 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
37470 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
37471 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
37472 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
37473 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
37474 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
37475 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
37476 and offsets in the `G' packets.
37477
37478 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
37479 write the information.
37480
37481 @kindex maint print reggroups
37482 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37483 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
37484 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
37485 information.
37486
37487 The register groups info looks like this:
37488
37489 @smallexample
37490 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
37491 Group Type
37492 general user
37493 float user
37494 all user
37495 vector user
37496 system user
37497 save internal
37498 restore internal
37499 @end smallexample
37500
37501 @kindex flushregs
37502 @item flushregs
37503 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
37504
37505 @kindex maint print objfiles
37506 @cindex info for known object files
37507 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
37508 Print a dump of all known object files.
37509 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
37510 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
37511 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
37512
37513 @kindex maint print user-registers
37514 @cindex user registers
37515 @item maint print user-registers
37516 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
37517 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
37518 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
37519 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
37520 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
37521 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
37522 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
37523
37524 @kindex maint print section-scripts
37525 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
37526 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
37527 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
37528 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
37529 matching @var{regexp}.
37530 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
37531 and the full path if known.
37532 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
37533
37534 @kindex maint print statistics
37535 @cindex bcache statistics
37536 @item maint print statistics
37537 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
37538 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
37539 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
37540 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
37541 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
37542 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
37543 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
37544 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
37545 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
37546 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
37547 lengths.
37548
37549 @kindex maint print target-stack
37550 @cindex target stack description
37551 @item maint print target-stack
37552 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
37553 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
37554 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
37555 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
37556 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
37557 address.
37558
37559 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
37560 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
37561
37562 @kindex maint print type
37563 @cindex type chain of a data type
37564 @item maint print type @var{expr}
37565 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
37566 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
37567 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
37568 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
37569 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
37570
37571 @kindex maint selftest
37572 @cindex self tests
37573 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
37574 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
37575 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
37576 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
37577 name will by ran.
37578
37579 @kindex maint info selftests
37580 @cindex self tests
37581 @item maint info selftests
37582 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
37583
37584 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37585 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37586 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37587 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37588 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
37589 information.
37590
37591 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
37592 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
37593 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
37594 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
37595 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
37596 always see the disassembly form.
37597
37598 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
37599
37600 @smallexample
37601 (gdb) info addr argc
37602 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
37603 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
37604 @end smallexample
37605
37606 For more information on these expressions, see
37607 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
37608
37609 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37610 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37611 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37612 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37613 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
37614
37615 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
37616 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
37617 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
37618 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
37619 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
37620 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
37621 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
37622 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
37623 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
37624
37625 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
37626 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
37627 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
37628 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
37629 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
37630
37631 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
37632 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
37633 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
37634 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
37635 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
37636 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
37637
37638 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
37639 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
37640 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
37641
37642 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
37643 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
37644 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
37645 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
37646
37647 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
37648 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
37649 @kindex maint set profile
37650 @kindex maint show profile
37651 @cindex profiling GDB
37652 @item maint set profile
37653 @itemx maint show profile
37654 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
37655
37656 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
37657 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
37658 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
37659 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
37660 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
37661 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
37662 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
37663
37664 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
37665 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
37666
37667 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
37668 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
37669 @cindex hardware debug registers
37670 @item maint set show-debug-regs
37671 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
37672 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
37673 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
37674 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
37675 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
37676 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
37677
37678 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
37679 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
37680 @item maint set show-all-tib
37681 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
37682 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
37683 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
37684 command.
37685
37686 @kindex maint set target-async
37687 @kindex maint show target-async
37688 @item maint set target-async
37689 @itemx maint show target-async
37690 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
37691 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
37692 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
37693 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
37694
37695 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
37696 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
37697 @item maint set target-non-stop
37698 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
37699
37700 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
37701 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
37702 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
37703 if supported by the target.
37704
37705 @table @code
37706 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
37707 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
37708 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
37709
37710 @item maint set target-non-stop on
37711 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
37712 does not indicate support.
37713
37714 @item maint set target-non-stop off
37715 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
37716 target supports it.
37717 @end table
37718
37719 @kindex maint set per-command
37720 @kindex maint show per-command
37721 @item maint set per-command
37722 @itemx maint show per-command
37723 @cindex resources used by commands
37724
37725 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
37726 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
37727
37728 @table @code
37729 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
37730 @itemx maint show per-command space
37731 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
37732 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
37733 took, following the command's own output.
37734 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37735 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37736
37737 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
37738 @itemx maint show per-command time
37739 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
37740 for each command.
37741 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
37742 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
37743 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
37744 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
37745 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
37746 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
37747 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
37748 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
37749 spent by the program been debugged.
37750 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37751 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37752
37753 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
37754 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
37755 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
37756 for each command.
37757 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
37758
37759 @enumerate a
37760 @item
37761 number of symbol tables
37762 @item
37763 number of primary symbol tables
37764 @item
37765 number of blocks in the blockvector
37766 @end enumerate
37767 @end table
37768
37769 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
37770 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
37771 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
37772 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
37773 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
37774 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
37775 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
37776 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
37777 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
37778 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
37779
37780 @kindex maint space
37781 @cindex memory used by commands
37782 @item maint space @var{value}
37783 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
37784 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37785
37786 @kindex maint time
37787 @cindex time of command execution
37788 @item maint time @var{value}
37789 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
37790 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37791
37792 @kindex maint translate-address
37793 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
37794 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
37795 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
37796 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
37797 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
37798 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
37799 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
37800
37801 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
37802 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
37803 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
37804
37805 @kindex maint test-options
37806 @item maint test-options require-delimiter
37807 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-error
37808 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-operand
37809 These commands are used by the testsuite to validate the command
37810 options framework. The @code{require-delimiter} variant requires a
37811 double-dash delimiter to indicate end of options. The
37812 @code{unknown-is-error} and @code{unknown-is-operand} do not. The
37813 @code{unknown-is-error} variant throws an error on unknown option,
37814 while @code{unknown-is-operand} treats unknown options as the start of
37815 the command's operands. When run, the commands output the result of
37816 the processed options. When completed, the commands store the
37817 internal result of completion in a variable exposed by the @code{maint
37818 show test-options-completion-result} command.
37819
37820 @kindex maint show test-options-completion-result
37821 @item maint show test-options-completion-result
37822 Shows the result of completing the @code{maint test-options}
37823 subcommands. This is used by the testsuite to validate completion
37824 support in the command options framework.
37825
37826 @kindex maint set test-settings
37827 @kindex maint show test-settings
37828 @item maint set test-settings @var{kind}
37829 @itemx maint show test-settings @var{kind}
37830 These are representative commands for each @var{kind} of setting type
37831 @value{GDBN} supports. They are used by the testsuite for exercising
37832 the settings infrastructure.
37833
37834 @kindex maint with
37835 @item maint with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
37836 Like the @code{with} command, but works with @code{maintenance set}
37837 variables. This is used by the testsuite to exercise the @code{with}
37838 command's infrastructure.
37839
37840 @end table
37841
37842 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
37843 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
37844
37845 @table @code
37846 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
37847 @kindex set watchdog
37848 @cindex watchdog timer
37849 @cindex timeout for commands
37850 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
37851 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
37852 reports and error and the command is aborted.
37853
37854 @item show watchdog
37855 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
37856 @end table
37857
37858 @node Remote Protocol
37859 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
37860
37861 @menu
37862 * Overview::
37863 * Packets::
37864 * Stop Reply Packets::
37865 * General Query Packets::
37866 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
37867 * Tracepoint Packets::
37868 * Host I/O Packets::
37869 * Interrupts::
37870 * Notification Packets::
37871 * Remote Non-Stop::
37872 * Packet Acknowledgment::
37873 * Examples::
37874 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
37875 * Library List Format::
37876 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
37877 * Memory Map Format::
37878 * Thread List Format::
37879 * Traceframe Info Format::
37880 * Branch Trace Format::
37881 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
37882 @end menu
37883
37884 @node Overview
37885 @section Overview
37886
37887 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
37888 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
37889 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
37890 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
37891
37892 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
37893 transmitted and received data, respectively.
37894
37895 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
37896 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
37897 @cindex remote serial protocol
37898 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
37899 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
37900 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
37901 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
37902 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
37903
37904 @smallexample
37905 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37906 @end smallexample
37907 @noindent
37908
37909 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
37910 @noindent
37911 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
37912 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
37913 eight bit unsigned checksum).
37914
37915 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
37916 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
37917
37918 @smallexample
37919 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37920 @end smallexample
37921
37922 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
37923 @noindent
37924 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
37925 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
37926 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
37927
37928 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
37929 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37930 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
37931 retransmission):
37932
37933 @smallexample
37934 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37935 <- @code{+}
37936 @end smallexample
37937 @noindent
37938
37939 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37940 once a connection is established.
37941 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37942
37943 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37944 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37945 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37946 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37947 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37948 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37949 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37950
37951 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37952 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37953 exceptions).
37954
37955 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37956 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37957 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37958 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37959
37960 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37961 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37962 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37963
37964 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37965 @anchor{Binary Data}
37966 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37967 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37968 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37969 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37970 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37971 binary data.
37972
37973 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37974 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37975 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37976 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37977 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37978 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37979 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37980 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37981 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37982 (described next).
37983
37984 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37985 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37986 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37987 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37988 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37989 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37990 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37991 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37992 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37993 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37994 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37995 3}} more times.
37996
37997 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37998 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37999 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
38000 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
38001 @samp{0*"00}.
38002
38003 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
38004 error number. That number is not well defined.
38005
38006 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
38007 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
38008 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
38009 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
38010 on that response.
38011
38012 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
38013 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
38014 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
38015 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
38016 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
38017 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
38018
38019 @node Packets
38020 @section Packets
38021
38022 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
38023 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
38024 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
38025 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
38026
38027 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
38028 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
38029 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
38030 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
38031 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
38032 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
38033 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
38034 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
38035 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
38036 @var{baz}.
38037
38038 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
38039 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
38040 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
38041 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
38042 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
38043 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
38044 pick any thread.
38045
38046 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
38047 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
38048 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
38049 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
38050 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
38051 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
38052 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
38053 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
38054 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
38055 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
38056 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
38057 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
38058 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
38059
38060 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
38061 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
38062 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
38063 more information.
38064
38065 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
38066 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
38067
38068 Here are the packet descriptions.
38069
38070 @table @samp
38071
38072 @item !
38073 @cindex @samp{!} packet
38074 @anchor{extended mode}
38075 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
38076 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
38077 debugged.
38078
38079 Reply:
38080 @table @samp
38081 @item OK
38082 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
38083 @end table
38084
38085 @item ?
38086 @cindex @samp{?} packet
38087 @anchor{? packet}
38088 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
38089 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
38090 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38091
38092 Reply:
38093 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38094
38095 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
38096 @cindex @samp{A} packet
38097 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
38098 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
38099 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
38100
38101 Reply:
38102 @table @samp
38103 @item OK
38104 The arguments were set.
38105 @item E @var{NN}
38106 An error occurred.
38107 @end table
38108
38109 @item b @var{baud}
38110 @cindex @samp{b} packet
38111 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
38112 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
38113
38114 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
38115 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
38116 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
38117
38118 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
38119 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
38120 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
38121 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
38122 of view, nothing actually happened.}
38123
38124 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
38125 @cindex @samp{B} packet
38126 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
38127 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
38128
38129 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
38130 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
38131
38132 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
38133 @anchor{bc}
38134 @item bc
38135 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
38136 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38137
38138 Reply:
38139 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38140
38141 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
38142 @anchor{bs}
38143 @item bs
38144 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
38145 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38146
38147 Reply:
38148 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38149
38150 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38151 @cindex @samp{c} packet
38152 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
38153 is omitted, resume at current address.
38154
38155 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38156 packet}.
38157
38158 Reply:
38159 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38160
38161 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38162 @cindex @samp{C} packet
38163 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
38164 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
38165
38166 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38167 packet}.
38168
38169 Reply:
38170 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38171
38172 @item d
38173 @cindex @samp{d} packet
38174 Toggle debug flag.
38175
38176 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
38177 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
38178
38179 @item D
38180 @itemx D;@var{pid}
38181 @cindex @samp{D} packet
38182 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
38183 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
38184 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
38185
38186 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
38187 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
38188 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
38189 big-endian hex string.
38190
38191 Reply:
38192 @table @samp
38193 @item OK
38194 for success
38195 @item E @var{NN}
38196 for an error
38197 @end table
38198
38199 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
38200 @cindex @samp{F} packet
38201 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
38202 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
38203 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
38204
38205 @item g
38206 @anchor{read registers packet}
38207 @cindex @samp{g} packet
38208 Read general registers.
38209
38210 Reply:
38211 @table @samp
38212 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38213 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
38214 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
38215 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
38216 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
38217 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
38218
38219 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
38220 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
38221 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
38222 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
38223 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
38224 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
38225 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
38226 have been collected, and both have zero value:
38227
38228 @smallexample
38229 -> @code{g}
38230 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
38231 @end smallexample
38232
38233 @item E @var{NN}
38234 for an error.
38235 @end table
38236
38237 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
38238 @cindex @samp{G} packet
38239 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
38240 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
38241
38242 Reply:
38243 @table @samp
38244 @item OK
38245 for success
38246 @item E @var{NN}
38247 for an error
38248 @end table
38249
38250 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
38251 @cindex @samp{H} packet
38252 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
38253 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
38254 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
38255 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
38256 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
38257 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
38258 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38259
38260 Reply:
38261 @table @samp
38262 @item OK
38263 for success
38264 @item E @var{NN}
38265 for an error
38266 @end table
38267
38268 @c FIXME: JTC:
38269 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
38270 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
38271 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
38272 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
38273 @c described. For example:
38274 @c
38275 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38276 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
38277 @c otherwise returns current registers.
38278 @c
38279 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38280 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
38281 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
38282
38283 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
38284 @anchor{cycle step packet}
38285 @cindex @samp{i} packet
38286 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
38287 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
38288 step starting at that address.
38289
38290 @item I
38291 @cindex @samp{I} packet
38292 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
38293 step packet}.
38294
38295 @item k
38296 @cindex @samp{k} packet
38297 Kill request.
38298
38299 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
38300
38301 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
38302 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
38303
38304 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
38305
38306 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
38307 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
38308 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
38309
38310 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
38311 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
38312 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
38313
38314 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
38315 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
38316 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
38317 (@pxref{? packet}).
38318
38319 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
38320 @cindex @samp{m} packet
38321 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38322 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
38323 any particular boundary.
38324
38325 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
38326 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
38327 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
38328 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
38329 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
38330 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
38331 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
38332 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
38333
38334 Reply:
38335 @table @samp
38336 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38337 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38338 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
38339 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
38340 @item E @var{NN}
38341 @var{NN} is errno
38342 @end table
38343
38344 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38345 @cindex @samp{M} packet
38346 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38347 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
38348 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38349
38350 Reply:
38351 @table @samp
38352 @item OK
38353 for success
38354 @item E @var{NN}
38355 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
38356 written).
38357 @end table
38358
38359 @item p @var{n}
38360 @cindex @samp{p} packet
38361 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
38362 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
38363 register value is encoded.
38364
38365 Reply:
38366 @table @samp
38367 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38368 the register's value
38369 @item E @var{NN}
38370 for an error
38371 @item @w{}
38372 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
38373 @end table
38374
38375 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
38376 @anchor{write register packet}
38377 @cindex @samp{P} packet
38378 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
38379 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
38380 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
38381
38382 Reply:
38383 @table @samp
38384 @item OK
38385 for success
38386 @item E @var{NN}
38387 for an error
38388 @end table
38389
38390 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38391 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38392 @cindex @samp{q} packet
38393 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
38394 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
38395 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
38396
38397 @item r
38398 @cindex @samp{r} packet
38399 Reset the entire system.
38400
38401 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
38402
38403 @item R @var{XX}
38404 @cindex @samp{R} packet
38405 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
38406 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38407
38408 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
38409
38410 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38411 @cindex @samp{s} packet
38412 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
38413 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
38414
38415 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38416 packet}.
38417
38418 Reply:
38419 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38420
38421 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38422 @anchor{step with signal packet}
38423 @cindex @samp{S} packet
38424 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
38425 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
38426
38427 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38428 packet}.
38429
38430 Reply:
38431 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38432
38433 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
38434 @cindex @samp{t} packet
38435 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
38436 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
38437 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
38438
38439 @item T @var{thread-id}
38440 @cindex @samp{T} packet
38441 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38442
38443 Reply:
38444 @table @samp
38445 @item OK
38446 thread is still alive
38447 @item E @var{NN}
38448 thread is dead
38449 @end table
38450
38451 @item v
38452 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
38453 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
38454
38455 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
38456 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
38457 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
38458 The process ID is a
38459 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
38460 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
38461 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
38462
38463 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
38464 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
38465 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
38466 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
38467 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
38468 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
38469 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
38470 @c stopping or restarting threads.
38471
38472 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38473
38474 Reply:
38475 @table @samp
38476 @item E @var{nn}
38477 for an error
38478 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38479 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38480 @item OK
38481 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
38482 @end table
38483
38484 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
38485 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
38486 @anchor{vCont packet}
38487 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
38488
38489 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
38490 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
38491 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
38492 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
38493 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
38494 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
38495 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
38496 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
38497 error.
38498
38499 Currently supported actions are:
38500
38501 @table @samp
38502 @item c
38503 Continue.
38504 @item C @var{sig}
38505 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38506 @item s
38507 Step.
38508 @item S @var{sig}
38509 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38510 @item t
38511 Stop.
38512 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
38513 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
38514 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
38515 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
38516 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
38517 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
38518
38519 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
38520 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
38521 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
38522 jumps to @var{start}).
38523
38524 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
38525 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
38526 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
38527
38528 @end table
38529
38530 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
38531 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
38532 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
38533
38534 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
38535 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
38536 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
38537 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
38538 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
38539 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
38540 as an implementation detail.
38541
38542 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
38543 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
38544 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
38545 stopped.
38546
38547 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
38548 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
38549 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
38550
38551 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
38552 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
38553
38554 Reply:
38555 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38556
38557 @item vCont?
38558 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
38559 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
38560
38561 Reply:
38562 @table @samp
38563 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
38564 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
38565 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
38566 @item @w{}
38567 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
38568 @end table
38569
38570 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
38571 @item vCtrlC
38572 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
38573 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
38574 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
38575 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
38576 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
38577 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
38578 variant.
38579
38580 Reply:
38581 @table @samp
38582 @item E @var{nn}
38583 for an error
38584 @item OK
38585 for success
38586 @end table
38587
38588 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
38589 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
38590 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
38591 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
38592
38593 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
38594 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
38595 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
38596 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
38597 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
38598 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
38599 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
38600 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
38601 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38602 packet is received.
38603
38604 Reply:
38605 @table @samp
38606 @item OK
38607 for success
38608 @item E @var{NN}
38609 for an error
38610 @end table
38611
38612 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38613 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
38614 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
38615 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
38616 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
38617 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
38618 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
38619 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
38620 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
38621 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
38622 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
38623 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
38624
38625
38626 Reply:
38627 @table @samp
38628 @item OK
38629 for success
38630 @item E.memtype
38631 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
38632 @item E @var{NN}
38633 for an error
38634 @end table
38635
38636 @item vFlashDone
38637 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
38638 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
38639 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
38640 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
38641 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
38642 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38643 request is completed.
38644
38645 @item vKill;@var{pid}
38646 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
38647 @anchor{vKill packet}
38648 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
38649 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
38650 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
38651 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
38652
38653 Reply:
38654 @table @samp
38655 @item E @var{nn}
38656 for an error
38657 @item OK
38658 for success
38659 @end table
38660
38661 @item vMustReplyEmpty
38662 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
38663 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
38664 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
38665 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
38666
38667 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
38668 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
38669 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
38670 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
38671 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
38672 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
38673
38674 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
38675 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
38676 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
38677 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
38678 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
38679 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
38680 state.
38681
38682 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
38683
38684 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38685
38686 Reply:
38687 @table @samp
38688 @item E @var{nn}
38689 for an error
38690 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38691 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38692 @end table
38693
38694 @item vStopped
38695 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
38696 @xref{Notification Packets}.
38697
38698 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38699 @anchor{X packet}
38700 @cindex @samp{X} packet
38701 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
38702 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
38703 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
38704 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38705
38706 Reply:
38707 @table @samp
38708 @item OK
38709 for success
38710 @item E @var{NN}
38711 for an error
38712 @end table
38713
38714 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38715 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38716 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
38717 @cindex @samp{z} packet
38718 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
38719 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
38720 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
38721
38722 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
38723 separately.
38724
38725 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
38726 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
38727 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
38728 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
38729 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
38730 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
38731
38732 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38733 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38734 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
38735 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
38736 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
38737 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
38738
38739 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
38740 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
38741 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
38742 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
38743 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
38744 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
38745 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
38746 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
38747 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
38748 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
38749 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
38750 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
38751 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38752
38753 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
38754 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
38755
38756 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
38757 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
38758
38759 @table @samp
38760
38761 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38762 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38763 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
38764
38765 @end table
38766
38767 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
38768 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38769 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
38770 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
38771 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
38772 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
38773 separators. Each expression has the following form:
38774
38775 @table @samp
38776
38777 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38778 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38779 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
38780
38781 @end table
38782
38783 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
38784 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
38785 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
38786 target, is not defined.}
38787
38788 Reply:
38789 @table @samp
38790 @item OK
38791 success
38792 @item @w{}
38793 not supported
38794 @item E @var{NN}
38795 for an error
38796 @end table
38797
38798 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38799 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38800 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
38801 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
38802 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
38803 address @var{addr}.
38804
38805 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
38806 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
38807 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
38808 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
38809
38810 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
38811 movement.}
38812
38813 Reply:
38814 @table @samp
38815 @item OK
38816 success
38817 @item @w{}
38818 not supported
38819 @item E @var{NN}
38820 for an error
38821 @end table
38822
38823 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38824 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38825 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
38826 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
38827 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38828 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38829
38830 Reply:
38831 @table @samp
38832 @item OK
38833 success
38834 @item @w{}
38835 not supported
38836 @item E @var{NN}
38837 for an error
38838 @end table
38839
38840 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38841 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38842 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
38843 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
38844 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38845 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38846
38847 Reply:
38848 @table @samp
38849 @item OK
38850 success
38851 @item @w{}
38852 not supported
38853 @item E @var{NN}
38854 for an error
38855 @end table
38856
38857 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38858 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38859 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
38860 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
38861 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38862 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38863
38864 Reply:
38865 @table @samp
38866 @item OK
38867 success
38868 @item @w{}
38869 not supported
38870 @item E @var{NN}
38871 for an error
38872 @end table
38873
38874 @end table
38875
38876 @node Stop Reply Packets
38877 @section Stop Reply Packets
38878 @cindex stop reply packets
38879
38880 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
38881 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
38882 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
38883 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
38884 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
38885 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
38886 @value{GDBN} source code.
38887
38888 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
38889 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
38890 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38891
38892 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
38893 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
38894 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
38895 components.
38896
38897 @table @samp
38898
38899 @item S @var{AA}
38900 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38901 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
38902 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
38903
38904 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
38905 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
38906 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38907 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
38908 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
38909 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
38910 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
38911 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
38912
38913 @itemize @bullet
38914 @item
38915 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
38916 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
38917 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
38918 two-digit hex number.
38919
38920 @item
38921 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
38922 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38923
38924 @item
38925 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
38926 the core on which the stop event was detected.
38927
38928 @item
38929 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
38930 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
38931 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
38932 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
38933
38934 @item
38935 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
38936 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
38937 future.
38938 @end itemize
38939
38940 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38941
38942 @table @samp
38943 @item watch
38944 @itemx rwatch
38945 @itemx awatch
38946 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38947 hex.
38948
38949 @item syscall_entry
38950 @itemx syscall_return
38951 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
38952 syscall number, in hex.
38953
38954 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38955 @item library
38956 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38957 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38958 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
38959
38960 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38961 @item replaylog
38962 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38963 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38964 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38965 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38966 for more information.
38967
38968 @item swbreak
38969 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
38970 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
38971 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
38972 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
38973 part must be left empty.
38974
38975 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
38976 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
38977 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
38978 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
38979 address.
38980
38981 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38982 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38983 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38984 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38985 indicating support.
38986
38987 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
38988
38989 @item hwbreak
38990 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
38991 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
38992
38993 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
38994 apply.
38995
38996 @cindex fork events, remote reply
38997 @item fork
38998 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
38999 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39000 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39001 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39002 fork events.
39003
39004 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39005 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39006 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39007 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39008 indicating support.
39009
39010 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
39011 @item vfork
39012 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
39013 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39014 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39015 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39016 vfork events.
39017
39018 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39019 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39020 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39021 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39022 indicating support.
39023
39024 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
39025 @item vforkdone
39026 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
39027 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
39028 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
39029 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
39030 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
39031
39032 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39033 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39034 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39035 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39036 indicating support.
39037
39038 @cindex exec events, remote reply
39039 @item exec
39040 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
39041 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
39042 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
39043
39044 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39045 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39046 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39047 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39048 indicating support.
39049
39050 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
39051 @anchor{thread create event}
39052 @item create
39053 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
39054 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
39055 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
39056 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
39057 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
39058 @var{r} part is ignored.
39059
39060 @end table
39061
39062 @item W @var{AA}
39063 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39064 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
39065 applicable to certain targets.
39066
39067 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39068 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39069 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39070 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39071 hex strings.
39072
39073 @item X @var{AA}
39074 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39075 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
39076
39077 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39078 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39079 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39080 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39081 hex strings.
39082
39083 @anchor{thread exit event}
39084 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
39085 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
39086
39087 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
39088 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
39089 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
39090 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
39091
39092 @item N
39093 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
39094 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
39095 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
39096 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
39097 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
39098 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
39099 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
39100 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
39101 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
39102 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
39103 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
39104 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
39105 support.
39106
39107 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
39108 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
39109 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
39110 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
39111 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
39112
39113 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
39114 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
39115 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
39116 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
39117 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
39118 system calls.
39119
39120 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
39121 this very system call.
39122
39123 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
39124 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
39125 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
39126 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39127 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
39128 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
39129
39130 @end table
39131
39132 @node General Query Packets
39133 @section General Query Packets
39134 @cindex remote query requests
39135
39136 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
39137 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
39138 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
39139 sending information to and from the stub.
39140
39141 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
39142 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
39143 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
39144 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
39145 conventions:
39146
39147 @itemize @bullet
39148 @item
39149 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
39150 @item
39151 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
39152 letter.
39153 @item
39154 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
39155 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
39156 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
39157 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
39158 @end itemize
39159
39160 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
39161 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
39162 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
39163 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
39164 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
39165 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
39166 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
39167 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
39168 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
39169 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
39170 packet.}.
39171
39172 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
39173 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
39174 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
39175 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
39176 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
39177
39178 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
39179
39180 @table @samp
39181
39182 @item QAgent:1
39183 @itemx QAgent:0
39184 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
39185 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
39186
39187 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
39188 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
39189 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
39190 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
39191 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
39192 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
39193 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
39194 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
39195 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
39196 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
39197 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
39198
39199 @item qC
39200 @cindex current thread, remote request
39201 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
39202 Return the current thread ID.
39203
39204 Reply:
39205 @table @samp
39206 @item QC @var{thread-id}
39207 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
39208 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39209 @item @r{(anything else)}
39210 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
39211 @end table
39212
39213 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
39214 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
39215 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
39216 @anchor{qCRC packet}
39217 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
39218 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
39219 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
39220 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
39221
39222 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
39223 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
39224 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
39225 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
39226 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
39227 detect trailing zeros.
39228
39229 Reply:
39230 @table @samp
39231 @item E @var{NN}
39232 An error (such as memory fault)
39233 @item C @var{crc32}
39234 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
39235 @end table
39236
39237 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
39238 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
39239 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
39240 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
39241 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
39242 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
39243 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
39244 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
39245 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
39246 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
39247 randomization.
39248
39249 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39250
39251 Reply:
39252 @table @samp
39253 @item OK
39254 The request succeeded.
39255
39256 @item E @var{nn}
39257 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39258
39259 @item @w{}
39260 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
39261 by the stub.
39262 @end table
39263
39264 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39265 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39266 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
39267 address space randomization.
39268
39269 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
39270 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
39271 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
39272 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
39273 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
39274 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
39275 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
39276 inferior using a shell or not.
39277
39278 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
39279 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
39280 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
39281 values are considered an error.
39282
39283 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39284 mode}).
39285
39286 Reply:
39287 @table @samp
39288 @item OK
39289 The request succeeded.
39290
39291 @item E @var{nn}
39292 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39293 @end table
39294
39295 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39296 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39297 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39298 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
39299
39300 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
39301 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
39302
39303 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
39304 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39305 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
39306 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
39307 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
39308 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
39309 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
39310 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
39311 environment}).
39312
39313 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39314 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
39315 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
39316 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
39317 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
39318 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
39319 not be present.
39320
39321 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39322 mode}).
39323
39324 Reply:
39325 @table @samp
39326 @item OK
39327 The request succeeded.
39328 @end table
39329
39330 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39331 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39332 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39333 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39334 inferior.
39335
39336 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
39337 @pxref{set environment}.
39338
39339 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
39340 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
39341 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
39342 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
39343 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
39344 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
39345 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
39346 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
39347
39348 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39349 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
39350
39351 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39352 mode}).
39353
39354 Reply:
39355 @table @samp
39356 @item OK
39357 The request succeeded.
39358 @end table
39359
39360 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39361 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39362 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39363 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39364 inferior.
39365
39366 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
39367 @pxref{unset environment}.
39368
39369 @item QEnvironmentReset
39370 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
39371 @cindex reset environment, remote request
39372 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
39373 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
39374 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
39375 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
39376 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
39377 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
39378 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39379 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
39380 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
39381
39382 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39383 mode}).
39384
39385 Reply:
39386 @table @samp
39387 @item OK
39388 The request succeeded.
39389 @end table
39390
39391 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39392 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39393 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39394 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39395 inferior.
39396
39397 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
39398 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
39399 @cindex set working directory, remote request
39400 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
39401 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
39402 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
39403
39404 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
39405 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
39406 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
39407 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
39408 directory to its original, empty value.
39409
39410 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39411 mode}).
39412
39413 Reply:
39414 @table @samp
39415 @item OK
39416 The request succeeded.
39417 @end table
39418
39419 @item qfThreadInfo
39420 @itemx qsThreadInfo
39421 @cindex list active threads, remote request
39422 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
39423 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
39424 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
39425 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
39426 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
39427 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
39428 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
39429 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
39430
39431 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
39432
39433 Reply:
39434 @table @samp
39435 @item m @var{thread-id}
39436 A single thread ID
39437 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
39438 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
39439 @item l
39440 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39441 @end table
39442
39443 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39444 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
39445 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
39446 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
39447 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
39448 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39449 fields.
39450
39451 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
39452 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
39453 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
39454 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
39455 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
39456
39457 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
39458 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
39459 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
39460 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
39461 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
39462
39463 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
39464 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
39465
39466 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
39467 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
39468 information associated with the variable.)
39469
39470 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
39471 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
39472 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
39473 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
39474 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
39475 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
39476
39477 Reply:
39478 @table @samp
39479 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39480 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
39481 local storage requested.
39482
39483 @item E @var{nn}
39484 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39485
39486 @item @w{}
39487 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39488 @end table
39489
39490 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
39491 @cindex get thread information block address
39492 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
39493 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
39494
39495 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
39496
39497 Reply:
39498 @table @samp
39499 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39500 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
39501 thread information block.
39502
39503 @item E @var{nn}
39504 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
39505 address could not be retrieved.
39506
39507 @item @w{}
39508 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39509 @end table
39510
39511 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
39512 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
39513 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
39514 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
39515 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
39516 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
39517 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
39518
39519 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
39520
39521 Reply:
39522 @table @samp
39523 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
39524 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
39525 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
39526 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
39527 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
39528 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
39529 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
39530 @end table
39531
39532 @item qOffsets
39533 @cindex section offsets, remote request
39534 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
39535 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
39536 image.
39537
39538 Reply:
39539 @table @samp
39540 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
39541 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
39542 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
39543 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
39544 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
39545 segments by the supplied offsets.
39546
39547 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
39548 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
39549 to the @code{Bss} section.}
39550
39551 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
39552 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
39553 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
39554 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
39555 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
39556 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
39557 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
39558 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
39559 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
39560 @end table
39561
39562 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
39563 @cindex thread information, remote request
39564 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
39565 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
39566 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
39567 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
39568
39569 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
39570 (see below).
39571
39572 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
39573
39574 @item QNonStop:1
39575 @itemx QNonStop:0
39576 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
39577 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
39578 @anchor{QNonStop}
39579 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
39580 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
39581
39582 Reply:
39583 @table @samp
39584 @item OK
39585 The request succeeded.
39586
39587 @item E @var{nn}
39588 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39589
39590 @item @w{}
39591 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
39592 the stub.
39593 @end table
39594
39595 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39596 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39597 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
39598 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
39599
39600 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
39601 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
39602 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
39603 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39604 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
39605 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
39606 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
39607
39608 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
39609 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
39610 is listed, every system call should be reported.
39611
39612 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
39613 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
39614 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
39615 report the requested syscalls.
39616
39617 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
39618 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39619
39620 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
39621 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
39622 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
39623 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
39624
39625 Reply:
39626 @table @samp
39627 @item OK
39628 The request succeeded.
39629
39630 @item E @var{nn}
39631 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39632
39633 @item @w{}
39634 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
39635 the stub.
39636 @end table
39637
39638 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
39639 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
39640 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39641 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39642
39643 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39644 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
39645 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39646 @anchor{QPassSignals}
39647 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
39648 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39649 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39650 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
39651 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
39652 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
39653 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
39654 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
39655 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
39656
39657 Reply:
39658 @table @samp
39659 @item OK
39660 The request succeeded.
39661
39662 @item E @var{nn}
39663 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39664
39665 @item @w{}
39666 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
39667 the stub.
39668 @end table
39669
39670 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
39671 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
39672 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39673 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39674
39675 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39676 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
39677 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
39678 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
39679 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
39680 Others should be silently discarded.
39681
39682 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
39683 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
39684 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
39685 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
39686 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
39687 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
39688 signals.
39689
39690 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
39691 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
39692
39693 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39694 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39695 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
39696 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
39697 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39698
39699 Reply:
39700 @table @samp
39701 @item OK
39702 The request succeeded.
39703
39704 @item E @var{nn}
39705 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39706
39707 @item @w{}
39708 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
39709 by the stub.
39710 @end table
39711
39712 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
39713 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
39714 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39715 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39716
39717 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
39718 @item QThreadEvents:1
39719 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
39720 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
39721 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
39722
39723 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
39724 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
39725 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
39726 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
39727 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
39728 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
39729 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
39730 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
39731 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
39732 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39733
39734 Reply:
39735 @table @samp
39736 @item OK
39737 The request succeeded.
39738
39739 @item E @var{nn}
39740 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39741
39742 @item @w{}
39743 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
39744 the stub.
39745 @end table
39746
39747 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
39748 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
39749
39750 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
39751 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
39752 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
39753 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
39754 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
39755 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
39756 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
39757 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
39758 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
39759
39760 Reply:
39761 @table @samp
39762 @item OK
39763 A command response with no output.
39764 @item @var{OUTPUT}
39765 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
39766 @item E @var{NN}
39767 Indicate a badly formed request.
39768 @item @w{}
39769 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
39770 @end table
39771
39772 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
39773 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39774 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39775 packets.)
39776
39777 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
39778 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
39779 @ifnotinfo
39780 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
39781 @end ifnotinfo
39782 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
39783 @anchor{qSearch memory}
39784 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
39785 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
39786 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
39787
39788 Reply:
39789 @table @samp
39790 @item 0
39791 The pattern was not found.
39792 @item 1,address
39793 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
39794 @item E @var{NN}
39795 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
39796 @item @w{}
39797 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
39798 @end table
39799
39800 @item QStartNoAckMode
39801 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
39802 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
39803 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
39804 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
39805
39806 Reply:
39807 @table @samp
39808 @item OK
39809 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
39810 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
39811 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
39812 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
39813 @item @w{}
39814 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
39815 @end table
39816
39817 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
39818 @cindex supported packets, remote query
39819 @cindex features of the remote protocol
39820 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
39821 @anchor{qSupported}
39822 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
39823 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
39824 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
39825 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
39826 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
39827 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
39828 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
39829 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
39830 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
39831 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
39832 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
39833 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
39834 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
39835 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
39836
39837 Reply:
39838 @table @samp
39839 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
39840 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
39841 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
39842 possible forms).
39843 @item @w{}
39844 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
39845 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
39846 @end table
39847
39848 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
39849 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
39850 are:
39851
39852 @table @samp
39853 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
39854 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
39855 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
39856 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
39857 @item @var{name}+
39858 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
39859 need an associated value.
39860 @item @var{name}-
39861 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
39862 @item @var{name}?
39863 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
39864 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
39865 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
39866 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
39867 @end table
39868
39869 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
39870 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
39871 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
39872 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
39873 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
39874
39875 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
39876 are defined:
39877
39878 @table @samp
39879 @item multiprocess
39880 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
39881 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39882 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39883 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39884 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
39885
39886 @item xmlRegisters
39887 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
39888 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
39889 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
39890 description.
39891
39892 @item qRelocInsn
39893 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
39894 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39895 instruction reply packet}).
39896
39897 @item swbreak
39898 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
39899 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39900
39901 @item hwbreak
39902 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
39903 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39904
39905 @item fork-events
39906 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
39907 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39908 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39909 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39910
39911 @item vfork-events
39912 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
39913 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39914 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39915 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39916
39917 @item exec-events
39918 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
39919 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39920 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39921 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39922
39923 @item vContSupported
39924 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
39925 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
39926 @end table
39927
39928 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
39929 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
39930 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
39931 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
39932 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
39933 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
39934 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
39935 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
39936 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
39937 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
39938 all the features it supports.
39939
39940 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39941 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39942
39943 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39944 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39945 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39946 form response.
39947
39948 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39949 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39950 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39951 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39952
39953 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39954 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39955 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39956 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39957 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39958
39959 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39960
39961 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39962 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39963 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39964 @item Feature Name
39965 @tab Value Required
39966 @tab Default
39967 @tab Probe Allowed
39968
39969 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39970 @tab Yes
39971 @tab @samp{-}
39972 @tab No
39973
39974 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39975 @tab No
39976 @tab @samp{-}
39977 @tab Yes
39978
39979 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39980 @tab No
39981 @tab @samp{-}
39982 @tab Yes
39983
39984 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39985 @tab No
39986 @tab @samp{-}
39987 @tab Yes
39988
39989 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
39990 @tab No
39991 @tab @samp{-}
39992 @tab Yes
39993
39994 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39995 @tab No
39996 @tab @samp{-}
39997 @tab Yes
39998
39999 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40000 @tab No
40001 @tab @samp{-}
40002 @tab Yes
40003
40004 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
40005 @tab No
40006 @tab @samp{-}
40007 @tab Yes
40008
40009 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
40010 @tab No
40011 @tab @samp{-}
40012 @tab No
40013
40014 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40015 @tab No
40016 @tab @samp{-}
40017 @tab Yes
40018
40019 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
40020 @tab No
40021 @tab @samp{-}
40022 @tab Yes
40023
40024 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
40025 @tab No
40026 @tab @samp{-}
40027 @tab Yes
40028
40029 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
40030 @tab No
40031 @tab @samp{-}
40032 @tab Yes
40033
40034 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
40035 @tab No
40036 @tab @samp{-}
40037 @tab Yes
40038
40039 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
40040 @tab No
40041 @tab @samp{-}
40042 @tab Yes
40043
40044 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
40045 @tab No
40046 @tab @samp{-}
40047 @tab Yes
40048
40049 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40050 @tab No
40051 @tab @samp{-}
40052 @tab Yes
40053
40054 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40055 @tab No
40056 @tab @samp{-}
40057 @tab Yes
40058
40059 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40060 @tab No
40061 @tab @samp{-}
40062 @tab Yes
40063
40064 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
40065 @tab Yes
40066 @tab @samp{-}
40067 @tab Yes
40068
40069 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
40070 @tab Yes
40071 @tab @samp{-}
40072 @tab Yes
40073
40074 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
40075 @tab Yes
40076 @tab @samp{-}
40077 @tab Yes
40078
40079 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
40080 @tab Yes
40081 @tab @samp{-}
40082 @tab Yes
40083
40084 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
40085 @tab Yes
40086 @tab @samp{-}
40087 @tab Yes
40088
40089 @item @samp{QNonStop}
40090 @tab No
40091 @tab @samp{-}
40092 @tab Yes
40093
40094 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
40095 @tab No
40096 @tab @samp{-}
40097 @tab Yes
40098
40099 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
40100 @tab No
40101 @tab @samp{-}
40102 @tab Yes
40103
40104 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
40105 @tab No
40106 @tab @samp{-}
40107 @tab Yes
40108
40109 @item @samp{multiprocess}
40110 @tab No
40111 @tab @samp{-}
40112 @tab No
40113
40114 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
40115 @tab No
40116 @tab @samp{-}
40117 @tab No
40118
40119 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
40120 @tab No
40121 @tab @samp{-}
40122 @tab No
40123
40124 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
40125 @tab No
40126 @tab @samp{-}
40127 @tab No
40128
40129 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
40130 @tab No
40131 @tab @samp{-}
40132 @tab No
40133
40134 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
40135 @tab No
40136 @tab @samp{-}
40137 @tab No
40138
40139 @item @samp{QAgent}
40140 @tab No
40141 @tab @samp{-}
40142 @tab No
40143
40144 @item @samp{QAllow}
40145 @tab No
40146 @tab @samp{-}
40147 @tab No
40148
40149 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
40150 @tab No
40151 @tab @samp{-}
40152 @tab No
40153
40154 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
40155 @tab No
40156 @tab @samp{-}
40157 @tab No
40158
40159 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
40160 @tab No
40161 @tab @samp{-}
40162 @tab No
40163
40164 @item @samp{tracenz}
40165 @tab No
40166 @tab @samp{-}
40167 @tab No
40168
40169 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
40170 @tab No
40171 @tab @samp{-}
40172 @tab No
40173
40174 @item @samp{swbreak}
40175 @tab No
40176 @tab @samp{-}
40177 @tab No
40178
40179 @item @samp{hwbreak}
40180 @tab No
40181 @tab @samp{-}
40182 @tab No
40183
40184 @item @samp{fork-events}
40185 @tab No
40186 @tab @samp{-}
40187 @tab No
40188
40189 @item @samp{vfork-events}
40190 @tab No
40191 @tab @samp{-}
40192 @tab No
40193
40194 @item @samp{exec-events}
40195 @tab No
40196 @tab @samp{-}
40197 @tab No
40198
40199 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
40200 @tab No
40201 @tab @samp{-}
40202 @tab No
40203
40204 @item @samp{no-resumed}
40205 @tab No
40206 @tab @samp{-}
40207 @tab No
40208
40209 @end multitable
40210
40211 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
40212
40213 @table @samp
40214 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
40215 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
40216 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
40217 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
40218 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
40219 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
40220 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
40221 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
40222 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
40223 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
40224
40225 @item qXfer:auxv:read
40226 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
40227 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
40228
40229 @item qXfer:btrace:read
40230 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40231 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
40232
40233 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
40234 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40235 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
40236
40237 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
40238 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
40239 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
40240
40241 @item qXfer:features:read
40242 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
40243 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
40244
40245 @item qXfer:libraries:read
40246 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
40247 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
40248
40249 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
40250 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40251 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40252
40253 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
40254 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
40255 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40256 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40257
40258 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
40259 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
40260 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
40261
40262 @item qXfer:sdata:read
40263 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
40264 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
40265
40266 @item qXfer:spu:read
40267 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
40268 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
40269
40270 @item qXfer:spu:write
40271 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
40272 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
40273
40274 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
40275 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
40276 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
40277
40278 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
40279 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
40280 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
40281
40282 @item qXfer:threads:read
40283 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40284 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
40285
40286 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
40287 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40288 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
40289
40290 @item qXfer:uib:read
40291 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40292 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
40293
40294 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
40295 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40296 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
40297
40298 @item QNonStop
40299 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
40300 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
40301
40302 @item QCatchSyscalls
40303 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
40304 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
40305
40306 @item QPassSignals
40307 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
40308 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
40309
40310 @item QStartNoAckMode
40311 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
40312 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
40313
40314 @item multiprocess
40315 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
40316 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
40317 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
40318 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
40319 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
40320 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
40321 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
40322 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
40323 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
40324 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
40325 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
40326
40327 @item qXfer:osdata:read
40328 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
40329 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
40330
40331 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
40332 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
40333 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
40334 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
40335
40336 @item ConditionalTracepoints
40337 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
40338 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
40339
40340 @item ReverseContinue
40341 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
40342 (@pxref{bc}).
40343
40344 @item ReverseStep
40345 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
40346 (@pxref{bs}).
40347
40348 @item TracepointSource
40349 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
40350 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
40351
40352 @item QAgent
40353 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
40354
40355 @item QAllow
40356 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
40357
40358 @item QDisableRandomization
40359 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
40360
40361 @item StaticTracepoint
40362 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
40363 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
40364
40365 @item InstallInTrace
40366 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
40367 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
40368
40369 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
40370 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
40371 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
40372 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
40373
40374 @item QTBuffer:size
40375 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
40376 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
40377
40378 @item tracenz
40379 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
40380 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
40381 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
40382
40383 @item BreakpointCommands
40384 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
40385 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
40386 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
40387
40388 @item Qbtrace:off
40389 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
40390
40391 @item Qbtrace:bts
40392 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
40393
40394 @item Qbtrace:pt
40395 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
40396
40397 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
40398 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
40399
40400 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
40401 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
40402
40403 @item swbreak
40404 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
40405 breakpoints.
40406
40407 @item hwbreak
40408 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
40409 breakpoints.
40410
40411 @item fork-events
40412 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
40413
40414 @item vfork-events
40415 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
40416 and vforkdone events.
40417
40418 @item exec-events
40419 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
40420
40421 @item vContSupported
40422 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
40423 @samp{vCont?} packet.
40424
40425 @item QThreadEvents
40426 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
40427
40428 @item no-resumed
40429 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
40430
40431 @end table
40432
40433 @item qSymbol::
40434 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
40435 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
40436 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
40437 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
40438
40439 Reply:
40440 @table @samp
40441 @item OK
40442 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40443 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40444 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
40445 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
40446 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
40447 below.
40448 @end table
40449
40450 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
40451 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
40452
40453 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
40454 target has previously requested.
40455
40456 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
40457 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
40458 will be empty.
40459
40460 Reply:
40461 @table @samp
40462 @item OK
40463 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40464 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40465 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
40466 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
40467 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
40468 @end table
40469
40470 @item qTBuffer
40471 @itemx QTBuffer
40472 @itemx QTDisconnected
40473 @itemx QTDP
40474 @itemx QTDPsrc
40475 @itemx QTDV
40476 @itemx qTfP
40477 @itemx qTfV
40478 @itemx QTFrame
40479 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
40480
40481 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40482
40483 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
40484 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
40485 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
40486 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
40487 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
40488 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
40489 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
40490 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
40491 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
40492 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
40493 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
40494
40495 Reply:
40496 @table @samp
40497 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
40498 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
40499 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
40500 the thread's attributes.
40501 @end table
40502
40503 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
40504 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
40505 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
40506 packets.)
40507
40508 @item QTNotes
40509 @itemx qTP
40510 @itemx QTSave
40511 @itemx qTsP
40512 @itemx qTsV
40513 @itemx QTStart
40514 @itemx QTStop
40515 @itemx QTEnable
40516 @itemx QTDisable
40517 @itemx QTinit
40518 @itemx QTro
40519 @itemx qTStatus
40520 @itemx qTV
40521 @itemx qTfSTM
40522 @itemx qTsSTM
40523 @itemx qTSTMat
40524 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40525
40526 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40527 @cindex read special object, remote request
40528 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
40529 @anchor{qXfer read}
40530 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
40531 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
40532 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
40533 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
40534 additional details about what data to access.
40535
40536 Reply:
40537 @table @samp
40538 @item m @var{data}
40539 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
40540 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
40541 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
40542 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
40543 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
40544 request.
40545
40546 @item l @var{data}
40547 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
40548 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
40549 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
40550
40551 @item l
40552 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
40553 There is no more data to be read.
40554
40555 @item E00
40556 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40557
40558 @item E @var{nn}
40559 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
40560 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40561
40562 @item @w{}
40563 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
40564 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
40565 @end table
40566
40567 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40568 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40569 formats, listed above.
40570
40571 @table @samp
40572 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40573 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
40574 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
40575 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
40576
40577 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40578 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40579
40580 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40581 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
40582
40583 Return a description of the current branch trace.
40584 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
40585 packet may have one of the following values:
40586
40587 @table @code
40588 @item all
40589 Returns all available branch trace.
40590
40591 @item new
40592 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
40593 the last read request.
40594
40595 @item delta
40596 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
40597 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
40598 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
40599 used to stitch traces together.
40600
40601 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
40602 @end table
40603
40604 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40605 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40606
40607 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40608 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
40609
40610 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
40611 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
40612
40613 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40614 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40615
40616 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40617 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
40618 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
40619 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
40620 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
40621 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
40622 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
40623
40624 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40625 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40626
40627 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40628 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
40629 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
40630 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
40631 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
40632
40633 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40634 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40635
40636 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40637 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
40638 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
40639 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40640 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40641
40642 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
40643 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
40644 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
40645
40646 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40647 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40648
40649 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40650 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
40651 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
40652 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
40653 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
40654 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
40655 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40656 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
40657
40658 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
40659 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
40660
40661 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40662 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40663
40664 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
40665 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
40666 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
40667 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
40668
40669 @table @code
40670 @item start=@var{address}
40671 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40672 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
40673 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
40674 chosen as the starting point.
40675
40676 @item prev=@var{address}
40677 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40678 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
40679 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
40680 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
40681 exists prior to the starting point.
40682
40683 @end table
40684
40685 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
40686 ignored.
40687
40688 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40689 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
40690 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
40691 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40692 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40693
40694 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40695 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40696
40697 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40698 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
40699
40700 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
40701 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
40702 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
40703 Action Lists}.
40704
40705 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40706 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40707 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40708
40709 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40710 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
40711 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
40712 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40713 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40714
40715 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40716 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40717 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40718
40719 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40720 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
40721 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40722 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
40723 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40724 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40725 in that context to be accessed.
40726
40727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40729 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40730
40731 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40732 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
40733 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
40734 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40735 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40736
40737 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40738 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40739
40740 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40741 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
40742
40743 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
40744 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
40745 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40746
40747 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40748 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40749
40750 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40751 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
40752
40753 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
40754 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
40755
40756 This packet is not probed by default.
40757
40758 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40759 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
40760 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
40761 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
40762 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
40763
40764 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40765 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40766
40767 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40768 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
40769 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
40770 @xref{Operating System Information}.
40771
40772 @end table
40773
40774 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40775 @cindex write data into object, remote request
40776 @anchor{qXfer write}
40777 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
40778 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
40779 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
40780 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
40781 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
40782 to access.
40783
40784 Reply:
40785 @table @samp
40786 @item @var{nn}
40787 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
40788 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
40789
40790 @item E00
40791 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40792
40793 @item E @var{nn}
40794 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
40795 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40796
40797 @item @w{}
40798 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
40799 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
40800 @end table
40801
40802 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40803 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40804 formats, listed above.
40805
40806 @table @samp
40807 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40808 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
40809 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
40810 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40811 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
40812
40813 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40814 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40815 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40816
40817 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40818 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
40819 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40820 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
40821 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40822 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40823 in that context to be accessed.
40824
40825 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40826 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40827 @end table
40828
40829 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
40830 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
40831 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
40832 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
40833 must respond with an empty packet.
40834
40835 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
40836 @cindex query attached, remote request
40837 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
40838 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
40839 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
40840 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
40841 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
40842 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
40843 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
40844
40845 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
40846 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
40847 the @code{quit} command.
40848
40849 Reply:
40850 @table @samp
40851 @item 1
40852 The remote server attached to an existing process.
40853 @item 0
40854 The remote server created a new process.
40855 @item E @var{NN}
40856 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40857 @end table
40858
40859 @item Qbtrace:bts
40860 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
40861
40862 Reply:
40863 @table @samp
40864 @item OK
40865 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40866 @item E.errtext
40867 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40868 @end table
40869
40870 @item Qbtrace:pt
40871 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
40872
40873 Reply:
40874 @table @samp
40875 @item OK
40876 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40877 @item E.errtext
40878 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40879 @end table
40880
40881 @item Qbtrace:off
40882 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
40883
40884 Reply:
40885 @table @samp
40886 @item OK
40887 Branch tracing has been disabled.
40888 @item E.errtext
40889 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40890 @end table
40891
40892 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
40893 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40894 btrace recording method in bts format.
40895
40896 Reply:
40897 @table @samp
40898 @item OK
40899 The ring buffer size has been set.
40900 @item E.errtext
40901 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40902 @end table
40903
40904 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
40905 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40906 btrace recording method in pt format.
40907
40908 Reply:
40909 @table @samp
40910 @item OK
40911 The ring buffer size has been set.
40912 @item E.errtext
40913 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40914 @end table
40915
40916 @end table
40917
40918 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40919 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40920
40921 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
40922 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
40923 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
40924
40925 @menu
40926 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
40927 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
40928 @end menu
40929
40930 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
40931 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
40932
40933 @menu
40934 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
40935 @end menu
40936
40937 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
40938 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
40939 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40940
40941 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40942
40943 @table @r
40944
40945 @item 2
40946 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40947
40948 @item 3
40949 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40950
40951 @item 4
40952 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40953
40954 @end table
40955
40956 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40957 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40958
40959 @menu
40960 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40961 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40962 @end menu
40963
40964 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40965 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40966 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40967
40968 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40969 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40970 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40971 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40972 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40973 most-significant -- least-significant.
40974
40975 @table @r
40976
40977 @item MIPS32
40978 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40979 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40980 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40981
40982 @item MIPS64
40983 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40984 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40985 as @code{MIPS32}.
40986
40987 @end table
40988
40989 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40990 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40991 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40992
40993 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40994
40995 @table @r
40996
40997 @item 2
40998 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40999
41000 @item 3
41001 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
41002
41003 @item 4
41004 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
41005
41006 @item 5
41007 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
41008
41009 @end table
41010
41011 @node Tracepoint Packets
41012 @section Tracepoint Packets
41013 @cindex tracepoint packets
41014 @cindex packets, tracepoint
41015
41016 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
41017 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
41018
41019 @table @samp
41020
41021 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
41022 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
41023 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
41024 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
41025 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
41026 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
41027 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
41028 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
41029 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
41030 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
41031 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
41032 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
41033 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
41034 actions.
41035
41036 Replies:
41037 @table @samp
41038 @item OK
41039 The packet was understood and carried out.
41040 @item qRelocInsn
41041 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41042 @item @w{}
41043 The packet was not recognized.
41044 @end table
41045
41046 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
41047 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
41048 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
41049 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
41050 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
41051 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
41052 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
41053
41054 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
41055 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
41056 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
41057 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
41058 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
41059 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
41060 tracepoint actions.
41061
41062 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
41063 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
41064 following forms:
41065
41066 @table @samp
41067
41068 @item R @var{mask}
41069 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
41070 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
41071 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
41072 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
41073 not fit in a 32-bit word.
41074
41075 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
41076 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
41077 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
41078 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
41079 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
41080 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
41081 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
41082
41083 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
41084 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
41085 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
41086 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
41087 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
41088 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
41089 packet).
41090
41091 @end table
41092
41093 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
41094 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
41095 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
41096 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
41097 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
41098 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
41099 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
41100 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
41101
41102 Replies:
41103 @table @samp
41104 @item OK
41105 The packet was understood and carried out.
41106 @item qRelocInsn
41107 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41108 @item @w{}
41109 The packet was not recognized.
41110 @end table
41111
41112 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
41113 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
41114 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
41115 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
41116 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
41117 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
41118 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
41119 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
41120
41121 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
41122 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
41123 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
41124 fit in a single packet.
41125 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
41126 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
41127
41128 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
41129 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
41130 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
41131 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
41132
41133 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
41134 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
41135 query packets.
41136
41137 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
41138 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
41139 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
41140 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
41141 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
41142 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
41143 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
41144 be found.
41145
41146 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
41147 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
41148 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
41149 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
41150 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
41151 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
41152 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
41153 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
41154 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
41155 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
41156 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
41157 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
41158 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
41159 variable.
41160
41161 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
41162 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
41163 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
41164 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
41165 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
41166
41167 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
41168 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
41169 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
41170 one of the following forms:
41171
41172 @table @samp
41173 @item F @var{f}
41174 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
41175 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
41176 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
41177
41178 @item T @var{t}
41179 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
41180 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
41181
41182 @end table
41183
41184 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
41185 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41186 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
41187 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
41188
41189 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
41190 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41191 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
41192 is a hexadecimal number.
41193
41194 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
41195 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41196 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
41197 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
41198 numbers.
41199
41200 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
41201 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
41202 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
41203
41204 @item qTMinFTPILen
41205 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
41206 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
41207 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
41208 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
41209 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
41210 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
41211 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
41212 arrange for that.
41213
41214 Replies:
41215
41216 @table @samp
41217 @item 0
41218 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
41219 @item @var{length}
41220 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
41221 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
41222 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
41223 regardless of size.
41224 @item E
41225 An error has occurred.
41226 @item @w{}
41227 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
41228 @end table
41229
41230 @item QTStart
41231 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
41232 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
41233 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
41234 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
41235 instruction reply packet}).
41236
41237 @item QTStop
41238 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
41239 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
41240
41241 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41242 @anchor{QTEnable}
41243 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
41244 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41245 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
41246 of data from it will resume.
41247
41248 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41249 @anchor{QTDisable}
41250 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
41251 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41252 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
41253 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
41254
41255 @item QTinit
41256 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
41257 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
41258
41259 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
41260 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
41261 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
41262 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
41263 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
41264
41265 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
41266 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
41267 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
41268 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
41269
41270 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
41271 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
41272 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
41273 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
41274 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
41275 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
41276
41277 @item qTStatus
41278 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
41279 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
41280
41281 The reply has the form:
41282
41283 @table @samp
41284
41285 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
41286 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
41287 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
41288 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
41289
41290 @end table
41291
41292 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
41293 explanations as one of the optional fields:
41294
41295 @table @samp
41296
41297 @item tnotrun:0
41298 No trace has been run yet.
41299
41300 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
41301 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
41302 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
41303 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
41304 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
41305
41306 @item tfull:0
41307 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
41308
41309 @item tdisconnected:0
41310 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
41311
41312 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
41313 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
41314
41315 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
41316 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
41317 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
41318 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
41319 is hex encoded.
41320
41321 @item tunknown:0
41322 The trace stopped for some other reason.
41323
41324 @end table
41325
41326 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
41327 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
41328 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
41329 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
41330 trace.
41331
41332 @table @samp
41333
41334 @item tframes:@var{n}
41335 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
41336
41337 @item tcreated:@var{n}
41338 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
41339 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
41340
41341 @item tsize:@var{n}
41342 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
41343
41344 @item tfree:@var{n}
41345 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
41346
41347 @item circular:@var{n}
41348 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
41349 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
41350 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
41351 and may fill up.
41352
41353 @item disconn:@var{n}
41354 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
41355 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
41356 that the trace run will stop.
41357
41358 @end table
41359
41360 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
41361 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
41362 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
41363 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
41364 address @var{addr}.
41365
41366 Replies:
41367 @table @samp
41368 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
41369 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
41370 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
41371 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
41372 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
41373
41374 @end table
41375
41376 @item qTV:@var{var}
41377 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
41378 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
41379 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
41380
41381 Replies:
41382 @table @samp
41383 @item V@var{value}
41384 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
41385 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
41386 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
41387 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
41388 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
41389 program is running.
41390
41391 @item U
41392 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
41393 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
41394 was not collected.
41395 @end table
41396
41397 @item qTfP
41398 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
41399 @itemx qTsP
41400 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
41401 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
41402 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
41403 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
41404 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
41405 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
41406
41407 @item qTfV
41408 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
41409 @itemx qTsV
41410 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
41411 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
41412 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
41413 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
41414 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
41415 trace state variables.
41416
41417 @item qTfSTM
41418 @itemx qTsSTM
41419 @anchor{qTfSTM}
41420 @anchor{qTsSTM}
41421 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
41422 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
41423 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
41424 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
41425 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
41426 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
41427
41428 Reply:
41429 @table @samp
41430 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
41431 A single marker
41432 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
41433 a comma-separated list of markers
41434 @item l
41435 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
41436 @item E @var{nn}
41437 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41438 @item @w{}
41439 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
41440 stub.
41441 @end table
41442
41443 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
41444 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
41445
41446 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
41447 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
41448 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
41449 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
41450 @dfn{last}).
41451
41452 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
41453 @anchor{qTSTMat}
41454 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
41455 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
41456 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
41457 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
41458 tracepoint markers.
41459
41460 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
41461 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
41462 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
41463 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
41464 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
41465 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
41466
41467 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
41468 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
41469 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
41470 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
41471 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
41472 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
41473 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
41474 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
41475 available.
41476
41477 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
41478 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
41479 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
41480
41481 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
41482 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
41483 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
41484 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
41485 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
41486 use whatever size it prefers.
41487
41488 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
41489 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
41490 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
41491 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
41492 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
41493
41494 @end table
41495
41496 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
41497 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
41498 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
41499 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
41500 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
41501 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
41502 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
41503 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
41504 it had executed in the original location.
41505
41506 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
41507 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
41508 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
41509 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
41510 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
41511 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
41512 format of the request is:
41513
41514 @table @samp
41515 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
41516
41517 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
41518 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
41519 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
41520 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
41521 memory starting at @var{to}.
41522 @end table
41523
41524 Replies:
41525 @table @samp
41526 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
41527 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
41528 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
41529 @item E @var{NN}
41530 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
41531 relocating the instruction.
41532 @end table
41533
41534 @node Host I/O Packets
41535 @section Host I/O Packets
41536 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
41537 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
41538
41539 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
41540 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
41541 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
41542 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
41543 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
41544 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
41545 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
41546 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
41547 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
41548 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
41549
41550 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
41551 its arguments. They have this format:
41552
41553 @table @samp
41554
41555 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
41556 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
41557 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
41558 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
41559 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
41560 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
41561 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
41562 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
41563 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
41564
41565 @end table
41566
41567 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
41568
41569 @table @samp
41570
41571 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
41572 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
41573 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
41574 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
41575 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
41576 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
41577 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
41578 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
41579 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
41580 @var{attachment}.
41581
41582 @item @w{}
41583 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
41584
41585 @end table
41586
41587 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
41588
41589 @table @samp
41590 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
41591 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
41592 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
41593 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
41594 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
41595 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
41596 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
41597
41598 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
41599 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
41600 -1 if an error occurs.
41601
41602 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
41603 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
41604 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
41605 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
41606 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
41607 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
41608 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
41609 @var{count} was zero.
41610
41611 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41612 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41613 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41614 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41615 some characters were escaped.
41616
41617 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
41618 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
41619 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
41620 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
41621 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
41622 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
41623 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
41624 error occurred.
41625
41626 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
41627 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
41628 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
41629 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
41630 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
41631 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
41632
41633 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
41634 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
41635 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
41636
41637 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
41638 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
41639 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
41640
41641 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41642 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41643 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41644 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41645 some characters were escaped.
41646
41647 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
41648 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
41649 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
41650 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
41651 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
41652 inferior(s).
41653
41654 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
41655 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
41656 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
41657 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
41658 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
41659 operation.
41660
41661 @end table
41662
41663 @node Interrupts
41664 @section Interrupts
41665 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
41666 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
41667
41668 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
41669 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
41670 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
41671 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
41672
41673 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
41674 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
41675 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
41676 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
41677 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
41678
41679 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
41680 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
41681 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
41682 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
41683 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
41684 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
41685 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
41686 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
41687
41688 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
41689 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
41690 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
41691
41692 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
41693 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
41694 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
41695 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
41696 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
41697 @code{0x03}.
41698
41699 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
41700 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
41701 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
41702 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
41703 currently-executing threads and processes.
41704 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
41705 running program, it should send one of the stop
41706 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
41707 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
41708 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
41709 Interrupts received while the
41710 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
41711 it is resumed next time.
41712
41713 @node Notification Packets
41714 @section Notification Packets
41715 @cindex notification packets
41716 @cindex packets, notification
41717
41718 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
41719 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
41720 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
41721 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
41722 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
41723 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
41724 is not a problem.
41725
41726 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
41727 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
41728 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
41729 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
41730 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
41731 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
41732 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
41733
41734 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
41735 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
41736
41737 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
41738 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
41739 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
41740 not they understand it.
41741
41742 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
41743 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
41744 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
41745 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
41746 recipients.
41747
41748 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
41749 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
41750 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
41751 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
41752 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
41753
41754 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
41755 @table @samp
41756 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
41757 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
41758 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
41759 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
41760 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
41761 @item @var{ack}
41762 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
41763 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
41764 @end table
41765
41766 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
41767 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
41768
41769 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
41770 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
41771 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
41772 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
41773 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
41774 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
41775 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
41776 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
41777 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
41778 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
41779
41780 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
41781 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
41782 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
41783 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
41784 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
41785 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
41786
41787 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
41788 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
41789 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
41790 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
41791 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
41792
41793 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
41794 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
41795 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
41796 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
41797 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
41798 normally.
41799
41800 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
41801 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
41802 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
41803 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
41804 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
41805 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
41806 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
41807 the process shall be repeated.
41808
41809 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
41810 following example:
41811 @smallexample
41812 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
41813 @code{...}
41814 -> @code{vStopped}
41815 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
41816 -> @code{vStopped}
41817 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
41818 -> @code{vStopped}
41819 <- @code{OK}
41820 @end smallexample
41821
41822 The following notifications are defined:
41823 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
41824
41825 @item Notification
41826 @tab Ack
41827 @tab Event
41828 @tab Description
41829
41830 @item Stop
41831 @tab vStopped
41832 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
41833 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
41834 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
41835 @value{GDBN}.
41836 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
41837
41838 @end multitable
41839
41840 @node Remote Non-Stop
41841 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
41842
41843 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
41844 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
41845 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
41846 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41847
41848 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
41849 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
41850 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
41851 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
41852 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
41853 probe the target state after a mode change.
41854
41855 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
41856 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
41857 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
41858 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
41859 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
41860 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
41861 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
41862 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
41863 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
41864 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
41865 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
41866
41867 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
41868 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
41869 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
41870 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
41871 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
41872 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
41873 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
41874 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
41875 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
41876 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
41877 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
41878 @samp{OK}.
41879
41880 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
41881 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
41882 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
41883 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
41884 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
41885 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
41886 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
41887 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
41888 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
41889 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
41890 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
41891 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
41892 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
41893
41894 @node Packet Acknowledgment
41895 @section Packet Acknowledgment
41896
41897 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41898 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41899 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
41900 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41901 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
41902 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
41903 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
41904
41905 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
41906 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
41907 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
41908 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
41909 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
41910
41911 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
41912 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
41913 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
41914 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
41915
41916 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
41917 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
41918 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
41919 @pxref{qSupported}.
41920 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
41921 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
41922 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
41923 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
41924 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
41925 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
41926 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
41927
41928 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
41929 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
41930 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
41931 connection.
41932 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
41933 new connection is established,
41934 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
41935 for the current connection, once disabled.
41936
41937 @node Examples
41938 @section Examples
41939
41940 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41941 does not get any direct output:
41942
41943 @smallexample
41944 -> @code{R00}
41945 <- @code{+}
41946 @emph{target restarts}
41947 -> @code{?}
41948 <- @code{+}
41949 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41950 -> @code{+}
41951 @end smallexample
41952
41953 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41954
41955 @smallexample
41956 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41957 <- @code{+}
41958 -> @code{s}
41959 <- @code{+}
41960 @emph{time passes}
41961 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41962 -> @code{+}
41963 -> @code{g}
41964 <- @code{+}
41965 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41966 -> @code{+}
41967 @end smallexample
41968
41969 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41970 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41971 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41972
41973 @menu
41974 * File-I/O Overview::
41975 * Protocol Basics::
41976 * The F Request Packet::
41977 * The F Reply Packet::
41978 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41979 * Console I/O::
41980 * List of Supported Calls::
41981 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41982 * Constants::
41983 * File-I/O Examples::
41984 @end menu
41985
41986 @node File-I/O Overview
41987 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41988 @cindex file-i/o overview
41989
41990 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41991 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41992 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41993 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41994 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41995 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41996
41997 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41998 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41999 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
42000 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
42001 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
42002
42003 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
42004 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
42005 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
42006 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
42007 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
42008 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
42009 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
42010
42011 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
42012 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
42013 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
42014 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
42015 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
42016
42017 @smallexample
42018 (@value{GDBP}) continue
42019 <- target requests 'system call X'
42020 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
42021 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
42022 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
42023 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
42024 @end smallexample
42025
42026 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
42027 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
42028 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
42029 system are not supported by this protocol.
42030
42031 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
42032
42033 @node Protocol Basics
42034 @subsection Protocol Basics
42035 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
42036
42037 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
42038 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
42039 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
42040 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
42041 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
42042 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
42043 to call the appropriate host system call:
42044
42045 @itemize @bullet
42046 @item
42047 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
42048
42049 @item
42050 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
42051 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
42052 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
42053 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
42054
42055 @end itemize
42056
42057 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
42058
42059 @itemize @bullet
42060 @item
42061 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
42062 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
42063 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
42064 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
42065 packet.
42066
42067 @item
42068 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
42069 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
42070
42071 @item
42072 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
42073
42074 @item
42075 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
42076
42077 @item
42078 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
42079 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
42080 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
42081 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
42082 packet.
42083
42084 @end itemize
42085
42086 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
42087 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
42088
42089 @itemize @bullet
42090 @item
42091 Return value.
42092
42093 @item
42094 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
42095
42096 @item
42097 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
42098
42099 @end itemize
42100
42101 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
42102 the latest continue or step action.
42103
42104 @node The F Request Packet
42105 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
42106 @cindex file-i/o request packet
42107 @cindex @code{F} request packet
42108
42109 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
42110
42111 @table @samp
42112 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
42113
42114 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
42115 This is just the name of the function.
42116
42117 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
42118 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
42119 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
42120 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
42121 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
42122 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
42123 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
42124
42125 @end table
42126
42127
42128
42129 @node The F Reply Packet
42130 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
42131 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
42132 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
42133
42134 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
42135
42136 @table @samp
42137
42138 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
42139
42140 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
42141
42142 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
42143 representation.
42144 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
42145
42146 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
42147 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
42148 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
42149
42150 @smallexample
42151 F0,0,C
42152 @end smallexample
42153
42154 @noindent
42155 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
42156
42157 @smallexample
42158 F-1,4,C
42159 @end smallexample
42160
42161 @noindent
42162 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
42163
42164 @end table
42165
42166
42167 @node The Ctrl-C Message
42168 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
42169 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
42170
42171 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
42172 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
42173 the target should behave as if it had
42174 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
42175 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
42176 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
42177 packet.
42178
42179 It's important for the target to know in which
42180 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
42181
42182 @itemize @bullet
42183 @item
42184 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
42185
42186 @item
42187 The system call on the host has been finished.
42188
42189 @end itemize
42190
42191 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
42192 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
42193 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
42194 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
42195 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
42196 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
42197
42198 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
42199 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
42200 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
42201 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
42202 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
42203 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
42204 or the full action has been completed.
42205
42206 @node Console I/O
42207 @subsection Console I/O
42208 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
42209
42210 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
42211 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
42212 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
42213 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
42214 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
42215 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
42216 conditions is met:
42217
42218 @itemize @bullet
42219 @item
42220 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
42221 @code{read}
42222 system call is treated as finished.
42223
42224 @item
42225 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
42226 newline.
42227
42228 @item
42229 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
42230 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
42231
42232 @end itemize
42233
42234 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
42235 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
42236 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
42237 is stopped at the user's request.
42238
42239
42240 @node List of Supported Calls
42241 @subsection List of Supported Calls
42242 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
42243
42244 @menu
42245 * open::
42246 * close::
42247 * read::
42248 * write::
42249 * lseek::
42250 * rename::
42251 * unlink::
42252 * stat/fstat::
42253 * gettimeofday::
42254 * isatty::
42255 * system::
42256 @end menu
42257
42258 @node open
42259 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
42260 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
42261
42262 @table @asis
42263 @item Synopsis:
42264 @smallexample
42265 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
42266 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
42267 @end smallexample
42268
42269 @item Request:
42270 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
42271
42272 @noindent
42273 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42274
42275 @table @code
42276 @item O_CREAT
42277 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
42278 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
42279 are concerned.
42280
42281 @item O_EXCL
42282 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
42283 an error and open() fails.
42284
42285 @item O_TRUNC
42286 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
42287 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
42288 truncated to zero length.
42289
42290 @item O_APPEND
42291 The file is opened in append mode.
42292
42293 @item O_RDONLY
42294 The file is opened for reading only.
42295
42296 @item O_WRONLY
42297 The file is opened for writing only.
42298
42299 @item O_RDWR
42300 The file is opened for reading and writing.
42301 @end table
42302
42303 @noindent
42304 Other bits are silently ignored.
42305
42306
42307 @noindent
42308 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42309
42310 @table @code
42311 @item S_IRUSR
42312 User has read permission.
42313
42314 @item S_IWUSR
42315 User has write permission.
42316
42317 @item S_IRGRP
42318 Group has read permission.
42319
42320 @item S_IWGRP
42321 Group has write permission.
42322
42323 @item S_IROTH
42324 Others have read permission.
42325
42326 @item S_IWOTH
42327 Others have write permission.
42328 @end table
42329
42330 @noindent
42331 Other bits are silently ignored.
42332
42333
42334 @item Return value:
42335 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
42336 occurred.
42337
42338 @item Errors:
42339
42340 @table @code
42341 @item EEXIST
42342 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
42343
42344 @item EISDIR
42345 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
42346
42347 @item EACCES
42348 The requested access is not allowed.
42349
42350 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42351 @var{pathname} was too long.
42352
42353 @item ENOENT
42354 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42355
42356 @item ENODEV
42357 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
42358
42359 @item EROFS
42360 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
42361 write access was requested.
42362
42363 @item EFAULT
42364 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
42365
42366 @item ENOSPC
42367 No space on device to create the file.
42368
42369 @item EMFILE
42370 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
42371
42372 @item ENFILE
42373 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
42374 has been reached.
42375
42376 @item EINTR
42377 The call was interrupted by the user.
42378 @end table
42379
42380 @end table
42381
42382 @node close
42383 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
42384 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
42385
42386 @table @asis
42387 @item Synopsis:
42388 @smallexample
42389 int close(int fd);
42390 @end smallexample
42391
42392 @item Request:
42393 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
42394
42395 @item Return value:
42396 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
42397
42398 @item Errors:
42399
42400 @table @code
42401 @item EBADF
42402 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
42403
42404 @item EINTR
42405 The call was interrupted by the user.
42406 @end table
42407
42408 @end table
42409
42410 @node read
42411 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
42412 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
42413
42414 @table @asis
42415 @item Synopsis:
42416 @smallexample
42417 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
42418 @end smallexample
42419
42420 @item Request:
42421 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42422
42423 @item Return value:
42424 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
42425 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
42426 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
42427
42428 @item Errors:
42429
42430 @table @code
42431 @item EBADF
42432 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42433 reading.
42434
42435 @item EFAULT
42436 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42437
42438 @item EINTR
42439 The call was interrupted by the user.
42440 @end table
42441
42442 @end table
42443
42444 @node write
42445 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
42446 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
42447
42448 @table @asis
42449 @item Synopsis:
42450 @smallexample
42451 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
42452 @end smallexample
42453
42454 @item Request:
42455 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42456
42457 @item Return value:
42458 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
42459 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
42460 is returned.
42461
42462 @item Errors:
42463
42464 @table @code
42465 @item EBADF
42466 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42467 writing.
42468
42469 @item EFAULT
42470 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42471
42472 @item EFBIG
42473 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
42474 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
42475
42476 @item ENOSPC
42477 No space on device to write the data.
42478
42479 @item EINTR
42480 The call was interrupted by the user.
42481 @end table
42482
42483 @end table
42484
42485 @node lseek
42486 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
42487 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
42488
42489 @table @asis
42490 @item Synopsis:
42491 @smallexample
42492 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
42493 @end smallexample
42494
42495 @item Request:
42496 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
42497
42498 @var{flag} is one of:
42499
42500 @table @code
42501 @item SEEK_SET
42502 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
42503
42504 @item SEEK_CUR
42505 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
42506 bytes.
42507
42508 @item SEEK_END
42509 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
42510 bytes.
42511 @end table
42512
42513 @item Return value:
42514 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
42515 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
42516 value of -1 is returned.
42517
42518 @item Errors:
42519
42520 @table @code
42521 @item EBADF
42522 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
42523
42524 @item ESPIPE
42525 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
42526
42527 @item EINVAL
42528 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
42529
42530 @item EINTR
42531 The call was interrupted by the user.
42532 @end table
42533
42534 @end table
42535
42536 @node rename
42537 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
42538 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
42539
42540 @table @asis
42541 @item Synopsis:
42542 @smallexample
42543 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
42544 @end smallexample
42545
42546 @item Request:
42547 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
42548
42549 @item Return value:
42550 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42551
42552 @item Errors:
42553
42554 @table @code
42555 @item EISDIR
42556 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
42557 directory.
42558
42559 @item EEXIST
42560 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
42561
42562 @item EBUSY
42563 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
42564 process.
42565
42566 @item EINVAL
42567 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
42568 of itself.
42569
42570 @item ENOTDIR
42571 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
42572 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
42573 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
42574
42575 @item EFAULT
42576 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
42577
42578 @item EACCES
42579 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42580
42581 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42582
42583 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
42584
42585 @item ENOENT
42586 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
42587
42588 @item EROFS
42589 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42590
42591 @item ENOSPC
42592 The device containing the file has no room for the new
42593 directory entry.
42594
42595 @item EINTR
42596 The call was interrupted by the user.
42597 @end table
42598
42599 @end table
42600
42601 @node unlink
42602 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
42603 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
42604
42605 @table @asis
42606 @item Synopsis:
42607 @smallexample
42608 int unlink(const char *pathname);
42609 @end smallexample
42610
42611 @item Request:
42612 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
42613
42614 @item Return value:
42615 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42616
42617 @item Errors:
42618
42619 @table @code
42620 @item EACCES
42621 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42622
42623 @item EPERM
42624 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
42625
42626 @item EBUSY
42627 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
42628 being used by another process.
42629
42630 @item EFAULT
42631 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42632
42633 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42634 @var{pathname} was too long.
42635
42636 @item ENOENT
42637 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42638
42639 @item ENOTDIR
42640 A component of the path is not a directory.
42641
42642 @item EROFS
42643 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42644
42645 @item EINTR
42646 The call was interrupted by the user.
42647 @end table
42648
42649 @end table
42650
42651 @node stat/fstat
42652 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
42653 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
42654 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
42655
42656 @table @asis
42657 @item Synopsis:
42658 @smallexample
42659 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
42660 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
42661 @end smallexample
42662
42663 @item Request:
42664 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
42665 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
42666
42667 @item Return value:
42668 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42669
42670 @item Errors:
42671
42672 @table @code
42673 @item EBADF
42674 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
42675
42676 @item ENOENT
42677 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
42678 path is an empty string.
42679
42680 @item ENOTDIR
42681 A component of the path is not a directory.
42682
42683 @item EFAULT
42684 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42685
42686 @item EACCES
42687 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42688
42689 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42690 @var{pathname} was too long.
42691
42692 @item EINTR
42693 The call was interrupted by the user.
42694 @end table
42695
42696 @end table
42697
42698 @node gettimeofday
42699 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
42700 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
42701
42702 @table @asis
42703 @item Synopsis:
42704 @smallexample
42705 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
42706 @end smallexample
42707
42708 @item Request:
42709 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
42710
42711 @item Return value:
42712 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
42713
42714 @item Errors:
42715
42716 @table @code
42717 @item EINVAL
42718 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
42719
42720 @item EFAULT
42721 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42722 @end table
42723
42724 @end table
42725
42726 @node isatty
42727 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
42728 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
42729
42730 @table @asis
42731 @item Synopsis:
42732 @smallexample
42733 int isatty(int fd);
42734 @end smallexample
42735
42736 @item Request:
42737 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
42738
42739 @item Return value:
42740 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
42741
42742 @item Errors:
42743
42744 @table @code
42745 @item EINTR
42746 The call was interrupted by the user.
42747 @end table
42748
42749 @end table
42750
42751 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
42752 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
42753 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
42754 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
42755 needed.
42756
42757
42758 @node system
42759 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
42760 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
42761
42762 @table @asis
42763 @item Synopsis:
42764 @smallexample
42765 int system(const char *command);
42766 @end smallexample
42767
42768 @item Request:
42769 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
42770
42771 @item Return value:
42772 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
42773 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
42774 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
42775 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
42776 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
42777 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
42778 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
42779
42780 @item Errors:
42781
42782 @table @code
42783 @item EINTR
42784 The call was interrupted by the user.
42785 @end table
42786
42787 @end table
42788
42789 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
42790 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
42791 the host is simplified before it's returned
42792 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
42793 is discarded, and the return value consists
42794 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
42795
42796 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
42797 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
42798 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
42799
42800 @table @code
42801 @item set remote system-call-allowed
42802 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
42803 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
42804 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
42805
42806 @item show remote system-call-allowed
42807 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
42808 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
42809 protocol.
42810 @end table
42811
42812 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42813 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42814 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42815
42816 @menu
42817 * Integral Datatypes::
42818 * Pointer Values::
42819 * Memory Transfer::
42820 * struct stat::
42821 * struct timeval::
42822 @end menu
42823
42824 @node Integral Datatypes
42825 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
42826 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42827
42828 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
42829 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
42830 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
42831
42832 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
42833 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
42834
42835 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
42836
42837 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
42838 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
42839
42840 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
42841
42842 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
42843 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
42844 byte order.
42845
42846 @node Pointer Values
42847 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
42848 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
42849
42850 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
42851 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
42852 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
42853 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
42854
42855 @smallexample
42856 @code{1aaf/12}
42857 @end smallexample
42858
42859 @noindent
42860 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
42861 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
42862 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
42863 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
42864
42865 @smallexample
42866 @code{123456/d}
42867 @end smallexample
42868
42869 @node Memory Transfer
42870 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
42871 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
42872
42873 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
42874 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
42875 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
42876 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
42877 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
42878 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
42879 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
42880
42881
42882 @node struct stat
42883 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
42884 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
42885
42886 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
42887 is defined as follows:
42888
42889 @smallexample
42890 struct stat @{
42891 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
42892 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
42893 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
42894 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
42895 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
42896 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
42897 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
42898 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
42899 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
42900 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
42901 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
42902 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
42903 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
42904 @};
42905 @end smallexample
42906
42907 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42908 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42909 structure is of size 64 bytes.
42910
42911 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
42912 range of values.
42913
42914 @table @code
42915
42916 @item st_dev
42917 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
42918
42919 @item st_ino
42920 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42921
42922 @item st_mode
42923 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
42924 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
42925
42926 @item st_uid
42927 @itemx st_gid
42928 @itemx st_rdev
42929 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42930
42931 @item st_atime
42932 @itemx st_mtime
42933 @itemx st_ctime
42934 These values have a host and file system dependent
42935 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
42936 support exact timing values.
42937 @end table
42938
42939 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42940 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42941 continuing.
42942
42943 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42944 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42945 get truncated on the target.
42946
42947 @node struct timeval
42948 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42949 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42950
42951 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42952 is defined as follows:
42953
42954 @smallexample
42955 struct timeval @{
42956 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42957 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42958 @};
42959 @end smallexample
42960
42961 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42962 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42963 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42964
42965 @node Constants
42966 @subsection Constants
42967 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42968
42969 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42970 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42971 values before and after the call as needed.
42972
42973 @menu
42974 * Open Flags::
42975 * mode_t Values::
42976 * Errno Values::
42977 * Lseek Flags::
42978 * Limits::
42979 @end menu
42980
42981 @node Open Flags
42982 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42983 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42984
42985 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42986
42987 @smallexample
42988 O_RDONLY 0x0
42989 O_WRONLY 0x1
42990 O_RDWR 0x2
42991 O_APPEND 0x8
42992 O_CREAT 0x200
42993 O_TRUNC 0x400
42994 O_EXCL 0x800
42995 @end smallexample
42996
42997 @node mode_t Values
42998 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42999 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
43000
43001 All values are given in octal representation.
43002
43003 @smallexample
43004 S_IFREG 0100000
43005 S_IFDIR 040000
43006 S_IRUSR 0400
43007 S_IWUSR 0200
43008 S_IXUSR 0100
43009 S_IRGRP 040
43010 S_IWGRP 020
43011 S_IXGRP 010
43012 S_IROTH 04
43013 S_IWOTH 02
43014 S_IXOTH 01
43015 @end smallexample
43016
43017 @node Errno Values
43018 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
43019 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
43020
43021 All values are given in decimal representation.
43022
43023 @smallexample
43024 EPERM 1
43025 ENOENT 2
43026 EINTR 4
43027 EBADF 9
43028 EACCES 13
43029 EFAULT 14
43030 EBUSY 16
43031 EEXIST 17
43032 ENODEV 19
43033 ENOTDIR 20
43034 EISDIR 21
43035 EINVAL 22
43036 ENFILE 23
43037 EMFILE 24
43038 EFBIG 27
43039 ENOSPC 28
43040 ESPIPE 29
43041 EROFS 30
43042 ENAMETOOLONG 91
43043 EUNKNOWN 9999
43044 @end smallexample
43045
43046 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
43047 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
43048
43049 @node Lseek Flags
43050 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
43051 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
43052
43053 @smallexample
43054 SEEK_SET 0
43055 SEEK_CUR 1
43056 SEEK_END 2
43057 @end smallexample
43058
43059 @node Limits
43060 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
43061 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
43062
43063 All values are given in decimal representation.
43064
43065 @smallexample
43066 INT_MIN -2147483648
43067 INT_MAX 2147483647
43068 UINT_MAX 4294967295
43069 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
43070 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
43071 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
43072 @end smallexample
43073
43074 @node File-I/O Examples
43075 @subsection File-I/O Examples
43076 @cindex file-i/o examples
43077
43078 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43079 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
43080
43081 @smallexample
43082 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
43083 @emph{request memory read from target}
43084 -> @code{m1234,6}
43085 <- XXXXXX
43086 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
43087 -> @code{F6}
43088 @end smallexample
43089
43090 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43091 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
43092
43093 @smallexample
43094 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43095 @emph{request memory write to target}
43096 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43097 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
43098 -> @code{F6}
43099 @end smallexample
43100
43101 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
43102 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
43103
43104 @smallexample
43105 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43106 -> @code{F-1,9}
43107 @end smallexample
43108
43109 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
43110 host is called:
43111
43112 @smallexample
43113 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43114 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
43115 <- @code{T02}
43116 @end smallexample
43117
43118 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
43119 host is called:
43120
43121 @smallexample
43122 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43123 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43124 <- @code{T02}
43125 @end smallexample
43126
43127 @node Library List Format
43128 @section Library List Format
43129 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43130
43131 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
43132 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
43133 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
43134 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
43135 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
43136 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
43137 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
43138 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
43139 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
43140 are loaded.
43141
43142 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
43143 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
43144 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
43145 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
43146
43147 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
43148 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
43149 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
43150 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
43151 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
43152 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
43153
43154 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43155 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43156
43157 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
43158 offset, looks like this:
43159
43160 @smallexample
43161 <library-list>
43162 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
43163 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
43164 </library>
43165 </library-list>
43166 @end smallexample
43167
43168 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
43169 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
43170
43171 @smallexample
43172 <library-list>
43173 <library name="sharedlib.o">
43174 <section address="0x10000000"/>
43175 <section address="0x20000000"/>
43176 <section address="0x30000000"/>
43177 </library>
43178 </library-list>
43179 @end smallexample
43180
43181 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
43182
43183 @smallexample
43184 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
43185 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
43186 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43187 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
43188 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43189 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
43190 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43191 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
43192 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43193 @end smallexample
43194
43195 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
43196 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
43197 section for each library.
43198
43199 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43200 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43201 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43202
43203 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
43204 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
43205 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
43206 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
43207
43208 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
43209 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
43210 target, the following parameters are reported:
43211
43212 @itemize @minus
43213 @item
43214 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
43215 @code{struct link_map}.
43216 @item
43217 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
43218 (Thread Local Storage) access.
43219 @item
43220 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
43221 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
43222 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
43223 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
43224 @item
43225 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
43226 @end itemize
43227
43228 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
43229 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
43230 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
43231
43232 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43233 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43234
43235 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
43236 looks like this:
43237
43238 @smallexample
43239 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
43240 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
43241 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
43242 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
43243 l_ld="0x152350"/>
43244 </library-list-svr>
43245 @end smallexample
43246
43247 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
43248
43249 @smallexample
43250 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
43251 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
43252 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43253 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
43254 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
43255 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43256 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
43257 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
43258 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
43259 @end smallexample
43260
43261 @node Memory Map Format
43262 @section Memory Map Format
43263 @cindex memory map format
43264
43265 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
43266 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
43267 memory map.
43268
43269 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
43270 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
43271 lists memory regions.
43272
43273 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43274 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
43275
43276 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43277
43278 @smallexample
43279 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43280 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
43281 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43282 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
43283 <memory-map>
43284 region...
43285 </memory-map>
43286 @end smallexample
43287
43288 Each region can be either:
43289
43290 @itemize
43291
43292 @item
43293 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
43294 bytes from there:
43295
43296 @smallexample
43297 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43298 @end smallexample
43299
43300
43301 @item
43302 A region of read-only memory:
43303
43304 @smallexample
43305 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43306 @end smallexample
43307
43308
43309 @item
43310 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
43311 bytes in length:
43312
43313 @smallexample
43314 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
43315 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
43316 </memory>
43317 @end smallexample
43318
43319 @end itemize
43320
43321 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
43322 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
43323 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
43324
43325 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
43326
43327 @smallexample
43328 <!-- ................................................... -->
43329 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
43330 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
43331 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
43332 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
43333 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
43334 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
43335 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
43336 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
43337 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
43338 and its type, or device. -->
43339 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
43340 start CDATA #REQUIRED
43341 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43342 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
43343 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
43344 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
43345 @end smallexample
43346
43347 @node Thread List Format
43348 @section Thread List Format
43349 @cindex thread list format
43350
43351 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
43352 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
43353 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
43354 the following structure:
43355
43356 @smallexample
43357 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43358 <threads>
43359 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
43360 ... description ...
43361 </thread>
43362 </threads>
43363 @end smallexample
43364
43365 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
43366 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
43367 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
43368 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
43369 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
43370 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
43371 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
43372 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
43373
43374
43375 @node Traceframe Info Format
43376 @section Traceframe Info Format
43377 @cindex traceframe info format
43378
43379 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
43380 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
43381 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
43382 collected in a traceframe.
43383
43384 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
43385 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
43386
43387 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43388 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43389
43390 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43391
43392 @smallexample
43393 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43394 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
43395 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43396 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
43397 <traceframe-info>
43398 block...
43399 </traceframe-info>
43400 @end smallexample
43401
43402 Each traceframe block can be either:
43403
43404 @itemize
43405
43406 @item
43407 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
43408 @var{length} bytes from there:
43409
43410 @smallexample
43411 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43412 @end smallexample
43413
43414 @item
43415 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
43416 collected:
43417
43418 @smallexample
43419 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
43420 @end smallexample
43421
43422 @end itemize
43423
43424 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
43425
43426 @smallexample
43427 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
43428 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43429
43430 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
43431 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
43432 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43433 <!ELEMENT tvar>
43434 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
43435 @end smallexample
43436
43437 @node Branch Trace Format
43438 @section Branch Trace Format
43439 @cindex branch trace format
43440
43441 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
43442 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
43443 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
43444 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
43445
43446 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
43447 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
43448
43449 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43450 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43451
43452 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43453
43454 @smallexample
43455 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43456 <!DOCTYPE btrace
43457 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
43458 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
43459 <btrace>
43460 block...
43461 </btrace>
43462 @end smallexample
43463
43464 @itemize
43465
43466 @item
43467 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
43468 and ending at @var{end}:
43469
43470 @smallexample
43471 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
43472 @end smallexample
43473
43474 @end itemize
43475
43476 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
43477
43478 @smallexample
43479 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
43480 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43481
43482 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
43483 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
43484 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
43485
43486 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
43487
43488 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
43489
43490 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
43491 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
43492 family CDATA #REQUIRED
43493 model CDATA #REQUIRED
43494 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
43495
43496 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
43497 @end smallexample
43498
43499 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
43500 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
43501 @cindex branch trace configuration format
43502
43503 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
43504 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
43505 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
43506
43507 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
43508 settings for that format. The following information is described:
43509
43510 @table @code
43511 @item bts
43512 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
43513 @table @code
43514 @item size
43515 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
43516 @end table
43517 @item pt
43518 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
43519 PT}) format.
43520 @table @code
43521 @item size
43522 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
43523 @end table
43524 @end table
43525
43526 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43527 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43528
43529 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
43530
43531 @smallexample
43532 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
43533 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43534
43535 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
43536 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43537
43538 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
43539 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43540 @end smallexample
43541
43542 @include agentexpr.texi
43543
43544 @node Target Descriptions
43545 @appendix Target Descriptions
43546 @cindex target descriptions
43547
43548 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
43549 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
43550 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
43551 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
43552 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
43553 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
43554 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
43555
43556 @itemize @bullet
43557 @item
43558 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
43559 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
43560 @item
43561 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
43562 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
43563 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
43564 @item
43565 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
43566 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
43567 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
43568 @end itemize
43569
43570 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
43571 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
43572 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
43573 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
43574 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
43575
43576 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43577 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
43578
43579 @menu
43580 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
43581 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
43582 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
43583 descriptions.
43584 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
43585 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
43586 @end menu
43587
43588 @node Retrieving Descriptions
43589 @section Retrieving Descriptions
43590
43591 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
43592 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
43593 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
43594 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
43595 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
43596 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
43597 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
43598 Format}.
43599
43600 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
43601 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
43602 specify a file are:
43603
43604 @table @code
43605 @cindex set tdesc filename
43606 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
43607 Read the target description from @var{path}.
43608
43609 @cindex unset tdesc filename
43610 @item unset tdesc filename
43611 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
43612 will use the description supplied by the current target.
43613
43614 @cindex show tdesc filename
43615 @item show tdesc filename
43616 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
43617 @end table
43618
43619
43620 @node Target Description Format
43621 @section Target Description Format
43622 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
43623
43624 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
43625 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
43626 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
43627 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
43628 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
43629 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
43630 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
43631
43632 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
43633 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
43634 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
43635 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
43636 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
43637
43638 Here is a simple target description:
43639
43640 @smallexample
43641 <target version="1.0">
43642 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
43643 </target>
43644 @end smallexample
43645
43646 @noindent
43647 This minimal description only says that the target uses
43648 the x86-64 architecture.
43649
43650 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
43651 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
43652 are explained further below.
43653
43654 @smallexample
43655 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43656 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
43657 <target version="1.0">
43658 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
43659 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
43660 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
43661 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
43662 </target>
43663 @end smallexample
43664
43665 @noindent
43666 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
43667 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
43668 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
43669 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
43670 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
43671 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
43672 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
43673 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
43674 the version mismatch.
43675
43676 @subsection Inclusion
43677 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
43678 @cindex XInclude
43679 @ifnotinfo
43680 @cindex <xi:include>
43681 @end ifnotinfo
43682
43683 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
43684 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
43685 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
43686 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
43687 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
43688
43689 @smallexample
43690 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
43691 @end smallexample
43692
43693 @noindent
43694 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
43695 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
43696 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
43697 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
43698 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
43699 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
43700 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
43701 original description.
43702
43703 @subsection Architecture
43704 @cindex <architecture>
43705
43706 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
43707
43708 @smallexample
43709 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
43710 @end smallexample
43711
43712 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43713 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43714
43715 @subsection OS ABI
43716 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
43717
43718 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43719 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43720
43721 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
43722
43723 @smallexample
43724 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
43725 @end smallexample
43726
43727 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
43728 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
43729
43730 @subsection Compatible Architecture
43731 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
43732
43733 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43734 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43735
43736 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
43737
43738 @smallexample
43739 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
43740 @end smallexample
43741
43742 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43743 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43744
43745 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
43746 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
43747 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
43748 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
43749 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
43750 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
43751 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
43752
43753 @smallexample
43754 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
43755 <compatible>spu</compatible>
43756 @end smallexample
43757
43758 @subsection Features
43759 @cindex <feature>
43760
43761 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
43762 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
43763 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
43764 has this form:
43765
43766 @smallexample
43767 <feature name="@var{name}">
43768 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
43769 @var{reg}@dots{}
43770 </feature>
43771 @end smallexample
43772
43773 @noindent
43774 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
43775 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
43776 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
43777 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
43778
43779 @subsection Types
43780
43781 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
43782 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
43783 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
43784 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
43785 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
43786 and enum types.
43787
43788 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
43789 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
43790 Types must be defined before they are used.
43791
43792 @cindex <vector>
43793 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
43794 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
43795 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
43796 @var{count}:
43797
43798 @smallexample
43799 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
43800 @end smallexample
43801
43802 @cindex <union>
43803 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
43804 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
43805 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
43806 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
43807
43808 @smallexample
43809 <union id="@var{id}">
43810 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43811 @dots{}
43812 </union>
43813 @end smallexample
43814
43815 @cindex <struct>
43816 @cindex <flags>
43817 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
43818 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
43819 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
43820 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
43821 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
43822 specified.
43823
43824 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
43825
43826 @smallexample
43827 <struct id="@var{id}">
43828 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43829 @dots{}
43830 </struct>
43831 @end smallexample
43832
43833 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
43834 No implicit padding is added.
43835
43836 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
43837
43838 @smallexample
43839 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43840 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43841 @dots{}
43842 </struct>
43843 @end smallexample
43844
43845 @smallexample
43846 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43847 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43848 @dots{}
43849 </flags>
43850 @end smallexample
43851
43852 The @var{name} value is required.
43853 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
43854 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
43855 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
43856
43857 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
43858 is optional.
43859 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
43860 and zero represents the least significant bit.
43861
43862 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
43863 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
43864
43865 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
43866
43867 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
43868 defining them with @samp{struct}:
43869
43870 @itemize @bullet
43871 @item
43872 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
43873 @item
43874 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
43875 @end itemize
43876
43877 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
43878 defining them with @samp{flags}:
43879
43880 @itemize @bullet
43881 @item
43882 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
43883
43884 @smallexample
43885 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
43886 $1 = 42
43887 @end smallexample
43888
43889 @end itemize
43890
43891 @subsection Registers
43892 @cindex <reg>
43893
43894 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
43895
43896 @smallexample
43897 <reg name="@var{name}"
43898 bitsize="@var{size}"
43899 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
43900 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
43901 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
43902 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
43903 @end smallexample
43904
43905 @noindent
43906 The components are as follows:
43907
43908 @table @var
43909
43910 @item name
43911 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
43912
43913 @item bitsize
43914 The register's size, in bits.
43915
43916 @item regnum
43917 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
43918 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
43919 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
43920 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
43921 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
43922 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
43923 in order of increasing register number.
43924
43925 @item save-restore
43926 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
43927 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
43928 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
43929 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
43930 ABI.
43931
43932 @item type
43933 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
43934 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
43935 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
43936 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
43937 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
43938 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
43939
43940 @item group
43941 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
43942 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
43943 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
43944 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
43945 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
43946 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
43947 @code{info registers}.
43948
43949 @end table
43950
43951 @node Predefined Target Types
43952 @section Predefined Target Types
43953 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43954
43955 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43956 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43957 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43958 types. The currently supported types are:
43959
43960 @table @code
43961
43962 @item bool
43963 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43964
43965 @item int8
43966 @itemx int16
43967 @itemx int24
43968 @itemx int32
43969 @itemx int64
43970 @itemx int128
43971 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43972
43973 @item uint8
43974 @itemx uint16
43975 @itemx uint24
43976 @itemx uint32
43977 @itemx uint64
43978 @itemx uint128
43979 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43980
43981 @item code_ptr
43982 @itemx data_ptr
43983 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43984 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43985 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43986 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43987 may be marked as data pointers.
43988
43989 @item ieee_single
43990 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43991
43992 @item ieee_double
43993 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43994
43995 @item arm_fpa_ext
43996 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43997
43998 @item i387_ext
43999 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
44000
44001 @item i386_eflags
44002 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
44003
44004 @item i386_mxcsr
44005 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
44006
44007 @end table
44008
44009 @node Enum Target Types
44010 @section Enum Target Types
44011 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
44012
44013 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
44014 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
44015
44016 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
44017
44018 @smallexample
44019 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
44020 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
44021 @dots{}
44022 </enum>
44023 @end smallexample
44024
44025 Enums must be defined before they are used.
44026
44027 @smallexample
44028 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
44029 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
44030 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
44031 </enum>
44032 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
44033 <field name="X" start="0"/>
44034 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
44035 </flags>
44036 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
44037 @end smallexample
44038
44039 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
44040 would be printed as:
44041
44042 @smallexample
44043 (gdb) info register flags
44044 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
44045 @end smallexample
44046
44047 @node Standard Target Features
44048 @section Standard Target Features
44049 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
44050
44051 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
44052 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
44053 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
44054 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
44055 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
44056 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
44057 can recognize them.
44058
44059 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
44060 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
44061 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
44062 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
44063 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
44064 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
44065 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
44066 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
44067
44068 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
44069 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
44070 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
44071
44072 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
44073 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
44074 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
44075 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
44076
44077 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
44078 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
44079 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
44080
44081 @menu
44082 * AArch64 Features::
44083 * ARC Features::
44084 * ARM Features::
44085 * i386 Features::
44086 * MicroBlaze Features::
44087 * MIPS Features::
44088 * M68K Features::
44089 * NDS32 Features::
44090 * Nios II Features::
44091 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
44092 * PowerPC Features::
44093 * RISC-V Features::
44094 * RX Features::
44095 * S/390 and System z Features::
44096 * Sparc Features::
44097 * TIC6x Features::
44098 @end menu
44099
44100
44101 @node AArch64 Features
44102 @subsection AArch64 Features
44103 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
44104
44105 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
44106 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
44107 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44108
44109 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44110 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
44111 and @samp{fpcr}.
44112
44113 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
44114 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
44115 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
44116
44117 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
44118 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
44119
44120 @node ARC Features
44121 @subsection ARC Features
44122 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
44123
44124 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
44125 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
44126 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
44127 that one of the core registers features is present.
44128 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
44129
44130 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
44131 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44132 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44133 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
44134 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44135 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
44136 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
44137
44138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
44139 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
44140 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
44141 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
44142 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
44143 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44144
44145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
44146 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44147 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44148 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
44149 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
44150 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
44151 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
44152 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
44153 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
44154 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
44155
44156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
44157 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
44158
44159 @node ARM Features
44160 @subsection ARM Features
44161 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
44162
44163 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
44164 ARM targets.
44165 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
44166 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44167
44168 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
44169 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
44170 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
44171 and @samp{xpsr}.
44172
44173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
44174 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
44175
44176 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
44177 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
44178 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
44179 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
44180
44181 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
44182 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
44183 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
44184 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
44185 halves of the double-precision registers.
44186
44187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
44188 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
44189 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
44190 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
44191 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
44192 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
44193
44194 @node i386 Features
44195 @subsection i386 Features
44196 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
44197
44198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
44199 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44200
44201 @itemize @minus
44202 @item
44203 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
44204 @item
44205 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
44206 @item
44207 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
44208 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
44209 @item
44210 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
44211 @item
44212 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
44213 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
44214 @end itemize
44215
44216 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
44217
44218 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
44219 describe registers:
44220
44221 @itemize @minus
44222 @item
44223 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
44224 @item
44225 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
44226 @item
44227 @samp{mxcsr}
44228 @end itemize
44229
44230 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
44231 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
44232 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
44233
44234 @itemize @minus
44235 @item
44236 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
44237 @item
44238 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
44239 @end itemize
44240
44241 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
44242 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
44243
44244 @itemize @minus
44245 @item
44246 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
44247 @item
44248 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
44249 @end itemize
44250
44251 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
44252 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
44253
44254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
44255 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
44256
44257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
44258 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
44259 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
44260
44261 @itemize @minus
44262 @item
44263 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44264 @end itemize
44265
44266 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
44267
44268 @itemize @minus
44269 @item
44270 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44271 @end itemize
44272
44273 It should
44274 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
44275
44276 @itemize @minus
44277 @item
44278 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
44279 @item
44280 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
44281 @end itemize
44282
44283 It should
44284 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
44285
44286 @itemize @minus
44287 @item
44288 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44289 @end itemize
44290
44291 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
44292 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
44293 valid for i386 and amd64.
44294
44295 @node MicroBlaze Features
44296 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
44297 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
44298
44299 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
44300 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44301 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
44302 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
44303 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
44304
44305 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
44306 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
44307
44308 @node MIPS Features
44309 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
44310 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
44311
44312 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
44313 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
44314 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
44315 on the target.
44316
44317 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
44318 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
44319 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44320
44321 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
44322 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
44323 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
44324 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44325
44326 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
44327 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
44328 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
44329 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44330
44331 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
44332 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
44333 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
44334
44335 @node M68K Features
44336 @subsection M68K Features
44337 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
44338
44339 @table @code
44340 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
44341 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
44342 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
44343 One of those features must be always present.
44344 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
44345 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
44346 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
44347 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
44348
44349 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
44350 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
44351 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
44352 @samp{fpiaddr}.
44353 @end table
44354
44355 @node NDS32 Features
44356 @subsection NDS32 Features
44357 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
44358
44359 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
44360 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
44361 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
44362 and @samp{pc}.
44363
44364 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44365 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
44366 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
44367 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
44368
44369 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
44370 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
44371 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
44372 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
44373 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
44374 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
44375 support to it could be totally removed some day.
44376
44377 @node Nios II Features
44378 @subsection Nios II Features
44379 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
44380
44381 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
44382 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
44383 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
44384 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
44385 @samp{mpuacc}).
44386
44387 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
44388 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
44389 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
44390
44391 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
44392 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
44393 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
44394
44395 @node PowerPC Features
44396 @subsection PowerPC Features
44397 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
44398
44399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
44400 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44401 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
44402 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44403
44404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44405 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
44406
44407 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
44408 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
44409 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
44410 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
44411 registers.
44412
44413 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44414 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
44415 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
44416 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
44417 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
44418 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
44419 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
44420 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
44421
44422 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
44423 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
44424 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
44425 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
44426 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
44427 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
44428 user.
44429
44430 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44431 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
44432
44433 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44434 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
44435
44436 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
44437 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
44438
44439 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
44440 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
44441 64-bit wide.
44442
44443 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
44444 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
44445 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
44446 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
44447
44448 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
44449 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
44450 64-bit wide.
44451
44452 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
44453 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
44454 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
44455 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
44456 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
44457 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
44458 wide.
44459
44460 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44461 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
44462 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
44463 @samp{cfpscr}.
44464
44465 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
44466 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
44467 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
44468 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
44469 wide.
44470
44471 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44472 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
44473 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
44474 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
44475 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
44476 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
44477 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
44478 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
44479 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
44480
44481 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44482 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
44483
44484 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44485 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
44486
44487 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
44488 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
44489
44490
44491 @node RISC-V Features
44492 @subsection RISC-V Features
44493 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
44494
44495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
44496 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
44497 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
44498 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
44499 etc).
44500
44501 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
44502 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
44503 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
44504 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
44505
44506 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
44507 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
44508 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
44509 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
44510 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
44511 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
44512 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
44513 least significant two bits.
44514
44515 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
44516 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
44517 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
44518 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
44519 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
44520 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
44521 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
44522 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
44523 other floating point hardware.
44524
44525 @node RX Features
44526 @subsection RX Features
44527 @cindex target descriptions, RX Features
44528
44529 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.rx.core} feature is required for RX
44530 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through
44531 @samp{r15}, @samp{usp}, @samp{isp}, @samp{psw}, @samp{pc}, @samp{intb},
44532 @samp{bpsw}, @samp{bpc}, @samp{fintv}, @samp{fpsw}, and @samp{acc}.
44533
44534 @node S/390 and System z Features
44535 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
44536 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
44537 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
44538
44539 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
44540 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
44541 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
44542 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
44543 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
44544 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
44545 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
44546 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
44547 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
44548
44549 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
44550 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
44551 @samp{fpc}.
44552
44553 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
44554 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
44555
44556 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
44557 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
44558 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
44559 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
44560 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
44561 32-bit wide.
44562
44563 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
44564 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
44565 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
44566
44567 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
44568 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
44569 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
44570 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
44571 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
44572 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
44573 @samp{v31}.
44574
44575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
44576 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
44577 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
44578
44579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
44580 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
44581 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
44582
44583 @node Sparc Features
44584 @subsection Sparc Features
44585 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
44586 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
44587 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44588 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44589
44590 @itemize @minus
44591 @item
44592 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
44593 @item
44594 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
44595 @item
44596 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
44597 @item
44598 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
44599 @end itemize
44600
44601 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44602
44603 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44604 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44605
44606 @itemize @minus
44607 @item
44608 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
44609 @item
44610 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
44611 @end itemize
44612
44613 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44614 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44615
44616 @itemize @minus
44617 @item
44618 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
44619 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
44620 @item
44621 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
44622 for sparc64
44623 @end itemize
44624
44625 @node TIC6x Features
44626 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
44627 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
44628 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
44629 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
44630 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
44631 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
44632
44633 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
44634 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
44635 through @samp{B31}.
44636
44637 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
44638 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
44639
44640 @node Operating System Information
44641 @appendix Operating System Information
44642 @cindex operating system information
44643
44644 @menu
44645 * Process list::
44646 @end menu
44647
44648 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
44649 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
44650 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
44651 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
44652 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
44653 on a different aspect of target.
44654
44655 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
44656 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
44657 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
44658 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
44659
44660 @node Process list
44661 @appendixsection Process list
44662 @cindex operating system information, process list
44663
44664 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
44665 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
44666 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
44667 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
44668
44669 An example document is:
44670
44671 @smallexample
44672 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44673 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
44674 <osdata type="processes">
44675 <item>
44676 <column name="pid">1</column>
44677 <column name="user">root</column>
44678 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
44679 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
44680 </item>
44681 </osdata>
44682 @end smallexample
44683
44684 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
44685 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
44686 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
44687 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
44688 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
44689 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
44690 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
44691
44692 @node Trace File Format
44693 @appendix Trace File Format
44694 @cindex trace file format
44695
44696 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
44697 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
44698
44699 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
44700 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
44701 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
44702 in the future.
44703
44704 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
44705 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
44706 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
44707 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
44708 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
44709 of this section.
44710
44711 @table @code
44712 @item R @var{size}
44713 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
44714 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
44715 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
44716 a single trace file.
44717
44718 @item status @var{status}
44719 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
44720 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
44721 file.
44722
44723 @item tp @var{payload}
44724 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44725 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
44726 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44727 reply packets.
44728
44729 @item tsv @var{payload}
44730 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44731 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
44732 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44733 reply packets.
44734
44735 @item tdesc @var{payload}
44736 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
44737 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
44738 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
44739 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
44740 file. Includes are not allowed.
44741
44742 @end table
44743
44744 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
44745 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
44746 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
44747 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
44748 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
44749 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
44750 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
44751 endianness.
44752
44753 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
44754
44755 @table @code
44756 @item R @var{bytes}
44757 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
44758 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
44759 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
44760
44761 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
44762 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
44763 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
44764 @var{length} bytes.
44765
44766 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
44767 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
44768 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
44769
44770 @end table
44771
44772 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
44773 of blocks.
44774
44775 @node Index Section Format
44776 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
44777 @cindex .gdb_index section format
44778 @cindex index section format
44779
44780 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
44781 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
44782 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
44783 description.
44784
44785 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
44786 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
44787 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
44788 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
44789 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
44790 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
44791
44792 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
44793
44794 @enumerate
44795 @item
44796 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
44797 unless otherwise noted:
44798
44799 @enumerate
44800 @item
44801 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
44802 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
44803 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
44804 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
44805 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
44806 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
44807 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
44808
44809 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
44810 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
44811 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
44812 currently not flagged as deprecated.
44813
44814 @item
44815 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
44816
44817 @item
44818 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
44819 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
44820 to the next offset.
44821
44822 @item
44823 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
44824
44825 @item
44826 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
44827
44828 @item
44829 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
44830 @end enumerate
44831
44832 @item
44833 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
44834 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
44835 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
44836 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
44837 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
44838 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
44839 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
44840 CU indices.
44841
44842 @item
44843 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
44844 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
44845 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
44846 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
44847
44848 @item
44849 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
44850 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
44851
44852 @enumerate
44853 @item
44854 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
44855
44856 @item
44857 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
44858 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
44859
44860 @item
44861 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
44862 @end enumerate
44863
44864 @item
44865 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
44866 the hash table is always a power of 2.
44867
44868 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
44869 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
44870 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
44871 constant pool.
44872
44873 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
44874 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
44875 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
44876
44877 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
44878 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
44879 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
44880 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
44881 index version:
44882
44883 @table @asis
44884 @item Version 4
44885 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
44886
44887 @item Versions 5 to 7
44888 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
44889 @end table
44890
44891 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
44892
44893 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
44894 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
44895 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
44896 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
44897 collision.
44898
44899 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
44900 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
44901 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
44902 the code.
44903
44904 @item
44905 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
44906 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
44907 strings.
44908
44909 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
44910 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
44911 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
44912 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
44913 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
44914 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
44915
44916 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
44917 @end enumerate
44918
44919 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
44920 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
44921 CU index+attributes value for each use.
44922
44923 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
44924 (bit 0 = LSB):
44925
44926 @table @asis
44927
44928 @item Bits 0-23
44929 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
44930 @item Bits 24-27
44931 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
44932 @item Bits 28-30
44933 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
44934
44935 @table @asis
44936 @item 0
44937 This value is reserved and should not be used.
44938 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
44939 with previous versions of the index.
44940 @item 1
44941 The symbol is a type.
44942 @item 2
44943 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
44944 @item 3
44945 The symbol is a function.
44946 @item 4
44947 Any other kind of symbol.
44948 @item 5,6,7
44949 These values are reserved.
44950 @end table
44951
44952 @item Bit 31
44953 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
44954
44955 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
44956 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
44957 @value{GDBN} sources.
44958
44959 @end table
44960
44961 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
44962 global/static attributes in the index.
44963
44964 @smallexample
44965 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
44966 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
44967 switch (die->tag)
44968 @{
44969 case DW_TAG_typedef:
44970 case DW_TAG_base_type:
44971 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
44972 kind = TYPE;
44973 is_static = 1;
44974 break;
44975 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44976 kind = VARIABLE;
44977 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44978 break;
44979 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44980 kind = FUNCTION;
44981 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44982 break;
44983 case DW_TAG_constant:
44984 kind = VARIABLE;
44985 is_static = ! is_external;
44986 break;
44987 case DW_TAG_variable:
44988 kind = VARIABLE;
44989 is_static = ! is_external;
44990 break;
44991 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44992 kind = TYPE;
44993 is_static = 0;
44994 break;
44995 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44996 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44997 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44998 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44999 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
45000 kind = TYPE;
45001 is_static = language != CPLUS;
45002 break;
45003 default:
45004 assert (0);
45005 @}
45006 @end smallexample
45007
45008 @node Man Pages
45009 @appendix Manual pages
45010 @cindex Man pages
45011
45012 @menu
45013 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
45014 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
45015 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
45016 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
45017 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
45018 @end menu
45019
45020 @node gdb man
45021 @heading gdb man
45022
45023 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
45024
45025 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
45026 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
45027 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
45028 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
45029 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
45030 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
45031 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
45032 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
45033 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
45034 @c man end
45035
45036 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
45037 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
45038 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
45039 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
45040
45041 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
45042 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
45043
45044 @itemize @bullet
45045 @item
45046 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
45047
45048 @item
45049 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
45050
45051 @item
45052 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
45053
45054 @item
45055 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
45056 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
45057 @end itemize
45058
45059 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
45060 Modula-2.
45061
45062 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
45063 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
45064 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
45065 by using the command @code{help}.
45066
45067 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
45068 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
45069 executable program as the argument:
45070
45071 @smallexample
45072 gdb program
45073 @end smallexample
45074
45075 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
45076
45077 @smallexample
45078 gdb program core
45079 @end smallexample
45080
45081 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
45082 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
45083
45084 @smallexample
45085 gdb program 1234
45086 gdb -p 1234
45087 @end smallexample
45088
45089 @noindent
45090 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
45091 can omit the @var{program} filename.
45092
45093 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
45094
45095 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
45096 @table @env
45097 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45098 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
45099
45100 @item run [@var{arglist}]
45101 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
45102
45103 @item bt
45104 Backtrace: display the program stack.
45105
45106 @item print @var{expr}
45107 Display the value of an expression.
45108
45109 @item c
45110 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
45111
45112 @item next
45113 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
45114 function calls in the line.
45115
45116 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45117 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
45118
45119 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45120 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
45121
45122 @item step
45123 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
45124 function calls in the line.
45125
45126 @item help [@var{name}]
45127 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
45128 about using @value{GDBN}.
45129
45130 @item quit
45131 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
45132 @end table
45133
45134 @ifset man
45135 For full details on @value{GDBN},
45136 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45137 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
45138 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
45139 @end ifset
45140 @c man end
45141
45142 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
45143 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
45144 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
45145 encountered with no
45146 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
45147 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
45148 Many options have
45149 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
45150 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
45151 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
45152 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
45153 more usual convention.)
45154
45155 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
45156 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
45157 option is used.
45158
45159 @table @env
45160 @item -help
45161 @itemx -h
45162 List all options, with brief explanations.
45163
45164 @item -symbols=@var{file}
45165 @itemx -s @var{file}
45166 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
45167
45168 @item -write
45169 Enable writing into executable and core files.
45170
45171 @item -exec=@var{file}
45172 @itemx -e @var{file}
45173 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
45174 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
45175 dump.
45176
45177 @item -se=@var{file}
45178 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
45179 file.
45180
45181 @item -core=@var{file}
45182 @itemx -c @var{file}
45183 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
45184
45185 @item -command=@var{file}
45186 @itemx -x @var{file}
45187 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
45188
45189 @item -ex @var{command}
45190 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
45191
45192 @item -directory=@var{directory}
45193 @itemx -d @var{directory}
45194 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
45195
45196 @item -nh
45197 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
45198
45199 @item -nx
45200 @itemx -n
45201 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
45202
45203 @item -quiet
45204 @itemx -q
45205 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
45206 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
45207
45208 @item -batch
45209 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
45210 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
45211 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
45212 commands in the command files.
45213
45214 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
45215 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
45216 more useful, the message
45217
45218 @smallexample
45219 Program exited normally.
45220 @end smallexample
45221
45222 @noindent
45223 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
45224 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
45225
45226 @item -cd=@var{directory}
45227 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
45228 instead of the current directory.
45229
45230 @item -fullname
45231 @itemx -f
45232 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
45233 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
45234 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
45235 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
45236 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
45237 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
45238 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
45239 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
45240
45241 @item -b @var{bps}
45242 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
45243 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
45244
45245 @item -tty=@var{device}
45246 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
45247 @end table
45248 @c man end
45249
45250 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
45251 @ifset man
45252 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45253 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45254 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45255
45256 @smallexample
45257 info gdb
45258 @end smallexample
45259
45260 @noindent
45261 should give you access to the complete manual.
45262
45263 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45264 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45265 @end ifset
45266 @c man end
45267
45268 @node gdbserver man
45269 @heading gdbserver man
45270
45271 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
45272 @format
45273 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
45274 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45275
45276 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45277
45278 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45279 @c man end
45280 @end format
45281
45282 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
45283 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
45284 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
45285
45286 @ifclear man
45287 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
45288 @end ifclear
45289 @ifset man
45290 Usage (server (target) side):
45291 @end ifset
45292
45293 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
45294 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
45295 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
45296 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
45297
45298 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
45299 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
45300 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
45301
45302 @smallexample
45303 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
45304 @end smallexample
45305
45306 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
45307
45308 @smallexample
45309 @ifset man
45310 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
45311 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
45312 @end ifset
45313 @ifclear man
45314 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
45315 @end ifclear
45316 @end smallexample
45317
45318 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
45319 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
45320 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
45321
45322 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
45323
45324 @smallexample
45325 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
45326 @end smallexample
45327
45328 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
45329 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
45330 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
45331 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
45332 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
45333 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
45334 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
45335 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
45336 print an error message and exit.
45337
45338 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
45339 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
45340
45341 @smallexample
45342 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45343 @end smallexample
45344
45345 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45346 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45347
45348 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45349 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
45350 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
45351 the program you want to debug.
45352
45353 @smallexample
45354 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45355 @end smallexample
45356
45357 @ifclear man
45358 @subheading Usage (host side)
45359 @end ifclear
45360 @ifset man
45361 Usage (host side):
45362 @end ifset
45363
45364 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
45365 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
45366 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
45367 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
45368 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
45369 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
45370 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
45371 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
45372 descriptor. For example:
45373
45374 @smallexample
45375 @ifset man
45376 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
45377 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
45378 @end ifset
45379 @ifclear man
45380 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
45381 @end ifclear
45382 @end smallexample
45383
45384 @noindent
45385 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
45386
45387 @smallexample
45388 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
45389 @end smallexample
45390
45391 @noindent
45392 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
45393 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
45394 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
45395 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
45396 `Connection refused'.
45397
45398 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
45399 described in
45400 @ifset man
45401 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
45402 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
45403 @end ifset
45404 @ifclear man
45405 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
45406 @end ifclear
45407 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
45408
45409 @smallexample
45410 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
45411 @end smallexample
45412
45413 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
45414 case.
45415 @c man end
45416
45417 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
45418 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
45419
45420 @itemize @bullet
45421
45422 @item
45423 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
45424
45425 @smallexample
45426 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45427 @end smallexample
45428
45429 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
45430 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
45431 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
45432 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
45433 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
45434 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
45435 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45436
45437 @item
45438 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
45439 program:
45440
45441 @smallexample
45442 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45443 @end smallexample
45444
45445 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
45446 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
45447 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
45448 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45449
45450 @item
45451 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
45452
45453 @smallexample
45454 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45455 @end smallexample
45456
45457 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
45458 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
45459 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
45460 debug several processes in the same session.
45461 @end itemize
45462
45463 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
45464
45465 @table @env
45466
45467 @item --help
45468 List all options, with brief explanations.
45469
45470 @item --version
45471 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
45472
45473 @item --attach
45474 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
45475
45476 @smallexample
45477 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45478 @end smallexample
45479
45480 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45481 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45482
45483 @item --multi
45484 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45485 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
45486 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
45487 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
45488
45489 @smallexample
45490 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45491 @end smallexample
45492
45493 @item --debug
45494 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
45495 process.
45496 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45497 the developers.
45498
45499 @item --remote-debug
45500 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
45501 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45502 the developers.
45503
45504 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
45505 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
45506 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45507 the developers.
45508
45509 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
45510 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
45511 of debugging output.
45512 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
45513
45514 @item --wrapper
45515 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
45516 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
45517 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
45518 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
45519
45520 @item --once
45521 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
45522 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
45523 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
45524 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
45525
45526 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
45527
45528 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
45529 @c QDisableRandomization.
45530
45531 @end table
45532 @c man end
45533
45534 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
45535 @ifset man
45536 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45537 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45538 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45539
45540 @smallexample
45541 info gdb
45542 @end smallexample
45543
45544 should give you access to the complete manual.
45545
45546 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45547 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45548 @end ifset
45549 @c man end
45550
45551 @node gcore man
45552 @heading gcore
45553
45554 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
45555
45556 @format
45557 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
45558 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
45559 @c man end
45560 @end format
45561
45562 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
45563 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
45564 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
45565 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
45566 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
45567 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
45568 its job the program remains running without any change.
45569 @c man end
45570
45571 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
45572 @table @env
45573 @item -a
45574 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
45575 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
45576 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
45577 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
45578 dump-excluded-mappings}).
45579
45580 @item -o @var{prefix}
45581 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
45582 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
45583 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
45584 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
45585 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
45586 @end table
45587 @c man end
45588
45589 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
45590 @ifset man
45591 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45592 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45593 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45594
45595 @smallexample
45596 info gdb
45597 @end smallexample
45598
45599 @noindent
45600 should give you access to the complete manual.
45601
45602 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45603 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45604 @end ifset
45605 @c man end
45606
45607 @node gdbinit man
45608 @heading gdbinit
45609
45610 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
45611
45612 @format
45613 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
45614 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45615 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45616 @end ifset
45617
45618 ~/.gdbinit
45619
45620 ./.gdbinit
45621 @c man end
45622 @end format
45623
45624 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
45625 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
45626 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
45627 described in
45628 @ifset man
45629 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
45630 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
45631 @end ifset
45632 @ifclear man
45633 @ref{Sequences}.
45634 @end ifclear
45635
45636 Please read more in
45637 @ifset man
45638 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
45639 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
45640 @end ifset
45641 @ifclear man
45642 @ref{Startup}.
45643 @end ifclear
45644
45645 @table @env
45646 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45647 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45648 @end ifset
45649 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45650 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
45651 @end ifclear
45652 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45653 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
45654 See more in
45655 @ifset man
45656 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
45657 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
45658 @end ifset
45659 @ifclear man
45660 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
45661 @end ifclear
45662
45663 @item ~/.gdbinit
45664 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45665 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
45666
45667 @item ./.gdbinit
45668 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
45669 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
45670 See more in
45671 @ifset man
45672 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
45673 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
45674 @end ifset
45675 @ifclear man
45676 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
45677 @end ifclear
45678 @end table
45679 @c man end
45680
45681 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
45682 @ifset man
45683 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
45684
45685 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45686 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45687 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45688
45689 @smallexample
45690 info gdb
45691 @end smallexample
45692
45693 should give you access to the complete manual.
45694
45695 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45696 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45697 @end ifset
45698 @c man end
45699
45700 @node gdb-add-index man
45701 @heading gdb-add-index
45702 @pindex gdb-add-index
45703 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
45704
45705 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
45706
45707 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
45708 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
45709 @c man end
45710
45711 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
45712 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
45713 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
45714 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
45715 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
45716 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
45717
45718 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
45719 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
45720 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
45721 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
45722 named @code{.debug_*}).
45723
45724 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
45725 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
45726 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
45727 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
45728
45729 See more in
45730 @ifset man
45731 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
45732 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
45733 @end ifset
45734 @ifclear man
45735 @ref{Index Files}.
45736 @end ifclear
45737 @c man end
45738
45739 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
45740 @ifset man
45741 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45742 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45743 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45744
45745 @smallexample
45746 info gdb
45747 @end smallexample
45748
45749 should give you access to the complete manual.
45750
45751 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45752 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45753 @end ifset
45754 @c man end
45755
45756 @include gpl.texi
45757
45758 @node GNU Free Documentation License
45759 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
45760 @include fdl.texi
45761
45762 @node Concept Index
45763 @unnumbered Concept Index
45764
45765 @printindex cp
45766
45767 @node Command and Variable Index
45768 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
45769
45770 @printindex fn
45771
45772 @tex
45773 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
45774 % meantime:
45775 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
45776 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
45777 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
45778 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
45779 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
45780 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
45781 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
45782 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
45783 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
45784 \page\colophon
45785 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
45786 @end tex
45787
45788 @bye
This page took 0.911103 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.